REJ09B0252-0130 16 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group Hardware Manual RENESAS 16-BIT SINGLE-CHIP MICROCOMPUTER R8C FAMILY / R8C/1x SERIES All information contained in these materials, including products and product specifications, represents information on the product at the time of publication and is subject to change by Renesas Technology Corp. without notice. Please review the latest information published by Renesas Technology Corp. through various means, including the Renesas Technology Corp. website (http://www.renesas.com). Rev.1.30 Revision Date: Dec 08, 2006 www.renesas.com Notes regarding these materials 1. This document is provided for reference purposes only so that Renesas customers may select the appropriate Renesas products for their use. Renesas neither makes warranties or representations with respect to the accuracy or completeness of the information contained in this document nor grants any license to any intellectual property rights or any other rights of Renesas or any third party with respect to the information in this document. 2. Renesas shall have no liability for damages or infringement of any intellectual property or other rights arising out of the use of any information in this document, including, but not limited to, product data, diagrams, charts, programs, algorithms, and application circuit examples. 3. You should not use the products or the technology described in this document for the purpose of military applications such as the development of weapons of mass destruction or for the purpose of any other military use. When exporting the products or technology described herein, you should follow the applicable export control laws and regulations, and procedures required by such laws and regulations. 4. All information included in this document such as product data, diagrams, charts, programs, algorithms, and application circuit examples, is current as of the date this document is issued. Such information, however, is subject to change without any prior notice. Before purchasing or using any Renesas products listed in this document, please confirm the latest product information with a Renesas sales office. Also, please pay regular and careful attention to additional and different information to be disclosed by Renesas such as that disclosed through our website. (http://www.renesas.com ) 5. Renesas has used reasonable care in compiling the information included in this document, but Renesas assumes no liability whatsoever for any damages incurred as a result of errors or omissions in the information included in this document. 6. When using or otherwise relying on the information in this document, you should evaluate the information in light of the total system before deciding about the applicability of such information to the intended application. Renesas makes no representations, warranties or guaranties regarding the suitability of its products for any particular application and specifically disclaims any liability arising out of the application and use of the information in this document or Renesas products. 7. With the exception of products specified by Renesas as suitable for automobile applications, Renesas products are not designed, manufactured or tested for applications or otherwise in systems the failure or malfunction of which may cause a direct threat to human life or create a risk of human injury or which require especially high quality and reliability such as safety systems, or equipment or systems for transportation and traffic, healthcare, combustion control, aerospace and aeronautics, nuclear power, or undersea communication transmission. If you are considering the use of our products for such purposes, please contact a Renesas sales office beforehand. Renesas shall have no liability for damages arising out of the uses set forth above. 8. Notwithstanding the preceding paragraph, you should not use Renesas products for the purposes listed below: (1) artificial life support devices or systems (2) surgical implantations (3) healthcare intervention (e.g., excision, administration of medication, etc.) (4) any other purposes that pose a direct threat to human life Renesas shall have no liability for damages arising out of the uses set forth in the above and purchasers who elect to use Renesas products in any of the foregoing applications shall indemnify and hold harmless Renesas Technology Corp., its affiliated companies and their officers, directors, and employees against any and all damages arising out of such applications. 9. You should use the products described herein within the range specified by Renesas, especially with respect to the maximum rating, operating supply voltage range, movement power voltage range, heat radiation characteristics, installation and other product characteristics. Renesas shall have no liability for malfunctions or damages arising out of the use of Renesas products beyond such specified ranges. 10. Although Renesas endeavors to improve the quality and reliability of its products, IC products have specific characteristics such as the occurrence of failure at a certain rate and malfunctions under certain use conditions. Please be sure to implement safety measures to guard against the possibility of physical injury, and injury or damage caused by fire in the event of the failure of a Renesas product, such as safety design for hardware and software including but not limited to redundancy, fire control and malfunction prevention, appropriate treatment for aging degradation or any other applicable measures. Among others, since the evaluation of microcomputer software alone is very difficult, please evaluate the safety of the final products or system manufactured by you. 11. In case Renesas products listed in this document are detached from the products to which the Renesas products are attached or affixed, the risk of accident such as swallowing by infants and small children is very high. You should implement safety measures so that Renesas products may not be easily detached from your products. Renesas shall have no liability for damages arising out of such detachment. 12. This document may not be reproduced or duplicated, in any form, in whole or in part, without prior written approval from Renesas. 13. Please contact a Renesas sales office if you have any questions regarding the information contained in this document, Renesas semiconductor products, or if you have any other inquiries. General Precautions in the Handling of MPU/MCU Products The following usage notes are applicable to all MPU/MCU products from Renesas. For detailed usage notes on the products covered by this manual, refer to the relevant sections of the manual. If the descriptions under General Precautions in the Handling of MPU/MCU Products and in the body of the manual differ from each other, the description in the body of the manual takes precedence. 1. Handling of Unused Pins Handle unused pins in accord with the directions given under Handling of Unused Pins in the manual. The input pins of CMOS products are generally in the high-impedance state. In operation with an unused pin in the open-circuit state, extra electromagnetic noise is induced in the vicinity of LSI, an associated shoot-through current flows internally, and malfunctions occur due to the false recognition of the pin state as an input signal become possible. Unused pins should be handled as described under Handling of Unused Pins in the manual. 2. Processing at Power-on The state of the product is undefined at the moment when power is supplied. The states of internal circuits in the LSI are indeterminate and the states of register settings and pins are undefined at the moment when power is supplied. In a finished product where the reset signal is applied to the external reset pin, the states of pins are not guaranteed from the moment when power is supplied until the reset process is completed. In a similar way, the states of pins in a product that is reset by an on-chip power-on reset function are not guaranteed from the moment when power is supplied until the power reaches the level at which resetting has been specified. 3. Prohibition of Access to Reserved Addresses Access to reserved addresses is prohibited. The reserved addresses are provided for the possible future expansion of functions. Do not access these addresses; the correct operation of LSI is not guaranteed if they are accessed. 4. Clock Signals After applying a reset, only release the reset line after the operating clock signal has become stable. When switching the clock signal during program execution, wait until the target clock signal has stabilized. When the clock signal is generated with an external resonator (or from an external oscillator) during a reset, ensure that the reset line is only released after full stabilization of the clock signal. Moreover, when switching to a clock signal produced with an external resonator (or by an external oscillator) while program execution is in progress, wait until the target clock signal is stable. 5. Differences between Products Before changing from one product to another, i.e. to one with a different type number, confirm that the change will not lead to problems. The characteristics of MPU/MCU in the same group but having different type numbers may differ because of the differences in internal memory capacity and layout pattern. When changing to products of different type numbers, implement a system-evaluation test for each of the products. How to Use This Manual 1. Purpose and Target Readers This manual is designed to provide the user with an understanding of the hardware functions and electrical characteristics of the MCU. It is intended for users designing application systems incorporating the MCU. A basic knowledge of electric circuits, logical circuits, and MCUs is necessary in order to use this manual. The manual comprises an overview of the product; descriptions of the CPU, system control functions, peripheral functions, and electrical characteristics; and usage notes. Particular attention should be paid to the precautionary notes when using the manual. These notes occur within the body of the text, at the end of each section, and in the Usage Notes section. The revision history summarizes the locations of revisions and additions. It does not list all revisions. Refer to the text of the manual for details. The following documents apply to the R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group. Make sure to refer to the latest versions of these documents. The newest versions of the documents listed may be obtained from the Renesas Technology Web site. Document Type Datasheet Description Document Title Document No. REJ03B0144 Hardware overview and electrical characteristics R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group Datasheet R8C/1A Group, This hardware Hardware manual Hardware specifications (pin assignments, R8C/1B Group manual memory maps, peripheral function Hardware Manual specifications, electrical characteristics, timing charts) and operation description Note: Refer to the application notes for details on using peripheral functions. Software manual Description of CPU instruction set R8C/Tiny Series REJ09B0001 Software Manual Available from Renesas Application note Information on using peripheral functions and Technology Web site. application examples Sample programs Information on writing programs in assembly language and C Renesas Product specifications, updates on documents, technical update etc. 2. Notation of Numbers and Symbols The notation conventions for register names, bit names, numbers, and symbols used in this manual are described below. (1) Register Names, Bit Names, and Pin Names Registers, bits, and pins are referred to in the text by symbols. The symbol is accompanied by the word “register,” “bit,” or “pin” to distinguish the three categories. Examples the PM03 bit in the PM0 register P3_5 pin, VCC pin (2) Notation of Numbers The indication “b” is appended to numeric values given in binary format. However, nothing is appended to the values of single bits. The indication “h” is appended to numeric values given in hexadecimal format. Nothing is appended to numeric values given in decimal format. Examples Binary: 11b Hexadecimal: EFA0h Decimal: 1234 3. Register Notation The symbols and terms used in register diagrams are described below. XXX Register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 *1 b2 b1 b0 Symbol XXX 0 Bit Symbol XXX0 Address XXX Bit Name XXX bits XXX1 After Reset 00h Function RW 1 0: XXX 0 1: XXX 1 0: Do not set. 1 1: XXX RW RW (b2) Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0. When read, the content is undefined. (b3) Reserved bits Set to 0. RW XXX bits Function varies according to the operating mode. RW XXX4 *3 XXX5 WO XXX6 RW XXX7 XXX bit *2 b1 b0 0: XXX 1: XXX *4 RO *1 Blank: Set to 0 or 1 according to the application. 0: Set to 0. 1: Set to 1. X: Nothing is assigned. *2 RW: Read and write. RO: Read only. WO: Write only. −: Nothing is assigned. *3 • Reserved bit Reserved bit. Set to specified value. *4 • Nothing is assigned Nothing is assigned to the bit. As the bit may be used for future functions, if necessary, set to 0. • Do not set to a value Operation is not guaranteed when a value is set. • Function varies according to the operating mode. The function of the bit varies with the peripheral function mode. Refer to the register diagram for information on the individual modes. 4. List of Abbreviations and Acronyms Abbreviation ACIA bps CRC DMA DMAC GSM Hi-Z IEBus I/O IrDA LSB MSB NC PLL PWM SFR SIM UART VCO Full Form Asynchronous Communication Interface Adapter bits per second Cyclic Redundancy Check Direct Memory Access Direct Memory Access Controller Global System for Mobile Communications High Impedance Inter Equipment bus Input/Output Infrared Data Association Least Significant Bit Most Significant Bit Non-Connection Phase Locked Loop Pulse Width Modulation Special Function Registers Subscriber Identity Module Universal Asynchronous Receiver/Transmitter Voltage Controlled Oscillator Table of Contents SFR Page Reference 1. 2. 3. B-1 Overview 1 1.1 Applications .................................................................................................1 1.2 Performance Overview................................................................................2 1.3 Block Diagram .............................................................................................4 1.4 Product Information .....................................................................................5 1.5 Pin Assignments..........................................................................................9 1.6 Pin Functions.............................................................................................12 Central Processing Unit (CPU) 15 2.1 Data Registers (R0, R1, R2, and R3)........................................................16 2.2 Address Registers (A0 and A1).................................................................16 2.3 Frame Base Register (FB) ........................................................................16 2.4 Interrupt Table Register (INTB) .................................................................16 2.5 Program Counter (PC) ..............................................................................16 2.6 User Stack Pointer (USP) and Interrupt Stack Pointer (ISP).....................16 2.7 Static Base Register (SB)..........................................................................16 2.8 Flag Register (FLG)...................................................................................16 2.8.1 Carry Flag (C).....................................................................................16 2.8.2 Debug Flag (D) ...................................................................................16 2.8.3 Zero Flag (Z).......................................................................................16 2.8.4 Sign Flag (S).......................................................................................16 2.8.5 Register Bank Select Flag (B) ............................................................16 2.8.6 Overflow Flag (O) ...............................................................................16 2.8.7 Interrupt Enable Flag (I)......................................................................17 2.8.8 Stack Pointer Select Flag (U) .............................................................17 2.8.9 Processor Interrupt Priority Level (IPL) ..............................................17 2.8.10 Reserved Bit .......................................................................................17 Memory 18 3.1 R8C/1A Group...........................................................................................18 3.2 R8C/1B Group...........................................................................................19 A-1 4. Special Function Registers (SFRs) 20 5. Programmable I/O Ports 24 6. 5.1 Functions of Programmable I/O Ports .......................................................24 5.2 Effect on Peripheral Functions ..................................................................24 5.3 Pins Other than Programmable I/O Ports..................................................24 5.4 Port Settings..............................................................................................32 5.5 Unassigned Pin Handling ..........................................................................37 Resets 6.1 7. When Power Supply is Stable ............................................................40 6.1.2 Power On............................................................................................40 6.2 Power-On Reset Function .........................................................................42 6.3 Voltage Monitor 1 Reset ...........................................................................43 6.4 Voltage Monitor 2 Reset............................................................................43 6.5 Watchdog Timer Reset..............................................................................43 6.6 Software Reset..........................................................................................43 Voltage Detection Circuit 44 VCC Input Voltage.....................................................................................50 7.1.1 Monitoring Vdet1 ................................................................................50 7.1.2 Monitoring Vdet2 ................................................................................50 7.1.3 Digital Filter.........................................................................................50 7.2 Voltage Monitor 1 Reset............................................................................52 7.3 Voltage Monitor 2 Interrupt and Voltage Monitor 2 Reset .........................53 Processor Mode 8.1 9. Hardware Reset ........................................................................................40 6.1.1 7.1 8. 38 55 Processor Modes ......................................................................................55 Bus 57 10. Clock Generation Circuit 58 10.1 Main Clock.................................................................................................65 10.2 On-Chip Oscillator Clocks .........................................................................66 10.2.1 Low-Speed On-Chip Oscillator Clock .................................................66 10.2.2 High-Speed On-Chip Oscillator Clock ................................................66 A-2 10.3 CPU Clock and Peripheral Function Clock................................................67 10.3.1 System Clock......................................................................................67 10.3.2 CPU Clock ..........................................................................................67 10.3.3 Peripheral Function Clock (f1, f2, f4, f8, f32) ......................................67 10.3.4 fRING and fRING128..........................................................................67 10.3.5 fRING-fast...........................................................................................67 10.3.6 fRING-S ..............................................................................................67 10.4 Power Control............................................................................................68 10.4.1 Standard Operating Mode ..................................................................68 10.4.2 Wait Mode ..........................................................................................69 10.4.3 Stop Mode ..........................................................................................72 10.5 Oscillation Stop Detection Function ..........................................................74 10.5.1 10.6 How to Use Oscillation Stop Detection Function ................................74 Notes on Clock Generation Circuit ............................................................76 10.6.1 Stop Mode ..........................................................................................76 10.6.2 Wait Mode ..........................................................................................76 10.6.3 Oscillation Stop Detection Function....................................................76 10.6.4 Oscillation Circuit Constants...............................................................76 10.6.5 High-Speed On-Chip Oscillator Clock ................................................76 11. Protection 77 12. Interrupts 78 12.1 Interrupt Overview .....................................................................................78 12.1.1 Types of Interrupts..............................................................................78 12.1.2 Software Interrupts .............................................................................79 12.1.3 Special Interrupts................................................................................80 12.1.4 Peripheral Function Interrupt ..............................................................80 12.1.5 Interrupts and Interrupt Vectors..........................................................81 12.1.6 Interrupt Control..................................................................................83 12.2 INT Interrupt ..............................................................................................91 12.2.1 INT0 Interrupt .....................................................................................91 12.2.2 INT0 Input Filter..................................................................................92 12.2.3 INT1 Interrupt .....................................................................................93 12.2.4 INT3 Interrupt .....................................................................................94 12.3 Key Input Interrupt.....................................................................................96 A-3 12.4 Address Match Interrupt ............................................................................98 12.5 Notes on Interrupts..................................................................................100 12.5.1 Reading Address 00000h .................................................................100 12.5.2 SP Setting.........................................................................................100 12.5.3 External Interrupt and Key Input Interrupt ........................................100 12.5.4 Watchdog Timer Interrupt.................................................................100 12.5.5 Changing Interrupt Sources..............................................................101 12.5.6 Changing Interrupt Control Register Contents .................................102 13. Watchdog Timer 103 13.1 Count Source Protection Mode Disabled ................................................106 13.2 Count Source Protection Mode Enabled .................................................107 14. Timers 14.1 108 Timer X....................................................................................................109 14.1.1 Timer Mode ......................................................................................112 14.1.2 Pulse Output Mode...........................................................................113 14.1.3 Event Counter Mode.........................................................................115 14.1.4 Pulse Width Measurement Mode .....................................................116 14.1.5 Pulse Period Measurement Mode ....................................................119 14.1.6 Notes on Timer X..............................................................................122 14.2 Timer Z ....................................................................................................123 14.2.1 Timer Mode ......................................................................................128 14.2.2 Programmable Waveform Generation Mode....................................130 14.2.3 Programmable One-shot Generation Mode .....................................133 14.2.4 Programmable Wait One-Shot Generation Mode.............................136 14.2.5 Notes on Timer Z..............................................................................140 14.3 Timer C....................................................................................................141 14.3.1 Input Capture Mode..........................................................................147 14.3.2 Output Compare Mode .....................................................................149 14.3.3 Notes on Timer C .............................................................................151 15. Serial Interface 15.1 152 Clock Synchronous Serial I/O Mode .......................................................158 15.1.1 Polarity Select Function....................................................................161 15.1.2 LSB First/MSB First Select Function ................................................161 A-4 15.1.3 15.2 Continuous Receive Mode ...............................................................162 Clock Asynchronous Serial I/O (UART) Mode ........................................163 15.2.1 CNTR0 Pin Select Function..............................................................166 15.2.2 Bit Rate.............................................................................................167 15.3 Notes on Serial Interface.........................................................................168 16. Clock Synchronous Serial Interface 169 16.1 Mode Selection........................................................................................169 16.2 Clock Synchronous Serial I/O with Chip Select (SSU)............................170 16.2.1 Transfer Clock ..................................................................................179 16.2.2 SS Shift Register (SSTRSR) ............................................................181 16.2.3 Interrupt Requests ............................................................................182 16.2.4 Communication Modes and Pin Functions .......................................183 16.2.5 Clock Synchronous Communication Mode.......................................184 16.2.6 Operation in 4-Wire Bus Communication Mode ...............................191 16.2.7 SCS Pin Control and Arbitration .......................................................197 16.2.8 Notes on Clock Synchronous Serial I/O with Chip Select ................198 16.3 I2C bus Interface .....................................................................................199 16.3.1 Transfer Clock ..................................................................................209 16.3.2 Interrupt Requests ............................................................................210 16.3.3 I2C bus Interface Mode.....................................................................211 16.3.4 Clock Synchronous Serial Mode ......................................................222 16.3.5 Noise Canceller ................................................................................225 16.3.6 Bit Synchronization Circuit................................................................226 16.3.7 Examples of Register Setting ...........................................................227 16.3.8 Notes on I2C bus Interface ...............................................................231 17. A/D Converter 232 17.1 One-Shot Mode .......................................................................................236 17.2 Repeat Mode...........................................................................................238 17.3 Sample and Hold.....................................................................................240 17.4 A/D Conversion Cycles ...........................................................................240 17.5 Internal Equivalent Circuit of Analog Input Block ....................................241 17.6 Inflow Current Bypass Circuit ..................................................................242 17.7 Output Impedance of Sensor under A/D Conversion ..............................243 17.8 Notes on A/D Converter ..........................................................................244 A-5 18. Flash Memory 245 18.1 Overview .................................................................................................245 18.2 Memory Map ...........................................................................................247 18.3 Functions to Prevent Rewriting of Flash Memory....................................249 18.3.1 ID Code Check Function ..................................................................249 18.3.2 ROM Code Protect Function ............................................................250 18.4 CPU Rewrite Mode..................................................................................251 18.4.1 EW0 Mode........................................................................................252 18.4.2 EW1 Mode........................................................................................252 18.4.3 Software Commands ........................................................................261 18.4.4 Status Register .................................................................................266 18.4.5 Full Status Check .............................................................................267 18.5 Standard Serial I/O Mode........................................................................269 18.5.1 18.6 Parallel I/O Mode.....................................................................................273 18.6.1 18.7 ID Code Check Function ..................................................................269 ROM Code Protect Function ............................................................273 Notes on Flash Memory ..........................................................................274 18.7.1 CPU Rewrite Mode...........................................................................274 19. Electrical Characteristics 276 20. Usage Notes 296 20.1 Notes on Clock Generation Circuit ..........................................................296 20.1.1 Stop Mode ........................................................................................296 20.1.2 Wait Mode ........................................................................................296 20.1.3 Oscillation Stop Detection Function..................................................296 20.1.4 Oscillation Circuit Constants.............................................................296 20.1.5 High-Speed On-Chip Oscillator Clock ..............................................296 20.2 Notes on Interrupts..................................................................................297 20.2.1 Reading Address 00000h .................................................................297 20.2.2 SP Setting.........................................................................................297 20.2.3 External Interrupt and Key Input Interrupt ........................................297 20.2.4 Watchdog Timer Interrupt.................................................................297 20.2.5 Changing Interrupt Sources..............................................................298 20.2.6 Changing Interrupt Control Register Contents .................................299 20.3 Precautions on Timers ............................................................................300 A-6 20.3.1 Notes on Timer X..............................................................................300 20.3.2 Notes on Timer Z..............................................................................300 20.3.3 Notes on Timer C .............................................................................301 20.4 Notes on Serial Interface.........................................................................302 20.5 Precautions on Clock Synchronous Serial Interface ...............................303 20.5.1 Notes on Clock Synchronous Serial I/O with Chip Select ................303 20.5.2 Notes on I2C bus Interface ...............................................................304 20.6 Notes on A/D Converter ..........................................................................305 20.7 Notes on Flash Memory ..........................................................................306 20.7.1 20.8 CPU Rewrite Mode...........................................................................306 Notes on Noise........................................................................................308 20.8.1 Inserting a Bypass Capacitor between VCC and VSS Pins as a Countermeasure against Noise and Latch-Up .................................308 20.8.2 Countermeasures against Noise Error of Port Control Registers.....308 21. Notes on On-Chip Debugger 309 Appendix 1. Package Dimensions 310 Appendix 2. Connection Examples between Serial Writer and On-Chip Debugging Emulator 312 Appendix 3. Example of Oscillation Evaluation Circuit 313 Register Index 314 A-7 SFR Page Reference Address 0000h 0001h 0002h 0003h 0004h 0005h 0006h 0007h 0008h 0009h 000Ah 000Bh 000Ch 000Dh 000Eh 000Fh 0010h 0011h 0012h 0013h 0014h 0015h 0016h 0017h 0018h 0019h 001Ah 001Bh 001Ch 001Dh 001Eh 001Fh 0020h 0021h 0022h 0023h 0024h 0025h 0026h 0027h 0028h 0029h 002Ah 002Bh 002Ch 002Dh 002Eh 002Fh 0030h 0031h 0032h 0033h 0034h 0035h 0036h 0037h 0038h 0039h 003Ah 003Bh 003Ch 003Dh 003Eh 003Fh Register Symbol Page Processor Mode Register 0 Processor Mode Register 1 System Clock Control Register 0 System Clock Control Register 1 PM0 PM1 CM0 CM1 55 56 60 61 Address Match Interrupt Enable Register Protect Register AIER PRCR 99 77 Oscillation Stop Detection Register Watchdog Timer Reset Register Watchdog Timer Start Register Watchdog Timer Control Register Address Match Interrupt Register 0 OCD WDTR WDTS WDC RMAD0 62 105 105 104 99 Address Match Interrupt Register 1 RMAD1 99 Count Source Protection Mode Register CSPR 105 INT0 Input Filter Select Register INT0F 91 High-Speed On-Chip Oscillator Control Register 0 High-Speed On-Chip Oscillator Control Register 1 High-Speed On-Chip Oscillator Control Register 2 HRA0 63 HRA1 64 HRA2 64 Voltage Detection Register 1 Voltage Detection Register 2 VCA1 VCA2 47 47 Voltage Monitor 1 Circuit Control Register Voltage Monitor 2 Circuit Control Register VW1C VW2C 48 49 Address 0040h 0041h 0042h 0043h 0044h 0045h 0046h 0047h 0048h 0049h 004Ah 004Bh 004Ch 004Dh 004Eh 004Fh 0050h 0051h 0052h 0053h 0054h 0055h 0056h 0057h 0058h 0059h 005Ah 005Bh 005Ch 005Dh 005Eh 005Fh 0060h 0061h 0062h 0063h 0064h 0065h 0066h 0067h 0068h 0069h 006Ah 006Bh 006Ch 006Dh 006Eh 006Fh 0070h 0071h 0072h 0073h 0074h 0075h 0076h 0077h 0078h 0079h 007Ah 007Bh 007Ch 007Dh 007Eh 007Fh NOTE: 1. The blank regions are reserved. Do not access locations in these regions. B-1 Register Symbol Page Key Input Interrupt Control Register A/D Conversion Interrupt Control Register SSU/IIC Interrupt Control Register Compare 1 Interrupt Control Register UART0 Transmit Interrupt Control Register UART0 Receive Interrupt Control Register UART1 Transmit Interrupt Control Register UART1 Receive Interrupt Control Register KUPIC ADIC SSUAIC/IIC2AIC CMP1IC S0TIC S0RIC S1TIC S1RIC 83 83 83 83 83 83 83 83 Timer X Interrupt Control Register TXIC 83 Timer Z Interrupt Control Register INT1 Interrupt Control Register INT3 Interrupt Control Register Timer C Interrupt Control Register Compare 0 Interrupt Control Register INT0 Interrupt Control Register TZIC INT1IC INT3IC TCIC CMP0IC INT0IC 83 83 83 83 83 84 Address 0080h 0081h 0082h 0083h 0084h 0085h 0086h 0087h 0088h 0089h 008Ah 008Bh 008Ch 008Dh 008Eh 008Fh 0090h 0091h 0092h 0093h 0094h 0095h 0096h 0097h 0098h 0099h 009Ah 009Bh 009Ch 009Dh 009Eh 009Fh 00A0h 00A1h 00A2h 00A3h 00A4h 00A5h 00A6h 00A7h 00A8h 00A9h 00AAh 00ABh 00ACh 00ADh 00AEh 00AFh 00B0h 00B1h 00B2h 00B3h 00B4h 00B5h 00B6h 00B7h 00B8h 00B9h 00BAh 00BBh 00BCh 00BDh 00BEh 00BFh Register Timer Z Mode Register Symbol TZMR Page 124 Timer Z Waveform Output Control Register Prescaler Z Register Timer Z Secondary Register Timer Z Primary Register PUM PREZ TZSC TZPR 126 125 125 125 Timer Z Output Control Register Timer X Mode Register Prescaler X Register Timer X Register Timer Count Source Setting Register TZOC TXMR PREX TX TCSS 126 110 111 111 111,127 Timer C Register TC 143 External Input Enable Register INTEN 91 Key Input Enable Register KIEN 97 Timer C Control Register 0 Timer C Control Register 1 Capture, Compare 0 Register TCC0 TCC1 TM0 144 145 143 Compare 1 Register TM1 143 UART0 Transmit/Receive Mode Register UART0 Bit Rate Register UART0 Transmit Buffer Register U0MR U0BRG U0TB 155 154 154 UART0 Transmit/Receive Control Register 0 UART0 Transmit/Receive Control Register 1 UART0 Receive Buffer Register U0C0 U0C1 U0RB 156 157 154 UART1 Transmit/Receive Mode Register UART1 Bit Rate Register UART1 Transmit Buffer Register U1MR U1BRG U1TB 155 154 154 UART1 Transmit/Receive Control Register 0 UART1 Transmit/Receive Control Register 1 UART1 Receive Buffer Register U1C0 U1C1 U1RB 156 157 154 UART Transmit/Receive Control Register 2 UCON 157 SS Control Register H / IIC bus Control Register 1 SS Control Register L / IIC bus Control Register 2 SS Mode Register / IIC bus Mode Register SS Enable Register / IIC bus Interrupt Enable Register SS Status Register / IIC bus Status Register SS Mode Register 2 / Slave Address Register SS Transmit Data Register / IIC bus Transmit Data Register SS Receive Data Register / IIC bus Receive Data Register SSCRH / ICCR1 172, 202 SSCRL / ICCR2 173, 203 SSMR / ICMR SSER / ICIER 174, 204 175, 205 SSSR / ICSR SSMR2 / SAR 176, 206 177, 207 SSTDR / ICDRT 178, 207 SSRDR / ICDRR 178, 208 NOTE: 1. The blank regions, 0100h to 01B2h, and 01C0h to 02FFh are reserved. Do not access locations in these regions. Address 00C0h 00C1h 00C2h 00C3h 00C4h 00C5h 00C6h 00C7h 00C8h 00C9h 00CAh 00CBh 00CCh 00CDh 00CEh 00CFh 00D0h 00D1h 00D2h 00D3h 00D4h 00D5h 00D6h 00D7h 00D8h 00D9h 00DAh 00DBh 00DCh 00DDh 00DEh 00DFh 00E0h 00E1h 00E2h 00E3h 00E4h 00E5h 00E6h 00E7h 00E8h 00E9h 00EAh 00EBh 00ECh 00EDh 00EEh 00EFh 00F0h 00F1h 00F2h 00F3h 00F4h 00F5h 00F6h 00F7h 00F8h 00F9h 00FAh 00FBh 00FCh 00FDh 00FEh 00FFh Register A/D Register Symbol AD A/D Control Register 2 ADCON2 235 A/D Control Register 0 A/D Control Register 1 ADCON0 ADCON1 234 234 Port P1 Register P1 29 Port P1 Direction Register PD1 29 Port P3 Register P3 29 Port P3 Direction Register Port P4 Register PD3 P4 29 30 Port P4 Direction Register PD4 29 Port Mode Register PMR 30, 178, 208 Pull-Up Control Register 0 Pull-Up Control Register 1 Port P1 Drive Capacity Control Register Timer C Output Control Register PUR0 PUR1 DRR TCOUT 31 31 31 146 01B3h 01B4h 01B5h 01B6h 01B7h Flash Memory Control Register 4 FMR4 257 Flash Memory Control Register 1 FMR1 256 Flash Memory Control Register 0 FMR0 255 0FFFFh Optional Function Select Register OFS B-2 Page 235 104, 250 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group SINGLE-CHIP 16-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER 1. REJ09B0252-0130 Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 Overview These MCUs are fabricated using the high-performance silicon gate CMOS process, embedding the R8C/ Tiny Series CPU core, and is packaged in a 20-pin molded-plastic LSSOP, SDIP or a 28-pin plastic molded-HWQFN. It implements sophisticated instructions for a high level of instruction efficiency. With 1 Mbyte of address space, they are capable of executing instructions at high speed. Furthermore, the R8C/1B Group has on-chip data flash ROM (1 KB × 2 blocks). The difference between the R8C/1A Group and R8C/1B Group is only the presence or absence of data flash ROM. Their peripheral functions are the same. 1.1 Applications Electric household appliances, office equipment, housing equipment (sensors, security systems), portable equipment, general industrial equipment, audio equipment, etc. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 1 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 1.2 1. Overview Performance Overview Table 1.1 outlines the Functions and Specifications for R8C/1A Group and Table 1.2 outlines the Functions and Specifications for R8C/1B Group. Table 1.1 CPU Functions and Specifications for R8C/1A Group Item Number of fundamental instructions Minimum instruction execution time Operating mode Address space Memory capacity Ports Specification 89 instructions 50 ns (f(XIN) = 20 MHz, VCC = 3.0 to 5.5 V) 100 ns (f(XIN) = 10 MHz, VCC = 2.7 to 5.5 V) Single-chip 1 Mbyte See Table 1.3 Product Information for R8C/1A Group Peripheral I/O ports: 13 pins (including LED drive port) Functions Input port: 3 pins LED drive ports I/O ports: 4 pins Timers Timer X: 8 bits × 1 channel, timer Z: 8 bits × 1 channel (Each timer equipped with 8-bit prescaler) Timer C: 16 bits × 1 channel (Input capture and output compare circuits) Serial interfaces 1 channel Clock synchronous serial I/O, UART 1 channel UART Clock synchronous serial interface 1 channel I2C bus Interface(1) Clock synchronous serial I/O with chip select (SSU) A/D converter 10-bit A/D converter: 1 circuit, 4 channels Watchdog timer 15 bits × 1 channel (with prescaler) Reset start selectable, count source protection mode Internal: 11 sources, External: 4 sources, Software: 4 sources, Interrupts Priority levels: 7 levels Clock generation circuits 2 circuits • Main clock oscillation circuit (with on-chip feedback resistor) • On-chip oscillator (high speed, low speed) High-speed on-chip oscillator has a frequency adjustment function Oscillation stop detection function Main clock oscillation stop detection function Voltage detection circuit On-chip Power-on reset circuit On-chip Electric Supply voltage VCC = 3.0 to 5.5 V (f(XIN) = 20 MHz) Characteristics VCC = 2.7 to 5.5 V (f(XIN) = 10 MHz) Current consumption Typ. 9 mA (VCC = 5.0 V, f(XIN) = 20 MHz, A/D converter stopped) Typ. 5 mA (VCC = 3.0 V, f(XIN) = 10 MHz, A/D converter stopped) Typ. 35 µA (VCC = 3.0 V, wait mode, peripheral clock off) Typ. 0.7 µA (VCC = 3.0 V, stop mode) Flash Memory Programming and erasure voltage VCC = 2.7 to 5.5 V Programming and erasure 100 times endurance Operating Ambient Temperature -20 to 85°C -40 to 85°C (D version) -20 to 105°C (Y version) (2) Package 20-pin molded-plastic LSSOP 20-pin molded-plastic SDIP 28-pin molded-plastic HWQFN NOTE: 1. I2C bus is a trademark of Koninklijke Philips Electronics N. V. 2. Please contact Renesas Technology sales offices for the Y version. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 2 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group Table 1.2 CPU 1. Overview Functions and Specifications for R8C/1B Group Item Number of fundamental instructions Minimum instruction execution time Operating mode Address space Memory capacity Ports Specification 89 instructions 50 ns (f(XIN) = 20 MHz, VCC = 3.0 to 5.5 V) 100 ns (f(XIN) = 10 MHz, VCC = 2.7 to 5.5 V) Single-chip 1 Mbyte See Table 1.4 Product Information for R8C/1B Group Peripheral I/O ports: 13 pins (including LED drive port) Functions Input port: 3 pins LED drive ports I/O ports: 4 pins Timers Timer X: 8 bits × 1 channel, timer Z: 8 bits × 1 channel (Each timer equipped with 8-bit prescaler) Timer C: 16 bits × 1 channel (Input capture and output compare circuits) Serial interfaces 1 channel Clock synchronous serial I/O, UART 1 channel UART Clock synchronous serial interface 1 channel I2C bus Interface(1) Clock synchronous serial I/O with chip select (SSU) A/D converter 10-bit A/D converter: 1 circuit, 4 channels Watchdog timer 15 bits × 1 channel (with prescaler) Reset start selectable, count source protection mode Internal: 11 sources, External: 4 sources, Software: 4 sources, Interrupts Priority levels: 7 levels Clock generation circuits 2 circuits • Main clock generation circuit (with on-chip feedback resistor) • On-chip oscillator (high speed, low speed) High-speed on-chip oscillator has a frequency adjustment function Oscillation stop detection function Main clock oscillation stop detection function Voltage detection circuit On-chip Power on reset circuit On-chip Electric Supply voltage VCC = 3.0 to 5.5 V (f(XIN) = 20 MHz) Characteristics VCC = 2.7 to 5.5 V (f(XIN) = 10 MHz) Current consumption Typ. 9 mA (VCC = 5.0 V, f(XIN) = 20 MHz, A/D converter stopped) Typ. 5 mA (VCC = 3.0 V, f(XIN) = 10 MHz, A/D converter stopped) Typ. 35 µA (VCC = 3.0 V, wait mode, peripheral clock off) Typ. 0.7 µA (VCC = 3.0 V, stop mode) Flash Memory Programming and erasure voltage VCC = 2.7 to 5.5 V Programming and erasure 10,000 times (data flash) endurance 1,000 times (program ROM) Operating Ambient Temperature -20 to 85°C -40 to 85°C (D version) -20 to 105°C (Y version) (2) Package 20-pin molded-plastic LSSOP 20-pin molded-plastic SDIP 28-pin molded-plastic HWQFN NOTE: 1. I2C bus is a trademark of Koninklijke Philips Electronics N. V. 2. Please contact Renesas Technology sales offices for the Y version. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 3 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 1.3 1. Overview Block Diagram Figure 1.1 shows a Block Diagram. I/O ports 8 4 Port P1 Port P3 1 3 Port P4 Peripheral Functions Timers A/D converter (10 bits × 4 channels) Timer X (8 bits) Timer Z (8 bits) Timer C (16 bits) UART or clock synchronous serial I/O (8 bits × 1 channel) System clock generator XIN-XOUT High-speed on-chip oscillator Low-speed on-chip oscillator SSU (8 bits × 1 channel) or I2C bus UART (8 bits × 1 channel) Watchdog timer (15 bits) R8C/Tiny Series CPU core R0H R1H R0L R1L R2 R3 SB ROM(1) USP ISP INTB A0 A1 FB Memory RAM(2) PC FLG Multiplier NOTES: 1. ROM size varies with MCU type. 2. RAM size varies with MCU type. Figure 1.1 Block Diagram Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 4 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 1.4 1. Overview Product Information Table 1.3 lists Product Information for R8C/1A Group and Table 1.4 lists Product Information for R8C/1B Group. Table 1.3 Product Information for R8C/1A Group R5F211A1SP R5F211A2SP R5F211A3SP R5F211A4SP R5F211A1DSP R5F211A2DSP R5F211A3DSP R5F211A4DSP R5F211A1DD R5F211A2DD R5F211A3DD R5F211A4DD R5F211A2NP R5F211A3NP R5F211A4NP R5F211A1XXXSP 4 Kbytes 8 Kbytes 12 Kbytes 16 Kbytes 4 Kbytes 8 Kbytes 12 Kbytes 16 Kbytes 4 Kbytes 8 Kbytes 12 Kbytes 16 Kbytes 8 Kbytes 12 Kbytes 16 Kbytes 4 Kbytes RAM Capacity 384 bytes 512 bytes 768 bytes 1 Kbyte 384 bytes 512 bytes 768 bytes 1 Kbyte 384 bytes 512 bytes 768 bytes 1 Kbyte 512 bytes 768 bytes 1 Kbyte 384 bytes R5F211A2XXXSP R5F211A3XXXSP R5F211A4XXXSP R5F211A1DXXXSP R5F211A2DXXXSP R5F211A3DXXXSP R5F211A4DXXXSP R5F211A1XXXDD R5F211A2XXXDD R5F211A3XXXDD R5F211A4XXXDD R5F211A2XXXNP R5F211A3XXXNP R5F211A4XXXNP 8 Kbytes 12 Kbytes 16 Kbytes 4 Kbytes 8 Kbytes 12 Kbytes 16 Kbytes 4 Kbytes 8 Kbytes 12 Kbytes 16 Kbytes 8 Kbytes 12 Kbytes 16 Kbytes 512 bytes 768 bytes 1 Kbyte 384 bytes 512 bytes 768 bytes 1 Kbyte 384 bytes 512 bytes 768 bytes 1 Kbyte 512 bytes 768 bytes 1 Kbyte Type No. ROM Capacity Package Type 1. The user ROM is programmed before shipment. Page 5 of 315 Remarks PLSP0020JB-A PLSP0020JB-A PLSP0020JB-A PLSP0020JB-A PLSP0020JB-A D version PLSP0020JB-A PLSP0020JB-A PLSP0020JB-A PRDP0020BA-A PRDP0020BA-A PRDP0020BA-A PRDP0020BA-A PWQN0028KA-B PWQN0028KA-B PWQN0028KA-B PLSP0020JB-A Factory programming product (1) PLSP0020JB-A PLSP0020JB-A PLSP0020JB-A PLSP0020JB-A D version PLSP0020JB-A PLSP0020JB-A PLSP0020JB-A PRDP0020BA-A Factory programming product (1) PRDP0020BA-A PRDP0020BA-A PRDP0020BA-A PWQN0028KA-B PWQN0028KA-B PWQN0028KA-B NOTE: Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Current of December 2006 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group Type No. 1. Overview R 5 F 21 1A 4 D XXX SP Package type: SP: PLSP0020JB-A DD: PRDP0020BA-A NP: PWQN0028KA-B ROM number Classification D: Operating ambient temperature -40°C to 85°C No Symbol: Operating ambient temperature -20°C to 85°C Y: Operating ambient temperature -20°C to 105°C (Note) ROM capacity 1: 4 KB 2: 8 KB 3: 12 KB 4: 16 KB R8C/1A Group R8C/Tiny Series Memory type F: Flash memory version Renesas MCU Renesas semiconductors NOTE: Please contact Renesas Technology sales offices for the Y version. Figure 1.2 Type Number, Memory Size, and Package of R8C/1A Group Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 6 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group Table 1.4 1. Overview Product Information for R8C/1B Group Type No. R5F211B1SP R5F211B2SP R5F211B3SP R5F211B4SP R5F211B1DSP R5F211B2DSP R5F211B3DSP R5F211B4DSP R5F211B1DD R5F211B2DD R5F211B3DD R5F211B4DD R5F211B2NP R5F211B3NP R5F211B4NP R5F211B1XXXSP R5F211B2XXXSP R5F211B3XXXSP R5F211B4XXXSP R5F211B1DXXXSP R5F211B2DXXXSP R5F211B3DXXXSP R5F211B4DXXXSP R5F211B1XXXDD R5F211B2XXXDD R5F211B3XXXDD R5F211B4XXXDD R5F211B2XXXNP R5F211B3XXXNP R5F211B4XXXNP ROM Capacity Program ROM Data Flash 4 Kbytes 1 Kbyte × 2 8 Kbytes 1 Kbyte × 2 12 Kbytes 1 Kbyte × 2 16 Kbytes 1 Kbyte × 2 4 Kbytes 1 Kbyte × 2 8 Kbytes 1 Kbyte × 2 12 Kbytes 1 Kbyte × 2 16 Kbytes 1 Kbyte × 2 4 Kbytes 1 Kbyte × 2 8 Kbytes 1 Kbyte × 2 12 Kbytes 1 Kbyte × 2 16 Kbytes 1 Kbyte × 2 8 Kbytes 1 Kbyte × 2 12 Kbytes 1 Kbyte × 2 16 Kbytes 1 Kbyte × 2 4 Kbytes 1 Kbyte × 2 8 Kbytes 1 Kbyte × 2 12 Kbytes 1 Kbyte × 2 16 Kbytes 1 Kbyte × 2 4 Kbytes 1 Kbyte × 2 8 Kbytes 1 Kbyte × 2 12 Kbytes 1 Kbyte × 2 16 Kbytes 1 Kbyte × 2 4 Kbytes 1 Kbyte × 2 8 Kbytes 1 Kbyte × 2 12 Kbytes 1 Kbyte × 2 16 Kbytes 1 Kbyte × 2 8 Kbytes 1 Kbyte × 2 12 Kbytes 1 Kbyte × 2 16 Kbytes 1 Kbyte × 2 RAM Capacity 384 bytes 512 bytes 768 bytes 1 Kbyte 384 bytes 512 bytes 768 bytes 1 Kbyte 384 bytes 512 bytes 768 bytes 1 Kbyte 512 bytes 768 bytes 1 Kbyte 384 bytes 512 bytes 768 bytes 1 Kbyte 384 bytes 512 bytes 768 bytes 1 Kbyte 384 bytes 512 bytes 768 bytes 1 Kbyte 512 bytes 768 bytes 1 Kbyte NOTE: 1. The user ROM is programmed before shipment. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 7 of 315 Current of December 2006 Package Type PLSP0020JB-A PLSP0020JB-A PLSP0020JB-A PLSP0020JB-A PLSP0020JB-A PLSP0020JB-A PLSP0020JB-A PLSP0020JB-A PRDP0020BA-A PRDP0020BA-A PRDP0020BA-A PRDP0020BA-A PWQN0028KA-B PWQN0028KA-B PWQN0028KA-B PLSP0020JB-A PLSP0020JB-A PLSP0020JB-A PLSP0020JB-A PLSP0020JB-A PLSP0020JB-A PLSP0020JB-A PLSP0020JB-A PRDP0020BA-A PRDP0020BA-A PRDP0020BA-A PRDP0020BA-A PWQN0028KA-B PWQN0028KA-B PWQN0028KA-B Remarks D version Factory programming product (1) D version Factory programming product (1) R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group Type No. 1. Overview R 5 F 21 1B 4 D XXX SP Package type: SP: PLSP0020JB-A DD: PRDP0020BA-A NP: PWQN0028KA-B ROM number Classification D: Operating ambient temperature -40°C to 85°C No Symbol: Operating ambient temperature -20 °C to 85°C Y: Operating ambient temperature -20°C to 105°C (Note) ROM capacity 1: 4 KB 2: 8 KB 3: 12 KB 4: 16 KB R8C/1B Group R8C/Tiny Series Memory Type F: Flash memory version Renesas MCU Renesas semiconductors NOTE: Please contact Renesas Technology sales offices for the Y version. Figure 1.3 Type Number, Memory Size, and Package of R8C/1B Group Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 8 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 1.5 1. Overview Pin Assignments Figure 1.4 shows Pin Assignments for PLSP0020JB-A Package (Top View), Figure 1.5 shows Pin Assignments for PRDP0020BA-A Package (Top View) and Figure 1.6 shows Pin Assignments for PWQN0028KA-B Package (Top View). PIN assignments (top view) 1 20 P3_4/SCS/SDA/CMP1_1 P3_7/CNTR0/SSO/TXD1 2 19 P3_3/TCIN/INT3/SSI00/CMP1_0 RESET 3 18 P1_0/KI0/AN8/CMP0_0 XOUT/P4_7(1) 4 17 P1_1/KI1/AN9/CMP0_1 VSS/AVSS 5 16 P4_2/VREF XIN/P4_6 6 15 P1_2/KI2/AN10/CMP0_2 VCC/AVCC 7 14 P1_3/KI3/AN11/TZOUT MODE 8 13 P1_4/TXD0 P4_5/INT0/RXD1 9 12 P1_5/RXD0/CNTR01/INT11 10 11 P1_6/CLK0/SSI01 P1_7/CNTR00/INT10 R8C/1A Group R8C/1B Group P3_5/SSCK/SCL/CMP1_2 NOTE: 1. P4_7 is an input-only port. Package: PLSP0020JB-A (20P2F-A) Figure 1.4 Pin Assignments for PLSP0020JB-A Package (Top View) Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 9 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 1. Overview PIN assignments (top view) 1 20 P3_4/SCS/SDA/CMP1_1 P3_7/CNTR0/SSO/TXD1 2 19 P3_3/TCIN/INT3/SSI00/CMP1_0 RESET 3 18 P1_0/KI0/AN8/CMP0_0 XOUT/P4_7(1) 4 17 P1_1/KI1/AN9/CMP0_1 VSS/AVSS 5 16 P4_2/VREF XIN/P4_6 6 15 P1_2/KI2/AN10/CMP0_2 VCC/AVCC 7 14 P1_3/KI3/AN11/TZOUT MODE 8 13 P1_4/TXD0 P4_5/INT0/RXD1 9 12 P1_5/RXD0/CNTR01/INT11 10 11 P1_6/CLK0/SSI01 P1_7/CNTR00/INT10 R8C/1A Group R8C/1B Group P3_5/SSCK/SCL/CMP1_2 NOTE: 1. P4_7 is an input-only port. Package: PRDP0020BA-A (20P4B) Figure 1.5 Pin Assignments for PRDP0020BA-A Package (Top View) Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 10 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 1. Overview NC P1_3/AN11/KI3/TZOUT P1_2/AN10/KI2/CMP0_2 NC NC P4_2/VREF NC PIN Assignment (top view) 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 P1_1/AN9/KI1/CMP0_1 22 14 P1_4/TXD0 P1_0/AN8/KI0/CMP0_0 23 13 P1_5/RXD0/CNTR01/INT11 P3_3/TCIN/INT3/SSI00/CMP1_0 24 12 P1_6/CLK0/SSI01 P3_4/SCS/SDA/CMP1_1 25 11 P1_7/CNTR00/INT10 P3_5/SSCK/SCL/CMP1_2 26 10 P4_5/INT0/RXD1 P3_7/CNTR0/SSO/TXD1 27 9 MODE RESET 28 8 VCC/AVCC 3 4 5 6 (1) VSS/AVSS NC NC XIN/P4_6 7 NC 2 XOUT/P4_7 1 NC R8C/1A Group R8C/1B Group NOTES: 1. P4_7 is a port for the input. Package: PWQN0028KA-B(28PJW-B) Figure 1.6 Pin Assignments for PWQN0028KA-B Package (Top View) Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 11 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 1.6 1. Overview Pin Functions Table 1.5 lists Pin Functions, Table 1.6 lists Pin Name Information by Pin Number of PLSP0020JB-A, PRDP0020BA-A Packages and Table 1.7 lists Pin Name Information by Pin Number of PWQN0028KAB Package. Table 1.5 Pin Functions Type Symbol I/O Type Description Power Supply Input VCC, VSS I Apply 2.7 V to 5.5 V to the VCC pin. Apply 0 V to the VSS pin. Analog Power Supply Input AVCC, AVSS I Power supply for the A/D converter Connect a capacitor between AVCC and AVSS. Reset Input RESET I Input “L” on this pin resets the MCU. MODE MODE I Connect this pin to VCC via a resistor. Main Clock Input XIN I Main Clock Output XOUT O These pins are provided for main clock generation circuit I/O. Connect a ceramic resonator or a crystal oscillator between the XIN and XOUT pins. To use an external clock, input it to the XIN pin and leave the XOUT pin open. INT Interrupt INT0, INT1, INT3 I INT interrupt input pins Key Input Interrupt KI0 to KI3 I Key input interrupt input pins Timer X CNTR0 I/O Timer X I/O pin CNTR0 O Timer X output pin Timer Z TZOUT O Timer Z output pin Timer C TCIN I Timer C input pin CMP0_0 to CMP0_2, CMP1_0 to CMP1_2 O Timer C output pins CLK0 I/O Transfer clock I/O pin Serial Interface RXD0, RXD1 I Serial data input pins TXD0, TXD1 O Serial data output pins I/O Data I/O pin. I/O Chip-select signal I/O pin I/O Clock I/O pin SSO I/O Data I/O pin SCL I/O Clock I/O pin SDA I/O Data I/O pin Clock synchronous SSI00, SSI01 serial I/O with chip SCS select (SSU) SSCK I2C bus Interface Reference Voltage Input VREF I Reference voltage input pin to A/D converter A/D Converter AN8 to AN11 I Analog input pins to A/D converter I/O Port P1_0 to P1_7, P3_3 to P3_5, P3_7, P4_5 Input Port P4_2, P4_6, P4_7 I: Input O: Output Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 I/O I I/O: Input and output Page 12 of 315 CMOS I/O ports. Each port has an I/O select direction register, allowing each pin in the port to be directed for input or output individually. Any port set to input can be set to use a pull-up resistor or not by a program. P1_0 to P1_3 also function as LED drive ports. Input-only ports R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group Table 1.6 Pin Number Pin Name Information by Pin Number of PLSP0020JB-A, PRDP0020BA-A Packages Control Pin 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 1. Overview Port Interrupt P3_5 P3_7 RESET XOUT VSS/AVSS XIN VCC/AVCC MODE I/O Pin Functions for Peripheral Modules Clock Synchronous I2C bus Serial A/D Timer Interface Serial I/O with Interface Converter Chip Select CMP1_2 SSCK SCL TXD1 SSO CNTR0 P4_7 P4_6 P4_5 INT0 10 P1_7 INT10 CNTR00 11 12 P1_6 P1_5 INT11 CNTR01 13 14 P1_4 P1_3 KI3 TZOUT AN11 15 P1_2 KI2 CMP0_2 AN10 P4_2 P1_1 KI1 CMP0_1 AN9 18 P1_0 KI0 CMP0_0 AN8 19 P3_3 INT3 20 P3_4 TCIN/ CMP1_0 CMP1_1 16 17 VREF Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 RXD1 CLK0 RXD0 SSI01 TXD0 Page 13 of 315 SSI00 SCS SDA R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group Table 1.7 Pin Number 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 1. Overview Pin Name Information by Pin Number of PWQN0028KA-B Package Control Pin NC XOUT VSS/AVSS NC NC XIN NC VCC/AVCC MODE Port Interrupt I/O Pin Functions for Peripheral Modules Clock Serial Synchronous I2C bus A/D Timer Interface Serial I/O with Interface Converter Chip Select P4_7 P4_6 P4_5 INT0 11 P1_7 INT10 CNTR00 12 13 P1_6 P1_5 INT11 CNTR01 14 15 16 P1_4 RXD1 CLK0 RXD0 SSI01 TXD0 NC P1_3 KI3 TZOUT AN11 P1_2 KI2 CMP0_2 AN10 P1_1 KI1 CMP0_1 AN9 23 P1_0 KI0 CMP0_0 AN8 24 P3_3 INT3 TCIN/CMP1_0 SSI00 25 P3_4 CMP1_1 26 27 P3_5 P3_7 CMP1_2 SCS SSCK SSO 17 18 19 20 21 22 28 NC NC VREF NC P4_2 RESET Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 14 of 315 CNTR0 TXD1 SDA SCL R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 2. 2. Central Processing Unit (CPU) Central Processing Unit (CPU) Figure 2.1 shows the CPU Registers. The CPU contains 13 registers. R0, R1, R2, R3, A0, A1, and FB configure a register bank. There are two sets of register bank. b31 b15 R2 R3 b8b7 b0 R0H (high-order of R0) R0L (low-order of R0) R1H (high-order of R1) R1L (low-order of R1) Data registers (1) R2 R3 A0 A1 FB b19 b15 Address registers (1) Frame base register (1) b0 Interrupt table register INTBL INTBH The 4 high order bits of INTB are INTBH and the 16 low bits of INTB are INTBL. b19 b0 Program counter PC b15 b0 USP User stack pointer ISP Interrupt stack pointer SB Static base register b15 b0 FLG b15 b8 IPL b7 Flag register b0 U I O B S Z D C Carry flag Debug flag Zero flag Sign flag Register bank select flag Overflow flag Interrupt enable flag Stack pointer select flag Reserved bit Processor interrupt priority level Reserved bit NOTE: 1. These registers comprise a register bank. There are two register banks. Figure 2.1 CPU Register Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 15 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 2.1 2. Central Processing Unit (CPU) Data Registers (R0, R1, R2, and R3) R0 is a 16-bit register for transfer, arithmetic, and logic operations. The same applies to R1 to R3. R0 can be split into high-order bits (R0H) and low-order bits (R0L) to be used separately as 8-bit data registers. R1H and R1L are analogous to R0H and R0L. R2 can be combined with R0 and used as a 32bit data register (R2R0). R3R1 is analogous to R2R0. 2.2 Address Registers (A0 and A1) A0 is a 16-bit register for address register indirect addressing and address register relative addressing. It is also used for transfer and arithmetic and logic operations. A1 is analogous to A0. A1 can be combined with A0 and used as a 32-bit address register (A1A0). 2.3 Frame Base Register (FB) FB is a 16-bit register for FB relative addressing. 2.4 Interrupt Table Register (INTB) INTB is a 20-bit register that indicates the start address of an interrupt vector table. 2.5 Program Counter (PC) PC is 20 bits wide indicates the address of the next instruction to be executed. 2.6 User Stack Pointer (USP) and Interrupt Stack Pointer (ISP) The stack pointer (SP), USP, and ISP, are each 16 bits wide. The U flag of FLG is used to switch between USP and ISP. 2.7 Static Base Register (SB) SB is a 16-bit register for SB relative addressing. 2.8 Flag Register (FLG) FLG is an 11-bit register indicating the CPU state. 2.8.1 Carry Flag (C) The C flag retains a carry, borrow, or shift-out bits that have been generated by the arithmetic and logic unit. 2.8.2 Debug Flag (D) The D flag is for debugging only. Set it to 0. 2.8.3 Zero Flag (Z) The Z flag is set to 1 when an arithmetic operation results in 0; otherwise to 0. 2.8.4 Sign Flag (S) The S flag is set to 1 when an arithmetic operation results in a negative value; otherwise to 0. 2.8.5 Register Bank Select Flag (B) Register bank 0 is selected when the B flag is 0. Register bank 1 is selected when this flag is set to 1. 2.8.6 Overflow Flag (O) The O flag is set to 1 when the operation results in an overflow; otherwise to 0. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 16 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 2.8.7 2. Central Processing Unit (CPU) Interrupt Enable Flag (I) The I flag enables maskable interrupts. Interrupts are disabled when the I flag is set to 0, and are enabled when the I flag is set to 1. The I flag is set to 0 when an interrupt request is acknowledged. 2.8.8 Stack Pointer Select Flag (U) ISP is selected when the U flag is set to 0; USP is selected when the U flag is set to 1. The U flag is set to 0 when a hardware interrupt request is acknowledged or the INT instruction of software interrupt numbers 0 to 31 is executed. 2.8.9 Processor Interrupt Priority Level (IPL) IPL is 3 bits wide, assigns processor interrupt priority levels from level 0 to level 7. If a requested interrupt has higher priority than IPL, the interrupt is enabled. 2.8.10 Reserved Bit If necessary, set to 0. When read, the content is undefined. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 17 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 3. 3. Memory Memory 3.1 R8C/1A Group Figure 3.1 is a Memory Map of R8C/1A Group. The R8C/1A Group has 1 Mbyte of address space from addresses 00000h to FFFFFh. The internal ROM is allocated lower addresses, beginning with address 0FFFFh. For example, a 16Kbyte internal ROM area is allocated addresses 0C000h to 0FFFFh. The fixed interrupt vector table is allocated addresses 0FFDCh to 0FFFFh. They store the starting address of each interrupt routine. The internal RAM is allocated higher addresses, beginning with address 00400h. For example, a 1Kbyte internal RAM area is allocated addresses 00400h to 007FFh. The internal RAM is used not only for storing data but also for calling subroutines and as stacks when interrupt requests are acknowledged. Special function registers (SFRs) are allocated addresses 00000h to 002FFh. The peripheral function control registers are allocated here. All addresses within the SFR, which have nothing allocated are reserved for future use and cannot be accessed by users. 00000h SFR (See 4. Special Function Registers (SFRs)) 002FFh 00400h Internal RAM 0XXXXh 0FFDCh Undefined instruction Overflow BRK instruction Address match Single step Watchdog timer•oscillation stop detection•voltage monitor 2 0YYYYh Address break (Reserved) Reset Internal ROM 0FFFFh 0FFFFh Expanded area FFFFFh NOTE: 1. The blank regions are reserved. Do not access locations in these regions. Internal ROM Part Number Internal RAM Size Address 0YYYYh Size Address 0XXXXh 16 Kbytes 0C000h 1 Kbyte 007FFh 12 Kbytes 0D000h 768 bytes 006FFh 8 Kbytes 0E000h 512 bytes 005FFh 4 Kbytes 0F000h 384 bytes 0057Fh R5F211A4SP, R5F211A4DSP, R5F211A4DD, R5F211A4NP, R5F211A4XXXSP, R5F211A4DXXXSP, R5F211A4XXXDD, R5F211A4XXXNP R5F211A3SP, R5F211A3DSP, R5F211A3DD, R5F211A3NP, R5F211A3XXXSP, R5F211A3DXXXSP, R5F211A3XXXDD, R5F211A3XXXNP R5F211A2SP, R5F211A2DSP, R5F211A2DD, R5F211A2NP, R5F211A2XXXSP, R5F211A2DXXXSP, R5F211A2XXXDD, R5F211A2XXXNP R5F211A1SP, R5F211A1DSP, R5F211A1DD, R5F211A1XXXSP, R5F211A1DXXXSP, R5F211A1XXXDD Figure 3.1 Memory Map of R8C/1A Group Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 18 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 3.2 3. Memory R8C/1B Group Figure 3.2 is a Memory Map of R8C/1B Group. The R8C/1B Group has 1 Mbyte of address space from addresses 00000h to FFFFFh. The internal ROM (program ROM) is allocated lower addresses, beginning with address 0FFFFh. For example, a 16-Kbyte internal ROM area is allocated addresses 0C000h to 0FFFFh. The fixed interrupt vector table is allocated addresses 0FFDCh to 0FFFFh. They store the starting address of each interrupt routine. The internal ROM (data flash) is allocated addresses 02400h to 02BFFh. The internal RAM is allocated higher addresses beginning with address 00400h. For example, a 1Kbyte internal RAM area is allocated addresses 00400h to 007FFh. The internal RAM is used not only for storing data but also for calling subroutines and as stacks when interrupt requests are acknowledged. Special function registers (SFRs) are allocated addresses 00000h to 002FFh. The peripheral function control registers are allocated here. All addresses within the SFR, which have nothing allocated are reserved for future use and cannot be accessed by users. 00000h SFR (See 4. Special Function Registers (SFRs)) 002FFh 00400h Internal RAM 0XXXXh 02400h 02BFFh Internal ROM (data Flash)(1) 0FFDCh Undefined instruction Overflow BRK instruction Address match Single step Watchdog timer • oscillation stop detection • voltage monitor 2 0YYYYh Address break (Reserved) Reset Internal ROM (program ROM) 0FFFFh 0FFFFh Expanded area FFFFFh NOTES: 1. Data flash block A (1 Kbyte) and B (1 Kbyte) are shown. 2. The blank regions are reserved. Do not access locations in these regions. Internal ROM Part Number Internal RAM Size Address 0YYYYh Size Address 0XXXXh 16 Kbytes 0C000h 1 Kbyte 007FFh 12 Kbytes 0D000h 768 bytes 006FFh 8 Kbytes 0E000h 512 bytes 005FFh 4 Kbytes 0F000h 384 bytes 0057Fh R5F211B4SP, R5F211B4DSP, R5F211B4DD, R5F211B4NP, R5F211B4XXXSP, R5F211B4DXXXSP, R5F211B4XXXDD, R5F211B4XXXNP R5F211B3SP, R5F211B3DSP, R5F211B3DD, R5F211B3NP, R5F211B3XXXSP, R5F211B3DXXXSP, R5F211B3XXXDD, R5F211B3XXXNP R5F211B2SP, R5F211B2DSP, R5F211B2DD, R5F211B2NP, R5F211B2XXXSP, R5F211B2DXXXSP, R5F211B2XXXDD, R5F211B2XXXNP R5F211B1SP, R5F211B1DSP, R5F211B1DD, R5F211B1XXXSP, R5F211B1DXXXSP, R5F211B1XXXDD Figure 3.2 Memory Map of R8C/1B Group Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 19 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 4. 4. Special Function Registers (SFRs) Special Function Registers (SFRs) An SFR (special function register) is a control register for a peripheral function. Tables 4.1 to 4.4 list the special function registers. Table 4.1 SFR Information (1)(1) Address 0000h 0001h 0002h 0003h 0004h 0005h 0006h 0007h 0008h 0009h 000Ah 000Bh 000Ch 000Dh 000Eh 000Fh 0010h 0011h 0012h 0013h 0014h 0015h 0016h 0017h 0018h 0019h 001Ah 001Bh 001Ch 001Dh 001Eh Register Symbol After reset Processor Mode Register 0 Processor Mode Register 1 System Clock Control Register 0 System Clock Control Register 1 PM0 PM1 CM0 CM1 00h 00h 01101000b 00100000b Address Match Interrupt Enable Register Protect Register AIER PRCR 00h 00h Oscillation Stop Detection Register Watchdog Timer Reset Register Watchdog Timer Start Register Watchdog Timer Control Register Address Match Interrupt Register 0 OCD WDTR WDTS WDC RMAD0 00000100b XXh XXh 00X11111b 00h 00h X0h Address Match Interrupt Register 1 RMAD1 00h 00h X0h Count Source Protection Mode Register CSPR 00h INT0 Input Filter Select Register INT0F 00h High-Speed On-Chip Oscillator Control Register 0 High-Speed On-Chip Oscillator Control Register 1 High-Speed On-Chip Oscillator Control Register 2 HRA0 HRA1 HRA2 00h When shipping 00h 002Ah 002Bh 002Ch 002Dh 002Eh 002Fh 0030h 0031h 0032h Voltage Detection Register 1(2) Voltage Detection Register 2(2) VCA1 VCA2 00001000b 0033h 0034h 0035h 0036h Voltage Monitor 1 Circuit Control Register (2) VW1C Voltage Monitor 2 Circuit Control Register (5) VW2C 0000X000b(3) 0100X001b(4) 00h 001Fh 0020h 0021h 0022h 0023h 0037h 0038h 0039h 003Ah 003Bh 003Ch 003Dh 003Eh 003Fh X: Undefined NOTES: 1. The blank regions are reserved. Do not access locations in these regions. 2. Software reset, watchdog timer reset, and voltage monitor 2 reset do not affect this register. 3. After hardware reset. 4. After power-on reset or voltage monitor 1 reset. 5. Software reset, watchdog timer reset, and voltage monitor 2 reset do not affect b2 and b3. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 20 of 315 00h(3) 01000000b(4) R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group Table 4.2 Address 0040h 0041h 0042h 0043h 0044h 0045h 0046h 0047h 0048h 0049h 004Ah 004Bh 004Ch 004Dh 004Eh 004Fh 0050h 0051h 0052h 0053h 0054h 0055h 0056h 0057h 0058h 0059h 005Ah 005Bh 005Ch 005Dh 005Eh 005Fh 0060h 0061h 0062h 0063h 0064h 0065h 0066h 0067h 0068h 0069h 006Ah 006Bh 006Ch 006Dh 006Eh 006Fh 0070h 0071h 0072h 0073h 0074h 0075h 0076h 0077h 0078h 0079h 007Ah 007Bh 007Ch 007Dh 007Eh 007Fh 4. Special Function Registers (SFRs) SFR Information (2)(1) Register Symbol After reset Key Input Interrupt Control Register A/D Conversion Interrupt Control Register SSU/IIC Interrupt Control Register(2) Compare 1 Interrupt Control Register UART0 Transmit Interrupt Control Register UART0 Receive Interrupt Control Register UART1 Transmit Interrupt Control Register UART1 Receive Interrupt Control Register KUPIC ADIC SSUAIC/IIC2AIC CMP1IC S0TIC S0RIC S1TIC S1RIC XXXXX000b XXXXX000b XXXXX000b XXXXX000b XXXXX000b XXXXX000b XXXXX000b XXXXX000b Timer X Interrupt Control Register TXIC XXXXX000b Timer Z Interrupt Control Register INT1 Interrupt Control Register INT3 Interrupt Control Register Timer C Interrupt Control Register Compare 0 Interrupt Control Register INT0 Interrupt Control Register TZIC INT1IC INT3IC TCIC CMP0IC INT0IC XXXXX000b XXXXX000b XXXXX000b XXXXX000b XXXXX000b XX00X000b X: Undefined NOTES: 1. The blank regions are reserved. Do not access locations in these regions. 2. Selected by the IICSEL bit in the PMR register. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 21 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group Table 4.3 Address 0080h 0081h 0082h 0083h 0084h 0085h 0086h 0087h 0088h 0089h 008Ah 008Bh 008Ch 008Dh 008Eh 008Fh 0090h 0091h 0092h 0093h 0094h 0095h 0096h 0097h 0098h 0099h 009Ah 009Bh 009Ch 009Dh 009Eh 009Fh 00A0h 00A1h 00A2h 00A3h 00A4h 00A5h 00A6h 00A7h 00A8h 00A9h 00AAh 00ABh 00ACh 00ADh 00AEh 00AFh 00B0h 00B1h 00B2h 00B3h 00B4h 00B5h 00B6h 00B7h 00B8h 00B9h 00BAh 00BBh 00BCh 00BDh 00BEh 00BFh 4. Special Function Registers (SFRs) SFR Information (3)(1) Timer Z Mode Register Register Symbol TZMR After reset 00h Timer Z Waveform Output Control Register Prescaler Z Register Timer Z Secondary Register Timer Z Primary Register PUM PREZ TZSC TZPR 00h FFh FFh FFh Timer Z Output Control Register Timer X Mode Register Prescaler X Register Timer X Register Timer Count Source Setting Register TZOC TXMR PREX TX TCSS 00h 00h FFh FFh 00h Timer C Register TC 00h 00h External Input Enable Register INTEN 00h Key Input Enable Register KIEN 00h Timer C Control Register 0 Timer C Control Register 1 Capture, Compare 0 Register TCC0 TCC1 TM0 Compare 1 Register TM1 UART0 Transmit/Receive Mode Register UART0 Bit Rate Generator UART0 Transmit Buffer Register U0MR U0BRG U0TB UART0 Transmit/Receive Control Register 0 UART0 Transmit/Receive Control Register 1 UART0 Receive Buffer Register U0C0 U0C1 U0RB UART1 Transmit/Receive Mode Register UART1 Bit Rate Generator UART1 Transmit Buffer Register U1MR U1BRG U1TB UART1 Transmit/Receive Control Register 0 UART1 Transmit/Receive Control Register 1 UART1 Receive Buffer Register U1C0 U1C1 U1RB UART Transmit/Receive Control Register 2 UCON 00h 00h 0000h(2) FFFFh(3) FFh FFh 00h XXh XXh XXh 00001000b 00000010b XXh XXh 00h XXh XXh XXh 00001000b 00000010b XXh XXh 00h SS Control Register H / IIC bus Control Register 1(4) SS Control Register L / IIC bus Control Register 2(4) SS Mode Register / IIC bus Mode Register(4) SS Enable Register / IIC bus Interrupt Enable Register(4) SS Status Register / IIC bus Status Register(4) SS Mode Register 2 / Slave Address Register(4) SS Transmit Data Register / IIC bus Transmit Data Register(4) SS Receive Data Register / IIC bus Receive Data Register(4) SSCRH / ICCR1 SSCRL / ICCR2 SSMR / ICMR SSER / ICIER SSSR / ICSR SSMR2 / SAR SSTDR / ICDRT SSRDR / ICDRR 00h 01111101b 00011000b 00h 00h / 0000X000b 00h FFh FFh X: Undefined NOTES: 1. The blank regions are reserved. Do not access locations in these regions. 2. In input capture mode. 3. In output compare mode. 4. Selected by the IICSEL bit in the PMR register. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 22 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group Table 4.4 Address 00C0h 00C1h 00C2h 00C3h 00C4h 00C5h 00C6h 00C7h 00C8h 00C9h 00CAh 00CBh 00CCh 00CDh 00CEh 00CFh 00D0h 00D1h 00D2h 00D3h 00D4h 00D5h 00D6h 00D7h 00D8h 00D9h 00DAh 00DBh 00DCh 00DDh 00DEh 00DFh 00E0h 00E1h 00E2h 00E3h 00E4h 00E5h 00E6h 00E7h 00E8h 00E9h 00EAh 00EBh 00ECh 00EDh 00EEh 00EFh 00F0h 00F1h 00F2h 00F3h 00F4h 00F5h 00F6h 00F7h 00F8h 00F9h 00FAh 00FBh 00FCh 00FDh 00FEh 00FFh 4. Special Function Registers (SFRs) SFR Information (4)(1) A/D Register Register Symbol AD After reset XXh XXh A/D Control Register 2 ADCON2 00h A/D Control Register 0 A/D Control Register 1 ADCON0 ADCON1 00000XXXb 00h Port P1 Register P1 XXh Port P1 Direction Register PD1 00h Port P3 Register P3 XXh Port P3 Direction Register Port P4 Register PD3 P4 00h XXh Port P4 Direction Register PD4 00h Port Mode Register PMR 00h Pull-Up Control Register 0 Pull-Up Control Register 1 Port P1 Drive Capacity Control Register Timer C Output Control Register PUR0 PUR1 DRR TCOUT 00XX0000b XXXXXX0Xb 00h 00h 01B3h 01B4h 01B5h 01B6h 01B7h Flash Memory Control Register 4 FMR4 01000000b Flash Memory Control Register 1 FMR1 1000000Xb Flash Memory Control Register 0 FMR0 00000001b 0FFFFh Optional Function Select Register OFS (2) X: Undefined NOTES: 1. Blank regions, 0100h to 01B2h and 01B8h to 02FFh are all reserved. Do not access locations in these regions. 2. The OFS register cannot be changed by a user program. Use a flash programmer to write to it. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 23 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 5. 5. Programmable I/O Ports Programmable I/O Ports There are 13 programmable Input/Output ports (I/O ports) P1, P3_3 to P3_5, P3_7, and P4_5. 4_2 can be used as an input-only port. Also, P4_6 and P4_7 can be used as input-only ports if the main clock oscillation circuit is not used. Table 5.1 lists an Overview of Programmable I/O Ports. Table 5.1 Overview of Programmable I/O Ports Ports I/O Type of Output I/O Setting Internal Pull-Up Resistor Drive Capacity Selection P1 I/O CMOS3 state Set per bit Set every 4 bits(1) P3_3, P4_5 I/O CMOS3 state Set per bit Set every bit(1) Set every bit(2) of P1_0 to P1_3 None P3_4, P3_5, P3_7 I/O CMOS3 state Set per bit P4_2, P4_6, P4_7(3) I (No output function) None Set every 3 bits(1) None None None NOTES: 1. In input mode, whether an internal pull-up resistor is connected or not can be selected by registers PUR0 and PUR1. 2. These ports can be used as the LED drive port by setting the DRR register to 1 (high). 3. When the main clock oscillation circuit is not used, P4_6 and P4_7 can be used as input -only ports. 5.1 Functions of Programmable I/O Ports The PDi_j (j=0 to 7) bit in the PDi (i=1, 3, and 4) register controls I/O of ports P1, P3_3 to P3_5, P3_7, and P4_5. The Pi register consists of a port latch to hold output data and a circuit to read pin states. Figures 5.1 to 5.3 show the Configurations of Programmable I/O Ports. Table 5.2 lists the Functions of Programmable I/O Ports. Also, Figure 5.5 shows Registers PD1, PD3, and PD4. Figure 5.6 shows Registers P1 and P3, Figure 5.9 shows Registers PUR0 and PUR1 and Figure 5.10 shows the DRR Register. Table 5.2 Functions of Programmable I/O Ports Operation when Accessing Pi Register Reading Writing Value of PDi_j Bit in PDi Register(1) When PDi_j Bit is Set to 0 (Input Mode) Read pin input level Write to the port latch When PDi_j Bit is Set to 1 (Output Mode) Read the port latch Write to the port latch. The value written to the port latch is output from the pin. NOTE: 1. Nothing is assigned to bits PD3_0 to PD3_2, PD3_6, PD4_0 to PD4_4, PD4_6, and PD4_7. 5.2 Effect on Peripheral Functions Programmable I/O ports function as I/O ports for peripheral functions (Refer to Table 1.6 Pin Name Information by Pin Number of PLSP0020JB-A, PRDP0020BA-A Packages). Table 5.3 lists the Settings of PDi_j Bit when Functioning as I/O Ports for Peripheral Functions. Refer to the description of each function for information on how to set peripheral functions. Table 5.3 Settings of PDi_j Bit when Functioning as I/O Ports for Peripheral Functions I/O of Peripheral Functions Input Output 5.3 PDi_j Bit Settings for Shared Pin Functions Set this bit to 0 (input mode). This bit can be set to either 0 or 1 (output regardless of the port setting). Pins Other than Programmable I/O Ports Figure 5.4 shows the Configuration of I/O Pins. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 24 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 5. Programmable I/O Ports P1_0 to P1_3 Pull-up selection Direction register 1 Output from individual peripheral function Data bus Port latch (Note 1) Drive capacity selection Input to individual peripheral function Analog input P1_4 Pull-up selection Direction register 1 Output from individual peripheral function Data bus Port latch (Note 1) P1_5 Pull-up selection Direction register Data bus Port latch (Note 1) Input to individual peripheral function NOTE : 1. symbolizes a parasitic diode. Ensure the input voltage to each port will not exceed VCC. Figure 5.1 Configuration of Programmable I/O Ports (1) Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 25 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 5. Programmable I/O Ports P1_6, P1_7 Pull-up selection Direction register 1 Output from individual peripheral function Data bus Port latch (Note 1) Input to individual peripheral function P3_3 Pull-up selection Direction register 1 Output from individual peripheral function Data bus Port latch (Note 1) Digital filter Input to individual peripheral function P3_4, P3_5, P3_7 Pull-up selection Direction register 1 Output from individual peripheral function Data bus Port latch (Note 1) Input to individual peripheral function NOTE : 1. symbolizes a parasitic diode. Ensure the input voltage to each port will not exceed VCC. Figure 5.2 Configuration of Programmable I/O Ports (2) Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 26 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 5. Programmable I/O Ports P4_2 Vref of A/D converter (Note 4) Data bus P4_5 Pull-up selection Direction register Port latch Data bus (Note 4) Input to individual peripheral function Digital filter P4_6/XIN Data bus (Note 4) Clocked inverter(1) (Note 2) P4_7/XOUT (Note 3) Data bus (Note 4) NOTES: 1. When CM05 = 1, CM10 = 1, or CM13 = 0, the clocked inverter is cut off. 2. When CM10 = 1 or CM13 = 0, the feedback resistor is disconnected. 3. When CM05 = CM13 = 1 or CM10 = CM13 = 1, this pin is pulled up. 4. symbolizes a parasitic diode. Ensure the input voltage to each port does not exceed VCC. Figure 5.3 Configuration of Programmable I/O Ports (3) Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 27 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 5. Programmable I/O Ports MODE MODE signal input (Note 1) RESET RESET signal input (Note 1) NOTE : 1. symbolizes a parasitic diode. Ensure the input voltage to each port will not exceed VCC. Figure 5.4 Configuration of I/O Pins Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 28 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 5. Programmable I/O Ports Port Pi Direction Register (i = 1, 3, 4)(1, 2) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol PD1 PD3 PD4 Bit Symbol PDi_0 PDi_1 PDi_2 PDi_3 PDi_4 PDi_5 PDi_6 PDi_7 Address 00E3h 00E7h 00EAh Bit Name Port Pi0 direction bit Port Pi1 direction bit Port Pi2 direction bit Port Pi3 direction bit Port Pi4 direction bit Port Pi5 direction bit Port Pi6 direction bit Port Pi7 direction bit After Reset 00h 00h 00h Function 0 : Input mode (functions as an input port) 1 : Output mode (functions as an output port) RW RW RW RW RW RW RW RW RW NOTES : 1. Bits PD3_0 to PD3_2, and PD3_6 in the PD3 register are unavailable on this MCU. If it is necessary to set bits PD3_0 to PD3_2, and PD3_6, set to 0 (input mode). When read, the content is 0. 2. Bits PD4_0 to PD4_4, PD4_6, and PD4_7 in the PD4 register are unavailable on this MCU. If it is necessary to set bits PD4_0 to PD4_4, PD4_6, and PD4_7, set to 0 (input mode). When read, the content is 0. Figure 5.5 Registers PD1, PD3, and PD4 Port Pi Register (i = 1, 3)(1) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol P1 P3 Bit Symbol Pi_0 Pi_1 Pi_2 Pi_3 Pi_4 Pi_5 Pi_6 Pi_7 Address 00E1h 00E5h Bit Name Port Pi0 bit Port Pi1 bit Port Pi2 bit Port Pi3 bit Port Pi4 bit Port Pi5 bit Port Pi6 bit Port Pi7 bit After Reset Undefined Undefined Function The pin level of any I/O port w hich is set to input mode can be read by reading the corresponding bit in this register. The pin level of any I/O port w hich is set to output mode can be controlled by w riting to the corresponding bit in this register. 0 : “L” level 1 : “H” level(1) NOTE : 1. Bits P3_0 to P3_2, and P3_6 in the P3 register are unavailable on this MCU. If it is necessary to set bits P3_0 to P3_2, and P3_6, set to 0 (“L” level). When read, the content is 0. Figure 5.6 Registers P1 and P3 Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 29 of 315 RW RW RW RW RW RW RW RW RW R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 5. Programmable I/O Ports Port P4 Register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol Address After Reset 00E8h Undefined P4 Bit Symbol Bit Name Function Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0 (“L” level). — When read, the content is 0. (b1-b0) Port P4_2 bit P4_2 — (b4-b3) Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0 (“L” level). When read, the content is 0. Port P4_5 bit P4_5 P4_6 P4_7 Figure 5.7 The level of the pin can be read by reading the bit. 0 : “L” level 1 : “H” level Port P4_6 bit Port P4_7 bit The pin level of any I/O port w hich is set to input mode can be read by reading the corresponding bit in this register. The pin level of any I/O port w hich is set to output mode can be controlled by w riting to the corresponding bit in this register. 0 : “L” level 1 : “H” level The level of the pin can be read by reading the bit. 0 : “L” level 1 : “H” level RW — R — RW R R P4 Register Port Mode Register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Symbol Address 00F8h PMR Bit Symbol Bit Name — Reserved bits (b2-b0) SSISEL — (b6-b4) IICSEL Figure 5.8 Set to 0. SSI signal pin select bit 0 : P3_3 pin is used for SSI00 pin. 1 : P1_6 pin is used for SSI01 pin. Reserved bits Set to 0. SSU / I2C bus sw itch bit 0 : Selects SSU function. 1 : Selects I2C bus function. PMR Register Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 After Reset 00h Function Page 30 of 315 RW RW RW RW RW R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 5. Programmable I/O Ports Pull-Up Control Register 0 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 0 Symbol PUR0 Bit Symbol (b1-b0) PU02 PU03 — (b5-b4) PU06 PU07 Address 00FCh Bit Name After Reset 00XX0000b Function Reserved bits Set to 0. P1_0 to P1_3 pull-up(1) 0 : Not pulled up 1 : Pulled up P1_4 to P1_7 pull-up(1) Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0. When read, the content is undefined. P3_3 pull-up(1) P3_4 to P3_5, and P3_7 pll-up(1) 0 : Not pulled up 1 : Pulled up RW RW RW RW — RW RW NOTE : 1. When this bit is set to 1 (pulled up), the pin w hose direction bit is set to 0 (input mode) is pulled up. Pull-Up Control Register 1 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol Address 00FDh PUR1 Bit Symbol Bit Name — Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0. (b0) When read, the content is undefined. PU11 — (b7-b2) P4_5 pull-up(1) After Reset XXXXXX0Xb Function 0 : Not pulled up 1 : Pulled up Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0. When read, the content is undefined. RW — RW — NOTE : 1. When the PU11 bit is set to 1 (pulled up), and the PD4_5 bit is set to 0 (input mode), the P4_5 pin is pulled up. Figure 5.9 Registers PUR0 and PUR1 Port P1 Drive Capacity Control Register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 0 0 0 Figure 5.10 Symbol DRR Bit Symbol DRR0 DRR1 DRR2 DRR3 (b7-b4) Address 00FEh Bit Name P1_0 drive capacity P1_1 drive capacity P1_2 drive capacity P1_3 drive capacity Reserved bits DRR Register Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 31 of 315 After Reset 00h Function Set P1 N-channel output transistor drive capacity. 0 : Low 1 : High Set to 0. RW RW RW RW RW RW R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 5.4 5. Programmable I/O Ports Port Settings Tables 5.4 to 5.17 list the port settings. Table 5.4 Port P1_0/KI0/AN8/CMP0_0 Register PD1 PUR0 DRR KIEN Bit PD1_0 PU02 DRR0 KI0EN CH2, CH1, CH0, ADGSEL0 0 0 X X 0 1 X Setting Value ADCON0 TCOUT P1 TCOUT0 P1_0 XXXXb 0 X Input port (not pulled up) X XXXXb 0 X Input port (pulled up) Function 0 0 X 1 XXXXb 0 X KI0 input 0 0 X X 1001b 0 X A/D Converter input (AN8) 1 X 0 X XXXXb 0 X Output port 1 X 1 X XXXXb 0 X Output port (High drive) X X 0 X XXXXb 1 0 Output port X X 1 X XXXXb 1 0 Output port (High drive) X X X X XXXXb 1 1 CMP0_0 output X: 0 or 1 Table 5.5 Port P1_1/KI1/AN9/CMP0_1 Register PD1 PUR0 DRR KIEN Bit PD1_1 PU02 DRR1 KI1EN CH2, CH1, CH0, ADGSEL0 0 0 X X 0 1 X 0 0 X 0 0 1 1 Setting Value ADCON0 TCOUT P1 TCOUT1 P1_1 XXXXb 0 X Input port (not pulled up) X XXXXb 0 X Input port (pulled up) 1 XXXXb 0 X KI1 input X X 1011b 0 X A/D converter input (AN9) X 0 X XXXXb 0 X Output port X 1 X XXXXb 0 X Output port (high drive) X X 0 X XXXXb 1 0 Output port X X 1 X XXXXb 1 0 Output port (high drive) X X X X XXXXb 1 1 CMP0_1 output ADCON0 TCOUT P1 TCOUT2 P1_2 Function X: 0 or 1 Table 5.6 Port P1_2/KI2/AN10/CMP0_2 Register PD1 PUR0 DRR KIEN Bit PD1_2 PU02 DRR2 KI2EN CH2, CH1, CH0, ADGSEL0 0 0 X X XXXXb 0 X Input port (not pulled up) 0 1 X X XXXXb 0 X Input port (pulled up) 0 0 X 1 XXXXb 0 X KI2 input 0 0 X X 1101b 0 X A/D converter input (AN10) 1 X 0 X XXXXb 0 X Output port Setting Value Function 1 X 1 X XXXXb 0 X Output port (high drive) X X 0 X XXXXb 1 0 Output port X X 1 X XXXXb 1 0 Output port (high drive) X X X X XXXXb 1 1 CMP0_2 input X: 0 or 1 Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 32 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group Table 5.7 5. Programmable I/O Ports Port P1_3/KI3/AN11/TZOUT Register PD1 PUR0 DRR KIEN ADCON0 TZMR TZOC Bit PD1_3 PU02 DRR3 KI3EN CH2, CH1, CH0, ADGSEL0 TZMOD1, TZMOD0 TZOCNT 0 0 X X XXXXb 00b X Input port (not pulled up) 0 1 X X XXXXb 00b X Input port (pulled up) 0 0 X 1 XXXXb 00b X KI3 input 0 0 X X 1111b 00b X A/D converter input (AN11) 1 X 0 X XXXXb 00b X Output port Setting Value Function 1 X 1 X XXXXb 00b X Output port (high drive) X X 0 X XXXXb 01b 1 Output port X X 1 X XXXXb 01b 1 Output port (high drive) X X X X XXXXb 01b 0 TZOUT output X X X X XXXXb 1Xb X TZOUT output X: 0 or 1 Table 5.8 Port P1_4/TXD0 Register PD1 PUR0 U0MR U0C0 Bit PD1_4 PU03 SMD2, SMD1, SMD0 NCH 0 0 000b X 0 1 000b X Input port (pulled up) 1 X 000b X Output port 0 TXD0 output, CMOS output 1 TXD0 output, N-channel open output Function Input port (not pulled up) 001b Setting Value X 100b X 101b 110b 001b X 100b X 101b 110b X: 0 or 1 Table 5.9 Port P1_5/RXD0/CNTR01/INT11 Register PD1 PUR0 UCON TXMR Bit PD1_5 PU03 CNTRSEL TXMOD1, TXMOD0 0 0 X XXb Input port (not pulled up) 0 1 X XXb Input port (pulled up) 0 X X Other than 01b RXD0 input Setting Value Function 0 X 1 Other than 01b CNTR01/INT11 input 1 X X Other than 01b Output port 1 X 1 Other than 01b CNTR01 output Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 33 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group Table 5.10 Register Bit Setting Value 5. Programmable I/O Ports Port P1_6/CLK0/SSI01 PD1 SSU (Refer to Table 16.4 Association between Communication Modes and I/O Pins) PUR0 U0MR PU03 SMD2, SMD1, SMD0, CKDIR PD1_6 SSI Output Control PMR Function SSI Input Control SSISEL 0 0 Other than 0X10b 0 0 X Input port (not pulled up) 0 1 Other than 0X10b 0 0 X Input port (pulled up) 0 0 XXX1b 0 0 X CLK0 (external clock) input 1 X Other than 0X10b 0 0 X Output port X X 0X10b 0 0 X CLK0 (internal clock) output X X XXXXb 0 1 1 SSI01 input X X XXXXb 1 0 1 SSI01 output X: 0 or 1 Table 5.11 Port P1_7/CNTR00/INT10 Register PD1 PUR0 TXMR UCON Bit PD1_7 PU03 TXMOD1, TXMOD0 CNTRSEL Setting Value Function 0 0 Other than 01b X Input port (not pulled up) 0 1 Other than 01b X Input port (pulled up) 0 0 Other than 01b 0 CNTR00/INT10 input 1 X Other than 01b X Output port X X Other than 01b 0 CNTR00 output X: 0 or 1 Table 5.12 Register Bit Setting Value Port P3_3/TCIN/INT3/SSI00/CMP1_0 PD3 PUR0 SSU (Refer to Table 16.4 Association between Communication Modes and I/O Pins) TCOUT P3 PMR Function PD3_3 PU06 SSI Output Control SSI Input Control TCOUT3 P3_3 SSISEL 0 0 0 0 0 X X Input port (not pulled up) 0 1 0 0 0 X X Input port (pulled up) X 0 0 1 X X 0 SSI00 input 1 X 0 0 0 X X Output port X X 0 0 1 0 X Output port X X 0 0 1 1 X CMP1_0 output X X 1 0 X X 0 SSI00 output 0 X 0 0 0 X X TCIN input/INT3 X: 0 or 1 Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 34 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group Table 5.13 Register Bit Setting Value 5. Programmable I/O Ports Port P3_4/SCS/SDA/CMP1_1 PD3 PUR0 SSU (Refer to Table 16.4 Association between Communication Modes and I/O Pins) TCOUT P3 ICCR1 Function PD3_4 PU07 SCS Output Control SCS Input Control TCOUT4 P3_4 ICE 0 0 0 0 0 X 0 0 1 0 0 0 X 0 Input port (pulled up) 0 0 0 1 0 X 0 SCS input X X 0 0 X X 1 SDA input/output Input port (not pulled up) 1 X 0 0 0 X 0 Output port X X 0 0 1 0 0 Output port X X 0 0 1 1 0 CMP1_1 output X X 1 0 X X 0 SCS output X: 0 or 1 Table 5.14 Register Bit Setting Value Port P3_5/SSCK/SCL/CMP1_2 PD3 PUR0 SSU (Refer to Table 16.4 Association between Communication Modes and I/O Pins) TCOUT P3 ICCR1 Function PD3_5 PU07 SSCK Output Control SSCK Input Control TCOUT5 P3_5 ICE 0 0 0 0 0 X 0 Input port (not pulled up) 0 1 0 0 0 X 0 Input port (pulled up) 0 0 0 1 0 X 0 SSCK input X X 0 0 X X 1 SCL input/output 1 X 0 0 0 X 0 Output port X X 0 0 1 0 0 Output port X X 0 0 1 1 0 CMP1_2 output X X 1 0 X X 0 SSCK output X: 0 or 1 Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 35 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group Table 5.15 Register Bit 5. Programmable I/O Ports Port P3_7/CNTR0/SSO/TXD1 PD3 PUR0 SSU (Refer to Table 16.4 Association between Communication Modes and I/O Pins) U1MR TXMR UCON Function SSO Input Control TXOCNT U1SEL1, U1SEL0 0 0 0 0Xb Input port (not pulled up) 000b 0 0 0 0Xb Input port (pulled up) 000b 0 0 0 0Xb Output port 0 0 X 11b TXD1 output pin SMD2, SSO Output SMD1, SMD0 Control PD3_7 PU07 0 0 000b 0 1 1 X 001b Setting Value X 100b X 101b 110b X X 000b 0 0 1 XXb CNTR0 output pin X X XXXb 0 1 X XXb SSO input pin X X XXXb 1 0 X XXb SSO output pin X: 0 or 1 Table 5.16 Port XIN/P4_6, XOUT/P4_7 Register CM1 CM1 CM0 Bit CM13 CM10 CM05 Oscillation Buffer Feedback Resistance 1 1 1 OFF OFF XIN-XOUT oscillation stop 1 0 1 OFF ON External input to XIN pin, “H” output from XOUT pin 1 0 1 OFF ON XIN-XOUT oscillation stop 1 0 0 ON ON XIN-XOUT oscillation 0 X X OFF OFF Input port Setting Value Circuit Specification Function X: 0 or 1 Table 5.17 Port P4_5/INT0/RXD1 Register PD4 PUR1 UCON INTEN Bit PD4_5 PU11 U1SEL1, U1SEL0 INT0EN 0 0 00b 0 Input port (not pulled up) 0 1 00b 0 Input port (pulled up) Setting Value Function 0 0 00b 1 INT0 input (not pulled up) 0 1 00b 1 INT0 input (pulled up) X 0 0 RXD1 input 1 X X Output port X: 0 or 1 Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 36 of 315 01b 11b 00b R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 5.5 5. Programmable I/O Ports Unassigned Pin Handling Table 5.18 lists Unassigned Pin Handling. Figure 5.11 shows Unassigned Pin Handling. Table 5.18 Unassigned Pin Handling Pin Name Ports P1, P3_3 to P3_5, P3_7, P4_5 Connection • After setting to input mode, connect each pin to VSS via a resistor (pulldown) or connect each pin to VCC via a resistor (pull-up).(2) • After setting to output mode, leave these pins open.(1, 2) Ports P4_6, P4_7 Port P4_2/VREF Connect to VCC via a pull-up resistor(2) Connect to VCC RESET (3) Connect to VCC via a pull-up resistor(2) NOTES: 1. If these ports are set to output mode and left open, they remain in input mode until they are switched to output mode by a program. The voltage level of these pins may be undefined and the power supply current may increase while the ports remain in input mode. The content of the direction registers may change due to noise or program runaway caused by noise. In order to enhance program reliability, the program should periodically repeat the setting of the direction registers. 2. Connect these unassigned pins to the MCU using the shortest wire length (2 cm or less) possible. 3. When the power-on reset function is in use. MCU Port P1, P3_3 to P3_5, (Input mode) P3_7, P4_5 : : (Input mode) (Output mode) Port P4_6, P4_7 RESET(1) Port P4_2/VREF NOTE: 1. When the power-on reset function is in use. Figure 5.11 Unassigned Pin Handling Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 37 of 315 : : Open R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 6. 6. Resets Resets The following resets are implemented: hardware reset, power-on reset, voltage monitor 1 reset, voltage monitor 2 reset, watchdog timer reset, and software reset. Table 6.1 lists the Reset Names and Sources. Table 6.1 Reset Names and Sources Reset Name Source Hardware reset Power-on reset Voltage monitor 1 reset Voltage monitor 2 reset Watchdog timer reset Software reset Input voltage of RESET pin is held “L”. VCC rises. VCC falls (monitor voltage: Vdet1). VCC falls (monitor voltage: Vdet2). Underflow of watchdog timer Write 1 to PM03 bit in PM0 register. Hardware reset RESET SFRs bits VCA26, VW1C0 and VW1C6 Power-on reset circuit VCC Voltage detection circuit Watchdog timer Power-on reset Voltage monitor 1 reset Voltage monitor 2 reset SFRs bits VCA13, VCA27, VW1C1, VW1C2, VW1F0, VW1F1, VW1C7, VW2C2, and VW2C3 Watchdog timer reset Pin, CPU, and SFR bits other than those listed above CPU Software reset VCA13: Bit in VCA1 register VCA26, VCA27: Bits in VCA2 register VW1C0 to VW1C2, VW1F0, VW1F1, VW1C6, VW1C7: Bits in VW1C register VW2C2, VW2C3: Bits in VW2C register Figure 6.1 Block Diagram of Reset Circuit Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 38 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 6. Resets Table 6.2 shows the Pin Functions while RESET Pin Level is “L”, Figure 6.2 shows CPU Register Status after Reset and Figure 6.3 shows Reset Sequence. Table 6.2 Pin Functions while RESET Pin Level is “L” Pin Name P1 P3_3 to P3_5, P3_7 P4_2, P4_5 to P4_7 Pin Functions Input port Input port Input port b15 b0 0000h Data register(R0) 0000h Data register(R1) 0000h Data register(R2) 0000h 0000h 0000h 0000h Data register(R3) b19 Address register(A0) Address register(A1) Frame base register(FB) b0 00000h Content of addresses 0FFFEh to 0FFFCh b15 b0 User stack pointer(USP) 0000h Interrupt stack pointer(ISP) 0000h Static base register(SB) b0 Flag register(FLG) 0000h b8 IPL Figure 6.2 Program counter(PC) 0000h b15 b15 Interrupt table register(INTB) b0 b7 U I O B S Z D C CPU Register Status after Reset fRING-S 20 cycles or more are needed(1) Internal reset signal Flash memory activation time (CPU clock × 11 cycles) CPU clock × 28 cycles CPU clock 0FFFEh 0FFFCh Address (internal address signal) 0FFFDh NOTE: 1. Hardware reset Figure 6.3 Reset Sequence Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 39 of 315 Content of reset vector R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 6.1 6. Resets Hardware Reset A reset is applied using the RESET pin. When an “L” signal is applied to the RESET pin while the supply voltage meets the recommended operating conditions, pins, CPU, and SFRs are reset (refer to Table 6.2 Pin Functions while RESET Pin Level is “L”). When the input level applied to the RESET pin changes from “L” to “H”, a program is executed beginning with the address indicated by the reset vector. After reset, the low-speed on-chip oscillator clock divided by 8 is automatically selected as the CPU clock. Refer to 4. Special Function Registers (SFRs) for the state of the SFRs after reset. The internal RAM is not reset. If the RESET pin is pulled “L” while writing to the internal RAM is in progress, the contents of internal RAM will be undefined. Figure 6.4 shows an Example of Hardware Reset Circuit and Operation and Figure 6.5 shows an Example of Hardware Reset Circuit (Usage Example of External Supply Voltage Detection Circuit) and Operation. 6.1.1 When Power Supply is Stable (1) Apply “L” to the RESET pin. (2) Wait for 500 µs (1/fRING-S × 20). (3) Apply “H” to the RESET pin. 6.1.2 Power On (1) Apply “L” to the RESET pin. (2) Let the supply voltage increase until it meets the recommended operating condition. (3) Wait for td(P-R) or more to allow the internal power supply to stabilize (refer to 19. Electrical Characteristics). (4) Wait for 500 µs (1/fRING-S × 20). (5) Apply “H” to the RESET pin. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 40 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 6. Resets VCC 2.7 V VCC 0V RESET RESET 0.2 VCC or below 0V td(P-R) + 500 µs or more NOTE: 1. Refer to 19. Electrical Characteristics. Figure 6.4 Example of Hardware Reset Circuit and Operation Supply voltage detection circuit RESET 5V VCC 2.7 V VCC 0V 5V RESET 0V td(P-R) + 500 µs or more Example when VCC = 5 V NOTE: 1. Refer to 19. Electrical Characteristics. Figure 6.5 Example of Hardware Reset Circuit (Usage Example of External Supply Voltage Detection Circuit) and Operation Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 41 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 6.2 6. Resets Power-On Reset Function When the RESET pin is connected to the VCC pin via a pull-up resistor of about 5 kΩ, and the VCC pin voltage level rises, the power-on reset function is enabled and the MCU resets its pins, CPU, and SFR. When a capacitor is connected to the RESET pin, always keep the voltage to the RESET pin 0.8VCC or more. When the input voltage to the VCC pin reaches the Vdet1 level or above, the low-speed on-chip oscillator clock starts counting. When the low-speed on-chip oscillator clock count reaches 32, the internal reset signal is held “H” and the MCU enters the reset sequence (refer to Figure 6.3). The low-speed on-chip oscillator clock divide by 8 is automatically selected as the CPU after reset. Refer to 4. Special Function Registers (SFRs) for the status of the SFR after power-on reset. The voltage monitor 1 reset is enabled after power-on reset. Figure 6.6 shows an Example of Power-On Reset Circuit and Operation. VCC 0.1 V to 2.7 V 0V VCC About 5 kΩ RESET 0.8 VCC or above RESET 0V within td(P-R) Vdet1(3) Vdet1(3) Vccmin Vpor2 Vpor1 tw(por1) tw(Vpor1–Vdet1) Sampling time(1, 2) tw(por2) tw(Vpor2–Vdet1) Internal reset signal (active “L”) 1 × 32 fRING-S 1 × 32 fRING-S NOTES: 1. The supply voltage must be held within the MCU’s operating voltage range (Vccmin or above) over the sampling time. 2. A sampling clock can be selected. Refer to 7. Voltage Detection Circuit for details. 3. Vdet1 indicates voltage detection level for the voltage detection 1 circuit. Refer to 7. Voltage Detection Circuit for details. 4. Refer to 19. Electrical Characteristics. Figure 6.6 Example of Power-On Reset Circuit and Operation Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 42 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 6.3 6. Resets Voltage Monitor 1 Reset A reset is applied using the on-chip voltage detection 1 circuit. The voltage detection 1 circuit monitors the input voltage to the VCC pin. The voltage to monitor is Vdet1. When the input voltage to the VCC pin reaches the Vdet1 level or below, the pins, CPU, and SFR are reset. When the input voltage to the VCC pin reaches the Vdet1 level or above, the low-speed on-chip oscillator clock starts counting. When the low-speed on-chip oscillator clock count reaches 32, the internal reset signal is held “H” and the MCU enters the reset sequence (refer to Figure 6.3). The low-speed on-chip oscillator clock divided by 8 is automatically selected as the CPU after reset. Refer to 4. Special Function Registers (SFRs) for the status of the SFR after voltage monitor 1 reset. The internal RAM is not reset. When the input voltage to the VCC pin reaches the Vdet1 level or below while writing to the internal RAM is in progress, the contents of internal RAM are undefined. Refer to 7. Voltage Detection Circuit for details of voltage monitor 1 reset. 6.4 Voltage Monitor 2 Reset A reset is applied using the on-chip voltage detection 2 circuit. The voltage detection 2 circuit monitors the input voltage to the VCC pin. The voltage to monitor is Vdet2. When the input voltage to the VCC pin reaches the Vdet2 level or below, pins, CPU, and SFR are reset and the program beginning with the address indicated by the reset vector is executed. After reset, the low-speed on-chip oscillator clock divided by 8 is automatically selected as the CPU clock. The voltage monitor 2 does not reset some SFRs. Refer to 4. Special Function Registers (SFRs) for details. The internal RAM is not reset. When the input voltage to the VCC pin reaches the Vdet2 level or below while writing to the internal RAM is in progress, the contents of internal RAM are undefined. Refer to 7. Voltage Detection Circuit for details of voltage monitor 2 reset. 6.5 Watchdog Timer Reset When the PM12 bit in the PM1 register is set to 1 (reset when watchdog timer underflows), the MCU resets its pins, CPU, and SFR if the watchdog timer underflows. Then the program beginning with the address indicated by the reset vector is executed. After reset, the low-speed on-chip oscillator clock divided by 8 is automatically selected as the CPU clock. The watchdog timer reset does not reset some SFRs. Refer to 4. Special Function Registers (SFRs) for details. The internal RAM is not reset. When the watchdog timer underflows, the contents of internal RAM are undefined. Refer to 13. Watchdog Timer for details of the watchdog timer. 6.6 Software Reset When the PM03 bit in the PM0 register is set to 1 (MCU reset), the MCU resets its pins, CPU, and SFR. The program beginning with the address indicated by the reset vector is executed. After reset, the low-speed on-chip oscillator clock divided by 8 is automatically selected for the CPU clock. The software reset does not reset some SFRs. Refer to 4. Special Function Registers (SFRs) for details. The internal RAM is not reset. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 43 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 7. 7. Voltage Detection Circuit Voltage Detection Circuit The voltage detection circuit monitors the input voltage to the VCC pin. This circuit can be used to monitor the VCC input voltage by a program. Alternately, voltage monitor 1 reset, voltage monitor 2 interrupt, and voltage monitor 2 reset can also be used. Table 7.1 lists the Specifications of Voltage Detection Circuit and Figures 7.1 to 7.3 show the Block Diagrams. Figures 7.4 to 7.6 show the Associated Registers. Table 7.1 Specifications of Voltage Detection Circuit VCC monitor Item Voltage to monitor Detection target Monitor Process when voltage is Reset detected Interrupt Digital filter Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Switch enabled/disabled Sampling time Page 44 of 315 Voltage Detection 1 Vdet1 Passing through Vdet1 by rising or falling None Voltage Detection 2 Vdet2 Passing through Vdet2 by rising or falling VCA13 bit in VCA1 register Whether VCC is higher or lower than Vdet2 Voltage monitor 1 reset Voltage monitor 2 reset Reset at Vdet2 > VCC; Reset at Vdet1 > VCC; restart CPU operation at restart CPU operation after a specified time VCC > Vdet1 None Voltage monitor 2 interrupt Interrupt request at Vdet2 > VCC and VCC > Vdet2 when digital filter is enabled; interrupt request at Vdet2 > VCC or VCC > Vdet2 when digital filter is disabled Available Available (Divide-by-n of fRING-S) (Divide-by-n of fRING-S) x4 x4 n: 1, 2, 4, and 8 n: 1, 2, 4, and 8 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 7. Voltage Detection Circuit VCA27 VCC + Internal reference voltage - Voltage detection 2 signal Noise filter ≥ Vdet2 VCA1 register b3 VCA26 VCA13 bit Voltage detection 1 signal + - Figure 7.1 ≥ Vdet1 Block Diagram of Voltage Detection Circuit Voltage monitor 1 reset generation circuit VW1F1 to VW1F0 = 00b = 01b Voltage detection 1 circuit = 10b fRING-S 1/2 1/2 1/2 = 11b VCA26 VCC Internal reference voltage + Digital filter Voltage detection 1 signal - Voltage detection 1 signal is held “H” when VCA26 bit is set to 0 (disabled). Voltage monitor 1 reset signal VW1C1 VW1C0 VW1C6 VW1C7 VW1C0 to VW1C1, VW1F0 to VW1F1, VW1C6, VW1C7: Bits in VW1C register VCA26: Bit in VCA2 register Figure 7.2 Block Diagram of Voltage Monitor 1 Reset Generation Circuit Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 45 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 7. Voltage Detection Circuit Voltage monitor 2 interrupt/reset generation circuit VW2F1 to VW2F0 = 00b = 01b Voltage detection 2 circuit = 10b fRING-S 1/2 1/2 1/2 VW2C2 bit is set to 0 (not detected) by writing 0 by a program. When VCA27 bit is set to 0 (voltage detection 2 circuit disabled), VW2C2 bit is set to 0. = 11b VCA27 Watchdog timer interrupt signal VCA13 VCC + Noise filter Internal reference voltage (Filter width: 200 ns) Digital Filter Voltage detection 2 signal VW2C2 Voltage detection 2 signal is held “H” when VCA27 bit is set to 0 (disabled). Voltage monitor 2 interrupt signal Non-maskable interrupt signal VW2C1 Oscillation stop detection interrupt signal Watchdog timer block VW2C3 Watchdog timer underflow signal VW2C7 This bit is set to 0 (not detected) by writing 0 by a program. VW2C0 VW2C6 VW2C0 to VW2C3, VW2F2, VW2F1, VW2C6, VW2C7: Bits in VW2C register VCA13: Bit in VCA1 register VCA27: Bit in VCA2 register Figure 7.3 Block Diagram of Voltage Monitor 2 Interrupt / Reset Generation Circuit Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 46 of 315 Voltage monitor 2 reset signal R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 7. Voltage Detection Circuit Voltage Detection Register 1 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Symbol Address 0031h VCA1 Bit Symbol Bit Name — Reserved bits (b2-b0) VCA13 — (b7-b4) After Reset(2) 00001000b Function Set to 0. RW RW Voltage detection 2 signal monitor flag(1) 0 : VCC < Vdet2 1 : VCC ≥ Vdet2 or voltage detection 2 circuit disabled Reserved bits Set to 0. RO RW NOTES : 1. The VCA13 bit is enabled w hen the VCA27 bit in the VCA2 register is set to 1 (voltage detection 2 circuit enabled). The VCA13 bit is set to 1 (VCC ≥ Vdet 2) w hen the VCA27 bit in the VCA2 register is set to 0 (voltage detection 2 circuit disabled). 2. The softw are reset, w atchdog timer reset, and voltage monitor 2 reset do not affect this register. Voltage Detection Register 2(1) After Reset(4) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Symbol VCA2 Address 0032h Bit Symbol Bit Name — Reserved bits (b5-b0) VCA26 VCA27 Hardw are reset : 00h Pow er-on reset, voltage monitor 1 reset : 01000000b Function Set to 0. 0 : Voltage detection 1 circuit disabled 1 : Voltage detection 1 circuit enabled RW Voltage detection 2 enable bit(3) 0 : Voltage detection 2 circuit disabled 1 : Voltage detection 2 circuit enabled RW 3. To use the voltage monitor 2 interrupt/reset or the VCA13 bit in the VCA1 register, set the VCA27 bit to 1. After the VCA27 bit is set to 1 from 0, the voltage detection circuit w aits for td(E-A) to elapse before starting operation. 4. Softw are reset, w atchdog timer reset, and voltage monitor 2 reset do not affect this register. Registers VCA1 and VCA2 Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 RW Voltage detection 1 enable bit(2) NOTES : 1. Set the PRC3 bit in the PRCR register to 1 (w rite enable) before w riting to this register. 2. To use the voltage monitor 1 reset, set the VCA26 bit to 1. After the VCA26 bit is set to 1 from 0, the voltage detection circuit w aits for td(E-A) to elapse before starting operation. Figure 7.4 RW Page 47 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 7. Voltage Detection Circuit Voltage Monitor 1 Circuit Control Register (1) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 Symbol VW1C Address 0036h After Reset(2) Hardw are reset : 0000X000b Pow er-on reset, voltage monitor 1 reset : 0100X001b Bit Symbol VW1C0 VW1C1 VW1C2 — (b3) Bit Name Voltage monitor 1 reset enable bit(3) Function RW 0 : Disable 1 : Enable RW Voltage monitor 1 digital filter disable mode select bit 0 : Digital filter enabled mode (digital filter circuit enabled) 1 : Digital filter disabled mode (digital filter circuit disabled) RW Reserved bit Set to 0. Reserved bit When read, the content is undefined. Sampling clock select bits b5 b4 VW1F0 0 0 : fRING-S divided by 0 1 : fRING-S divided by 1 0 : fRING-S divided by 1 1 : fRING-S divided by VW1F1 RW 1 2 4 8 VW1C6 Voltage monitor 1 circuit mode select bit When the VW1C0 bit is set to 1 (voltage monitor 1 reset enabled), set to 1. VW1C7 Voltage monitor 1 reset generation When the VW1C1 bit is set to 1 (digital filter condition select bit disabled mode), set to 1. RO RW RW RW RW NOTES : 1. Set the PRC3 bit in the PRCR register to 1 (w rite enable) before w riting to this register. When rew riting the VW1C register, the VW1C2 bit may be set to 1. Set the VW1C2 bit to 0 after rew riting the VW1C register. 2. The value remains unchanged after a softw are reset, w atchdog timer reset, or voltage monitor 2 reset. 3. The VW1C0 bit is enabled w hen the VCA26 bit in the VCA2 register is set to 1 (voltage detection 1 circuit enabled). Set the VW1C0 bit to 0 (disable), w hen the VCA26 bit is set to 0 (voltage detection 1 circuit disabled). Figure 7.5 VW1C Register Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 48 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 7. Voltage Detection Circuit Voltage Monitor 2 Circuit Control Register (1) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol VW2C Bit Symbol VW2C0 VW2C1 VW2C2 VW2C3 Address 0037h Bit Name Voltage monitor 2 interrupt / reset enable bit(6, 10) RW Voltage monitor 2 digital filter disabled mode select bit(2) 0 : Digital filter enabled mode (digital filter circuit enabled) 1 : Digital filter disabled mode (digital filter circuit disabled) RW Voltage change detection flag(3,4,8) 0 : Not detected 1 : Vdet2 crossing detected RW WDT detection flag(4,8) 0 : Not detected 1 : Detected RW Sampling clock select bits b5 b4 0 0 : fRING-S divided by 0 1 : fRING-S divided by 1 0 : fRING-S divided by 1 1 : fRING-S divided by VW2F1 VW2C7 RW 0 : Disable 1 : Enable VW2F0 VW2C6 After Reset(8) 00h Function 1 2 4 8 Voltage monitor 2 circuit mode select bit(5) 0 : Voltage monitor 2 interrupt mode 1 : Voltage monitor 2 reset mode Voltage monitor 2 interrupt / reset generation condition select bit(7,9) 0 : When VCC reaches Vdet2 or above. 1 : When VCC reaches Vdet2 or below . RW RW RW RW NOTES : 1. Set the PRC3 bit in the PRCR register to 1 (rew rite enable) before w riting to this register. When rew riting the VW2C register, the VW2C2 bit may be set to 1. Set the VW2C2 bit to 0 after rew riting the VW2C register. 2. When the voltage monitor 2 interrupt is used to exit stop mode and to return again, w rite 0 to the VW2C1 bit before w riting 1. 3. This bit is enabled w hen the VCA27 bit in the VCA2 register is set to 1 (voltage detection 2 circuit enabled). 4. Set this bit to 0 by a program. When 0 is w ritten by a program, it is set to 0 (and remains unchanged even if 1 is w ritten to it). 5. This bit is enabled w hen the VW2C0 bit is set to 1 (voltage monitor 2 interrupt/reset enabled). 6. The VW2C0 bit is enabled w hen the VCA27 bit in the VCA2 register is set to 1 (voltage detection 2 circuit enabled). Set the VW2C0 bit to 0 (disable) w hen the VCA27 bit is set to 0 (voltage detection 2 circuit disabled). 7. The VW2C7 bit is enabled w hen the VW2C1 bit is set to 1 (digital filter disabled mode). 8. Bits VW2C2 and VW2C3 remain unchanged after a softw are reset, w atchdog timer reset, or voltage monitor 2 reset. 9. When the VW2C6 bit is set to 1 (voltage monitor 2 reset mode), set the VW2C7 bit to 1 (w hen VCC reaches Vdet2 or below ). (Do not set to 0.) 10. Set the VW2C0 bit to 0 (disabled) w hen the VCA13 bit in the VCA1 register is set to 1 (VCC ≥ Vdet2 or voltage detection 2 circuit disabled), the VW2C1 bit is set to 1 (digital filter disabled mode), and the VW2C7 bit is set to 0 (w hen VCC reaches Vdet2 or above). Set the VW2C0 bit to 0 (disabled) w hen the VCA13 bit is set to 0 (VCC < Vdet2), the VW2C1 bit is set to 1 (digital filter disabled mode), and the VW2C7 bit is set to 1 (w hen VCC reaches Vdet2 or below ). Figure 7.6 VW2C Register Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 49 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 7.1 7. Voltage Detection Circuit VCC Input Voltage 7.1.1 Monitoring Vdet1 Vdet1 cannot be monitored. 7.1.2 Monitoring Vdet2 Set the VCA27 bit in the VCA2 register to 1 (voltage detection 2 circuit enabled). After td(E-A) has elapsed (refer to 19. Electrical Characteristics), Vdet2 can be monitored by the VCA13 bit in the VCA1 register. 7.1.3 Digital Filter A digital filter can be used for monitoring the VCC input voltage. When the VW1C1 bit in the VW1C register is set to 0 (digital filter enabled) for the voltage monitor 1 circuit and the VW2C1 bit in the VW2C register is set to 0 (digital filter enabled) for the voltage monitor 2 circuit, the digital filter circuit is enabled. fRING-S divided by 1, 2, 4, or 8 may be selected as a sampling clock. The level of VCC input voltage is sampled every sampling clock cycle, and when the sampled input level matches two times, the internal reset signal changes to “L” or a voltage monitor 2 interrupt request is generated. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 50 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 7. Voltage Detection Circuit Voltage monitor 1 reset VCC Vdet1 Sampling timing Internal reset signal Sampling clock of digital filter x 4 cycles Operation when the VW1C1 bit in the VW1C register is set to 0 (digital filter enabled) Voltage monitor 2 interrupt VCC Vdet2 Sampling timing Sampling clock of digital filter x 4 cycles VW2C2 bit in VW2C register Sampling clock of digital filter x 4 cycles 1 0 Set to 0 by a program 1 Voltage monitor 2 interrupt request 0 Set to 0 by an interrupt request acknowledgment Operation when the VW2C1 bit in the VW2C register is set to 0 (digital filter enabled) and the VW2C6 bit is set to 0 (voltage monitor 2 interrupt mode) Figure 7.7 Operating Example of Digital Filter Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 51 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 7.2 7. Voltage Detection Circuit Voltage Monitor 1 Reset Table 7.2 lists the Setting Procedure of Voltage Monitor 1 Reset Associated Bits and Figure 7.8 shows an Operating Example of Voltage Monitor 1 Reset. To use voltage monitor 1 reset to exit stop mode, set the VW1C1 bit in the VW1C register to 1 (digital filter disabled). Table 7.2 Step 1 2 3(1) 4(1) 5(1) 6 7 8 9 Setting Procedure of Voltage Monitor 1 Reset Associated Bits When Using Digital Filter When Not Using Digital Filter Set the VCA26 bit in the VCA2 register to 1 (voltage detection 1 circuit enabled). Wait for td(E-A) Select the sampling clock of the digital filter Set the VW1C7 bit in the VW1C register to 1. by bits VW1F0 to VW1F1 in the VW1C register. Set the VW1C1 bit in the VW1C register to Set the VW1C1 bit in the VW1C register to 0 (digital filter enabled). 1 (digital filter disabled). Set the VW1C6 bit in the VW1C register to 1 (voltage monitor 1 reset mode). Set the VW1C2 bit in the VW1C register to 0. Set the CM14 bit in the CM1 register to 0 − (low-speed on-chip oscillator on). Wait for 4 cycles of the sampling clock of − (No wait time) the digital filter Set the VW1C0 bit in the VW1C register to 1 (voltage monitor 1 reset enabled). NOTE: 1. When the VW1C0 bit is set to 0 (disabled), steps 3, 4, and 5 can be executed simultaneously (with 1 instruction). VCC Vdet1 (Typ. 2.85V) Sampling clock of digital filter x 4 cycles When the VW1C1 bit is set to 0 (digital filter enabled). 1 x 32 fRING-S Internal reset signal 1 x 32 fRING-S When the VW1C1 bit is set to 1 (digital filter disabled) and the VW1C7 bit is set to 1. Internal reset signal VW1C1 and VW1C7: Bits in VW1C Register The above applies under the following conditions. • VCA26 bit in VCA2 register = 1 (voltage detection 1 circuit enabled) • VW1C0 bit in VW1C register = 1 (voltage monitor 1 reset enabled) • VW1C6 bit in VW1C register = 1 (voltage monitor 1 reset mode) When the internal reset signal is held “L”, the pins, CPU, and SFR are reset. The internal reset signal level changes from “L” to “H”, and a program is executed beginning with the address indicated by the reset vector. Refer to 4. Special Function Register (SFR), for the SFR status after reset. Figure 7.8 Operating Example of Voltage Monitor 1 Reset Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 52 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 7.3 7. Voltage Detection Circuit Voltage Monitor 2 Interrupt and Voltage Monitor 2 Reset Table 7.3 lists the Setting Procedure of Voltage Monitor 2 Interrupt and Voltage Monitor 2 Reset Associated Bits. Figure 7.9 shows an Operating Example of Voltage Monitor 2 Interrupt and Voltage Monitor 2 Reset. To use voltage monitor 2 interrupt or voltage monitor 2 reset to exit stop mode, set the VW2C1 bit in the VW2C register to 1 (digital filter disabled). Table 7.3 Step 1 2 3(2) 4(2) 5(2) 6 7 8 9 Setting Procedure of Voltage Monitor 2 Interrupt and Voltage Monitor 2 Reset Associated Bits When Using Digital Filter When Not Using Digital Filter Voltage Monitor 2 Voltage Monitor 2 Voltage Monitor 2 Voltage Monitor 2 Interrupt Reset Interrupt Reset Set the VCA27 bit in the VCA2 register to 1 (voltage detection 2 circuit enabled). Wait for td(E-A) Select the sampling clock of the digital filter Select the timing of the interrupt and reset by bits VW2F0 to VW2F1 in the VW2C request by the VW2C7 bit in the VW2C register. register(1). Set the VW2C1 bit in the VW2C register to 0 Set the VW2C1 bit in the VW2C register to 1 (digital filter enabled). (digital filter disabled). Set the VW2C6 bit in Set the VW2C6 bit in Set the VW2C6 bit in Set the VW2C6 bit in the VW2C register to the VW2C register to the VW2C register to the VW2C register to 0 (voltage monitor 2 1 (voltage monitor 2 0 (voltage monitor 2 1 (voltage monitor 2 reset mode). interrupt mode). reset mode). interrupt mode). Set the VW2C2 bit in the VW2C register to 0 (passing of Vdet2 is not detected). − Set the CM14 bit in the CM1 register to 0 (low-speed on-chip oscillator on). Wait for 4 cycles of the sampling clock of the − (No wait time) digital filter Set the VW2C0 bit in the VW2C register to 1 (voltage monitor 2 interrupt/reset enabled). NOTES: 1. Set the VW2C7 bit to 1 (when VCC reaches Vdet2 or below) for the voltage monitor 2 reset. 2. When the VW2C0 bit is set to 0 (disabled), steps 3, 4 and 5 can be executed simultaneously (with 1 instruction). Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 53 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group Vdet2 (Typ. 3.30 V) 7. Voltage Detection Circuit VCC 2.7 V(1) 1 VCA13 bit 0 Sampling clock of digital filter x 4 cycles Sampling clock of digital filter x 4 cycles 1 VW2C2 bit 0 Set to 0 by a program When the VW2C1 bit is set to 0 (digital filter enabled). Set to 0 by interrupt request acknowledgement Voltage monitor 2 interrupt request (VW2C6 = 0) Internal reset signal (VW2C6 = 1) Set to 0 by a program 1 When the VW2C1 bit is set to 1 (digital filter disabled) and the VW2C7 bit is set to 0 (Vdet2 or above). VW2C2 bit 0 Set to 0 by interrupt request acknowledgement Voltage monitor 2 interrupt request (VW2C6 = 0) Set to 0 by a program 1 VW2C2 bit 0 When the VW2C1 bit is set to 1 (digital filter disabled) and the VW2C7 bit is set to 1 (Vdet2 or below). Voltage monitor 2 interrupt request (VW2C6 = 0) Set to 0 by interrupt request acknowledgement Internal reset signal (VW2C6 = 1) VCA13: Bit in VCA1 register VW2C1, VW2C2, VW2C6, VW2C7: Bit in VW2C register The above applies under the following conditions. • VCA27 bit in VCA2 register = 1 (voltage detection 2 circuit enabled) • VW2C0 bit in VW2C register = 1 (voltage monitor 2 interrupt and voltage monitor 2 reset enabled) NOTE: 1. If voltage monitor 1 reset is not used, set the power supply to VCC ≥ 2.7. Figure 7.9 Operating Example of Voltage Monitor 2 Interrupt and Voltage Monitor 2 Reset Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 54 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 8. 8. Processor Mode Processor Mode 8.1 Processor Modes Single-chip mode can be selected as the processor mode. Table 8.1 lists Features of Processor Mode. Figure 8.1 shows the PM0 Register and Figure 8.2 shows the PM1 Register. Table 8.1 Features of Processor Mode Processor Mode Single-chip mode Accessible Areas Pins Assignable as I/O Port Pins SFR, internal RAM, internal ROM All pins are I/O ports or peripheral function I/O pins. Processor Mode Register 0(1) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 0 0 Symbol PM0 Address 0004h Bit Symbol Bit Name — Reserved bits (b2-b0) Softw are reset bit After Reset 00h Function Set to 0. RW Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0. When read, the content is 0. NOTE : 1. Set the PRC1 bit in the PRCR register to 1 (w rite enable) before rew riting the PM0 register. Figure 8.1 PM0 Register Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 RW The MCU is reset w hen this bit is set to 1. When read, the content is 0. PM03 — (b7-b4) RW Page 55 of 315 — R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 8. Processor Mode Processor Mode Register 1(1) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 0 Symbol PM1 Address 0005h After Reset 00h Bit Symbol Bit Name Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0. — When read, the content is undefined. (b0) — (b1) PM12 — (b6-b3) — (b7) Function Reserved bit Set to 0. WDT interrupt/reset sw itch bit 0 : Watchdog timer interrupt 1 : Watchdog timer reset(2) Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0. When read, the content is 0. Reserved bit Set to 0. NOTES : 1. Set the PRC1 bit in the PRCR register to 1 (w rite enable) before rew riting the PM1 register. 2. The PM12 bit is set to 1 by a program (and remains unchanged even if 0 is w ritten to it). When the CSPRO bit in the CSPR register is set to 1 (count source protect mode enabled), the PM12 bit is automatically set to 1. Figure 8.2 PM1 Register Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 56 of 315 RW — RW RW — RW R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 9. 9. Bus Bus The bus cycles differ when accessing ROM/RAM, and when accessing SFR. Table 9.1 lists Bus Cycles by Access Space of the R8C/1A Group and Table 9.2 lists Bus Cycles by Access Space of the R8C/1B Group. ROM/RAM and SFR are connected to the CPU by an 8-bit bus. When accessing in word (16-bit) units, these areas are accessed twice in 8-bit units. Table 9.3 lists Access Units and Bus Operations. Table 9.1 Bus Cycles by Access Space of the R8C/1A Group Access Area SFR ROM/RAM Table 9.2 Bus Cycle 2 cycles of CPU clock 1 cycle of CPU clock Bus Cycles by Access Space of the R8C/1B Group Access Area SFR/data flash Program ROM/RAM Table 9.3 Bus Cycle 2 cycles of CPU clock 1 cycle of CPU clock Access Units and Bus Operations SFR, data flash Area Even address Byte access CPU clock CPU clock Even Address Data Odd address Byte access CPU clock Odd Data Even Data Even+1 Data CPU clock Data Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Data Odd Data Data CPU clock Data Address Data Address CPU clock Address Even CPU clock Data Odd address Word access Address Data Address Even address Word access ROM (program ROM), RAM Address Data Even Data Even+1 Data CPU clock Odd Odd+1 Data Page 57 of 315 Data Address Data Odd+1 Odd Data Data R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 10. Clock Generation Circuit 10. Clock Generation Circuit The clock generation circuit has: • Main clock oscillation circuit • On-chip oscillator (oscillation stop detection function) Table 10.1 lists Specifications of Clock Generation Circuit. Figure 10.1 shows a Clock Generation Circuit. Figures 9.2 to 10.5 show clock associated registers. Table 10.1 Specifications of Clock Generation Circuit Item Applications Main Clock Oscillation Circuit • CPU clock source • Peripheral function clock source On-Chip Oscillator High-Speed On-Chip Oscillator Low-Speed On-Chip Oscillator • CPU clock source • CPU clock source • Peripheral function clock • Peripheral function clock source source • CPU and peripheral function • CPU and peripheral function clock sources when main clock sources when main clock stops oscillating clock stops oscillating Approx. 8 MHz Approx. 125 kHz − − Clock frequency Connectable oscillator 0 to 20 MHz • Ceramic resonator • Crystal oscillator Oscillator connect pins Oscillation stop, restart function Oscillator status after reset Others XIN, XOUT(1) (Note 1) (Note 1) Usable Usable Usable Stop Stop Oscillate Externally generated clock can be input − − NOTE: 1. These pins can be used as P4_6 or P4_7 when using the on-chip oscillator clock as the CPU clock while the main clock oscillation circuit is not used. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 58 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 10. Clock Generation Circuit HRA2 register HRA1 register On-chip oscillator clock Frequency adjustable SSU High-speed on-chip oscillator HRA00 fRING-fast I2C bus Watchdog timer 1/128 HRA01 = 0 Low-speed on-chip oscillator CM14 CM10 = 1(Stop mode) Timer C S Q Timer Z A/D Converter f1 f2 c Oscillation stop detection S Q f4 d f8 e Main clock WAIT instruction Timer X Voltage detection circuit b Power-on reset Software reset Interrupt request INT0 Power-on reset circuit fRING-S R RESET UART1 fRING128 fRING HRA01 = 1 R OCD2 = 1 g f32 CM13 a XIN Divider h CPU clock OCD2 = 0 XOUT CM13 System clock CM05 CM02 1/2 a 1/2 g e d c b 1/2 1/2 1/2 CM06 = 0 CM17 to CM16 = 11b CM06 = 1 CM06 = 0 CM17 to CM16 = 10b CM02, CM05, CM06: Bits in CM0 register CM10, CM13, CM14, CM16, CM17: Bits in CM1 register OCD0, OCD1, OCD2: Bits in OCD register HRA00, HRA01: Bits in HRA0 register h CM06 = 0 CM17 to CM16 = 01b CM06 = 0 CM17 to CM16 = 00b Detail of divider Oscillation Stop Detection Circuit Forcible discharge when OCD0(1)=0 Main clock Pulse generation circuit for clock edge detection and charge, discharge control circuit Charge, discharge circuit OCD1(1) Oscillation Stop Detection Interrupt Generation Circuit Detection Watchdog Timer Interrupt Voltage Watch 2 Interrupt OCD2 bit switch signal NOTE : 1. Set the same value in bits OCD1 and OCD0. Figure 10.1 Clock Generation Circuit Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 59 of 315 CM14 bit switch signal Oscillation stop detection, Watchdog timer, Voltage monitor 2 interrupt UART0 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 10. Clock Generation Circuit System Clock Control Register 0(1) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 0 1 0 0 Symbol Address 0006h CM0 Bit Symbol Bit Name — Reserved bits (b1-b0) After Reset 68h Function Set to 0. RW RW WAIT peripheral function clock stop bit 0 : Peripheral function clock does not stop in w ait mode. 1 : Peripheral function clock stops in w ait mode. — (b3) Reserved bit Set to 1. — (b4) Reserved bit Set to 0. Main clock (XIN-XOUT) stop bit(2,4) 0 : Main clock oscillates. 1 : Main clock stops.(3) RW 0 : CM16, CM17 enabled 1 : Divide-by-8 mode RW CM02 CM05 CM06 — (b7) System clock division select bit Reserved bit 0(5) Set to 0. RW RW RW RW NOTES : 1. Set the PRC0 bit in the PRCR register to 1 (w rite enable) before rew riting the CM0 register. 2. The CM05 bit stops the main clock w hen the on-chip oscillator mode is selected. Do not use this bit to detect w hether the main clock is stopped. To stop the main clock, set the bits in the follow ing order: (a) Set bits OCD1 and OCD0 in the OCD register to 00b (oscillation stop detection function disabled). (b) Set the OCD2 bit to 1 (selects on-chip oscillator clock). 3. To input an external clock, set the CM05 bit to 1 (main clock stops) and the CM13 bit in the CM1 register to 1 (XINXOUT pin). 4. When the CM05 bit is set to 1 (main clock stops) and the CM13 bit in the CM1 register is set to 0 (P4_6, P4_7), P4_6 and P4_7 can be used as input ports. 5. When entering stop mode from high or medium speed mode, the CM06 bit is set to 1 (divide-by-8 mode). Figure 10.2 CM0 Register Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 60 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 10. Clock Generation Circuit System Clock Control Register 1(1) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 0 Symbol CM1 Bit Symbol Address 0007h Bit Name All clock stop control bit(4,7,8) After Reset 20h Function 0 : Clock operates. 1 : Stops all clocks (stop mode). — (b1) Reserved bit Set to 0. — (b2) Reserved bit Set to 0. Port XIN-XOUT sw itch bit(7) 0 : Input port P4_6, P4_7 1 : XIN-XOUT Pin RW Low -speed on-chip oscillation stop bit(5,6,8) 0 : Low -speed on-chip oscillator on 1 : Low -speed on-chip oscillator off RW XIN-XOUT drive capacity select bit(2) 0 : Low 1 : High RW System clock division select bits 1(3) b7 b6 0 0 : No division mode 0 1 : Divide-by-2 mode 1 0 : Divide-by-4 mode 1 1 : Divide-by-16 mode CM10 CM13 CM14 CM15 CM16 CM17 RW RW RW RW RW RW NOTES : 1. Set the PRC0 bit in the PRCR register to 1 (w rite enable) before rew riting the CM1 register. 2. When entering stop mode from high or medium speed mode, this bit is set to 1 (drive capacity high). 3. When the CM06 bit is set to 0 (bits CM16, CM17 enabled), bits CM16 to CM17 are enabled. 4. If the CM10 bit is set to 1 (stop mode), the on-chip feedback resistor is disabled. 5. When the OCD2 bit is set to 0 (main clock selected), the CM14 bit is set to 1 (low -speed on-chip oscillator stopped). When the OCD2 bit is set to 1 (on-chip oscillator clock selected), the CM14 bit is set to 0 (low -speed on-chip oscillator on). And remains unchanged even if 1 is w ritten to it. 6. When using the voltage detection interrupt, set the CM14 bit to 0 (low -speed on-chip oscillator on). 7. When the CM10 bit is set to 1 (stop mode), or the CM05 bit in the CM0 register to 1 (main clock stops) and the CM13 bit is set to 1 (XIN-XOUT pin), the XOUT (P4_7) pin becomes “H”. When the CM13 bit is set to 0 (input ports, P4_6, P4_7), P4_7 (XOUT) enters input mode. 8. In count source protect mode (refer to 13.2 Count Source Protect Mode), the value remains unchanged even if bits CM10 and CM14 are set. Figure 10.3 CM1 Register Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 61 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 10. Clock Generation Circuit Oscillation Stop Detection Register(1) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 0 0 0 Symbol OCD Bit Symbol OCD0 OCD1 Address After Reset 000Ch 04h Bit Name Function Oscillation stop detection enable b1 b0 bits 0 0 : Oscillation stop detection function disabled 0 1 : Do not set. 1 0 : Do not set. 1 1 : Oscillation stop detection function enabled(4,7) System clock select bit(6) — (b7-b4) RW RW 0 : Selects main clock.(7) 1 : Selects on-chip oscillator clock.(2) RW Clock monitor bit(3,5) 0 : Main clock oscillates. 1 : Main clock stops. RO Reserved bits Set to 0. OCD2 OCD3 RW RW NOTES : 1. Set the PRC0 bit in the PRCR register to 1 (w rite enable) before rew riting to this register. 2. The OCD2 bit is automatically set to 1 (on-chip oscillator clock selected) if a main clock oscillation stop is detected w hile bits OCD1 to OCD0 are set to 11b (oscillation stop detection function enabled). If the OCD3 bit is set to 1 (main clock stops), the OCD2 bit remains unchanged even w hen set to 0 (main clock selected). 3. The OCD3 bit is enabled w hen bits OCD1 to OCD0 are set to 11b (oscillation stop detection function enabled). 4. Set bits OCD1 to OCD0 to 00b (oscillation stop detection function disabled) before entering stop or on-chip oscillator mode (main clock stops). 5. The OCD3 bit remains 0 (main clock oscillates) if bits OCD1 to OCD0 are set to 00b. 6. The CM14 bit is set to 0 (low -speed on-chip oscillator on) if the OCD2 bit is set to 1 (on-chip oscillator clock selected). 7. Refer to Figure 10.8 Sw itching Clock Source from Low -speed On-Chip Oscillator to Main Clock for the sw itching procedure w hen the main clock re-oscillates after detecting an oscillation stop. Figure 10.4 OCD Register Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 62 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 10. Clock Generation Circuit High-Speed On-Chip Oscillator Control Register 0(1) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Symbol HRA0 Bit Symbol HRA00 HRA01 — (b7-b2) Address After Reset 0020h 00h Bit Name Function High-speed on-chip oscillator enable 0 : High-speed on-chip oscillator off bit 1 : High-speed on-chip oscillator on High-speed on-chip oscillator select bit(2) 0 : Selects low -speed on-chip oscillator.(3) 1 : Selects high-speed on-chip oscillator. Reserved bits Set to 0. RW RW RW RW NOTES : 1. Set the PRC0 bit in the PRCR register to 1 (w rite enable) before rew riting the HRA0 register. 2. Change the HRA01 bit under the follow ing conditions. • HRA00 = 1 (high-speed on-chip oscillation) • The CM14 bit in the CM1 register = 0 (low -speed on-chip oscillator on) 3. When setting the HRA01 bit to 0 (low -speed on-chip oscillator selected), do not set the HRA00 bit to 0 (high-speed on-chip oscillator off) at the same time. Set the HRA00 bit to 0 after setting the HRA01 bit to 0. Figure 10.5 HRA0 Register Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 63 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 10. Clock Generation Circuit High-Speed On-Chip Oscillator Control Register 1(1) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol HRA1 Address 0021h After Reset When Shipping Function The frequency of the high-speed on-chip oscillator is adjusted w ith bits 0 to 7.(2) High-speed on-chip oscillator frequency = 8 MHz (HRA1 register = value w hen shipping ; fRING-fast mode 0) Setting the HRA1 register to a low er value (minimum value: 00h), results in a higher frequency. Setting the HRA1 register to a higher value (maximum value: FFh), results in a low er frequency. RW RW NOTE : 1. Set the PRC0 bit in the PRCR register to 1 (w rite enable) before rew riting the HRA1 register. 2. Adjust the HRA1 register so that the frequency of the high-speed on-chip oscillator w ill be the maximum value or less of the system clock. High-Speed On-Chip Oscillator Control Register 2(1) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 0 0 Symbol HRA2 Bit Symbol HRA20 Address 0022h Bit Name High-speed on-chip oscillator mode select bits (5) HRA21 Af ter Reset 00h Function RW b1 b0 00 01 10 11 : f RING-f ast mode 0(2) : f RING-f ast mode 1(3) : f RING-f ast mode 2(4) : Do not set. — (b4-b2) Reserved bits Set to 0. — (b7-b5) Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0. When read, the content is 0. RW RW RW — NOTES : 1. Set the PRC0 bit in the PRCR register to 1 (w rite enable) bef ore rew riting the HRA2 register. 2. High-speed on-chip oscillator f requency = 8 MHz (HRA1 register = value w hen shipping) 3. If f RING-f ast mode 0 is sw itched to f RING-f ast mode 1, the f requency is multiplied by 1.5. 4. If f RING-f ast mode 0 is sw itched to f RING-f ast mode 2, the f requency is multiplied by 0.5. 5. Set the HRA20 and HRA21 bits so that the f requency of the high-speed on-chip oscillator w ill be the maximum value or less of the system clock. Figure 10.6 Registers HRA1 and HRA2 Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 64 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 10. Clock Generation Circuit The clocks generated by the clock generation circuits are described below. 10.1 Main Clock This clock is supplied by a main clock oscillation circuit. This clock is used as the clock source for the CPU and peripheral function clocks. The main clock oscillation circuit is configured by connecting a resonator between the XIN and XOUT pins. The main clock oscillation circuit includes an on-chip feedback resistor, which is disconnected from the oscillation circuit in stop mode in order to reduce the amount of power consumed by the chip. The main clock oscillation circuit may also be configured by feeding an externally generated clock to the XIN pin. Figure 10.7 shows Examples of Main Clock Connection Circuit. During reset and after reset, the main clock stops. The main clock starts oscillating when the CM05 bit in the CM0 register is set to 0 (main clock on) after setting the CM13 bit in the CM1 register to 1 (XIN- XOUT pin). To use the main clock for the CPU clock source, set the OCD2 bit in the OCD register to 0 (selects main clock) after the main clock is oscillating stably. The power consumption can be reduced by setting the CM05 bit in the CM0 register to 1 (main clock stops) if the OCD2 bit is set to 1 (select on-chip oscillator clock). When an external clock is input to the XIN pin, the main clock does not stop if the CM05 bit is set to 1. If necessary, use an external circuit to stop the clock. In stop mode, all clocks including the main clock stop. Refer to 10.4 Power Control for details. MCU (on-chip feedback resistor) MCU (on-chip feedback resistor) XIN XIN XOUT XOUT Open Rd(1) Externally derived clock CIN COUT VCC VSS Ceramic resonator external circuit External clock input circuit NOTE : 1. Insert a damping resistor if required. The resistance will vary depending on the oscillator and the oscillation drive capacity setting. Use the value recommended by the manufacturer of the oscillator. When the oscillation drive capacity is set to low, check that oscillation is stable. Also, if the oscillator manufacturer's data sheet specifies that a feedback resistor be added to the chip externally, insert a feedback resistor between XIN and XOUT following the instructions. Figure 10.7 Examples of Main Clock Connection Circuit Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 65 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 10.2 10. Clock Generation Circuit On-Chip Oscillator Clocks These clocks are supplied by the on-chip oscillators (high-speed on-chip oscillator and a low-speed on-chip oscillator). The on-chip oscillator clock is selected by the HRA01 bit in the HRA0 register. 10.2.1 Low-Speed On-Chip Oscillator Clock The clock generated by the low-speed on-chip oscillator is used as the clock source for the CPU clock, peripheral function clock, fRING, fRING128, and fRING-S. After reset, the on-chip oscillator clock generated by the low-speed on-chip oscillator divided by 8 is selected as the CPU clock. If the main clock stops oscillating when bits OCD1 to OCD0 in the OCD register are set to 11b (oscillation stop detection function enabled), the low-speed on-chip oscillator automatically starts operating, supplying the necessary clock for the MCU. The frequency of the low-speed on-chip oscillator varies depending on the supply voltage and the operating ambient temperature. Application products must be designed with sufficient margin to allow for the frequency changes. 10.2.2 High-Speed On-Chip Oscillator Clock The clock generated by the high-speed on-chip oscillator is used as the clock source for the CPU clock, peripheral function clock, fRING, fRING128, and fRING1-fast. After reset, the on-chip oscillator clock generated by the high-speed on-chip oscillator stops. Oscillation is started by setting the HRA00 bit in the HRA0 register to 1 (high-speed on-chip oscillator on). The frequency can be adjusted by registers HRA1 and HRA2. Since there are differences in delay among the bits in the HRA1 register, make adjustments by changing the settings of individual bits. The high-speed on-chip oscillator frequency may be changed in flash memory CPU rewrite mode during autoprogram operation or auto-erase operation. Refer to 10.6.5 High-Speed On-Chip Oscillator Clock for details. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 66 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 10.3 10. Clock Generation Circuit CPU Clock and Peripheral Function Clock There are a CPU clock to operate the CPU and a peripheral function clock to operate the peripheral functions. Refer to Figure 10.1 Clock Generation Circuit. 10.3.1 System Clock The system clock is the clock source for the CPU and peripheral function clocks. Either the main clock or the on-chip oscillator clock can be selected. 10.3.2 CPU Clock The CPU clock is an operating clock for the CPU and watchdog timer. The system clock can be divided by 1 (no division), 2, 4, 8, or 16 to produce the CPU clock. Use the CM06 bit in the CM0 register and bits CM16 to CM17 in the CM1 register to select the value of the division. After reset, the low-speed on-chip oscillator clock divided by 8 provides the CPU clock. When entering stop mode from high-speed or medium-speed mode, the CM06 bit is set to 1 (divide-by-8 mode). 10.3.3 Peripheral Function Clock (f1, f2, f4, f8, f32) The peripheral function clock is the operating clock for the peripheral functions. The clock fi (i = 1, 2, 4, 8, and 32) is generated by the system clock divided by i. The clock fi is used for timers X, Y, Z, and C, the serial interface and the A/D converter. When the WAIT instruction is executed after setting the CM02 bit in the CM0 register to 1 (peripheral function clock stops in wait mode), the clock fi stops. 10.3.4 fRING and fRING128 fRING and fRING128 are operating clocks for the peripheral functions. fRING runs at the same frequency as the on-chip oscillator clock and can be used as the source for timer X. fRING128 is generated from fRING by dividing it by 128, and it can be used as timer C. When the WAIT instruction is executed, the clocks fRING and fRING128 do not stop. 10.3.5 fRING-fast fRING-fast is used as the count source for timer C. fRING-fast is generated by the high-speed on-chip oscillator and supplied by setting the HRA00 bit to 1. When the WAIT instruction is executed, the clock fRING-fast does not stop. 10.3.6 fRING-S fRING-S is an operating clock for the watchdog timer and voltage detection circuit. fRING-S is supplied by setting the CM14 bit to 0 (low-speed on-chip oscillator on) and uses the clock generated by the low-speed onchip oscillator. When the WAIT instruction is executed or in count source protect mode of the watchdog timer, fRING-S does not stop. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 67 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 10.4 10. Clock Generation Circuit Power Control There are three power control modes. All modes other than wait mode and stop mode are referred to as standard operating mode. 10.4.1 Standard Operating Mode Standard operating mode is further separated into four modes. In standard operating mode, the CPU clock and the peripheral function clock are supplied to operate the CPU and the peripheral function clocks. Power consumption control is enabled by controlling the CPU clock frequency. The higher the CPU clock frequency, the more processing power increases. The lower the CPU clock frequency, the more power consumption decreases. When unnecessary oscillator circuits stop, power consumption is further reduced. Before the clock sources for the CPU clock can be switched over, the new clock source needs to be oscillating and stable. If the new clock source is the main clock, allow sufficient wait time in a program until oscillation is stabilized before exiting. Table 10.2 Settings and Modes of Clock Associated Bits OCD Register CM1 Register OCD2 CM17, CM16 CM13 High-speed mode 0 00b 1 MediumDivide-by-2 0 01b 1 speed mode Divide-by-4 0 10b 1 Divide-by-8 0 − 1 Divide-by-16 0 11b 1 High-speed No division 1 00b − and low-speed Divide-by-2 1 01b − on-chip Divide-by-4 1 10b − oscillator Divide-by-8 1 − − modes(1) Divide-by-16 1 11b − Modes CM0 Register CM06 CM05 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 0 0 0 0 − 0 − 0 − 1 − 0 − NOTE: 1. The low-speed on-chip oscillator is used as the on-chip oscillator clock when the CM14 bit in the CM1 register is set to 0 (low-speed on-chip oscillator on) and the HRA01 bit in the HRA0 register is set to 0. The high-speed on-chip oscillator is used as the on-chip oscillator clock when the HRA00 bit in the HRA0 register is set to 1 (high-speed on-chip oscillator A on) and the HRA01 bit in the HRA0 register is set to 1. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 68 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 10.4.1.1 10. Clock Generation Circuit High-Speed Mode The main clock divided by 1 (no division) provides the CPU clock. If the CM14 bit is set to 0 (low-speed onchip oscillator on) or the HRA00 bit in the HRA0 register is set to 1 (high-speed on-chip oscillator on), fRING and fRING128 can be used as timers X and C. When the HRA00 bit is set to 1, fRING-fast can be used as timer C. When the CM14 bit is set to 0 (low-speed on-chip oscillator on), fRING-S can be used for the watchdog timer and voltage detection circuit. 10.4.1.2 Medium-Speed Mode The main clock divided by 2, 4, 8, or 16 provides the CPU clock. If the CM14 bit is set to 0 (low-speed on-chip oscillator on) or the HRA00 bit in the HRA0 register is set to 1 (high-speed on-chip oscillator on), fRING and fRING128 can be used as timers X and C. When the HRA00 bit is set to 1, fRING-fast can be used as timer C. When the CM14 bit is set to 0 (low-speed on-chip oscillator on), fRING-S can be used for the watchdog timer and voltage detection circuit. 10.4.1.3 High-Speed and Low-Speed On-Chip Oscillator Modes The on-chip oscillator clock divided by 1 (no division), 2, 4, 8, or 16 provides the CPU clock. The on-chip oscillator clock is also the clock source for the peripheral function clocks. When the HRA00 bit is set to 1, fRING-fast can be used as timer C. When the CM14 bit is set to 0 (low-speed on-chip oscillator on), fRING-S can be used for the watchdog timer and voltage detection circuit. 10.4.2 Wait Mode Since the CPU clock stops in wait mode, the CPU which operates using the CPU clock and the watchdog timer when count source protection mode is disabled stop. The main clock and on-chip oscillator clock do not stop and the peripheral functions using these clocks continue operating. 10.4.2.1 Peripheral Function Clock Stop Function If the CM02 bit is set to 1 (peripheral function clock stops in wait mode), the f1, f2, f4, f8, and f32 clocks stop in wait mode. This reduces power consumption. 10.4.2.2 Entering Wait Mode The MCU enters wait mode when the WAIT instruction is executed. 10.4.2.3 Pin Status in Wait Mode The status before wait mode was entered is maintained. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 69 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 10.4.2.4 10. Clock Generation Circuit Exiting Wait Mode The MCU exits wait mode by a hardware reset or a peripheral function interrupt. To use a hardware reset to exit wait mode, set bits ILVL2 to ILVL0 for the peripheral function interrupts to 000b (interrupts disabled) before executing the WAIT instruction. The peripheral function interrupts are affected by the CM02 bit. When the CM02 bit is set to 0 (peripheral function clock does not stop in wait mode), all peripheral function interrupts can be used to exit wait mode. When the CM02 bit is set to 1 (peripheral function clock stops in wait mode), the peripheral functions using the peripheral function clock stop operating and the peripheral functions operated by external signals can be used to exit wait mode. Table 10.3 lists Interrupts to Exit Wait Mode and Usage Conditions. Table 10.3 Interrupts to Exit Wait Mode and Usage Conditions Interrupt Serial interface interrupt Key input interrupt A/D conversion interrupt Timer X interrupt Timer Z interrupt Timer C interrupt INT interrupt Voltage monitor 2 interrupt Oscillation stop detection interrupt Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 CM02 = 0 Usable when operating with internal or external clock Usable Usable in one-shot mode Usable in all modes Usable in all modes Usable in all modes Usable Usable Usable Page 70 of 315 CM02 = 1 Usable when operating with external clock Usable (Do not use) Usable in event counter mode (Do not use) (Do not use) Usable (INT0 and INT3 can be used if there is no filter.) Usable (Do not use) R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 10. Clock Generation Circuit Figure 10.8 shows the Time from Wait Mode to Interrupt Routine Execution. To use a peripheral function interrupt to exit wait mode, set up the following before executing the WAIT instruction. (1) Set the interrupt priority level in bits ILVL2 to ILVL0 in the interrupt control registers of the peripheral function interrupts to be used for exiting wait mode. Set bits ILVL2 to ILVL0 of the peripheral function interrupts that are not to be used for exiting wait mode to 000b (interrupt disabled). (2) Set the I flag to 1. (3) Operate the peripheral function to be used for exiting wait mode. When exiting by a peripheral function interrupt, the interrupt sequence is executed when an interrupt request is generated and the CPU clock supply is started. The CPU clock, when exiting wait mode by a peripheral function interrupt, is the same clock as the CPU clock when the WAIT instruction is executed. FMR0 Register Time until Flash Memory is Activated (T1) FMSTP Bit 0 Period of system clock (flash memory operates) × 12 cycles + 30 µs (max.) 1 (flash memory stops) Period of system clock × 12 cycles Wait mode Time until CPU Clock is Supplied (T2) Period of CPU clock × 6 cycles Same as above Time for Interrupt Sequence (T3) Period of CPU clock Following total time is the × 20 cycles time from wait mode until an interrupt routine is Same as above executed. T1 T2 T3 Flash memory activation sequence CPU clock restart sequence Interrupt sequence Interrupt request generated Figure 10.8 Time from Wait Mode to Interrupt Routine Execution Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Remarks Page 71 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 10.4.3 10. Clock Generation Circuit Stop Mode Since the oscillator circuits stop in stop mode, the CPU clock and peripheral function clock stop and the CPU and peripheral functions that use these clocks stop operating. The least power required to operate the MCU is in stop mode. If the voltage applied to the VCC pin is VRAM or more, the contents of internal RAM is maintained. The peripheral functions clocked by external signals continue operating. Table 10.4 lists Interrupts to Exit Stop Mode and Usage Conditions. Table 10.4 Interrupts to Exit Stop Mode and Usage Conditions Interrupt Key input interrupt − INT0 to INT1 interrupts INT0 can be used if there is no filter. INT3 interrupt No filter. Interrupt request is generated at INT3 input (TCC06 bit in TCC0 register is set to 1). Timer X interrupt Serial interface interrupt Voltage monitor 2 interrupt When external pulse is counted in event counter mode. When external clock is selected. Usable in digital filter disabled mode (VW2C1 bit in VW2C register is set to 1) 10.4.3.1 Usage Conditions Entering Stop Mode The MCU enters stop mode when the CM10 bit in the CM1 register is set to 1 (all clocks stop). At the same time, the CM06 bit in the CM0 register is set to 1 (divide-by-8 mode) and the CM15 bit in the CM10 register is set to 1 (main clock oscillator circuit drive capability high). When using stop mode, set bits OCD1 to OCD0 to 00b (oscillation stop detection function disabled) before entering stop mode. 10.4.3.2 Pin Status in Stop Mode The status before wait mode was entered is maintained. However, when the CM13 bit in the CM1 register is set to 1 (XIN-XOUT pins), the XOUT(P4_7) pin is held “H”. When the CM13 bit is set to 0 (input ports P4_6 and P4_7), the P4_7(XOUT) pin is held in input status. 10.4.3.3 Exiting Stop Mode The MCU exits stop mode by a hardware reset or peripheral function interrupt. Figure 10.9 shows the Time from Stop Mode to Interrupt Routine Execution. When using a hardware reset to exit stop mode, set bits ILVL2 to ILVL0 for the peripheral function interrupts to 000b (interrupts disabled) before setting the CM10 bit to 1. When using a peripheral function interrupt to exit stop mode, set up the following before setting the CM10 bit to 1. (1) Set the interrupt priority level in bits ILVL2 to ILVL0 of the peripheral function interrupts to be used for exiting stop mode. Set bits ILVL2 to ILVL0 of the peripheral function interrupts that are not to be used for exiting stop mode to 000b (interrupt disabled). (2) Set the I flag to 1. (3) Operate the peripheral function to be used for exiting stop mode. When exiting by a peripheral function interrupt, the interrupt sequence is executed when an interrupt request is generated and the CPU clock supply is started. The CPU clock, when exiting stop mode by a peripheral function interrupt, is the divide-by-8 of the clock which was used before stop mode was entered. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 72 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group FMR0 Register FMSTP Bit 0 (flash memory operates) 1 (flash memory stops) 10. Clock Generation Circuit Time until Flash Memory is Activated (T2) Time until CPU Clock is Supplied (T3) Period of system clock × 12 cycles + 30 µs (max.) Period of system clock × 12 cycles Period of CPU clock × 6 cycles T0 Stop mode T1 Same as above T2 Oscillation time of Internal power CPU clock source stability time used immediately Flash memory activation sequence before stop mode Time for Interrupt Sequence (T4) Remarks Period of CPU clock Following total time is × 20 cycles the time from stop mode until an interrupt Same as above handling is executed. T3 T4 CPU clock restart sequence Interrupt sequence 150 µs (max.) Interrupt request generated Figure 10.9 Time from Stop Mode to Interrupt Routine Execution Figure 10.10 shows the State Transitions in Power Control. Reset 5= There are six power control modes. (1) High-speed mode (2) Medium-speed mode (3) High-speed on-chip oscillator mode (4) Low-speed on-chip oscillator mode (5) Wait mode (6) Stop mode HRA00 = 1, HRA01 = 1 01 = 1, 05 = 0, Interrupt CM14 = 1, HRA01 = 0 CM O C 13 D2 = 1 = , CM 0 0 RA CM 1, = 13 = 0 CM D2 OC H 1, = 0 1 A0 = HR D 2 OC High-speed mode, medium-speed mode OCD2 = 0 CM05 = 0 CM13 = 1 0, CM OC 1 4 D2 = 0 = 1 , HR A 01 =0 , Low-speed on-chip oscillator mode OCD2 = 1 HRA01 = 0 CM14 = 0 High-speed on-chip oscillator mode OCD2 = 1 HRA01 = 1 HRA00 = 1 WAIT instruction Interrupt Wait mode Figure 10.10 CM05: Bit in CM0 register CM10, CM13, CM14: Bit in CM1 register OCD2: Bit in OCD register HRA00, HRA01: Bit in HRA0 register Stop mode State Transitions in Power Control Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 CM10 = 1 (all oscillators stop) Page 73 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 10.5 10. Clock Generation Circuit Oscillation Stop Detection Function The oscillation stop detection function detects the stop of the main clock oscillating circuit. The oscillation stop detection function can be enabled and disabled by bits OCD1 to OCD0 in the OCD register. Table 10.5 lists the Specifications of Oscillation Stop Detection Function. When the main clock is the CPU clock source and bits OCD1 to OCD0 are set to 11b (oscillation stop detection function enabled), the system is placed in the following state if the main clock stops. • OCD2 bit in OCD register = 1 (on-chip oscillator clock selected) • OCD3 bit in OCD register = 1 (main clock stops) • CM14 bit in CM1 register = 0 (low-speed on-chip oscillator oscillates) • Oscillation stop detection interrupt request is generated. Table 10.5 Specifications of Oscillation Stop Detection Function Item Oscillation stop detection clock and frequency bandwidth Enabled condition for oscillation stop detection function Operation at oscillation stop detection 10.5.1 Specification f(XIN) ≥ 2 MHz Set bits OCD1 to OCD0 to 11b (oscillation stop detection function enabled). Oscillation stop detection interrupt is generated How to Use Oscillation Stop Detection Function • The oscillation stop detection interrupt shares a vector with the voltage monitor 2 interrupt, and the watchdog timer interrupt. When using the oscillation stop detection interrupt and watchdog timer interrupt, the interrupt source needs to be determined. Table 10.6 lists Determining Interrupt Source for Oscillation Stop Detection, Watchdog Timer, and Voltage Monitor 2 Interrupts. • When the main clock restarts after oscillation stop, switch the main clock to the clock source of the CPU clock and peripheral functions by a program. • Figure 10.11 shows the Procedure for Switching Clock Source from Low-Speed On-Chip Oscillator to Main Clock. • To enter wait mode while using the oscillation stop detection function, set the CM02 bit to 0 (peripheral function clock does not stop in wait mode). • Since the oscillation stop detection function is a function for cases where the main clock is stopped by an external cause, set bits OCD1 to OCD0 to 00b (oscillation stop detection function disabled) when the main clock stops or is started by a program (stop mode is selected or the CM05 bit is changed). • This function cannot be used when the main clock frequency is 2 MHz or below. In this case, set bits OCD1 to OCD0 to 00b (oscillation stop detection function disabled). • To use the low-speed on-chip oscillator clock for the CPU clock and clock sources of peripheral functions after detecting the oscillation stop, set the HRA01 bit in the HRA0 register to 0 (low-speed on-chip oscillator selected) and bits OCD1 to OCD0 to 11b (oscillation stop detection function enabled). To use the high-speed on-chip oscillator clock for the CPU clock and clock sources of peripheral functions after detecting the oscillation stop, set the HRA01 bit to 1 (high-speed on-chip oscillator selected) and bits OCD1 to OCD0 to 11b (oscillation stop detection function enabled). Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 74 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group Table 10.6 10. Clock Generation Circuit Determining Interrupt Source for Oscillation Stop Detection, Watchdog Timer, and Voltage Monitor 2 Interrupts Generated Interrupt Source Bit Showing Interrupt Cause Oscillation stop detection (a) OCD3 bit in OCD register = 1 ( (a) or (b) ) (b) Bits OCD1 to OCD0 in OCD register = 11b and OCD2 bit = 1 Watchdog timer VW2C3 bit in VW2C register = 1 Voltage monitor 2 VW2C2 bit in VW2C register = 1 Switch to main clock Determine OCD3 bit 1(main clock stops) 0 (main clock oscillates) Judge several times Determine several times that the main clock is supplied Set bits OCD1 to OCD0 to 00b (oscillation stop detection function disabled) Set OCD2 bit to 0 (select main clock) End Bits OCD3 to OCD0: Bits in OCD register Figure 10.11 Procedure for Switching Clock Source from Low-Speed On-Chip Oscillator to Main Clock Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 75 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 10.6 10. Clock Generation Circuit Notes on Clock Generation Circuit 10.6.1 Stop Mode When entering stop mode, set the FMR01 bit in the FMR0 register to 0 (CPU rewrite mode disabled) and the CM10 bit in the CM1 register to 1 (stop mode). An instruction queue pre-reads 4 bytes from the instruction which sets the CM10 bit to 1 (stop mode) and the program stops. Insert at least 4 NOP instructions following the JMP.B instruction after the instruction which sets the CM10 bit to 1. • Program example to enter stop mode BCLR BSET FSET BSET JMP.B LABEL_001 : NOP NOP NOP NOP 10.6.2 1,FMR0 0,PRCR I 0,CM1 LABEL_001 ; CPU rewrite mode disabled ; Protect disabled ; Enable interrupt ; Stop mode Wait Mode When entering wait mode, set the FMR01 bit in the FMR0 register to 0 (CPU rewrite mode disabled) and execute the WAIT instruction. An instruction queue pre-reads 4 bytes from the WAIT instruction and the program stops. Insert at least 4 NOP instructions after the WAIT instruction. • Program example to execute the WAIT instruction BCLR FSET WAIT NOP NOP NOP NOP 10.6.3 1,FMR0 I ; CPU rewrite mode disabled ; Enable interrupt ; Wait mode Oscillation Stop Detection Function Since the oscillation stop detection function cannot be used if the main clock frequency is below 2 MHz, set bits OCD1 to OCD0 to 00b (oscillation stop detection function disabled) in this case. 10.6.4 Oscillation Circuit Constants Ask the manufacturer of the oscillator to specify the best oscillation circuit constants for your system. 10.6.5 High-Speed On-Chip Oscillator Clock The high-speed on-chip oscillator frequency may be changed up to 10%(1) in flash memory CPU rewrite mode during auto-program operation or auto-erase operation. The high-speed on-chip oscillator frequency after auto-program operation ends or auto-erase operation ends is held the state before the program command or block erase command is generated. Also, this note is not applicable when the read array command, read status register command, or clear status register command is generated. The application products must be designed with careful considerations for the frequency change. NOTE: 1. Change ratio to 8 MHz frequency adjusted in shipping. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 76 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 11. Protection 11. Protection The protection function protects important registers from being easily overwritten when a program runs out of control. Figure 11.1 shows the PRCR Register. The registers protected by the PRCR register are listed below. • Registers protected by PRC0 bit: Registers CM0, CM1, and OCD, HRA0, HRA1, and HRA2 • Registers protected by PRC1 bit: Registers PM0 and PM1 • Registers protected by PRC3 bit: Registers VCA2, VW1C, and VW2C Protect Register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 0 0 Symbol PRCR Bit Symbol Address 000Ah Bit Name Protect bit 0 PRC0 Protect bit 1 PRC1 — (b2) Set to 0. Protect bit 3 Writing to registers VCA2, VW1C, and VW2C is enabled. 0 : Disables w riting. 1 : Enables w riting. — (b5-b4) Reserved bits Set to 0. — (b7-b6) Reserved bits When read, the content is 0. PRCR Register Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Writing to registers PM0 and PM1 is enabled. 0 : Disables w riting. 1 : Enables w riting. Reserved bit PRC3 Figure 11.1 After Reset 00h Function Writing to registers CM0, CM, OCD, HRA0, HRA1, and HRA2 is enabled. 0 : Disables w riting. 1 : Enables w riting. Page 77 of 315 RW RW RW RW RW RW RO R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 12. Interrupts 12. Interrupts 12.1 Interrupt Overview 12.1.1 Types of Interrupts Figure 12.1 shows the types of Interrupts. Software (non-maskable interrupt) Interrupt Special (non-maskable interrupt) Hardware Undefined instruction (UND instruction) Overflow (INTO instruction) BRK instruction INT instruction Watchdog timer Oscillation stop detection Voltage monitor 2 Single step(2) Address match Peripheral function(1) (maskable interrupt) NOTES : 1. Peripheral function interrupts in the MCU are used to generate peripheral interrupts. 2. Do not use this interrupt. This is for use with development tools only. Figure 12.1 Interrupts • Maskable interrupts: • Non-maskable interrupts: Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 The interrupt enable flag (I flag) enables or disables these interrupts. The interrupt priority order can be changed based on the interrupt priority level. The interrupt enable flag (I flag) does not enable or disable interrupts. The interrupt priority order cannot be changed based on interrupt priority level. Page 78 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 12.1.2 12. Interrupts Software Interrupts A software interrupt is generated when an instruction is executed. Software interrupts are non-maskable. 12.1.2.1 Undefined Instruction Interrupt The undefined instruction interrupt is generated when the UND instruction is executed. 12.1.2.2 Overflow Interrupt The overflow interrupt is generated when the O flag is set to 1 (arithmetic operation overflow) and the INTO instruction is executed. Instructions that set the O flag are: ABS, ADC, ADCF, ADD, CMP, DIV, DIVU, DIVX, NEG, RMPA, SBB, SHA, and SUB. 12.1.2.3 BRK Interrupt A BRK interrupt is generated when the BRK instruction is executed. 12.1.2.4 INT Instruction Interrupt An INT instruction interrupt is generated when the INT instruction is executed. The INT instruction can select software interrupt numbers 0 to 63. Software interrupt numbers 4 to 31 are assigned to the peripheral function interrupt. Therefore, the MCU executes the same interrupt routine when the INT instruction is executed as when a peripheral function interrupt is generated. For software interrupt numbers 0 to 31, the U flag is saved to the stack during instruction execution and the U flag is set to 0 (ISP selected) before the interrupt sequence is executed. The U flag is restored from the stack when returning from the interrupt routine. For software interrupt numbers 32 to 63, the U flag does not change state during instruction execution, and the selected SP is used. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 79 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 12.1.3 12. Interrupts Special Interrupts Special interrupts are non-maskable. 12.1.3.1 Watchdog Timer Interrupt The watchdog timer interrupt is generated by the watchdog timer. Reset the watchdog timer after the watchdog timer interrupt is generated. For details, refer to 13. Watchdog Timer. 12.1.3.2 Oscillation Stop Detection Interrupt The oscillation stop detection interrupt is generated by the oscillation stop detection function. For details of the oscillation stop detection function, refer to 10. Clock Generation Circuit. 12.1.3.3 Voltage Monitor 2 Interrupt The voltage monitor 2 interrupt is generated by the voltage detection circuit. For details of the voltage detection circuit, refer to 7. Voltage Detection Circuit. 12.1.3.4 Single-Step Interrupt, and Address Break Interrupt Do not use these interrupts. They are for use by development tools only. 12.1.3.5 Address Match Interrupt The address match interrupt is generated immediately before executing an instruction that is stored at an address indicated by registers RMAD0 to RMAD1 when the AIER0 or AIER1 bit in the AIER register is set to 1 (address match interrupt enable). For details of the address match interrupt, refer to 12.4 Address Match Interrupt. 12.1.4 Peripheral Function Interrupt The peripheral function interrupt is generated by the internal peripheral function of the MCU and is a maskable interrupt. Refer to Table 12.2 Relocatable Vector Tables for sources of the peripheral function interrupt. For details of peripheral functions, refer to the descriptions of individual peripheral functions. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 80 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 12.1.5 12. Interrupts Interrupts and Interrupt Vectors There are 4 bytes in each vector. Set the starting address of an interrupt routine in each interrupt vector. When an interrupt request is acknowledged, the CPU branches to the address set in the corresponding interrupt vector. Figure 12.2 shows an Interrupt Vector. MSB LSB Vector address (L) Low address Mid address Vector address (H) Figure 12.2 12.1.5.1 0000 High address 0000 0000 Interrupt Vector Fixed Vector Tables The fixed vector tables are allocated addresses 0FFDCh to 0FFFFh. Table 12.1 lists the Fixed Vector Tables. The vector addresses (H) of fixed vectors are used by the ID code check function. For details, refer to 18.3 Functions to Prevent Rewriting of Flash Memory. Table 12.1 Fixed Vector Tables Vector Addresses Address (L) to (H) Undefined instruction 0FFDCh to 0FFDFh Interrupt Source Remarks Interrupt on UND instruction Interrupt on INTO instruction If the content of address 0FFE7h is FFh, program execution starts from the address shown by the vector in the relocatable vector table. Reference R8C/Tiny Series Software Manual Overflow 0FFE0h to 0FFE3h BRK instruction 0FFE4h to 0FFE7h Address match 0FFE8h to 0FFEBh 0FFECh to 0FFEFh 12.4 Address Match Interrupt 0FFF0h to 0FFF3h • 13. Watchdog Timer • 10. Clock Generation Circuit • 7. Voltage Detection Circuit step(1) Single • Watchdog timer • Oscillation stop detection • Voltage monitor 2 Address break(1) (Reserved) Reset 0FFF4h to 0FFF7h 0FFF8h to 0FFFBh 0FFFCh to 0FFFFh 6. Resets NOTE: 1. Do not use these interrupts. They are for use by development support tools only. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 81 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 12.1.5.2 12. Interrupts Relocatable Vector Tables The relocatable vector tables occupy 256 bytes beginning from the starting address set in the INTB register. Table 12.2 lists the Relocatable Vector Tables. Table 12.2 Relocatable Vector Tables Interrupt Source BRK instruction(2) (Reserved) Key input A/D conversion Clock synchronous serial I/O with chip select / I2C bus interface(3) Compare 1 UART0 transmit UART0 receive UART1 transmit UART1 receive (Reserved) Timer X (Reserved) Timer Z INT1 INT3 Timer C Compare 0 INT0 (Reserved) (Reserved) Software interrupt(2) Vector Address(1) Address (L) to Address (H) +0 to +3 (0000h to 0003h) Software Reference Interrupt Number 0 R8C/Tiny Series Software Manual 1 to 12 +52 to +55 (0034h to 0037h) +56 to +59 (0038h to 003Bh) +60 to +63 (003Ch to 003Fh) 13 14 15 12.3 Key Input Interrupt 17. A/D Converter 16.2 Clock Synchronous Serial I/O with Chip Select (SSU), 16.3 I2C bus Interface +64 to +67 (0040h to 0043h) +68 to +71 (0044h to 0047h) +72 to +75 (0048h to 004Bh) +76 to +79 (004Ch to 004Fh) +80 to +83 (0050h to 0053h) 14.3 Timer C 15. Serial Interface +96 to +99 (0060h to 0063h) +100 to +103 (0064h to 0067h) 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 +104 to +107 (0068h to 006Bh) 26 +108 to +111 (006Ch to 006Fh) +112 to +115 (0070h to 0073h) +116 to +119 (0074h to 0077h) 27 28 29 +88 to +91 (0058h to 005Bh) +128 to +131 (0080h to 0083h) to +252 to +255 (00FCh to 00FFh) NOTES: 1. These addresses are relative to those in the INTB register. 2. The I flag does not disable these interrupts. 3. The IICSEL bit in the PMR register switches functions. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 82 of 315 30 31 32 to 63 14.1 Timer X 14.2 Timer Z 12.2 INT interrupt 14.3 Timer C 12.2 INT interrupt R8C/Tiny Series Software Manual R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 12.1.6 12. Interrupts Interrupt Control The following describes enabling and disabling the maskable interrupts and setting the priority for acknowledgement. The explanation does not apply to nonmaskable interrupts. Use the I flag in the FLG register, IPL, and bits ILVL2 to ILVL0 in each interrupt control register to enable or disable maskable interrupts. Whether an interrupt is requested is indicated by the IR bit in each interrupt control register. Figure 12.3 shows the Interrupt Control Register and Figure 12.4 shows the INT0IC Register Interrupt Control Register(2) Symbol KUPIC ADIC SSUAIC/IIC2AIC(3) CMP1IC S0TIC, S1TIC S0RIC, S1RIC TXIC TZIC INT1IC INT3IC TCIC CMP0IC b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Bit Symbol Address 004Dh 004Eh 004Fh 0050h 0051h, 0053h 0052h, 0054h 0056h 0058h 0059h 005Ah 005Bh After Reset XXXXX000b XXXXX000b XXXXX000b XXXXX000b XXXXX000b XXXXX000b XXXXX000b XXXXX000b XXXXX000b XXXXX000b XXXXX000b 005Ch XXXXX000b Bit Name Interrupt priority level select bits 0 0 0 : Level 0 (interrupt disable) 0 0 1 : Level 1 0 1 0 : Level 2 0 1 1 : Level 3 1 0 0 : Level 4 1 0 1 : Level 5 1 1 0 : Level 6 1 1 1 : Level 7 ILVL0 ILVL1 ILVL2 IR — (b7-b4) Function Interrupt request bit RW b2 b1 b0 0 : Requests no interrupt 1 : Requests interrupt Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0. When read, the content is undefined. RW RW RW RW(1) — NOTES : 1. Only 0 can be w ritten to the IR bit. Do not w rite 1. 2. Rew rite the interrupt control register w hen the interrupt request w hich is applicable for the register is not generated. Refer to 12.5.6 Changing Interrupt Control Registers. 3. The IICSEL bit in the PMR register sw itches functions. Figure 12.3 Interrupt Control Register Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 83 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 12. Interrupts INT0 Interrupt Control Register(2) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 Symbol INT0IC Bit Symbol Address 005Dh Bit Name Interrupt priority level select bits ILVL1 ILVL2 POL — (b5) — (b7-b6) RW b2 b1 b0 0 0 0 : Level 0 (interrupt disable) 0 0 1 : Level 1 0 1 0 : Level 2 0 1 1 : Level 3 1 0 0 : Level 4 1 0 1 : Level 5 1 1 0 : Level 6 1 1 1 : Level 7 ILVL0 IR After Reset XX00X000b Function RW RW RW Interrupt request bit 0 : Requests no interrupt. 1 : Requests interrupt. RW(1) Polarity sw itch bit(4) 0 : Selects falling edge. 1 : Selects rising edge.(3) RW Reserved bit Set to 0. Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0. When read, the content is undefined. RW — NOTES : 1. Only 0 can be w ritten to the IR bit. (Do not w rite 1.) 2. Rew rite the interrupt control register w hen the interrupt request w hich is applicable for the register is not generated. Refer to 12.5.6 Changing Interrupt Control Registers. 3. If the INTOPL bit in the INTEN register is set to 1 (both edges), set the POL bit to 0 (selects falling edge). 4. The IR bit may be set to 1 (requests interrupt) w hen the POL bit is rew ritten. Refer to 12.5.5 Changing Interrupt Sources. Figure 12.4 INT0IC Register Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 84 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 12.1.6.1 12. Interrupts I Flag The I flag enables or disables maskable interrupts. Setting the I flag to 1 (enabled) enables maskable interrupts. Setting the I flag to 0 (disabled) disables all maskable interrupts. 12.1.6.2 IR Bit The IR bit is set to 1 (interrupt requested) when an interrupt request is generated. Then, when the interrupt request is acknowledged and the CPU branches to the corresponding interrupt vector, the IR bit is set to 0 (= interrupt not requested). The IR bit can be set to 0 by a program. Do not write 1 to this bit. 12.1.6.3 Bits ILVL2 to ILVL0 and IPL Interrupt priority levels can be set using bits ILVL2 to ILVL0. Table 12.3 lists the Settings of Interrupt Priority Levels and Table 12.4 lists the Interrupt Priority Levels Enabled by IPL. The following are conditions under which an interrupt is acknowledged: • I flag = 1 • IR bit = 1 • Interrupt priority level > IPL The I flag, IR bit, bits ILVL2 to ILVL0, and IPL are independent of each other. They do not affect one another. Table 12.3 ILVL2 to ILVL0 Bits 000b 001b 010b 011b 100b 101b 110b 111b Settings of Interrupt Priority Levels Interrupt Priority Level Priority Order Level 0 (interrupt disabled) Level 1 Level 2 Level 3 Level 4 Level 5 Level 6 Level 7 − Low Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 85 of 315 High Table 12.4 IPL 000b 001b 010b 011b 100b 101b 110b 111b Interrupt Priority Levels Enabled by IPL Enabled Interrupt Priority Levels Interrupt level 1 and above Interrupt level 2 and above Interrupt level 3 and above Interrupt level 4 and above Interrupt level 5 and above Interrupt level 6 and above Interrupt level 7 and above All maskable interrupts are disabled R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 12.1.6.4 12. Interrupts Interrupt Sequence An interrupt sequence is performed between an interrupt request acknowledgement and interrupt routine execution. When an interrupt request is generated while an instruction is being executed, the CPU determines its interrupt priority level after the instruction is completed. The CPU starts the interrupt sequence from the following cycle. However, for the SMOVB, SMOVF, SSTR, or RMPA instruction, if an interrupt request is generated while the instruction is being executed, the MCU suspends the instruction to start the interrupt sequence. The interrupt sequence is performed as indicated below. Figure 12.5 shows the Time Required for Executing Interrupt Sequence. (1) The CPU gets interrupt information (interrupt number and interrupt request level) by reading address 00000h. The IR bit for the corresponding interrupt is set to 0 (interrupt not requested). (2) The FLG register is saved to a temporary register(1) in the CPU immediately before entering the interrupt sequence. (3) The I, D, and U flags in the FLG register are set as follows: The I flag is set to 0 (interrupts disabled). The D flag is set to 0 (single-step interrupt disabled). The U flag is set to 0 (ISP selected). However, the U flag does not change state if an INT instruction for software interrupt number 32 to 63 is executed. (4) The CPU’s internal temporary register(1) is saved to the stack. (5) The PC is saved to the stack. (6) The interrupt priority level of the acknowledged interrupt is set in the IPL. (7) The starting address of the interrupt routine set in the interrupt vector is stored in the PC. After the interrupt sequence is completed, instructions are executed from the starting address of the interrupt routine. NOTE: 1. This register cannot be used by user. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 CPU clock Address bus Data bus Address 0000h Undefined Interrupt information RD Undefined SP-2 SP-1 SP-4 SP-2 SP-1 SP-4 contents contents contents SP-3 SP-3 contents VEC VEC+1 VEC contents Undefined WR The undefined state depends on the instruction queue buffer. A read cycle occurs when the instruction queue buffer is ready to acknowledge instructions. Figure 12.5 Time Required for Executing Interrupt Sequence Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 86 of 315 VEC+1 contents VEC+2 VEC+2 contents PC R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 12.1.6.5 12. Interrupts Interrupt Response Time Figure 12.6 shows the Interrupt Response Time. The interrupt response time is the period between an interrupt request generation and the execution of the first instruction in the interrupt routine. The interrupt response time includes the period between interrupt request generation and the completion of execution of the instruction (refer to (a) in Figure 12.6) and the period required to perform the interrupt sequence (20 cycles, see (b) in Figure 12.6). Interrupt request is generated. Interrupt request is acknowledged. Time Instruction (a) Interrupt sequence Instruction in interrupt routine 20 cycles (b) Interrupt response time (a) Period between interrupt request generation and the completion of execution of an instruction. The length of time varies depending on the instruction being executed. The DIVX instruction requires the longest time, 30 cycles (assuming no wait states and that a register is set as the divisor). (b) 21 cycles for address match and single-step interrupts. Figure 12.6 12.1.6.6 Interrupt Response Time IPL Change when Interrupt Request is Acknowledged When an interrupt request of a maskable interrupt is acknowledged, the interrupt priority level of the acknowledged interrupt is set in the IPL. When a software interrupt or special interrupt request is acknowledged, the level listed in Table 12.5 is set in the IPL. Table 12.5 lists the IPL Value When a Software or Special Interrupt Is Acknowledged. Table 12.5 IPL Value When a Software or Special Interrupt Is Acknowledged Interrupt Source Watchdog timer, oscillation stop detection, voltage monitor 2 Software, address match, single-step, address break Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 87 of 315 Value Set in IPL 7 Not changed R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 12.1.6.7 12. Interrupts Saving a Register In the interrupt sequence, the FLG register and PC are saved to the stack. After an extended 16 bits, 4 high-order bits in the PC and 4 high-order (IPL) and 8 low-order bits in the FLG register, are saved to the stack, the 16 low-order bits in the PC are saved. Figure 12.7 shows the Stack State Before and After Acknowledgement of Interrupt Request. The other necessary registers are saved by a program at the beginning of the interrupt routine. The PUSHM instruction can save several registers in the register bank being currently used(1) with a single instruction. NOTE: 1. Selectable from registers R0, R1, R2, R3, A0, A1, SB, and FB. Stack Address Stack Address MSB LSB MSB LSB m-4 m-4 PCL m-3 m-3 PCM m-2 m-2 FLGL m-1 m-1 m Previous stack contents m+1 Previous stack contents [SP] SP value before interrupt is generated m m+1 Stack state before interrupt request is acknowledged FLGH [SP] New SP value PCH Previous stack contents Previous stack contents PCH PCM PCL FLGH FLGL : 4 high-order bits of PC : 8 middle-order bits of PC : 8 low-order bits of PC : 4 high-order bits of FLG : 8 low-order bits of FLG Stack state after interrupt request is acknowledged NOTE : 1.When executing software number 32 to 63 INT instructions, this SP is specified by the U flag. Otherwise it is ISP. Figure 12.7 Stack State Before and After Acknowledgement of Interrupt Request The register saving operation, which is performed as part of the interrupt sequence, saved in 8 bits at a time in four steps. Figure 12.8 shows the Register Saving Operation. Stack Address Sequence in which order registers are saved [SP]−5 [SP]−4 PCL (3) [SP]−3 PCM (4) [SP]−2 FLGL (1) Saved, 8 bits at a time [SP]−1 FLGH PCH (2) [SP] Completed saving registers in four operations. PCH PCM PCL FLGH FLGL : 4 high-order bits of PC : 8 middle-order bits of PC : 8 low-order bits of PC : 4 high-order bits of FLG : 8 low-order bits of FLG NOTE : 1.[SP] indicates the initial value of the SP when an interrupt request is acknowledged. After registers are saved, the SP content is [SP] minus 4. When executing software number 32 to 63 INT instructions, this SP is specified by the U flag. Otherwise it is ISP. Figure 12.8 Register Saving Operation Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 88 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 12.1.6.8 12. Interrupts Returning from an Interrupt Routine When the REIT instruction is executed at the end of an interrupt routine, the FLG register and PC, which have been saved to the stack, are automatically restored. The program, that was running before the interrupt request was acknowledged, starts running again. Restore registers saved by a program in an interrupt routine using the POPM instruction or others before executing the REIT instruction. 12.1.6.9 Interrupt Priority If two or more interrupt requests are generated while a single instruction is being executed, the interrupt with the higher priority is acknowledged. Set bits ILVL2 to ILVL0 to select the desired priority level for maskable interrupts (peripheral functions). However, if two or more maskable interrupts have the same priority level, their interrupt priority is resolved by hardware, and the higher priority interrupts acknowledged. The priority levels of special interrupts, such as reset (reset has the highest priority) and watchdog timer, are set by hardware. Figure 12.9 shows the Priority Levels of Hardware Interrupts. The interrupt priority does not affect software interrupts. The MCU jumps to the interrupt routine when the instruction is executed. Reset High Address break Watchdog timer Oscillation stop detection Voltage monitor 2 Peripheral function Single step Address match Figure 12.9 Priority Levels of Hardware Interrupts Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 89 of 315 Low R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 12. Interrupts 12.1.6.10 Interrupt Priority Judgement Circuit The interrupt priority judgement circuit selects the highest priority interrupt, as shown in Figure 12.10. Priority level of each interrupt Level 0 (default value) Highest Compare 0 INT3 Timer Z Timer X INT0 Timer C INT1 UART1 receive UART0 receive Priority of peripheral function interrupts (if priority levels are same) Compare 1 A/D conversion UART1 transmit UART0 transmit SSU / I2C bus(1) Key input IPL Lowest Interrupt request level judgment output signal I flag Address match Watchdog timer Oscillation stop detection Voltage monitor 2 NOTE : 1. The IICSEL bit in the PMR register switches functions. Figure 12.10 Interrupt Priority Level Judgement Circuit Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 90 of 315 Interrupt request acknowledged R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 12.2 12. Interrupts INT Interrupt 12.2.1 INT0 Interrupt The INT0 interrupt is generated by an INT0 input. When using the INT0 interrupt, the INT0EN bit in the INTEN register is set to 1 (enable). The edge polarity is selected using the INT0PL bit in the INTEN register and the POL bit in the INT0IC register. Inputs can be passed through a digital filter with three different sampling clocks. The INT0 pin is shared with the external trigger input pin of timer Z. Figure 12.11 shows Registers INTEN and INT0F. External Input Enable Register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Symbol INTEN Bit Symbol INT0EN Address 0096h Bit Name _____ INT0 input enable bit(1) After Reset 00h Function RW INT0 input polarity select bit(2, 3) 0 : One edge 1 : Both edges RW Reserved bits Set to 0. _____ INT0PL — (b7-b2) RW 0 : Disable 1 : Enable RW NOTES : 1. Set the INT0EN bit w hile the INOSTG bit in the PUM register is set to 0 (one-shot trigger disabled). 2. When setting the INT0PL bit to 1 (both edges), set the POL bit in the INT0IC register to 0 (selects falling edge). 3. The IR bit in the INT0IC register may be set to 1 (requests interrupt) w hen the INT0PL bit is rew ritten. Refer to 12.5.5 Changing Interrupt Sources. _______ INT0 Input Filter Select Register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 Symbol INT0F Bit Symbol Address 001Eh Bit Name _____ INT0F0 INT0 input filter select bits INT0F1 — (b2) — (b7-b3) Figure 12.11 Reserved bit Page 91 of 315 RW b1 b0 0 0 : No filter 0 1 : Filter w ith f1 sampling 1 0 : Filter w ith f8 sampling 1 1 : Filter w ith f32 sampling Set to 0. Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0. When read, the content is 0. Registers INTEN and INT0F Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 After Reset 00h Function RW RW RW — R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 12.2.2 12. Interrupts INT0 Input Filter The INT0 input contains a digital filter. The sampling clock is selected by bits INT0F1 to INT0F0 in the INT0F register. The INT0 level is sampled every sampling clock cycle and if the sampled input level matches three times, the IR bit in the INT0IC register is set to 1 (interrupt requested). Figure 12.12 shows the Configuration of INT0 Input Filter. Figure 12.13 shows an Operating Example of INT0 Input Filter. INT0F1 to INT0F0 f1 f8 f32 INT0 Port P4_5 direction register = 01b = 10b Sampling clock = 11b INT0EN Digital filter (input level matches 3x) Other than INT0F1 to INT0F0 = 00b = 00b INT0F0, INT0F1: Bits in INT0F register INT0EN, INT0PL: Bits in INTEN register Figure 12.12 INT0 interrupt INT0PL = 0 Both edges detection INT0PL = 1 circuit Configuration of INT0 Input Filter INT0 input Sampling timing IR bit in INT0IC register Set to 0 by a program This is an operating example in which bits INT0F1 to INT0F0 in the INT0F register are set to 01b, 10b, or 11b (digital filter enabled). Figure 12.13 Operating Example of INT0 Input Filter Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 92 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 12.2.3 12. Interrupts INT1 Interrupt The INT1 interrupt is generated by an INT1 input. The edge polarity is selected by the R0EDG bit in the TXMR register. When the CNTRSEL bit in the UCON register is set to 0, the INT10 pin becomes the INT1 input pin. When the CNTRSEL bit is set to 1, the INT11 pin becomes the INT1 input pin. The INT10 pin is shared with the CNTR00 pin and the INT11 pin is shared with the CNTR01 pin. Figure 12.14 shows the TXMR Register when INT1 Interrupt is Used. Timer X Mode Register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol TXMR Bit Symbol TXMOD0 Address 008Bh Bit Name Operating mode select bits 0, 1(1) TXMOD1 After Reset 00h Function RW b1 b0 0 0 : Timer mode or pulse period measurement mode 0 1 : Do not set. 1 0 : Event count mode 1 1 : Pulse w idth measurement mode RW RW _____ R0EDG TXS INT1/CNTR0 polarity sw itch 0 : Rising edge 1 : Falling edge bit(2) 0 : Stops counting. Timer X count start flag(3) 1 : Starts counting. ________ TXOCNT TXMOD2 TXEDG TXUND P3_7/CNTR0 select bit Function varies depending on operating mode. Operating mode select bit 2 0 : Other than pulse period measurement mode 1 : Pulse period measurement mode Active edge reception flag Function varies depending on operating mode. Timer X underflow flag Function varies depending on operating mode. RW RW RW RW RW RW NOTES : _____ 1. When using INT1 interrupt, select modes other than pulse output mode. 2. The IR bit in the INT1IC register may be set to 1 (requests interrupt) w hen the R0EDG bit is rew ritten. Refer to 12.5.5 Changing Interrupt Sources. 3. Refer to 14.1.6 Notes on Tim er X for precautions regarding the TXS bit. Figure 12.14 TXMR Register when INT1 Interrupt is Used Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 93 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 12.2.4 12. Interrupts INT3 Interrupt The INT3 interrupt is generated by an INT3 input. Set the TCC07 bit in the TCC0 register to 0 (INT3). When the TCC06 bit in the TCC0 register is set to 0, an INT3 interrupt request is generated in synchronization with the count source of timer C. If the TCC06 bit is set to 1, the INT3 interrupt request is generated when an INT3 input occurs. The INT3 input contains a digital filter. The INT3 level is sampled every sampling clock cycle and if the sampled input level matches three times, the IR bit in the INT3IC register is set to 1 (interrupt requested). The sampling clock is selected by bits TCC11 to TCC10 in the TCC1 register. If filter is selected, the interrupt request is generated in synchronization with the sampling clock, even if the TCC06 bit is set to 1. The P3_3 bit in the P3 register indicates the value before filtering regardless of the contents set in bits TCC11 to TCC10. The INT3 pin is used with the TCIN pin. If the TCC07 bit is set to 1 (fRING128), the INT3 interrupt is generated by the fRING128 clock. The IR bit in the INT3IC register is set to 1 (interrupt requested) every fRING128 clock cycle or every half fRING128 clock cycle. Figure 12.15 shows the TCC0 Register and Figure 12.16 shows the TCC1 Register. Timer C Control Register 0 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 Symbol TCC0 Bit Symbol TCC00 Address 009Ah Bit Name Timer C count start bit After Reset 00h Function 0 : Stops counting. 1 : Starts counting. Timer C count source select bits (1) b2 b1 0 0 : f1 0 1 : f8 1 0 : f32 1 1 : fRING-fast TCC01 TCC02 _____ TCC03 0 0 : Rising edge 0 1 : Falling edge 1 0 : Both edges 1 1 : Do not set. (1,2) TCC04 — (b5) Set to 0. Reserved bit _____ TCC06 TCC07 RW RW RW b4 b3 INT3 interrupt and capture polarity select bits RW RW RW RW _____ INT3 interrupt request generation timing select bit(2,3) 0 : INT3 interrupt is generated in synchronization w ith timer C count. _____ 1 : INT3 interrupt is generated w hen _____ INT3 interrupt is input.(4) _____ 0 : INT3 1 : fRING128 _____ INT3 interrupt and capture input sw itch bit(1,2) RW RW NOTES : 1. Change this bit w hen the TCC00 bit is set to 0 (count stops). 2. The IR bit in the INT3IC register may be set to 1 (requests interrupt) w hen the TCC03, TCC04, TCC06, or TCC07 bit is rew ritten. Refer to 12.5.5 Changing Interrupt Sources. _____ 3. When the TCC13 bit is set to 1 (output compare mode) and an INT3 interrupt is input, regardless of the setting value of the TCC06 bit, an interrupt request is generated. _____ _____ 4. When using the INT3 filter, the INT3 interrupt is generated in synchronization w ith the clock for the digital filter. Figure 12.15 TCC0 Register Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 94 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 12. Interrupts Timer C Control Register 1 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol TCC1 Bit Symbol TCC10 _____ Address 009Bh Bit Name INT3 filter select bits (1) After Reset 00h Function b1b0 0 0 : No filter 0 1 : Filter w ith f1 sampling 1 0 : Filter w ith f8 sampling 1 1 : Filter w ith f32 sampling TCC11 TCC12 Timer C counter reload select bit(2,3) TCC13 Compare 0 / capture select bit 0 : Capture select (input capture mode) (2) 1 : Compare 0 output select (output compare mode) TCC14 TCC15 TCC16 TCC17 0 : No reload 1 : Set TC register to 0000h w hen compare 1 is matched. Compare 0 output mode select b5 b4 bits (3) 0 0 : CMP output remains unchanged even w hen compare 0 is matched. 0 1 : CMP output is reversed w hen compare 0 signal is matched. 1 0 : CMP output is set to “L” w hen compare 0 signal is matched. 1 1 : CMP output is set to “H” w hen compare 0 signal is matched. Compare 1 output mode select b7 b6 bits (3) 0 0 : CMP output remains unchanged even w hen compare 1 is matched. 0 1 : CMP output is reversed w hen compare 1 signal is matched. 1 0 : CMP output is set to “L” w hen compare 1 signal is matched. 1 1 : CMP output is set to “H” w hen compare 1 signal is matched. NOTES : _____ 1. When the same value from the INT3 pin is sampled three times continuously, the input is determined. 2. When the TCC00 bit in the TCC0 register is set to 0 (count stops), rew rite the TCC13 bit. 3. When the TCC13 bit is set to 0 (input capture mode), set bits TCC12 and TCC14 to TCC17 to 0. Figure 12.16 TCC1 Register Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 95 of 315 RW RW RW RW RW RW RW RW RW R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 12.3 12. Interrupts Key Input Interrupt A key input interrupt request is generated by one of the input edges of pins K10 to K13. The key input interrupt can be used as a key-on wake-up function to exit wait or stop mode. The KIiEN (i = 0 to 3) bit in the KIEN register can select whether or not the pins are used as KIi input. The KIiPL bit in the KIEN register can select the input polarity. When “L” is input to the KIi pin, which sets the KIiPL bit to 0 (falling edge), input to the other pins K10 to K13 is not detected as interrupts. Also, when “H” is input to the KIi pin, which sets the KIiPL bit to 1 (rising edge), input to the other pins K10 to K13 is not detected as interrupts. Figure 12.17 shows a Block Diagram of Key Input Interrupt. PU02 bit in PUR0 register KUPIC register Pull-up transistor PD1_3 bit in PD1 register KI3EN bit PD1_3 bit KI3PL = 0 KI3 KI3PL = 1 Pull-up transistor KI2EN bit PD1_2 bit KI2PL = 0 Interrupt control circuit KI2 KI2PL = 1 Pull-up transistor Key input interrupt request KI1EN bit PD1_1 bit KI1PL = 0 KI1 KI1PL = 1 Pull-up transistor KI0EN bit PD1_0 bit KI0PL = 0 KI0 KI0PL = 1 Figure 12.17 Block Diagram of Key Input Interrupt Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 96 of 315 KI0EN, KI1EN, KI2EN, KI3EN, KI0PL, KI1PL, KI2PL, KI3PL: Bits in KIEN register PD1_0, PD1_1, PD1_2, PD1_3: Bits in PD1 register R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 12. Interrupts Key Input Enable Register(1) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol KIEN Bit Symbol KI0EN KI0PL KI1EN KI1PL KI2EN KI2PL KI3EN KI3PL Address 0098h Bit Name KI0 input enable bit After Reset 00h Function RW KI0 input polarity select bit 0 : Falling edge 1 : Rising edge RW KI1 input enable bit 0 : Disable 1 : Enable RW KI1 input polarity select bit 0 : Falling edge 1 : Rising edge RW KI2 input enable bit 0 : Disable 1 : Enable RW KI2 input polarity select bit 0 : Falling edge 1 : Rising edge RW KI3 input enable bit 0 : Disable 1 : Enable RW KI3 input polarity select bit 0 : Falling edge 1 : Rising edge RW NOTE : 1. The IR bit in the KUPIC register may be set to 1 (requests interrupt) w hen the KIEN register is rew ritten. Refer to 12.5.5 Changing Interrupt Sources. Figure 12.18 KIEN Register Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 RW 0 : Disable 1 : Enable Page 97 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 12.4 12. Interrupts Address Match Interrupt An address match interrupt request is generated immediately before execution of the instruction at the address indicated by the RMADi register (i = 0, 1). This interrupt is used as a break function by the debugger. When using the on-chip debugger, do not set an address match interrupt (registers of AIER, RMAD0, and RMAD1 and fixed vector tables) in a user system. Set the starting address of any instruction in the RMADi register. Bits AIER0 and AIER1 in the AIER0 register can be used to select enable or disable of the interrupt. The I flag and IPL do not affect the address match interrupt. The value of the PC (Refer to 12.1.6.7 Saving a Register for the value of the PC) which is saved to the stack when an address match interrupt is acknowledged varies depending on the instruction at the address indicated by the RMADi register. (The appropriate return address is not saved on the stack.) When returning from the address match interrupt, return by one of the following means: • Change the content of the stack and use the REIT instruction. • Use an instruction such as POP to restore the stack as it was before the interrupt request was acknowledged. Then use a jump instruction. Table 12.6 lists the Values of PC Saved to Stack when Address Match Interrupt is Acknowledged. Figure 12.19 shows Registers AIER, and RMAD0 to RMAD1. Table 12.6 Values of PC Saved to Stack when Address Match Interrupt is Acknowledged Address Indicated by RMADi Register (i = 0,1) • Instruction with 2-byte operation code(2) • Instruction shown below among instruction with 1-byte operation code(2) ADD.B:S #IMM8,dest SUB.B:S #IMM8,dest AND.B:S #IMM8,dest OR.B:S #IMM8,dest MOV.B:S #IMM8,dest STZ.B:S #IMM8,dest STNZ.B:S #IMM8,dest STZX.B:S #IMM81,#IMM82,dest CMP.B:S #IMM8,dest PUSHM src POPM dest JMPS #IMM8 JSRS #IMM8 MOV.B:S #IMM,dest (however, dest = A0 or A1) • Instructions other than the above PC Value Saved(1) Address indicated by RMADi register + 2 Address indicated by RMADi register + 1 NOTES: 1. Refer to the 12.1.6.7 Saving a Register for the PC value saved. 2. Operation code: Refer for the “R8C/Tiny Series Software Manual (REJ09B0001)”. “Chapter 4. Instruction Code/Number of Cycles” contains diagrams showing operation code below each syntax. Operation code is shown in the bold frame in the diagrams. Table 12.7 Correspondence Between Address Match Interrupt Sources and Associated Registers Address Match Interrupt Source Address Match Interrupt Enable Bit Address Match Interrupt Register Address match interrupt 0 AIER0 RMAD0 Address match interrupt 1 AIER1 RMAD1 Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 98 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 12. Interrupts Address Match Interrupt Enable Register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol AIER Bit Symbol AIER0 AIER1 — (b7-b2) Address 0009h Bit Name Address match interrupt 0 enable bit 0 : Disable 1 : Enable After Reset 00h Function RW RW Address match interrupt 1 enable bit 0 : Disable 1 : Enable RW Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0. When read, the content is 0. — Address Match Interrupt Register i(i = 0,1) (b23) b7 (b19) b3 (b16) (b15) b0 b7 (b8) b0 b7 b0 Symbol RMAD0 RMAD1 Address 0012h-0010h 0016h-0014h Function Address setting register for address match interrupt — Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0. (b7-b4) When read, the content is undefined. Figure 12.19 Registers AIER, and RMAD0 to RMAD1 Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 99 of 315 After Reset X00000h X00000h Setting Range RW 00000h to FFFFFh RW — R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 12.5 12. Interrupts Notes on Interrupts 12.5.1 Reading Address 00000h Do not read address 00000h by a program. When a maskable interrupt request is acknowledged, the CPU reads interrupt information (interrupt number and interrupt request level) from 00000h in the interrupt sequence. At this time, the acknowledged interrupt IR bit is set to 0. If address 00000h is read by a program, the IR bit for the interrupt which has the highest priority among the enabled interrupts is set to 0. This may cause the interrupt to be canceled, or an unexpected interrupt to be generated. 12.5.2 SP Setting Set any value in the SP before an interrupt is acknowledged. The SP is set to 0000h after reset. Therefore, if an interrupt is acknowledged before setting a value in the SP, the program may run out of control. 12.5.3 External Interrupt and Key Input Interrupt Either “L” level or “H” level of at least 250 ns width is necessary for the signal input to pins INT0 to INT3 and pins KI0 to KI3, regardless of the CPU clock. 12.5.4 Watchdog Timer Interrupt Reset the watchdog timer after a watchdog timer interrupt is generated. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 100 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 12.5.5 12. Interrupts Changing Interrupt Sources The IR bit in the interrupt control register may be set to 1 (interrupt requested) when the interrupt source changes. When using an interrupt, set the IR bit to 0 (no interrupt requested) after changing the interrupt source. In addition, changes of interrupt sources include all factors that change the interrupt sources assigned to individual software interrupt numbers, polarities, and timing. Therefore, if a mode change of a peripheral function involves interrupt sources, edge polarities, and timing, set the IR bit to 0 (no interrupt requested) after the change. Refer to the individual peripheral function for its related interrupts. Figure 12.20 shows an Example of Procedure for Changing Interrupt Sources. Interrupt source change Disable interrupts (2, 3) Change interrupt source (including mode of peripheral function) Set the IR bit to 0 (interrupt not requested) using the MOV instruction(3) Enable interrupts (2, 3) Change completed IR bit: The interrupt control register bit of an interrupt whose source is changed. NOTES: 1. Execute the above settings individually. Do not execute two or more settings at once (by one instruction). 2. Use the I flag for the INTi (i = 0 to 3) interrupts. To prevent interrupt requests from being generated when using peripheral function interrupts other than the INTi interrupt, disable the peripheral function before changing the interrupt source. In this case, use the I flag if all maskable interrupts can be disabled. If all maskable interrupts cannot be disabled, use bits ILVL0 to ILVL2 of the interrupt whose source is changed. 3. Refer to 12.5.6 Changing Interrupt Control Register for the instructions to be used and usage notes. Figure 12.20 Example of Procedure for Changing Interrupt Sources Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 101 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 12.5.6 12. Interrupts Changing Interrupt Control Register Contents (a) The contents of an interrupt control register can only be changed while no interrupt requests corresponding to that register are generated. If interrupt requests may be generated, disable interrupts before changing the interrupt control register contents. (b) When changing the contents of an interrupt control register after disabling interrupts, be careful to choose appropriate instructions. Changing any bit other than IR bit If an interrupt request corresponding to a register is generated while executing the instruction, the IR bit may not be set to 1 (interrupt requested), and the interrupt request may be ignored. If this causes a problem, use the following instructions to change the register: AND, OR, BCLR, BSET Changing IR bit If the IR bit is set to 0 (interrupt not requested), it may not be set to 0 depending on the instruction used. Therefore, use the MOV instruction to set the IR bit to 0. (c) When disabling interrupts using the I flag, set the I flag as shown in the sample programs below. Refer to (b) regarding changing the contents of interrupt control registers by the sample programs. Sample programs 1 to 3 are for preventing the I flag from being set to 1 (interrupts enabled) before the interrupt control register is changed for reasons of the internal bus or the instruction queue buffer. Example 1: Use NOP instructions to prevent I flag from being set to 1 before interrupt control register is changed INT_SWITCH1: FCLR I ; Disable interrupts AND.B #00H,0056H ; Set TXIC register to 00h NOP ; NOP FSET I ; Enable interrupts Example 2: Use dummy read to delay FSET instruction INT_SWITCH2: FCLR I ; Disable interrupts AND.B #00H,0056H ; Set TXIC register to 00h MOV.W MEM,R0 ; Dummy read FSET I ; Enable interrupts Example 3: Use POPC instruction to change I flag INT_SWITCH3: PUSHC FLG FCLR I ; Disable interrupts AND.B #00H,0056H ; Set TXIC register to 00h POPC FLG ; Enable interrupts Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 102 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 13. Watchdog Timer 13. Watchdog Timer The watchdog timer is a function that detects when a program is out of control. Use of the watchdog timer is recommended to improve the reliability of the system. The watchdog timer contains a 15-bit counter and allows selection of count source protection mode enable or disable. Table 13.1 lists information on the Count Source Protection Mode. Refer to 6.5 Watchdog Timer Reset for details on the watchdog timer reset. Figure 13.1 shows the Block Diagram of Watchdog Timer and Figures 13.2 to 13.3 show Registers OFS, WDC, WDTR, WDTS, and CSPR. Table 13.1 Count Source Protection Mode Count Source Protection Mode Disabled CPU clock Item Count source Count operation Reset condition of watchdog timer Count Source Protection Mode Enabled Low-speed on-chip oscillator clock Decrement • Reset • Write 00h to the WDTR register before writing FFh • underflow Either of the following can be selected • After reset, count starts automatically • Count starts by writing to WDTS register Stop mode, wait mode None Watchdog timer interrupt or Watchdog timer reset watchdog timer reset Count start condition Count stop condition Operation at time of underflow Prescaler 1/16 WDC7 = 0 CSPRO = 0 1/128 CPU clock PM12 = 0 Watchdog timer interrupt request Watchdog timer WDC7 = 1 fRING-S CSPRO = 1 Write to WDTR register Set to 7FFFh(1) PM12 = 1 Watchdog timer reset Internal reset signal CSPRO: Bit in CSPR register WDC7: Bit in WDC register PM12: Bit in PM1 register NOTE: 1. When the CSPRO bit is set to 1 (count source protection mode enabled), 0FFFh is set. Figure 13.1 Block Diagram of Watchdog Timer Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 103 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 13. Watchdog Timer Option Function Select Register(1) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 1 1 1 1 Symbol OFS Bit Symbol WDTON — (b1) ROMCR ROMCP1 — (b6-b4) Address 0FFFFh Bit Name Watchdog timer start select bit Before Shipment FFh(2) Function 0 : Starts w atchdog timer automatically after reset. 1 : Watchdog timer is inactive after reset. Reserved bit Set to 1. ROM code protect disabled bit 0 : ROM code protect disabled 1 : ROMCP1 enabled RW ROM code protect bit 0 : ROM code protect enabled 1 : ROM code protect disabled RW Reserved bits Set to 1. RW RW RW RW Count source protection 0 : Count source protect mode enabled after reset CSPROINI mode after reset select 1 : Count source protect mode disabled after reset bit RW NOTES : 1. The OFS register is on the flash memory. Write to the OFS register w ith a program. 2. If the block including the OFS register is erased, FFh is set to the OFS register. Watchdog Timer Control Register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 0 Symbol Address 000Fh WDC Bit Symbol Bit Name — High-order bits of w atchdog timer (b4-b0) — (b5) Reserved bit Set to 0. When read, the content is undefined. — (b6) Reserved bit Set to 0. Prescaler select bit 0 : Divided by 16 1 : Divided by 128 WDC7 Figure 13.2 Registers OFS and WDC Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 After Reset 00X11111b Function Page 104 of 315 RW RO RW RW RW R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 13. Watchdog Timer Watchdog Timer Reset Register b7 b0 Symbol WDTR Address 000Dh After Reset Undefined Function When 00h is w ritten before w riting FFh, the w atchdog timer is reset.(1) The default value of the w atchdog timer is 7FFFh w hen count source protection mode is disabled and 0FFFh w hen count source protection mode is enabled.(2) RW WO NOTES : 1. Do not generate an interrupt betw een w hen 00h and FFh are w ritten. 2. When the CSPRO bit in the CSPR register is set to 1 (count source protection mode enabled), 0FFFh is set in the w atchdog timer. Watchdog Timer Start Register b7 b0 Symbol WDTS Address 000Eh After Reset Undefined Function The w atchdog timer starts counting after a w rite instruction to this register. RW WO Count Source Protection Mode Register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Symbol Address 001Ch CSPR Bit Symbol Bit Name — Reserved bits (b6-b0) CSPRO After Reset(1) 00h Function Set to 0. Count source protection mode 0 : Count source protection mode disabled 1 : Count source protection mode enabled select bit(2) NOTES : 1. When 0 is w itten to the CSPROINI bit in the OFS register, the value after reset is 10000000b. 2. Write 0 before w riting 1 to set the CSPRO bit to 1. 0 cannot be set by a program. Figure 13.3 Registers WDTR, WDTS, and CSPR Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 105 of 315 RW RW RW R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 13.1 13. Watchdog Timer Count Source Protection Mode Disabled The count source of the watchdog timer is the CPU clock when count source protection mode is disabled. Table 13.2 lists the Watchdog Timer Specifications (with Count Source Protection Mode Disabled). Table 13.2 Watchdog Timer Specifications (with Count Source Protection Mode Disabled) Item Count source Count operation Period Specification CPU clock Decrement Division ratio of prescaler (n) × count value of watchdog timer (32768)(1) CPU clock n: 16 or 128 (selected by WDC7 bit in WDC register) Example: When the CPU clock frequency is 16 MHz and prescaler divides by 16, the period is approximately 32.8 ms. Count start conditions The WDTON bit(2) in the OFS register (0FFFFh) selects the operation of the watchdog timer after a reset. • When the WDTON bit is set to 1 (watchdog timer is in stop state after reset). The watchdog timer and prescaler stop after a reset and the count starts when the WDTS register is written to. • When the WDTON bit is set to 0 (watchdog timer starts automatically after exiting). The watchdog timer and prescaler start counting automatically after reset. Reset condition of watchdog • Reset • Write 00h to the WDTR register before writing FFh. timer • Underflow Count stop condition Stop and wait modes (inherit the count from the held value after exiting modes) Operation at time of underflow • When the PM12 bit in the PM1 register is set to 0. Watchdog timer interrupt • When the PM12 bit in the PM1 register is set to 1. Watchdog timer reset (Refer to 6.5 Watchdog Timer Reset.) NOTES: 1. The watchdog timer is reset when 00h is witten to the WDTR register before FFh. The prescaler is reset after the MCU is reset. Some errors in the period of the watchdog timer may be caused by the prescaler. 2. The WDTON bit cannot be changed by a program. To set the WDTON bit, write 0 to bit 0 of address 0FFFFh with a flash programmer. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 106 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 13.2 13. Watchdog Timer Count Source Protection Mode Enabled The count source of the watchdog timer is the low-speed on-chip oscillator clock when count source protection mode is enabled. If the CPU clock stops when a program is out of control, the clock can still be supplied to the watchdog timer. Table 13.3 lists the Watchdog Timer Specifications (with Count Source Protection Mode Enabled). Table 13.3 Watchdog Timer Specifications (with Count Source Protection Mode Enabled) Item Count source Count operation Period Specification Low-speed on-chip oscillator clock Decrement Count value of watchdog timer (4096) Low-speed on-chip oscillator clock Example: Period is approximately 32.8 ms when the low-speed on-chip oscillator clock frequency is 125 kHz Count start conditions The WDTON bit(1) in the OFS register (0FFFFh) selects the operation of the watchdog timer after a reset. • When the WDTON bit is set to 1 (watchdog timer is in stop state after reset). The watchdog timer and prescaler stop after a reset and the count starts when the WDTS register is written to. • When the WDTON bit is set to 0 (watchdog timer starts automatically after reset). The watchdog timer and prescaler start counting automatically after a reset. • Reset • Write 00h to the WDTR register before writing FFh. • Underflow None (The count does not stop in wait mode after the count starts. The MCU does not enter stop mode.) Watchdog timer reset (Refer to 6.5 Watchdog Timer Reset.) Reset condition of watchdog timer Count stop condition Operation at time of underflow Registers, bits • When setting the CSPPRO bit in the CSPR register to 1 (count source protection mode is enabled)(2), the following are set automatically - Set 0FFFh to the watchdog timer - Set the CM14 bit in the CM1 register to 0 (low-speed on-chip oscillator on) - Set the PM12 bit in the PM1 register to 1 (The watchdog timer is reset when watchdog timer underflows) • The following conditions apply in count source protection mode - Writing to the CM10 bit in the CM1 register is disabled. (It remains unchanged even if it is set to 1. The MCU does not enter stop mode.) - Writing to the CM14 bit in the CM1 register is disabled. (It remains unchanged even if it is set to 1. The low-speed on-chip oscillator does not stop.) NOTES: 1. The WDTON bit cannot be changed by a program. To set the WDTON bit, write 0 to bit 0 of address 0FFFFh with a flash programmer. 2. Even if 0 is written to the CSPROINI bit in the OFS register, the CSPRO bit is set to 1. The CSPROINI bit cannot be changed by a program. To set the CSPROINI bit, write 0 to bit 7 of address 0FFFFh with a flash programmer. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 107 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 14. Timers 14. Timers The MCU has two 8-bit timers with 8-bit prescalers, and a 16-bit timer. The two 8-bit timers with 8-bit prescalers are timer X and timer Z. These timers contain a reload register to store the default value of the counter. The 16-bit timer is timer C, and has input capture and output compare functions. All the timers operate independently. The count source for each timer is the operating clock that regulates the timing of timer operations such as counting and reloading. Table 14.1 lists Functional Comparison of Timers. Table 14.1 Functional Comparison of Timers Item Configuration Count Count sources Function Timer mode Pulse output mode Event counter mode Pulse width measurement mode Pulse period measurement mode Programmable waveform generation mode Programmable one-shot generation mode Programmable wait oneshot generation mode Input capture mode Output compare mode Input pin Output pin Related interrupt Timer stop Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Timer X 8-bit timer with 8-bit prescaler (with reload register) Decrement • f1 • f2 • f8 • fRING Provided Provided Provided Provided Timer Z 8-bit timer with 8-bit prescaler (with reload register) Decrement • f1 • f2 • f8 • Timer X underflow Provided Not provided Not provided Not provided Timer C 16-bit free-run timer (with input capture and output compare) Increment • f1 • f8 • f32 • fRING-fast Not provided Not provided Not provided Not provided Provided Not provided Not provided Not provided Provided Not provided Not provided Provided Not provided Not provided Provided Not provided Not provided Not provided CNTR0 Not provided Not provided Provided Provided TCIN CNTR0 CNTR0 Timer X interrupt INT1 interrupt Provided Page 108 of 315 INT0 TZOUT Timer Z interrupt INT0 interrupt Provided CMP0_0 to CMP0_2 CMP1_0 to CMP1_2 Timer C interrupt INT3 interrupt Compare 0 interrupt Compare 1 interrupt Provided R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 14.1 14. Timers Timer X Timer X is an 8-bit timer with an 8-bit prescaler. The prescaler and timer each consist of a reload register and counter. The reload register and counter are allocated at the same address, and can be accessed when accessing registers PREX and TX (refer to Tables 14.2 to 14.6 the Specifications of Each Mode). Figure 14.1 shows a Block Diagram of Timer X. Figures 14.2 and 14.3 show the registers associated with Timer X. Timer X has the following five operating modes: • Timer mode: The timer counts the internal count source. • Pulse output mode: The timer counts the internal count source and outputs pulses which inverts the polarity by underflow of the timer. • Event counter mode: The timer counts external pulses. • Pulse width measurement mode: The timer measures the pulse width of an external pulse. • Pulse period measurement mode: The timer measures the pulse period of an external pulse. Data Bus TXCK1 to TXCK0 = 00b f1 f8 fRING f2 = 01b TXMOD1 to TXMOD0 = 00b or 01b = 10b = 11b Reload register Reload register = 11b Counter PREX register = 10b Counter TXS bit CNTRSEL = 1 INT11/CNTR01 Polarity switching INT10/CNTR00 CNTRSEL = 0 Timer X interrupt TX register TXMOD1 to TXMOD0 bits = 01b INT1 interrupt R0EDG = 1 Q TXOCNT bit Q R0EDG = 0 Toggle flip-flop CK CLR Write to TX register Bits TXMOD1 to TXMOD0 = 01b CNTR0 TXMOD0 to TXMOD1, R0EDG, TXS, TXOCNT: Bits in TXMR register TXCK0 to TXCK1: Bits in TCSS register CNTRSEL: Bit in UCON register Figure 14.1 Block Diagram of Timer X Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 109 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 14. Timers Timer X Mode Register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol TXMR Bit Symbol Address 008Bh Bit Name Operating mode select bits 0, 1 TXMOD1 _____ TXS INT1/CNTR0 signal polarity sw itch bit(1) Timer X count start flag(2) ________ TXOCNT TXEDG TXUND Function varies depending on operating mode. 0 : Stops counting. 1 : Starts counting. P3_7/CNTR0 select bit Function varies depending on operating mode. Operating mode select bit 2 0 : Other than pulse period measurement mode 1 : Pulse period measurement mode TXMOD2 Active edge judgment flag Function varies depending on operating mode. Timer X underflow flag Function varies depending on operating mode. NOTES : 1. The IR bit in the INT1IC register may be set to 1 (requests interrupt) w hen the R0EDG bit is rew ritten. Refer to 12.5.5 Changing Interrupt Sources. 2. Refer to 14.1.6 Notes on Tim er X for precautions regarding the TXS bit. Figure 14.2 TXMR Register Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 110 of 315 RW b1 b0 0 0 : Timer mode or pulse period measurement mode 0 1 : Pulse output mode 1 0 : Event counter mode 1 1 : Pulse w idth measurement mode TXMOD0 R0EDG After Reset 00h Function RW RW RW RW RW RW RW RW R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 14. Timers Prescaler X Register b7 b0 Symbol PREX Mode Timer mode Pulse output mode Event counter mode Address 008Ch Function Counts internal count source. Counts internal count source. Counts input pulses from external clock. After Reset FFh Setting Range 00h to FFh 00h to FFh RW RW RW 00h to FFh RW Pulse w idth measurement mode Measures pulse w idth of input pulses from external clock (counts internal count source). 00h to FFh RW Pulse period measurement mode Measures pulse period of input pulses from external clock (counts internal count source). 00h to FFh RW After Reset FFh Setting Range RW 00h to FFh RW Timer X Register b7 b0 Symbol TX Address 008Dh Function Counts underflow of prescaler X Timer Count Source Setting Register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 0 0 0 Symbol TCSS Bit Symbol TXCK0 Address 008Eh Bit Name Timer X count source select bits (1) TXCK1 — (b3-b2) TZCK0 b1 b0 0 0 : f1 0 1 : f8 1 0 : fRING 1 1 : f2 Reserved bits Set to 0. Timer Z count source select bits (1) b5 b4 TZCK1 — (b7-b6) After Reset 00h Function Reserved bits 0 0 : f1 0 1 : f8 1 0 : Selects timer X underflow . 1 1 : f2 Set to 0. NOTE : 1. Do not sw itch count sources during a count operation. Stop the timer count before sw itching count sources. Figure 14.3 Registers PREX, TX, and TCSS Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 111 of 315 RW RW RW RW RW RW RW R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 14.1.1 14. Timers Timer Mode In timer mode, the timer counts an internally generated count source (refer to Table 14.2 Timer Mode Specifications). Figure 14.4 shows the TXMR Register in Timer Mode. Table 14.2 Timer Mode Specifications Item Count sources Count operations Specification f1, f2, f8, fRING • Decrement • When the timer underflows, the contents of the reload register are reloaded and the count is continued. 1/(n+1)(m+1) n: value set in PREX register, m: value set in TX register 1 (count starts) is written to the TXS bit in the TXMR register. 0 (count stops) is written to the TXS bit in the TXMR register. When timer X underflows [timer X interrupt]. Divide ratio Count start condition Count stop condition Interrupt request generation timing INT10/CNTR00, INT11/CNTR01 pin functions Programmable I/O port, or INT1 interrupt input CNTR0 pin function Read from timer Write to timer Programmable I/O port The count value can be read out by reading registers TX and PREX. • When registers TX and PREX are written while the count is stopped, values are written to both the reload register and counter. • When registers TX and PREX are written during the count, the value is written to each reload register of registers TX and PREX at the following count source input, the data is transferred to the counter at the second count source input, and the count re-starts at the third count source input. Timer X Mode Register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Symbol TXMR Bit Symbol TXMOD0 Address 008Bh Bit Name Operating mode select bits 0, 1 After Reset 00h Function b1 b0 0 0 : Timer mode or pulse period measurement mode TXMOD1 TXS TXOCNT TXMOD2 TXEDG TXUND INT1/CNTR0 signal polarity sw itch bit(1, 2) Timer X count start flag(3) Set to 0 in timer mode. Operating mode select bit 2 Set to 0 in timer mode. Set to 0 in timer mode. 0 : Rising edge 1 : Falling edge RW 0 : Stops counting. 1 : Starts counting. RW 0 : Other than pulse period measurement mode NOTES : 1. The IR bit in the INT1IC register may be set to 1 (requests interrupt) w hen the R0EDG bit is rew ritten. Refer to 12.5.5 Changing Interrupt Sources. _____ 2. This bit is used to select the polarity of INT1 interrupt in timer mode. 3. Refer to 14.1.6 Notes on Tim er X for precautions regarding the TXS bit. Figure 14.4 TXMR Register in Timer Mode Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 RW RW _____ R0EDG RW Page 112 of 315 RW RW RW RW R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 14.1.2 14. Timers Pulse Output Mode In pulse output mode, the internally generated count source is counted, and a pulse with inverted polarity is output from the CNTR0 pin each time the timer underflows (refer to Table 14.3 Pulse Output Mode Specifications). Figure 14.5 shows the TXMR Register in Pulse Output Mode. Table 14.3 Pulse Output Mode Specifications Item Count sources Count operations Divide ratio Count start condition Count stop condition Interrupt request generation timing Specification f1, f2, f8, fRING • Decrement • When the timer underflows, the contents of the reload register are reloaded and the count is continued. 1/(n+1)(m+1) n: value set in PREX register, m: value set in TX register 1 (count starts) is written to the TXS bit in the TXMR register. 0 (count stops) is written to the TXS bit in the TXMR register. When timer X underflows [timer X interrupt]. INT10/CNTR00 pin function Pulse output CNTR0 pin function Programmable I/O port, or inverted output of CNTR0 Read from timer Write to timer The count value can be read out by reading registers TX and PREX. Select functions • INT1/CNTR0 signal polarity switch function The R0EDG bit can select the polarity level when the pulse output starts.(1) • Inverted pulse output function The pulse which inverts the polarity of the CNTR0 output can be output from the CNTR0 pin (selected by TXOCNT bit). • When registers TX and PREX are written while the count is stopped, values are written to both the reload register and counter. • When registers TX and PREX are written during the count, the value is written to each reload register of registers TX and PREX at the following count source input, the data is transferred to the counter at the second count source input, and the count re-starts at the third count source input. NOTE: 1. The level of the output pulse becomes the level when the pulse output starts when the TX register is written to. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 113 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 14. Timers Timer X Mode Register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 0 0 0 1 Symbol TXMR Bit Symbol TXMOD0 Address 008Bh Bit Name Operating mode select bits 0, 1 After Reset 00h Function b1 b0 0 1 : Pulse output mode TXMOD1 TXS INT1/CNTR0 signal polarity sw itch bit(1) Timer X count start flag(2) ________ TXOCNT TXMOD2 TXEDG TXUND P3_7/CNTR0 select bit 0 : CNTR0 signal output starts at “H”. 1 : CNTR0 signal output starts at “L”. RW 0 : Stops counting. 1 : Starts counting. RW 0 : Port P3_7 ________ 1 : CNTR0 output Set to 0 in pulse output mode. Set to 0 in pulse output mode. Set to 0 in pulse output mode. NOTES : 1. The IR bit in the INT1IC register may be set to 1 (requests interrupt) w hen the R0EDG bit is rew ritten. Refer to 12.5.5 Changing Interrupt Sources. 2. Refer to 14.1.6 Notes on Tim er X for precautions regarding the TXS bit. Figure 14.5 TXMR Register in Pulse Output Mode Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 RW RW _____ R0EDG RW Page 114 of 315 RW RW RW RW R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 14.1.3 14. Timers Event Counter Mode In event counter mode, external signal inputs to the INT1/CNTR0 pin are counted (refer to Table 14.4 Event Counter Mode Specifications). Figure 14.6 shows the TXMR Register in Event Counter Mode. Table 14.4 Event Counter Mode Specifications Item Count source Count operations Specification External signal which is input to CNTR0 pin (Active edge selectable by software) • Decrement • When the timer underflows, the contents of the reload register are reloaded and the count is continued. 1/(n+1)(m+1) n: value set in PREX register, m: value set in TX register 1 (count starts) is written to the TXS bit in the TXMR register. 0 (count stops) is written to the TXS bit in the TXMR register. • When timer X underflows [timer X interrupt] Divide ratio Count start condition Count stop condition Interrupt request generation timing INT10/CNTR00, INT11/CNTR01 pin functions Count source input (INT1 interrupt input) CNTR0 pin function Read from timer Write to timer Programmable I/O port Select functions • INT1/CNTR0 signal polarity switch function The R0EDG bit can select the active edge of the count source. • Count source input pin select function The CNTRSEL bit in the UCON register can select the CNTR00 or CNTR01 pin. The count value can be read out by reading registers TX and PREX. • When registers TX and PREX are written while the count is stopped, values are written to both the reload register and counter. • When registers TX and PREX are written during the count, the value is written to each reload register of registers TX and PREX at the following count source input, the data is transferred to the counter at the second count source input, and the count re-starts at the third count source input. Timer X Mode Register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 0 0 0 1 0 Symbol Address 008Bh TXMR Bit Symbol Bit Name TXMOD0 Operating mode select bits 0, 1 TXMOD1 _____ R0EDG TXS TXOCNT TXMOD2 TXEDG TXUND INT1/CNTR0 signal polarity sw itch bit(1) Timer X count start flag(2) Set to 0 in event counter Set to 0 in event counter Set to 0 in event counter Set to 0 in event counter After Reset 00h Function b1 b0 1 0 : Event counter mode 0 : Rising edge 1 : Falling edge RW 0 : Stops counting. 1 : Starts counting. RW mode. mode. mode. mode. NOTES : 1. The IR bit in the INT1IC register may be set to 1 (requests interrupt) w hen the R0EDG bit is rew ritten. Refer to 12.5.5 Changing Interrupt Sources. 2. Refer to 14.1.6 Notes on Tim er X for precautions regarding the TXS bit. Figure 14.6 TXMR Register in Event Counter Mode Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 115 of 315 RW RW RW RW RW RW RW R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 14.1.4 14. Timers Pulse Width Measurement Mode In pulse width measurement mode, the pulse width of an external signal input to the INT1/CNTR0 pin is measured (refer to Table 14.5 Pulse Width Measurement Mode Specifications). Figure 14.7 shows the TXMR Register in Pulse Width Measurement Mode. Figure 14.8 shows an Operating Example in Pulse Width Measurement Mode. Table 14.5 Pulse Width Measurement Mode Specifications Item Count sources Count operations Count start condition Count stop condition Interrupt request generation timing Specification f1, f2, f8, fRING • Decrement • Continuously counts the selected signal only when the measured pulse is “H” level, or conversely only “L” level. • When the timer underflows, the contents of the reload register are reloaded and the count is continued. 1 (count starts) is written to the TXS bit in the TXMR register. 0 (count stops) is written to the TXS bit in the TXMR register. • When timer X underflows [timer X interrupt]. • Rising or falling of the CNTR0 input (end of measurement period) [INT1 interrupt] INT10/CNTR00, INT11/CNTR01 pin functions Measured pulse input (INT1 interrupt input) CNTR0 pin function Read from timer Write to timer Programmable I/O port Select functions Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 The count value can be read out by reading registers TX and PREX. • When registers TX and PREX are written while the count is stopped, values are written to both the reload register and counter. • When registers TX and PREX are written during the count, the value is written to each reload register of registers TX and PREX at the following count source input, the data is transferred to the counter at the second count source input, and the count re-starts at the third count source input. • INT1/CNTR0 signal polarity switch function The R0EDG bit can select “H” or “L” level period for the input pulse width measurement. • Measured pulse input pin select function The CNTRSEL bit in the UCON register can select the CNTR00 or CNTR01 pin. Page 116 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 14. Timers Timer X Mode Register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 0 0 0 1 1 Symbol Address 008Bh TXMR Bit Symbol Bit Name TXMOD0 Operating mode select bits 0, 1 TXMOD1 _____ R0EDG INT1/CNTR0 signal polarity sw itch bit(1) After Reset 00h Function b1 b0 1 1 : Pulse w idth measurement mode [CNTR0] 0 : Measures “L” level w idth 1 : Measures “H” level w idth _______ [INT1] 0 : Rising edge 1 : Falling edge TXS TXOCNT TXMOD2 TXEDG TXUND Timer X count start flag(2) 0 : Stops counting. 1 : Starts counting. Set to 0 in pulse w idth measurement mode. Set to 0 in pulse w idth measurement mode. Set to 0 in pulse w idth measurement mode. Set to 0 in pulse w idth measurement mode. NOTES : 1. The IR bit in the INT1IC register may be set to 1 (requests interrupt) w hen the R0EDG bit is rew ritten. Refer to 12.5.5 Changing Interrupt Sources. 2. Refer to 14.1.6 Notes on Tim er X for precautions regarding the TXS bit. Figure 14.7 TXMR Register in Pulse Width Measurement Mode Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 117 of 315 RW RW RW RW RW RW RW RW RW R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 14. Timers n = high level: the contents of TX register, low level: the contents of PREX register FFFFh Count start Underflow Counter contents (hex) n Count stop Count stop Count start 0000h Period Set to 1 by program TXS bit in TXMR register 1 Measured pulse (CNTR0i pin input) 1 0 0 Set to 0 when interrupt request is acknowledged, or set by program IR bit in INT1IC register 1 0 Set to 0 when interrupt request is acknowledged, or set by program IR bit in TXIC register 1 0 Conditions: “H” level width of measured pulse is measured. (R0EDG = 1) i = 0 to 1 Figure 14.8 Operating Example in Pulse Width Measurement Mode Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 118 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 14.1.5 14. Timers Pulse Period Measurement Mode In pulse period measurement mode, the pulse period of an external signal input to the INT1/CNTR0 pin is measured (refer to Table 14.6 Pulse Period Measurement Mode Specifications). Figure 14.9 shows the TXMR Register in Pulse Period Measurement Mode. Figure 14.10 shows an Operating Example in Pulse Period Measurement Mode. Table 14.6 Pulse Period Measurement Mode Specifications Item Count sources Count operations Count start condition Count stop condition Interrupt request generation timing Specification f1, f2, f8, fRING • Decrement • After an active edge of the measured pulse is input, contents for the read-out buffer are retained at the first underflow of prescaler X. Then timer X reloads contents in the reload register at the second underflow of prescaler X and continues counting. 1 (count starts) is written to the TXS bit in the TXMR register. 0 (count stops) is written to the TXS bit in the TXMR register. • When timer X underflows or reloads [timer X interrupt]. • Rising or falling of CNTR0 input (end of measurement period) [INT1 interrupt] INT10/CNTR00, INT11/CNTR01 pin functions Measured pulse input(1) (INT1 interrupt input) CNTR0 pin function Read from timer Programmable I/O port Write to timer Select functions Contents of the read-out buffer can be read out by reading the TX register. The value retained in the read-out buffer is released by reading the TX register. • When registers TX and PREX are written while the count is stopped, values are written to both the reload register and counter. • When registers TX and PREX are written during the count, the value is written to each reload register of registers TX and PREX at the following count source input, the data is transferred to the counter at the second count source input, and the count re-starts at the third count source input. • INT1/CNTR0 polarity switch function The R0EDG bit can select the measurement period for the input pulse. • Measured pulse input pin select function The CNTRSEL bit in the UCON register can select the CNTR00 or CNTR01 pin. NOTE: 1. Input a pulse with a period longer than twice of the prescaler X period. Input a pulse with a longer “H” and “L” width than the prescaler X period. If a pulse with a shorter period is input to the CNTR0 pin, the input may be ignored. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 119 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 14. Timers Timer X Mode Register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 1 0 0 0 Symbol TXMR Bit Symbol TXMOD0 Address 008Bh Bit Name Operating mode select bits 0, 1 After Reset 00h Function b1 b0 0 0 : Timer mode or pulse period measurement mode TXMOD1 RW RW RW _____ INT1/CNTR0 signal polarity sw itch bit(1) R0EDG [CNTR0] 0 : Measures measured pulse from one rising edge to next rising edge. 1 : Measures measured pulse from one falling edge to next falling edge. RW ______ [INT1] 0 : Rising edge 1 : Falling edge TXS TXOCNT TXMOD2 TXEDG(2) TXUND(2) Timer X count start flag(3) 0 : Stops counting. 1 : Starts counting. Set to 0 in pulse w idth measurement mode. Operating mode select bit 2 1 : Pulse period measurement mode Active edge judgment flag 0 : Active edge not received 1 : Active edge received Timer X underflow flag 0 : No underflow 1 : Underflow NOTES : 1. The IR bit in the INT1IC register may be set to 1 (requests interrupt) w hen the R0EDG bit is rew ritten. Refer to 12.5.5 Changing Interrupt Sources. 2. This bit is set to 0 by w riting 0 in a program. (It remains unchanged even if w riting 1.) 3. Refer to 14.1.6 Notes on Tim er X for precautions regarding the TXS bit. Figure 14.9 TXMR Register in Pulse Period Measurement Mode Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 120 of 315 RW RW RW RW RW R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 14. Timers Underflow signal of prescaler X Set to 1 by program TXS bit in TXMR register 1 0 Starts counting CNTR0i pin input 1 0 Timer X reloads Timer X reloads 0Fh 0Eh 0Dh 0Fh 0Eh 0Dh 0Ch 0Bh 0Ah 09h 0Fh 0Eh 0Dh Contents of timer X Contents of read-out buffer1 0Fh 0Eh 01h 00h 0Fh 0Eh Retained Retained 0Dh 0Bh 0Ah 09h (2) 0Dh 01h 00h 0Fh 0Eh Timer X read(3) Timer X read(3) TXEDG bit in TXMR register Timer X reloads (2) 1 0 Set to 0 by program(4) (6) TXUND bit in TXMR register 1 0 Set to 0 by program(5) IR bit in TXIC register 1 0 Set to 0 when interrupt request is acknowledged, or set by program IR bit in INT1IC register 1 0 Set to 0 when interrupt request is acknowledged, or set by program Conditions: The period from one rising edge to the next rising edge of the measured pulse is measured (R0EDG = 0) with the default value of the TX register as 0Fh. i = 0 to 1 NOTES : 1. The contents of the read-out buffer can be read by reading the TX register in pulse period measurement mode. 2. After an active edge of the measured pulse is input, the TXEDG bit in the TXMR register is set to 1 (active edge found) when the prescale X underflows for the second time. 3. The TX register should be read before the next active edge is input after the TXEDG bit is set to 1 (active edge found). The contents in the read-out buffer are retained until the TX register is read. If the TX register is not read before the next active edge is input, the measured result of the previous period is retained. 4. To set to 0 by a program, use a MOV instruction to write 0 to the TXEDG in the TXMR register. At the same time, write 1 to the TXUND bit. 5. To set to 0 by a program, use a MOV instruction to write 0 to the TXUND in the TXMR register. At the same time, write 1 to the TXEDG bit. 6. Bits TXUND and TXEDG are both set to 1 if timer X underflows and reloads on an active edge simultaneously. Figure 14.10 Operating Example in Pulse Period Measurement Mode Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 121 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 14.1.6 14. Timers Notes on Timer X • Timer X stops counting after a reset. Set the values in the timer and prescaler before the count starts. • Even if the prescaler and timer are read out in 16-bit units, these registers are read 1 byte at a time by the MCU. Consequently, the timer value may be updated during the period when these two registers are being read. • Do not rewrite bits TXMOD0 to TXMOD1, and bits TXMOD2 and TXS simultaneously. • In pulse period measurement mode, bits TXEDG and TXUND in the TXMR register can be set to 0 by writing 0 to these bits by a program. However, these bits remain unchanged if 1 is written. When using the READ-MODIFY-WRITE instruction for the TXMR register, the TXEDG or TXUND bit may be set to 0 although these bits are set to 1 while the instruction is being executed. In this case, write 1 to the TXEDG or TXUND bit which is not supposed to be set to 0 with the MOV instruction. • When changing to pulse period measurement mode from another mode, the contents of bits TXEDG and TXUND are undefined. Write 0 to bits TXEDG and TXUND before the count starts. • The TXEDG bit may be set to 1 by the prescaler X underflow generated after the count starts. • When using the pulse period measurement mode, leave two or more periods of the prescaler X immediately after the count starts, then set the TXEDG bit to 0. • The TXS bit in the TXMR register has a function to instruct timer X to start or stop counting and a function to indicate that the count has started or stopped. 0 (count stops) can be read until the following count source is applied after 1 (count starts) is written to the TXS bit while the count is being stopped. If the following count source is applied, 1 can be read from the TXS bit. After writing 1 to the TXS bit, do not access registers associated with timer X (registers TXMR, PREX, TX, TCSS, and TXIC) except for the TXS bit, until 1 can be read from the TXS bit. The count starts at the following count source after the TXS bit is set to 1. Also, after writing 0 (count stops) to the TXS bit during the count, timer X stops counting at the following count source. 1 (count starts) can be read by reading the TXS bit until the count stops after writing 0 to the TXS bit. After writing 0 to the TXS bit, do not access registers associated with timer X except for the TXS bit, until 0 can be read from the TXS bit. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 122 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 14.2 14. Timers Timer Z Timer Z is an 8-bit timer with an 8-bit prescaler. The prescaler and timer each consist of a reload register and counter. The reload register and counter are allocated at the same address. Refer to the Tables 14.7 to 14.10 for the Specifications of Each Mode. Timer Z contains timer Z primary and timer Z secondary reload registers. Figure 14.11 shows a Block Diagram of Timer Z. Figures 14.12 to 14.15 show registers TZMR, PREZ, TZSC, TZPR, TZOC, PUM, and TCSS. Timer Z has the following four operating modes: • Timer mode: • Programmable waveform generation mode: • Programmable one-shot generation mode: • Programmable wait one-shot generation mode: The timer counts an internal count source or timer X underflows. The timer outputs pulses of a given width successively. The timer outputs a one-shot pulse. The timer outputs a delayed one-shot pulse. Data bus TZSC register Reload register TZCK1 to TZCK0 f1 f8 = 00b Timer X underflow = 10b = 11b f2 = 01b Reload register TZPR register Reload register Counter Counter Timer Z interrupt PREZ register TZMOD1 to TZMOD0 = 10b, 11b TZS TZOS INT0 interrupt INT0 Digital filter Input polarity selected to be one edge or both edges INT0PL INT0EN TZMOD1 to TZMOD0 = 01b, 10b, 11b TZOCNT = 0 Polarity select INOSEG TZOPL = 1 TZOUT P1_3 bit in P1 register Q Toggle flip-flop Q CLR TZOPL = 0 TZOCNT = 1 TZMOD0 to TZMOD1, TZS: Bits in TZMR register TZOS, TZOCNT: Bits in TZOC register Figure 14.11 Block Diagram of Timer Z Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 123 of 315 TZOPL, INOSTG: Bits in PUM register TZCK0 to TZCK1: Bits in TCSS register INT0EN, INT0PL: Bits in INTEN register CK Write to TZMR register TZMOD1 to TZMOD0 = 01b, 10b, 11b R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 14. Timers Timer Z Mode Register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 0 0 0 Symbol Address 0080h TZMR Bit Symbol Bit Name — Reserved bits (b3-b0) TZMOD0 TZMOD1 TZWC TZS After Reset 00h Function Set to 0. Timer Z operating mode b5 b4 bits 0 0 : Timer mode 0 1 : Programmable w aveform generation mode 1 0 : Programmable one-shot generation mode 1 1 : Programmable w ait one-shot generation mode Timer Z w rite control bit Functions varies depending on operating mode. Timer Z count start flag(1) 0 : Stops counting. 1 : Starts counting. NOTE : 1. Refer to 14.2.5 Notes on Tim er Z for precautions regarding the TZS bit. Figure 14.12 TZMR Register Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 124 of 315 RW RW RW RW RW RW R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 14. Timers Prescaler Z Register b7 b0 Symbol PREZ Mode Address 0085h Function Counts internal count source or timer X underflow s. After Reset FFh Setting Range 00h to FFh Programmable w aveform generation mode Counts internal count source or timer X underflow s. 00h to FFh Programmable one-shot generation mode Counts internal count source or timer X underflow s. 00h to FFh Programmable w ait one-shot Counts internal count source or timer X generation mode underflow s. 00h to FFh Timer mode RW RW RW RW RW Timer Z Secondary Register b7 b0 Symbol TZSC Mode Timer mode Address 0086h Function Disabled Programmable w aveform generation mode Counts underflow of prescaler Z.(1) Programmable one-shot generation mode Disabled After Reset FFh Setting Range RW — — 00h to FFh — Programmable w ait one-shot Counts underflow of prescaler Z (counts one- 00h to FFh generation mode shot w idth). WO(2) — WO NOTES : 1. Each value in the TZPR register and TZSC register is reloaded to the counter alternately and counted. 2. The count value can be read out by reading the TZPR register even w hen the secondary period is being counted. Timer Z Primary Register b7 b0 Symbol TZPR Mode Address 0087h Function Counts underflow s of prescaler Z. After Reset FFh Setting Range 00h to FFh Programmable w aveform generation mode Counts underflow s of prescaler Z.(1) 00h to FFh Programmable one-shot generation mode Counts underflow s of prescaler Z (counts one-shot w idth). 00h to FFh Programmable w ait one-shot Counts underflow s of prescaler Z generation mode (counts w ait period). 00h to FFh Timer mode NOTE : 1. Each value in registers TZPR and TZSC is reloaded to the counter alternately and counted. Figure 14.13 Registers PREZ, TZSC, and TZPR Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 125 of 315 RW RW RW RW RW R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 14. Timers Timer Z Output Control Register(3) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 Symbol TZOC Bit Symbol Address 008Ah Bit Name Timer Z one-shot start bit(1) After Reset 00h Function 0 : One-shot stops. 1 : One-shot starts. Reserved bit Set to 0. TZOCNT Timer Z programmable w aveform generation output sw itch bit(2) 0 : Outputs programmable w aveform. 1 : Outputs value in P1_3 port register. — (b7-b3) Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0. When read, the content is 0. TZOS — (b1) RW RW RW RW — NOTES : 1. This bit is set to 0 w hen the output of a one-shot w aveform is completed. If the TZS bit in the TZMR register w as set to 0 (count stops) to stop the w aveform output during one-shot w aveform output, set the TZOS bit to 0. 2. This bit is enabled only w hen operating in programmable w aveform generation mode. 3. When executing an instruction w hich changes this register w hen the TZOS bit is set to 1 (during count), the TZOS bit is automatically set to 0 (one-shot stop) if the count is completed w hile the instruction is being executed. If this causes problems, execute an instruction w hich changes the contents of this register w hen the TZOS bit is set to 0 (one-shot stop). Timer Z Waveform Output Control Register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 0 0 0 0 Symbol Address 0084h PUM Bit Symbol Bit Name Reserved bits — (b4-b0) TZOPL Timer Z output level latch _____ INOSTG INOSEG INT0 pin one-shot trigger control bit (timer Z) (2) _____ INT0 pin one-shot trigger polarity select bit (timer Z) (1) After Reset 00h Function Set to 0. Function varies depending on operating mode. Registers TZOC and PUM Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 126 of 315 RW RW _____ 0 : INT0 pin one-shot trigger disabled _____ 1 : INT0 pin one-shot trigger enabled 0 : Falling edge trigger 1 : Rising edge trigger NOTES : 1. The INOSEG bit is enabled only w hen the INT0PL bit in the INTEN register is set to 0 (one edge). 2. Set the INOSTG bit to 1 after setting the INT0EN bit in the INTEN register and the INOSEG bit in the PUM register. Figure 14.14 RW RW RW R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 14. Timers Timer Count Source Setting Register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 0 0 0 Symbol TCSS Bit Symbol TXCK0 Address 008Eh Bit Name Timer X count source select bits (1) TZCK0 Reserved bits Set to 0. Timer Z count source select bits (1) b5 b4 0 0 : f1 0 1 : f8 1 0 : Selects Timer X underflow . 1 1 : f2 TZCK1 — (b7-b6) b1 b0 0 0 : f1 0 1 : f8 1 0 : fRING 1 1 : f2 TXCK1 — (b3-b2) After Reset 00h Function Reserved bits Set to 0. NOTE : 1. Do not sw itch count sources during a count operation. Stop the timer count before sw itching count sources. Figure 14.15 TCSS Register Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 127 of 315 RW RW RW RW RW RW RW R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 14.2.1 14. Timers Timer Mode In timer mode, a count source which is internally generated or timer X underflow is counted (refer to Table 14.7 Timer Mode Specifications). The TZSC register is not used in timer mode. Figure 14.16 shows Registers TZMR and PUM in Timer Mode. Table 14.7 Timer Mode Specifications Item Count sources Count operations Divide ratio Count start condition Count stop condition Interrupt request generation timing TZOUT pin function INT0 pin function Read from timer Write to timer(1) Specification f1, f2, f8, Timer X underflow • Decrement • When the timer underflows, it reloads the reload register contents before the count continues. (When timer Z underflows, the contents of timer Z primary reload register is reloaded.) 1/(n+1)(m+1) fi: Count source frequency n: Value set in PREZ register, m: value set in TZPR register 1 (count starts) is written to the TZS bit in the TZMR register. 0 (count stops) is written to the TZS bit in the TZMR register. • When timer Z underflows [timer Z interrupt]. Programmable I/O port Programmable I/O port, or INT0 interrupt input The count value can be read out by reading registers TZPR and PREZ. • When registers TZPR and PREZ are written while the count is stopped, values are written to both the reload register and counter. • When registers TZPR and PREZ are written during the count while the TZWC bit is set to 0 (writing to the reload register and counter simultaneously), the value is written to each reload register of registers TZPR and PREZ at the following count source input, the data is transferred to the counter at the second count source input, and the count re-starts at the third count source input. When the TZWC bit is set to 1 (writing to only the reload register), the value is written to each reload register of registers TZPR and PREZ (the data is transferred to the counter at the following reload). NOTE: 1. The IR bit in the TZIC register is set to 1 (interrupt requested) when writing to the TZPR or PREZ register while both of the following conditions are met. • TZWC bit in TZMR register is set to 0 (write to reload register and counter simultaneously) • TZS bit in TZMR register is set to 1 (count starts) Disable interrupts before writing to the TZPR or PREZ register in the above state. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 128 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 14. Timers Timer Z Mode Register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Symbol Address 0080h TZMR Bit Symbol Bit Name — Reserved bits (b3-b0) TZMOD0 TZMOD1 TZWC TZS After Reset 00h Function Set to 0. RW RW Timer Z operating mode bits b5 b4 0 0 : Timer mode RW RW Timer Z w rite control bit(1) 0 : Write to reload register and counter 1 : Write to reload register only RW Timer Z count start flag(2) 0 : Stops counting. 1 : Starts counting. RW NOTES : 1. When the TZS bit is set to 1 (count starts), the setting value in the TZWC bit is enabled. When the TZWC bit is set to 0, timer Z count value is w ritten to both reload register and counter. Timer Z count value is w ritten to the reload register only w hen the TZWC bit is set to 1. When the TZS bit is set to 0 (count stops), timer Z count value is w ritten to both reload register and counter regardless of the setting value of the TZWC bit. 2. Refer to 14.2.5 Notes on Tim er Z for precautions regarding the TZS bit. Timer Z Waveform Output Control Register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Symbol Address 0084h PUM Bit Symbol Bit Name — Reserved bits (b4-b0) TZOPL Timer Z output level latch _____ INOSTG Figure 14.16 Set to 0. Set to 0 in timer mode. INT0 pin one-shot trigger control bit Set to 0 in timer mode. INT0 pin one-shot trigger polarity select bit Set to 0 in timer mode. ____ INOSEG After Reset 00h Function Registers TZMR and PUM in Timer Mode Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 129 of 315 RW RW RW RW RW R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 14.2.2 14. Timers Programmable Waveform Generation Mode In programmable waveform generation mode, the signal output from the TZOUT pin is inverted each time the counter underflows, while the values in registers TZPR and TZSC are counted alternately (refer to Table 14.8 Programmable Waveform Generation Mode Specifications). Counting starts by counting the value set in the TZPR register. Figure 14.17 shows Registers TZMR and PUM in Programmable Waveform Generation Mode. Figure 14.18 shows an Operating Example of Timer Z in Programmable Waveform Generation Mode. Table 14.8 Programmable Waveform Generation Mode Specifications Item Count sources Count operations Width and period of output waveform Count start condition Count stop condition Interrupt request generation timing TZOUT pin function INT0 pin function Read from timer Write to timer Select functions Specification f1, f2, f8, timer X underflow • Decrement • When the timer underflows, it reloads the contents of the primary reload and secondary reload registers alternately before the count is continued. Primary period: (n+1)(m+1)/fi Secondary period: (n+1)(p+1)/fi Period: (n+1){(m+1)+(p+1)}/fi fi: Count source frequency n: Value set in PREZ register, m: value set in TZPR register, p: value set in TZSC register 1 (count starts) is written to the TZS bit in the TZMR register. 0 (count stops) is written to the TZS bit in the TZMR register. In half a cycle of the count source, after timer Z underflows during the secondary period (at the same time as the TZout output change) [timer Z interrupt]. Pulse output (To use this pin as a programmable I/O port, select timer mode.) Programmable I/O port, or INT0 interrupt input The count value can be read out by reading registers TZPR and PREZ.(1) The value written to registers TZSC, PREZ, and TZPR is written to the reload register only(2) • Output level latch select function The TZOPL bit can select the output level during primary and secondary periods. • Programmable waveform generation output switch function When the TZOCNT bit in the TZOC register is set to 0, the output from the TZOUT pin is inverted synchronously when timer Z underflows. When set to 1, the value in the P1_3 bit is output from the TZOUT pin(3) NOTES: 1. Even when counting the secondary period, the TZPR register may be read. 2. The value set in registers TZPR and TZSC are made effective by writing a value to the TZPR register. The set values are reflected in the waveform output beginning with the following primary period after writing to the TZPR register. 3. The TZOCNT bit is enabled by the following. • When counting starts. • When a timer Z interrupt request is generated. The contents after the TZOCNT bit is changed are reflected from the output of the following primary period. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 130 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 14. Timers Timer Z Mode Register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 1 0 1 0 0 0 0 Symbol Address 0080h TZMR Bit Symbol Bit Name — Reserved bits (b3-b0) TZMOD0 TZMOD1 Timer Z operating mode bits Timer Z w rite control bit TZWC TZS Timer Z count start flag(2) After Reset 00h Function Set to 0. RW RW b5 b4 0 1 : Programmable w aveform generation mode RW RW Set to 1 in programmable w aveform generation mode.(1) RW 0 : Stops counting. 1 : Starts counting. RW NOTES : 1. When the TZS bit is set to 1 (count starts), the count value is w ritten to the reload register only. When the TZS bit is set to 0 (count stops), the count value is w ritten to both reload register and counter. 2. Refer to 14.2.5 Notes on Tim er Z for precautions regarding the TZS bit. Timer Z Waveform Output Control Register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Symbol Address 0084h PUM Bit Symbol Bit Name — Reserved bits (b4-b0) Timer Z output level latch TZOPL _____ INOSTG Figure 14.17 Set to 0. 0 : Outputs Outputs Outputs 1 : Outputs Outputs Outputs RW “H” for primary period. “L” for secondary period. “L” w hen the timer is stopped. “L” for primary period. “H” for secondary period. “H” w hen the timer is stopped. RW Set to 0 in programmable w aveform generation mode. RW INT0 pin one-shot trigger polarity select bit Set to 0 in programmable w aveform generation mode. RW Registers TZMR and PUM in Programmable Waveform Generation Mode Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 RW INT0 pin one-shot trigger control bit _____ INOSEG After Reset 00h Function Page 131 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 14. Timers Set to 1 by program TZS bit in TZMR register 1 0 Count source Prescaler Z underflow signal Timer Z secondary reloads 01h Contents of timer Z 00h 02h Timer Z primary reloads 01h 00h 01h 00h 02h Set to 0 when interrupt request is acknowledged, or set by program IR bit in TZIC register 1 TZOPL bit in PUM register 1 0 Set to 0 by program 0 Waveform output starts TZOUT pin output Waveform output inverted Waveform output inverted “H” “L” Primary period Secondary period Primary period The above applies under the following conditions. PREZ = 01h, TZPR = 01h, TZSC = 02h TZOC register TZOCNT bit = 0 Figure 14.18 Operating Example of Timer Z in Programmable Waveform Generation Mode Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 132 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 14.2.3 14. Timers Programmable One-shot Generation Mode In programmable one-shot generation mode, one-shot pulse is output from the TZOUT pin by a program or an external trigger input (input to the INT0 pin) (refer to Table 14.9 Programmable One-Shot Generation Mode Specifications). When a trigger is generated, the timer starts operating from the point only once for a given period equal to the set value in the TZPR register. The TZSC register is not used in this mode. Figure 14.19 shows Registers TZMR and PUM in Programmable One-Shot Generation Mode. Figure 14.20 shows an Operating Example in Programmable One-Shot Generation Mode. Table 14.9 Programmable One-Shot Generation Mode Specifications Item Count sources Count operations One-shot pulse output time Specification f1, f2, f8, Timer X underflow • Decrement the value set in the TZPR register • When the timer underflows, it reloads the contents of the reload register before the count completes and the TZOS bit is set to 0 (one-shot stops). • When the count stops, the timer reloads the contents of the reload register before it stops. (n+1)(m+1)/fi fi: Count source frequency, n: value set in PREZ register, m: value set in TZPR register Count start conditions • Set the TZOS bit in the TZOC register to 1 (one-shot starts).(1) • Input active trigger to the INT0 pin(2) Count stop conditions • When reloading completes after the count value is set to 00h. • When the TZS bit in the TZMR register is set to 0 (count stops). • When the TZOS bit in the TZOC register is set to 0 (one-shot stops). Interrupt request In half a cycle of the count source, after the timer underflows (at the same time as generation timing the TZOUT output ends) [timer Z interrupt]. TZOUT pin function Pulse output (To use this pin as a programmable I/O port, select timer mode.) INT0 pin function Read from timer Write to timer Select functions • When the INOSTG bit in the PUM register is set to 0 (INT0 one-shot trigger disabled): programmable I/O port or INT0 interrupt input • When the INOSTG bit in the PUM register is set to 1 (INT0 one-shot trigger enabled): external trigger (INT0 interrupt input) The count value can be read out by reading registers TZPR and PREZ. The value written to registers TZPR and PREZ is written to the reload register only(3). • Output level latch select function The TZOPL bit can select the output level of the one-shot pulse waveform. • INT0 pin one-shot trigger control and polarity select functions The INOSTG bit can select the trigger as active or inactive from the INT0 pin. Also, the INOSEG bit can select the active trigger polarity. NOTES: 1. Set the TZS bit in the TZMR register to 1 (count starts). 2. Set the TZS bit to 1 (count starts), the INT0EN bit in the INTEN register to 1 (enables INT0 input), and the INOSTG bit in the PUM register to 1 (INT0 one-shot trigger enabled). A trigger which is input during the count cannot be acknowledged, however an INT0 interrupt request is generated. 3. The set value is reflected at the following one-shot pulse after writing to the TZPR register. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 133 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 14. Timers Timer Z Mode Register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 Symbol Address 0080h TZMR Bit Symbol Bit Name — Reserved bits (b3-b0) TZMOD0 TZMOD1 TZWC TZS Timer Z operating mode bit After Reset 00h Function Set to 0. RW RW b5 b4 1 0 : Programmable one-shot generation mode RW RW Timer Z w rite control bit Set to 1 in programmable one-shot generation mode.(1) RW Timer Z count start flag(2) 0 : Stops counting. 1 : Starts counting. RW NOTES : 1. When the TZS bit is set to 1 (count starts), the count value is w ritten to the reload register only. When the TZS bit is set to 0 (count stops), the count value is w ritten to both reload register and counter. 2. Refer to 14.2.5 Notes on Tim er Z for precautions regarding the TZS bit. Timer Z Waveform Output Control Register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 0 0 0 0 Symbol Address 0084h PUM Bit Symbol Bit Name — Reserved bits (b4-b0) Timer Z output level latch TZOPL _____ INOSTG INOSEG INT0 pin one-shot trigger control bit(1) _____ INT0 pin one-shot trigger polarity select bit(2) After Reset 00h Function Set to 0. 0 : Outputs one-shot pulse “H”. Outputs “L” w hen the timer is stopped. 1 : Outputs one-shot pulse “L”. Outputs “H” w hen the timer is stopped. Registers TZMR and PUM in Programmable One-Shot Generation Mode Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 134 of 315 RW RW _____ 0 : INT0 pin one-shot trigger disabled _____ 1 : INT0 pin one-shot trigger enabled 0 : Falling edge trigger 1 : Rising edge trigger NOTES : 1. Set the INOSTG bit to 1 after the INT0EN bit in the INTEN register and the INOSEG bit in the PUM _____ register are set. When setting the INOSTG bit to 1 (INT0 pin one-shot trigger enabled), set the INT0F0 to _____ INT0F1 bits in the INT0F register. Set the INOSTG bit to 0 (INT0 pin one-shot trigger disabled) after the TZS bit in the TZMR register is set to 0 (count stops). 2. The INOSEG bit is enabled only w hen the INT0PL bit in the INTEN register is set to 0 (one edge). Figure 14.19 RW RW RW R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 14. Timers Set to 1 by program TZS bit in TZMR register 1 0 Set to 0 when counting ends Set to 1 by program TZOS bit in TZOC register Set to 1 by INT0 pin input trigger 1 0 Count source Prescaler Z underflow signal INT0 pin input 1 0 Count starts 01h Contents of timer Z Timer Z Count primary starts reloads 00h 01h Timer Z primary reloads 00h 01h Set to 0 when interrupt request i s acknowledged, or set to 0 by program IR bit in TZIC register 1 TZOPL bit in PUM register 1 0 Set to 0 by program 0 Waveform output starts TZOUT pin input Waveform output ends Waveform output starts “H” “L” The above applies under the following conditions. PREZ = 01h, TZPR = 01h TZOPL bit in PUM register = 0, INOSTG bit = 1 (INT0 one-shot trigger enabled) INOSEG bit = 1 (rising edge trigger) Figure 14.20 Operating Example in Programmable One-Shot Generation Mode Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 135 of 315 Waveform output ends R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 14.2.4 14. Timers Programmable Wait One-Shot Generation Mode In programmable wait one-shot generation mode, a one-shot pulse is output from the TZOUT pin by a program or an external trigger input (input to the INT0 pin) (refer to Table 14.10 Programmable Wait One-Shot Generation Mode Specifications). When a trigger is generated, from that point the timer outputs a pulse only once for a given length of time equal to the setting value in the TZSC register after waiting for a given length of time equal to the value set in the TZPR register. Figure 14.21 shows Registers TZMR and PUM in Programmable Wait One-Shot Generation Mode. Figure 14.22 shows an Operating Example in Programmable Wait One-Shot Generation Mode. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 136 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group Table 14.10 14. Timers Programmable Wait One-Shot Generation Mode Specifications Item Count sources Count operations Wait time One-shot pulse output time Count start conditions Count stop conditions Interrupt request generation timing TZOUT pin function INT0 pin function Read from timer Write to timer Select functions Specification f1, f2, f8, Timer X underflow • Decrement the value set in Timer Z primary • When the count of TZPR register underflows, the timer reloads the contents of the TZSC register before the count is continued. • When the count of the TZSC register underflows, the timer reloads the contents of the TZPR register before the count completes and the TZOS bit is set to 0. • When the count stops, the timer reloads the contents of the reload register before it stops. (n+1)(m+1)/fi fi: Count source frequency n: Value set in PREZ register, m: value set in TZPR register (n+1)(p+1)/fi fi: Count source frequency n: Value set in PREZ register, p: value set in TZSC register • Set the TZOS bit in the TZOC register to 1 (one-shot starts).(1) • Input active trigger to the INT0 pin(2) • When reloading completes after timer Z underflows during secondary period. • When the TZS bit in the TZMR register is set to 0 (count stops). • When the TZOS bit in the TZOC register is set to 0 (one-shot stops). In half a cycle of the count source after timer Z underflows during secondary period (complete at the same time as waveform output from the TZOUT pin) [timer Z interrupt]. Pulse output (To use this pin as a programmable I/O port, select timer mode.) • When the INOSTG bit in the PUM register is set to 0 (INT0 one-shot trigger disabled): programmable I/O port or INT0 interrupt input • When the INOSTG bit in the PUM register is set to 1 (INT0 one-shot trigger enabled): external trigger (INT0 interrupt input) The count value can be read out by reading registers TZPR and PREZ. The value written to registers TZPR and PREZ is written to the reload register only(3). • Output level latch select function The output level of the one-shot pulse waveform is selected by the TZOPL bit. • INT0 pin one-shot trigger control function and polarity select function Trigger input from the INT0 pin can be set to active or inactive by the INOSTG bit. Also, the active trigger's polarity can be selected by the INOSEG bit. NOTES: 1. The TZS bit in the TZMR register must be set to 1 (start counting). 2. The TZS bit must be set to 1 (start counting), the INT0EN bit in the INTEN register to 1 (enabling INT0 input), and the INOSTG bit in the PUM register to 1 (enabling INT0 one-shot trigger). A trigger which is input during the count cannot be acknowledged, however an INT0 interrupt request is generated. 3. The set values are reflected at the following one-shot pulse after writing to the TZPR register. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 137 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 14. Timers Timer Z Mode Register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 Symbol Address 0080h TZMR Bit Symbol Bit Name — Reserved bits (b3-b0) TZMOD0 Timer Z operating mode bits After Reset 00h Function Set to 0. RW b5 b4 1 1 : Programmable w ait one-shot generation mode TZS RW RW TZMOD1 TZWC RW Timer Z w rite control bit Set to 1 in programmable w ait one-shot generation mode.(1) RW Timer Z count start flag(2) 0 : Stops counting. 1 : Starts counting. RW NOTES : 1. When the TZS bit is set to 1 (count starts), the count value is w ritten to the reload register only. When the TZS bit is set to 0 (count stops), the count value is w ritten to both reload register and counter. 2. Refer to 14.2.5 Notes on Tim er Z for precautions regarding the TZS bit. Timer Z Waveform Output Control Register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 0 0 0 0 Symbol Address 0084h PUM Bit Symbol Bit Name — Reserved bits (b4-b0) Timer Z output level latch TZOPL _____ INOSTG INT0 pin one-shot trigger control bit(1) _____ INOSEG INT0 pin one-shot trigger polarity select bit(2) After Reset 00h Function Set to 0. 0 : Outputs one-shot pulse “H”. Outputs “L” w hen the timer is stopped. 1 : Outputs one-shot pulse “L”. Outputs “H” w hen the timer is stopped. Registers TZMR and PUM in Programmable Wait One-Shot Generation Mode Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 138 of 315 RW RW _____ 0 : INT0 pin one-shot trigger disabled _____ 1 : INT0 pin one-shot trigger enabled 0 : Falling edge trigger 1 : Rising edge trigger NOTES : 1. Set the INOSTG bit to 1 after the INT0EN bit in the INTEN register and the INOSEG bit in the PUM _____ register are set. When setting the INOSTG bit to 1 (INT0 pin one-shot trigger enabled), set the INT0F0 to _____ INT0F1 bits in the INT0F register. Set the INOSTG bit to 0 (INT0 pin one-shot trigger disabled) after the TZS bit in the TZMR register is set to 0 (count stops). 2. The INOSEG bit is enabled only w hen the INT0PL bit in the INTEN register is set to 0 (one edge). Figure 14.21 RW RW RW R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 14. Timers Set to 1 by program TZS bit in TZMR register 1 0 Set to 1 by program, or set to 1 by INT0 pin input trigger TZOS bit in TZOC register Set to 0 when counting ends 1 0 Count source Prescaler Z underflow signal INT0 pin input 1 0 Timer Z secondary reloads Count starts 01h Contents of timer Z 00h 02h 01h Timer Z primary reloads 00h 01h Set to 0 when interrupt request is accepted, or set by program IR bit in TZIC register 1 0 Set to 0 by program TZOPL bit in PUM register 1 0 Wait starts TZOUT pin output Waveform output starts Waveform output ends “H” “L” The above applies under the following conditions. PREZ = 01h, TZPR = 01h, TZSC = 02h PUM register TZOPL bit = 0, INOSTG bit = 1 (INT0 one-shot trigger enabled) INOSEG bit = 1 (edge trigger at rising edge) Figure 14.22 Operating Example in Programmable Wait One-Shot Generation Mode Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 139 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 14.2.5 14. Timers Notes on Timer Z • Timer Z stops counting after a reset. Set the values in the timer and prescaler before the count starts. • Even if the prescaler and timer are read out in 16-bit units, these registers are read 1 byte at a time by the MCU. Consequently, the timer value may be updated during the period when these two registers are being read. • Do not rewrite bits TZMOD0 to TZMOD1, and the TZS bit simultaneously. • In programmable one-shot generation mode, and programmable wait one-shot generation mode, when setting the TZS bit in the TZMR register to 0 (stops counting) or setting the TZOS bit in the TZOC register to 0 (stops one-shot), the timer reloads the value of the reload register and stops. Therefore, in programmable one-shot generation mode and programmable wait one-shot generation mode read the timer count value before the timer stops. • The TZS bit in the TZMR register has a function to instruct timer Z to start or stop counting and a function to indicate that the count has started or stopped. 0 (count stops) can be read until the following count source is applied after 1 (count starts) is written to the TZS bit while the count is being stopped. If the following count source is applied, 1 can be read from the TZS bit. After writing 1 to the TZS bit, do not access registers associated with timer Z (registers TZMR, PREZ, TZSC, TZPR, TZOC, PUM, TCSC, and TZIC) except for the TZS bit, until 1 can be read from the TZS bit. The count starts at the following count source after the TZS bit is set to 1. Also, after writing 0 (count stops) to the TZS bit during the count, timer Z stops counting at the following count source. 1 (count starts) can be read by reading the TZS bit until the count stops after writing 0 to the TZS bit. After writing 0 to the TZS bit, do not access registers associated with timer Z except for the TZS bit, until 0 can be read from the TZS bit. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 140 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 14.3 14. Timers Timer C Timer C is a 16-bit timer. Figure 14.23 shows a Block Diagram of Timer C. Figure 14.24 shows a Block Diagram of CMP Waveform Generation Unit. Figure 14.25 shows a Block Diagram of CMP Waveform Output Unit. Timer C has two modes: input capture mode and output compare mode. Figures 14.26 to 14.29 show the Timer Cassociated registers. TCC11 to TCC10 f1 f8 f32 Sampling clock = 01b = 10b = 11b INT3/TCIN Other than 00b TCC07 = 0 Digital filter = 00b TCC07 = 1 Edge detection INT3 interrupt fRING128 Transfer signal Higher 8 bits Lower 8 bits Capture and compare 0 register TM0 register Data Bus Compare circuit 0 Compare 0 interrupt TCC02 to TCC01 f1 f8 f32 fRING-fast = 00b Higher 8 bits = 01b = 10b = 11b Lower 8 bits Timer C interrupt Counter TC register TYC00 TCC12 =0 TCC12 = 1 Timer C counter reset signal Compare circuit 1 Higher 8 bits Lower 8 bits Compare register 1 TM1 register TCC01 to TCC02, TCC07: Bits in TCC0 register TCC10 to TCC12: Bits in TCC1 register Figure 14.23 Block Diagram of Timer C Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 141 of 315 Compare 1 interrupt R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 14. Timers TCC14 TCC15 Compare 0 interrupt signal Compare 1 interrupt signal TCC16 TCC17 “H” “L” Reverse TCC17 to TCC16 T = 11b D = 10b = 01b Latch Q R CMP output (internal signal) Reset Reverse “L” “H” TCC15 to TCC14 = 01b = 10b = 11b TCC14 to TCC17: Bits in TCC1 register Figure 14.24 Block Diagram of CMP Waveform Generation Unit PD1_0 TCOUT6 = 0 CMP output (Internal signal) TCOUT0 = 1 TCOUT0 Reverse CMP0_0 TCOUT6 = 1 TCOUT0 = 0 P1_0 Register Bit Setting Value TCOUT TCOUT0 1 1 1 1 P1 P1_0 1 1 0 0 TCOUT TCOUT6 0 1 0 1 CMP0_0 Output CMP0_0 waveform output CMP0_0 reversed waveform output “L” output “H” output This diagram is a block diagram of the CMP0_0 waveform output unit. The CMP0_1 to CMP0_2 and CMP1_0 to CMP1_2 waveform output units have the same configuration. Figure 14.25 Block Diagram of CMP Waveform Output Unit Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 142 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 14. Timers Timer C Register (b15) b7 (b8) b0 b7 b0 Symbol TC Address 0091h-0090h After Reset 0000h RW Function Counts internal count source. 0000h can be read w hen the TCC00 bit is set to 0 (count stops). Count value can be read w hen the TCC00 bit is set to 1 (count starts). RO Capture and Compare 0 Register (b15) b7 (b8) b0 b7 b0 Symbol TM0 Address 009Dh-009Ch After Reset 0000h(2) Function Mode RW When the active edge of the measured pulse is input, store the value in the TC register Input capture mode Mode Function (1) Output compare mode Store the value compared w ith timer C Setting Range 0000h to FFFFh RO RW RW NOTES : 1. When setting a value in the TM0 register, set the TCC13 bit in the TCC1 register to 1 (compare 0 output selected). When the TCC13 bit is set to 0 (capture selected), no value can be w ritten. 2. When the TCC13 bit in the TCC1 register is set to 1, the value is set to FFFFh. Compare 1 Register (b15) b7 (b8) b0 b7 b0 Symbol TM1 Mode Output compare mode Figure 14.26 Registers TC, TM0, and TM1 Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 143 of 315 Address 009Fh-009Eh After Reset FFFFh Function Setting Range Store the value compared w ith timer C 0000h to FFFFh RW RW R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 14. Timers Timer C Control Register 0 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 Symbol TCC0 Bit Symbol TCC00 TCC01 Address 009Ah Bit Name Timer C count start bit After Reset 00h Function 0 : Stops counting. 1 : Starts counting. Timer C count source select bits (1) b2 b1 0 0 : f1 0 1 : f8 1 0 : f32 1 1 : fRING-fast TCC02 RW RW RW RW _____ TCC03 INT3 interrupt / capture polarity select bits (1, 2) TCC04 — (b5) Reserved bit 0 0 : Rising edge 0 1 : Falling edge 1 0 : Both edges 1 1 : Do not set. Set to 0. _____ RW RW RW _____ INT3 interrupt generation timing select bit(2, 3) TCC06 0 : INT3 Interrupt is generated in synchronization w ith timer C count source. _____ 1 : INT3 Interrupt is generated w hen _____ INT3 interrupt is input.(4) _____ 0 : INT3 1 : fRING128 _____ TCC07 b4 b3 INT3 interrupt / capture input sw itch bit(1, 2) RW RW NOTES : 1. Change this bit w hen the TCC00 bit is set to 0 (count stops). 2. The IR bit in the INT3IC register may be set to 1 (requests interrupt) w hen the TCC03, TCC04, TCC06, or TCC07 bit is rew ritten. Refer to 12.5.5 Changing Interrupt Sources. _____ 3. When the TCC13 bit is set to 1 (output compare mode) and INT3 interrupt is input, regardless of the setting value of the TCC06 bit, an interrupt request is generated. _____ _____ 4. When using the INT3 filter, the INT3 interrupt is generated in synchronization w ith the clock for the digital filter. Figure 14.27 TCC0 Register Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 144 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 14. Timers Timer C Control Register 1 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol TCC1 Bit Symbol TCC10 _____ Address 009Bh Bit Name INT3 filter select bits (1) TCC13 TCC14 TCC15 TCC16 TCC17 b1 b0 0 0 : No filter 0 1 : Filter w ith f1 sampling 1 0 : Filter w ith f8 sampling 1 1 : Filter w ith f32 sampling TCC11 TCC12 After Reset 00h Function Timer C counter reload select bit(3) 0 : No reload 1 : Set TC register to 0000h w hen compare 1 is matched. Compare 0 / capture select bit(2) 0 : Selects capture (input capture mode).(3) 1 : Selects compare 0 output. (output compare mode) RW RW RW RW Compare 1 output mode select b7 b6 bits (3) 0 0 : CMP output remains unchanged even w hen compare 1 is matched. 0 1 : CMP output is inverted w hen compare 1 signal is matched. 1 0 : CMP output is set to “L” w hen compare 1 signal is matched. 1 1 : CMP output is set to “H” w hen compare 1 signal is matched. RW 3. When the TCC13 bit is set to 0 (input capture mode), set bits TCC12, and TCC14 to TCC17 to 0. TCC1 Register Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 RW Compare 0 output mode select b5 b4 bits (3) 0 0 : CMP output remains unchanged even w hen compare 0 is matched. 0 1 : CMP output is inverted w hen compare 0 signal is matched. 1 0 : CMP output is set to “L” w hen compare 0 signal is matched. 1 1 : CMP output is set to “H” w hen compare 0 signal is matched. NOTES : _____ 1. When the same value is sampled from the INT3 pin three times continuously, the input is determined. 2. When the TCC00 bit in the TCC0 register is set to 0 (count stops), rew rite the TCC13 bit. Figure 14.28 RW Page 145 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 14. Timers Timer C Output Control Register(1) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol TCOUT Bit Symbol TCOUT0 TCOUT1 TCOUT2 TCOUT3 TCOUT4 TCOUT5 A ddress 00FFh Bit Name CMP output enable bit 0 A f ter Reset 00h Function 0 : Disables CMP output f rom CMP0_0. 1 : Enables CMP output f rom CMP0_0. RW CMP output enable bit 1 0 : Disables CMP output f rom CMP0_1. 1 : Enables CMP output f rom CMP0_1. RW CMP output enable bit 2 0 : Disables CMP output f rom CMP0_2. 1 : Enables CMP output f rom CMP0_2. RW CMP output enable bit 3 0 : Disables CMP output f rom CMP1_0. 1 : Enables CMP output f rom CMP1_0. RW CMP output enable bit 4 0 : Disables CMP output f rom CMP1_1. 1 : Enables CMP output f rom CMP1_1. RW CMP output enable bit 5 0 : Disables CMP output f rom CMP1_2. 1 : Enables CMP output f rom CMP1_2. RW CMP output invert bit 0 0 : Does not invert CMP output f rom CMP0_0 to CMP0_2. 1 : Inverts CMP output f rom CMP0_0 to CMP0_2. RW 0 : Does not invert CMP output f rom CMP1_0 to CMP1_2. 1 : Inverts CMP output f rom CMP1_0 to CMP1_2. RW TCOUT6 CMP output invert bit 1 TCOUT7 NOTE : 1. Set the bits w hich are not used f or CMP output to 0. Figure 14.29 TCOUT Register Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 146 of 315 RW R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 14.3.1 14. Timers Input Capture Mode In input capture mode, the edge of the TCIN pin input signal or the fRING128 clock is used as a trigger to latch the timer value and generate an interrupt request. The TCIN input contains a digital filter, and this prevents errors caused by noise or the like from occurring. Table 14.11 shows the Input Capture Mode Specifications. Figure 14.30 shows an Operating Example in Input Capture Mode. Table 14.11 Input Capture Mode Specifications Item Count sources Count operations Count start condition Count stop condition Interrupt request generation timing INT3/TCIN pin function Specification f1, f8, f32, fRING-fast • Increment • Transfer the value in the TC register to the TM0 register at the active edge of the measured pulse. • The value in the TC register is set to 0000h when the count stops. The TCC00 bit in the TCC0 register is set to 1 (count starts). The TCC00 bit in the TCC0 register is set to 0 (count stops). • When the active edge of the measured pulse is input [INT3 interrupt].(1) • When timer C overflows [timer C interrupt]. Programmable I/O port or the measured pulse input (INT3 interrupt input) P1_0 to P1_2, P3_3 to Programmable I/O port P3_5 pin functions Counter value reset timing When the TCC00 bit in the TCC0 register is set to 0 (count stops). • The count value can be read out by reading the TC register. Read from timer(2) • The count value at the measured pulse active edge input can be read out by reading the TM0 register. Write to timer Write to the TC and TM0 registers is disabled. Select functions • INT3/TCIN polarity select function Bits TCC03 to TCC04 can select the active edge of the measured pulse. • Digital filter function Bits TCC11 to TCC10 can select the digital filter sampling frequency. • Trigger select function The TCC07 bit can select the TCIN input or the fRING128. NOTES: 1. The INT3 interrupt includes a digital filter delay and one count source (max.) delay. 2. Read registers TC and TM0 in 16-bit unit. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 147 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 14. Timers FFFFh Counter contents (hex) Overflow Count starts ←Measurement value 2 ← Measurement value3 ←Measurement value1 0000h Set to 0 by program Set to 1 by program TCC00 bit in TCC0 register Time 1 0 The delay caused by digital filter and one count source cycle delay (max.) Measured pulse (TCIN pin input) Transmit timing from timer C counter to TM0 register 1 0 Transmit (measured value 1) Transmit (measured value 2) Transmit (measured value 3) 1 0 Indeterminate Indeterminate Measured value 1 TM0 register Measured value 2 Measured value 3 Set to 0 when interrupt request is acknowledged, or set by program IR bit in INT3IC register IR bit in TCIC register 1 0 Set to 0 when interrupt request is acknowledged, or set by program 1 0 The above applies under the following conditions. TCC0 register TCC04 to TCC03 bits = 01b (capture input polarity is set for falling edge). TCC07 = 0 (INT3/TCIN input as capture input trigger) Figure 14.30 Operating Example in Input Capture Mode Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 148 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 14.3.2 14. Timers Output Compare Mode In output compare mode, an interrupt request is generated when the value of the TC register matches the value of the TM0 or TM1 register. Table 14.12 shows the Output Compare Mode Specifications. Figure 14.31 shows an Operating Example in Output Compare Mode. Table 14.12 Output Compare Mode Specifications Item Count sources Count operations Specification f1, f8, f32, fRING-fast • Increment • The value in the TC register is set to 0000h when the count stops. The TCC00 bit in the TCC0 register is set to 1 (count starts). The TCC00 bit in the TCC0 register is set to 0 (count stops). Bits TCOUT0 to TCOUT5 in the TCOUT register are set to 1 (enables CMP output).(2) Bits TCOUT0 to TCOUT5 in the TCOUT register are set to 0 (disables CMP output). • When a match occurs in compare circuit 0 [compare 0 interrupt]. • When a match occurs in compare circuit 1 [compare 1 interrupt]. • When time C overflows [timer C interrupt]. Count start condition Count stop condition Waveform output start condition Waveform output stop condition Interrupt request generation timing INT3/TCIN pin function P1_0 to P1_2 pins and P3_3 to P3_5 pins functions Counter value reset timing Read from timer(2) Write to timer(2) Select functions Programmable I/O port or INT3 interrupt input Programmable I/O port or CMP output(1) When the TCC00 bit in the TCC0 register is set to 0 (count stops). • The value in the compare register can be read out by reading registers TM0 and TM1. • The count value can be read out by reading the TC register. • Write to the TC register is disabled. • The values written to registers TM0 and TM1 are stored in the compare register in the following timings: - When registers TM0 and TM1 are written to, if the TCC00 bit is set to 0 (count stops). - When the counter overflows, if the TCC00 bit is set to 1 (during counting) and the TCC12 bit in the TCC1 register is set to 0 (free-run). - When the compare 1 matches a counter, if the TCC00 bit is set to 1 and the TCC12 bit is set to 1 (the TC register is set to 0000h at compare 1 match). • Timer C counter reload select function The TCC12 bit in the TCC1 register can select whether the counter value in the TC register is set to 0000h when the compare circuit 1 matches. • Bits TCC14 to TCC15 in the TCC1 register can be used to select the output level when compare circuit 0 matches. Bits TCC16 to TCC17 in the TCC1 register can be used to select the output level when compare circuit 1 matches. • Bits TCOUT6 to TCOUT7 in the TCOUT register can select whether the output is inverted or not. NOTES: 1. When the corresponding port data is 1, the waveform is output depending on the setting of the registers TCC1 and TCOUT. When the corresponding port data is 0, the fixed level is output (refer to Figure 14.25 Block Diagram of CMP Waveform Output Unit). 2. Access registers TC, TM0, and TM1 in 16-bit units. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 149 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 14. Timers Match Counter content (hex) Value set in TM1 register Count starts Match Match Value set in TM0 register 0000h Time Set to 1 by program TCC00 bit in 1 TCC0 register 0 Set to 0 when interrupt request is acknowledged, or set by program IR bit in CMP0IC 1 register 0 Set to 0 when interrupt request is acknowledged, or set by program IR bit in CMP1IC 1 register 0 CMP0_0 output 1 0 1 CMP1_0 output 0 The above applies to the following conditions : TCC12 bit in TCC1 register = 1 (TC register is set to 0000h at compare 1 match occurrence ) TCC13 bit in TCC1 register = 1 (Compare 0 output selected) TCC15 to TCC14 bits in TCC1 register = 11b (CMP output level is set to high at compare 0 match occurrence) TCC17 to TCC16 bits in TCC1 register = 10b (CMP output level is set to low at compare 1 match occurrence) TCOUT6 bit in TCOUT register = 0 (not inverted) TCOUT7 bit in TCOUT register = 1 (inverted) TCOUT0 bit in TCOUT register = 1 (CMP0_0 output enabled) TCOUT3 bit in TCOUT register = 1 (CMP1_0 output enabled) P1_0 bit in P1 register = 1 (high) P3_0 bit in P3 register = 1 (high) Figure 14.31 Operating Example in Output Compare Mode Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 150 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 14.3.3 14. Timers Notes on Timer C Access registers TC, TM0, and TM1 in 16-bit units. The TC register can be read in 16-bit units. This prevents the timer value from being updated between when the low-order bytes and high-order bytes are being read. Example of reading timer C: MOV.W 0090H,R0 Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 ; Read out timer C Page 151 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 15. Serial Interface 15. Serial Interface The serial interface consists of two channels (UART0 and UART1). Each UARTi (i = 0 or 1) has an exclusive timer to generate the transfer clock and operates independently. Figure 15.1 shows a UARTi (i = 0 or 1) Block Diagram. Figure 15.2 shows a UARTi Transmit/Receive Unit. UART0 has two modes: clock synchronous serial I/O mode and clock asynchronous serial I/O mode (UART mode). UART1 has only clock asynchronous serial I/O mode (UART mode). Figures 15.3 to 15.6 show the Registers Associated with UARTi. (UART0) TXD0 RXD0 CLK1 to CLK0 = 00b f1 f8 f32 CKDIR = 0 Internal = 01b = 10b 1/16 Clock synchronous type U0BRG register 1/(n0+1) UART reception 1/16 Reception control circuit UART transmission Clock synchronous type External CKDIR=1 1/2 Clock synchronous type (when internal clock is selected) Clock synchronous type (when external clock is selected) Clock synchronous type (when internal clock is selected) Transmission control circuit Receive clock Transmit clock Transmit/ receive unit CKDIR = 0 CKDIR = 1 CLK polarity reversing circuit CLK0 (UART1) RXD1 TXD1 1/16 CLK1 to CLK0 f1 f8 f32 Figure 15.1 = 00b = 01b = 10b Internal U1BRG register 1/(n1+1) 1/16 UART reception Page 152 of 315 Receive clock Transmission control circuit Transmit clock Transmit/ receive unit UART transmission UARTi (i = 0 or 1) Block Diagram Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Reception control circuit R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 15. Serial Interface PRYE = 0 Clock PAR disabled synchronous type 1SP RXDi SP SP Clock synchronous type UART (7 bits) UART (8 bits) UART (7 bits) UARTi receive register PAR PAR UART enabled PRYE = 1 2SP UART (9 bits) Clock synchronous type UART (8 bits) UART (9 bits) 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 D8 D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0 UiRB register MSB/LSB conversion circuit Data bus high-order bits Data bus low-order bits MSB/LSB conversion circuit D8 PRYE = 1 PAR enabled 2SP SP SP UART (9 bits) UART D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 UART (8 bits) UART (9 bits) Clock synchronous type PAR 1SP D0 UiTB register TXDi Clock PAR disabled synchronous PRYE = 0 type 0 UART (7 bits) UART (8 bits) Clock synchronous type UART (7 bits) UARTi transmit register i = 0 or 1 SP: Stop bit PAR: Parity bit Note: Clock synchronous type is implemented in UART0 only. Figure 15.2 UARTi Transmit/Receive Unit Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 153 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 15. Serial Interface UARTi Transmit Buffer Register (i = 0 or 1)(1, 2) (b15) b7 (b8) b0 b7 b0 Symbol U0TB U1TB Bit Symbol — (b8-b0) — (b15-b9) Address 00A3h-00A2h 00ABh-00AAh Function After Reset Undefined Undefined RW Transmit data WO Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0. When read, the content is undefined. — NOTES : 1. When the transfer data length is 9 bits, w rite data to high byte first, then low byte. 2. Use the MOV instruction to w rite to this register. UARTi Receive Buffer Register (i = 0 or 1)(1) (b15) b7 (b8) b0 b7 b0 Symbol U0RB U1RB Bit Symbol — (b7-b0) Address 00A7h-00A6h 00AFh-00AEh Bit Name — — (b8) — (b11-b9) Receive data (D8) — Overrun error flag (2) FER Framing error flag (2) PER Parity error flag (2) SUM Error sum flag RW RO RO Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0. When read, the content is undefined. (2) OER After Reset Undefined Undefined Function Receive data (D7 to D0) — 0 : No overrun error 1 : Overrun error RO 0 : No framing error 1 : Framing error RO 0 : No parity error 1 : Parity error RO 0 : No error 1 : Error RO NOTES : 1. Read out the UiRB register in 16-bit units. 2. Bits SUM, PER, FER, and OER are set to 0 (no error) w hen bits SMD2 to SMD0 in the UiMR register are set to 000b (serial interface disabled) or the RE bit in the UiC1 register is set to 0 (receive disabled). The SUM bit is set to 0 (no error) w hen bits PER, FER, and OER are set to 0 (no error). Bits PER and FER are set to 0 even w hen the higher byte of the UiRB register is read out. Also, bits PER and FER are set to 0 w hen reading the high-order byte of the UiRB register. UARTi Bit Rate Register (i = 0 or 1)(1, 2, 3) b7 b0 Symbol U0BRG U1BRG Address 00A1h 00A9h After Reset Undefined Undefined Function Setting Range Assuming the set value is n, UiBRG divides the count source by n+1 00h to FFh NOTES : 1. Write to this register w hile the serial I/O is neither transmitting nor receiving. 2. Use the MOV instruction to w rite to this register. 3. After setting the CLK0 to CLK1 bits of the UiC0 register, w rite to the UiBRG register. Figure 15.3 Registers U0TB to U1TB, U0RB to U1RB, and U0BRG to U1BRG Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 154 of 315 RW WO R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 15. Serial Interface UARTi Transmit / Receive Mode Register (i = 0 or 1) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 Symbol U0MR U1MR Bit Symbol SMD0 Address 00A0h 00A8h Bit Name Serial interface mode select bits (2) SMD1 SMD2 CKDIR STPS — (b7) 0 0 0 : Serial interface disabled 0 0 1 : Clock synchronous serial I/O mode 1 0 0 : UART mode transfer data 7 bits long 1 0 1 : UART mode transfer data 8 bits long 1 1 0 : UART mode transfer data 9 bits long Other than above : Do not set. RW RW RW Stop bit length select bit 0 : 1 stop bit 1 : 2 stop bits RW Odd / even parity select bit Enabled w hen PRYE = 1. 0 : Odd parity 1 : Even parity RW Parity enable bit 0 : Parity disabled 1 : Parity enabled RW Reserved bit Set to 0. Registers U0MR to U1MR Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 RW 0 : Internal clock 1 : External clock(1) NOTES : 1. Set the PD1_6 bit in the PD1 register to 0 (input). 2. Do not set bits SMD2 to SMD0 in the U1MR register to any values other than 000b, 100b, 101b, and 110b. 3. Set the CKDIR bit in UART1 to 0 (internal clock). Figure 15.4 RW b2 b1 b0 Internal / external clock select bit(3) PRY PRYE After Reset 00h 00h Function Page 155 of 315 RW R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 15. Serial Interface UARTi Transmit / Receive Control Register 0 (i = 0 or 1) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 Symbol U0C0 U1C0 Bit Symbol CLK0 CLK1 — (b2) TXEPT — (b4) NCH Address 00A4h 00ACh Bit Name BRG count source select b1 b0 0 0 : Selects f1. bits (1) 0 1 : Selects f8. 1 0 : Selects f32. 1 1 : Do not set. Reserved bit Set to 0. Transmit register empty flag 0 : Data in transmit register (during transmit) 1 : No data in transmit register (transmit completed) Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0. When read, the content is 0. RW RW RO — RW CLK polarity select bit 0 : Transmit data is output at falling edge of transfer clock and receive data is input at rising edge. 1 : Transmit data is output at rising edge of transfer clock and receive data is input at falling edge. RW Transfer format select bit 0 : LSB first 1 : MSB first Registers U0C0 to U1C0 Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 RW 0 : TXDi pin is for CMOS output. 1 : TXDi pin is for N-channel open drain output. NOTE : 1. If the BRG count source is sw itched, set the UiBRG register again. Figure 15.5 RW Data output select bit CKPOL UFORM After Reset 08h 08h Function Page 156 of 315 RW R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 15. Serial Interface UARTi Transmit / Receive Control Register 1 (i = 0 or 1) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol U0C1 U1C1 Bit Symbol TE TI RE RI — (b7-b4) Address 00A5h 00ADh Bit Name Transmit enable bit After Reset 02h 02h Function 0 : Disables transmission. 1 : Enables transmission. Transmit buffer empty flag 0 : Data in UiTB register 1 : No data in UiTB register RO Receive enable bit 0 : Disables reception. 1 : Enables reception. RW Receive complete flag(1) 0 : No data in UiRB register 1 : Data in UiRB register RO Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0. When read, the content is 0. RW RW — NOTE : 1. The RI bit is set to 0 w hen the higher byte of the UiRB register is read out. UART Transmit / Receive Control Register 2 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 0 Symbol UCON Bit Symbol Address 00B0h Bit Name UART0 transmit interrupt source select bit After Reset 00h Function 0 : Transmit buffer empty (TI = 1) 1 : Transmit completed (TXEPT = 1) RW U1IRS UART1 transmit interrupt source select bit 0 : Transmit buffer empty (TI = 1) 1 : Transmit completed (TXEPT = 1) RW U0RRM UART0 continuous receive mode enable bit 0 : Disables continuous receive mode. 1 : Enables continuous receive mode. RW Reserved bit Set to 0. UART1 pin (P3_7/TXD1, P4_5/RXD1) select bits b5 b4 U0IRS — (b3) U1SEL0 U1SEL1 — (b6) 0 0 : P3_7, P4_5 0 1 : P3_7, RXD1 1 0 : Do not set. 1 1 : TXD1, RXD1 Reserved bit Set to 0. CNTR0 signal pin select bit(1) 0 : P1_5/RXD0 ______ P1_7/CNTR00/INT10 ______ 1 : P1_5/RXD0/CNTR01/INT11 P1_7 CNTRSEL NOTE : _____ 1. The CNTRSEL bit selects the input pin of the CNTR0 (INTI) signal. When the CNTR0 signal is output, it is output from the CNTR00 pin regardless of the CNTRSEL bit setting. Figure 15.6 Registers U0C1 to U1C1, and UCON Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 157 of 315 RW RW RW RW RW RW R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 15.1 15. Serial Interface Clock Synchronous Serial I/O Mode In clock synchronous serial I/O mode, data is transmitted and received using a transfer clock. Table 15.1 lists the Clock Synchronous Serial I/O Mode Specifications. Table 15.2 lists the Registers Used and Settings in Clock Synchronous Serial I/O Mode(1). Table 15.1 Clock Synchronous Serial I/O Mode Specifications Item Transfer data format Transfer clocks Specification • Transfer data length: 8 bits • CKDIR bit in U0MR register is set to 0 (internal clock): fi/(2(n+1)). fi = f1, f8, f32 n = value set in U0BRG register: 00h to FFh • The CKDIR bit is set to 1 (external clock): input from CLK0 pin. Transmit start conditions • Before transmission starts, the following requirements must be met.(1) - The TE bit in the U0C1 register is set to 1 (transmission enabled). - The TI bit in the U0C1 register is set to 0 (data in the U0TB register). Receive start conditions • Before reception starts, the following requirements must be met.(1) - The RE bit in the U0C1 register is set to 1 (reception enabled). - The TE bit in the U0C1 register is set to 1 (transmission enabled). - The TI bit in the U0C1 register is set to 0 (data in the U0TB register). • When transmitting, one of the following conditions can be selected. - The U0IRS bit is set to 0 (transmit buffer empty): When transferring data from the U0TB register to UART0 transmit register (when transmission starts). - The U0IRS bit is set to 1 (transmission completes): When completing data transmission from UARTi transmit register. • When receiving When data transfer from the UART0 receive register to the U0RB register (when reception completes). Interrupt request generation timing Error detection Select functions • Overrun error(2) This error occurs if the serial interface starts receiving the next data item before reading the U0RB register and receives the 7th bit of the next data. • CLK polarity selection Transfer data input/output can be selected to occur synchronously with the rising or the falling edge of the transfer clock. • LSB first, MSB first selection Whether transmitting or receiving data begins with bit 0 or begins with bit 7 can be selected. • Continuous receive mode selection Receive is enabled immediately by reading the U0RB register. NOTES: 1. If an external clock is selected, ensure that the external clock is “H” when the CKPOL bit in the U0C0 register is set to 0 (transmit data output at falling edge and receive data input at rising edge of transfer clock), and that the external clock is “L” when the CKPOL bit is set to 1 (transmit data output at rising edge and receive data input at falling edge of transfer clock). 2. If an overrun error occurs, the receive data (b0 to b8) of the U0RB register will be undefined. The IR bit in the S0RIC register remains unchanged. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 158 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group Table 15.2 Register U0TB U0RB U0BRG U0MR U0C0 U0C1 UCON 15. Serial Interface Registers Used and Settings in Clock Synchronous Serial I/O Mode(1) Bit 0 to 7 0 to 7 OER 0 to 7 SMD2 to SMD0 CKDIR CLK1 to CLK0 TXEPT NCH CKPOL UFORM TE TI RE RI U0IRS U0RRM CNTRSEL Function Set data transmission. Data reception can be read. Overrun error flag Set bit rate. Set to 001b. Select the internal clock or external clock. Select the count source in the U0BRG register. Transmit register empty flag Select TXD0 pin output mode. Select the transfer clock polarity. Select the LSB first or MSB first. Set this bit to 1 to enable transmission/reception. Transmit buffer empty flag Set this bit to 1 to enable reception. Reception complete flag Select the UART0 transmit interrupt source. Set this bit to 1 to use continuous receive mode. Set this bit to 1 to select P1_5/RXD0/CNTR01/INT11. NOTE: 1. Set bits which are not in this table to 0 when writing to the above registers in clock synchronous serial I/O mode. Table 15.3 lists the I/O Pin Functions in Clock Synchronous Serial I/O Mode. The TXD0 pin outputs “H” level between the operating mode selection of UART0 and transfer start. (If the NCH bit is set to 1 (N-channel opendrain output), this pin is in a high-impedance state.) Table 15.3 I/O Pin Functions in Clock Synchronous Serial I/O Mode Pin Name TXD0 (P1_4) RXD0 (P1_5) Function Output serial data Input serial data CLK0 (P1_6) Output transfer clock Input transfer clock Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Selection Method (Outputs dummy data when performing reception only.) PD1_5 bit in PD1 register = 0 (P1_5 can be used as an input port when performing transmission only.) CKDIR bit in U0MR register = 0 CKDIR bit in U0MR register = 1 PD1_6 bit in PD1 register = 0 Page 159 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 15. Serial Interface • Example of transmit timing (when internal clock is selected) TC Transfer clock TE bit in U0C1 register 1 0 TI bit in U0C1 register 1 0 Set data in U0TB register Transfer from U0TB register to UART0 transmit register TCLK Pulse stops because the TE bit is set to 0 CLK0 D0 TXD0 TXEPT bit in U0C0 register 1 0 IR bit in S0TIC register 1 0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 Set to 0 when interrupt request is acknowledged, or set by a program TC=TCLK=2(n+1)/fi fi: Frequency of U0BRG count source (f1, f8, f32) The above applies under the following settings: n: Setting value to U0BRG register • CKDIR bit in U0MR register = 0 (internal clock) • CKPOL bit in U0C0 register = 0 (output transmit data at the falling edge and input receive data at the rising edge of the transfer clock) • U0IRS bit in UCON register = 0 (an interrupt request is generated when the transmit buffer is empty) • Example of receive timing (when external clock is selected) RE bit in U0C1 register 1 0 TE bit in U0C1 register 1 0 TI bit in U0C1 register 1 0 Write dummy data to U0TB register Transfer from U0TB register to UART0 transmit register 1/fEXT CLK0 Receive data is taken in D0 RXD0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 D0 D1 Transfer from UART0 receive register to U0RB register RI bit in U0C1 register 1 0 IR bit in S0RIC register 1 0 D2 D3 D4 D5 Read out from U0RB register Set to 0 when interrupt request is acknowledged, or set by a program The above applies under the following settings: • CKDIR bit in U0MR register = 1 (external clock) • CKPOL bit in U0C0 register = 0 (output transmit data at the falling edge and input receive data at the rising edge of the transfer clock) The following conditions are met when “H” is applied to the CLK0 pin before receiving data: • TE bit in U0C1 register = 1 (enables transmit) • RE bit in U0C1 register = 1 (enables receive) • Write dummy data to the U0TB register fEXT: Frequency of external clock Figure 15.7 Transmit and Receive Timing Example in Clock Synchronous Serial I/O Mode Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 160 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 15.1.1 15. Serial Interface Polarity Select Function Figure 15.8 shows the Transfer Clock Polarity. Use the CKPOL bit in the U0C0 register to select the transfer clock polarity. • When the CKPOL bit in the U0C0 register = 0 (output transmit data at the falling edge and input the receive data at the rising edge of the transfer clock) CLK0(1) TXD0 D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 RXD0 D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 • When the CKPOL bit in the U0C0 register = 1 (output transmit data at the rising edge and input receive data at the falling edge of the transfer clock) CLK0(2) TXD0 D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 RXD0 D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 NOTES : 1. When not transferring, the CLK0 pin level is “H”. 2. When not transferring, the CLK0 pin level is “L”. Figure 15.8 15.1.2 Transfer Clock Polarity LSB First/MSB First Select Function Figure 15.9 shows the Transfer Format. Use the UFORM bit in the U0C0 register to select the transfer format. • When UFORM bit in U0C0 register = 0 (LSB first)(1) CLK0 TXD0 D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 RXD0 D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 • When UFORM bit in U0C0 register = 1 (MSB first)(1) CLK0 TXD0 D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0 RXD0 D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0 NOTE : 1. The above applies when the CKPOL bit in the U0C0 register is set to 0 (output transmit data at the falling edge and input receive data at the rising edge of the transfer clock). Figure 15.9 Transfer Format Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 161 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 15.1.3 15. Serial Interface Continuous Receive Mode Continuous receive mode is selected by setting the U0RRM bit in the UCON register to 1 (enables continuous receive mode). In this mode, reading the U0RB register sets the TI bit in the U0C1 register to 0 (data in the U0TB register). When the U0RRM bit is set to 1, do not write dummy data to the U0TB register by a program. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 162 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 15.2 15. Serial Interface Clock Asynchronous Serial I/O (UART) Mode The UART mode allows data transmission and reception after setting the desired bit rate and transfer data format. Table 15.4 lists the UART Mode Specifications. Table 15.5 lists the Registers Used and Settings for UART Mode. Table 15.4 UART Mode Specifications Item Transfer data format Transfer clocks Transmit start conditions Receive start conditions Interrupt request generation timing Error detection Specification • Character bit (transfer data): Selectable among 7, 8 or 9 bits • Start bit: 1 bit • Parity bit: Selectable among odd, even, or none • Stop bit: Selectable among 1 or 2 bits • CKDIR bit in UiMR register is set to 0 (internal clock): fj/(16(n+1)) fj = f1, f8, f32 n = value set in UiBRG register: 00h to FFh • CKDIR bit is set to 1 (external clock): fEXT/(16(n+1)) fEXT: input from CLKi pin n=setting value in UiBRG register: 00h to FFh • Before transmission starts, the following are required. - TE bit in UiC1 register is set to 1 (transmission enabled). - TI bit in UiC1 register is set to 0 (data in UiTB register). • Before reception starts, the following are required. - RE bit in UiC1 register is set to 1 (reception enabled). - Start bit detected • When transmitting, one of the following conditions can be selected. - UiIRS bit is set to 0 (transmit buffer empty): When transferring data from the UiTB register to UARTi transmit register (when transmit starts). - UiIRS bit is set to 1 (transfer ends): When serial interface completes transmitting data from the UARTi transmit register. • When receiving When transferring data from the UARTi receive register to UiRB register (when receive ends). • Overrun error(1) This error occurs if the serial interface starts receiving the next data item before reading the UiRB register and receives the bit preceding the final stop bit of the next data item. • Framing error This error occurs when the set number of stop bits is not detected. • Parity error This error occurs when parity is enabled, and the number of 1’s in parity and character bits do not match the number of 1’s set. • Error sum flag This flag is set is set to 1 when an overrun, framing, or parity error is generated. i = 0 to 1 NOTE: 1. If an overrun error occurs, the receive data (b0 to b8) of the UiRB register will be undefined. The IR bit in the SiRIC register remains unchanged. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 163 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group Table 15.5 15. Serial Interface Registers Used and Settings for UART Mode Register UiTB 0 to 8 Bit Set transmit UiRB 0 to 8 UiBRG UiMR OER,FER,PER,SUM 0 to 7 SMD2 to SMD0 Receive data can be read.(1) Error flag Set a bit rate. Set to 100b when transfer data is 7 bits long. Set to 101b when transfer data is 8 bits long. Set to 110b when transfer data is 9 bits long. CKDIR UiC0 UiC1 UCON STPS PRY, PRYE CLK0, CLK1 TXEPT NCH CKPOL UFORM TE TI RE RI U0IRS, U1IRS U0RRM CNTRSEL Function data.(1) Select the internal clock or external clock.(2) Select the stop bit. Select whether parity is included and whether odd or even. Select the count source for the UiBRG register. Transmit register empty flag Select TXDi pin output mode. Set to 0. LSB first or MSB first can be selected when transfer data is 8 bits long. Set to 0 when transfer data is 7 or 9 bits long. Set to 1 to enable transmit. Transmit buffer empty flag Set to 1 to enable receive. Receive complete flag Select the source of UART0 transmit interrupt. Set to 0. Set to 1 to select P1_5/RXD0/CNTR01/INT11. NOTES: 1. The bits used for transmit/receive data are as follows: Bits 0 to 6 when transfer data is 7 bits long; bits 0 to 7 when transfer data is 8 bits long; bits 0 to 8 when transfer data is 9 bits long. 2. An external clock can be selected in UART0 only. Table 15.6 lists the I/O Pin Functions in Clock Asynchronous Serial I/O Mode. The TXDi pin outputs “H” level between the operating mode selection of UARTi (i = 0 or 1) and transfer start. (If the NCH bit is set to 1 (N-channel open-drain output), this pin is in a high-impedance state.) Table 15.6 Pin name TXD0(P1_4) RXD0(P1_5) CLK0(P1_6) TXD1(P3_7) RXD1(P4_5) I/O Pin Functions in Clock Asynchronous Serial I/O Mode Function Output serial data Input serial data Selection Method (Cannot be used as a port when performing reception only.) PD1_5 bit in PD1 register = 0 (P1_5 can be used as an input port when performing transmission only.) Programmable I/O Port CKDIR bit in U0MR register = 0 Input transfer clock CKDIR bit in U0MR register = 1 PD1_6 bit in PD1 register = 0 Output serial data Bits U1SEL1 to U1SEL0 in UCON register = 11b (P3_7 can be used as a port when bits U1SEL1 to U1SEL0 = 01b and performing reception only.) Input serial data PD4_5 bit in PD4 register = 0 Bits U1SEL1 to U1SEL0 in UCON register = 01b or 11b (Cannot be used as a port when performing transmission only.) Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 164 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 15. Serial Interface • Transmit timing when transfer data is 8 bits long (parity enabled, 1 stop bit) TC Transfer clock TE bit in UiC1 register 1 0 TI bit in UiC1 register 1 0 Write data to UiTB register Stop pulsing because the TE bit is set to 0 Transfer from UiTB register to UARTi transmit register Start bit TXDi ST TXEPT bit in UiC0 register 1 0 IR bit SiTIC register 1 0 Parity Stop bit bit D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 P SP ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 P SP ST D0 D1 Set to 0 when interrupt request is acknowledged, or set by a program TC=16 (n + 1) / fj or 16 (n + 1) / fEXT The above timing diagram applies under the following conditions: • PRYE bit in UiMR register = 1 (parity enabled) fj: Frequency of UiBRG count source (f1, f8, f32) • STPS bit in UiMR register = 0 (1 stop bit) fEXT: Frequency of UiBRG count source (external clock) • UiIRS bit in UiC1 register = 1 (an interrupt request is generated when transmit completes) n: Setting value to UiBRG register i = 0 or 1 • Transmit timing when transfer data is 9 bits long (parity disabled, 2 stop bits) TC Transfer clock TE bit in UiC1 register TI bit in UiC1 register 1 0 Write data to UiTB register 1 0 Transfer from UiTB register to UARTi transmit register Stop Stop bit bit Start bit TXDi ST TXEPT bit in UiC0 register 1 0 IR bit in SiTIC register 1 0 D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 D8 SP SP ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 D8 SP SP ST D0 Set to 0 when interrupt request is acknowledged, or set by a program The above timing diagram applies under the following conditions: • PRYE bit in UiMR register = 0 (parity disabled) • STPS bit in UiMR register = 1 (2 stop bits) • UiIRS bit in UiC1 register = 0 (an interrupt request is generated when transmit buffer is empty) Figure 15.10 Transmit Timing in UART Mode Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 165 of 315 TC=16 (n + 1) / fj or 16 (n + 1) / fEXT fj: Frequency of UiBRG count source (f1, f8, f32) fEXT: Frequency of UiBRG count source (external clock) n: Setting value to UiBRG register i = 0 or 1 D1 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 15. Serial Interface • Example of receive timing when transfer data is 8 bits long (parity disabled, one stop bit) UiBRG output UiC1 register RE bit 1 0 Stop bit Start bit RXDi D0 D1 D7 Determined to be “L” Receive data taken in Transfer clock Reception triggered when transfer clock is generated by falling edge of start bit UiC1 register RI bit 1 0 SiRIC register IR bit 1 0 Transferred from UARTi receive register to UiRB register Set to 0 when interrupt request is accepted, or set by a program The above timing diagram applies when the register bits are set as follows: • PRYE bit in UiMR register = 0 (parity disabled) • STPS bit in UiMR register = 0 (1 stop bit) i = 0 or 1 Figure 15.11 15.2.1 Receive Timing in UART Mode CNTR0 Pin Select Function The CNTRSEL bit in the UCON register selects whether P1_7 is used as the CNTR00/INT10 input pin or P1_5 is used as the CNTR01/INT11 input pin. When the CNTRSEL bit is set to 0, P1_7 is used as the CNTR00/INT10 pin and when the CNTRSEL bit is set to 1, P1_5 is used as the CNTR01/INT11 pin. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 166 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 15.2.2 15. Serial Interface Bit Rate In UART mode, the bit rate is the frequency divided by the UiBRG (i = 0 or 1) register. UART Mode • Internal clock selected UiBRG register setting value = fj Bit Rate × 16 -1 Fj: Count source frequency of the UiBRG register (f1, f8, or f32) • External clock selected UiBRG register setting value = fEXT Bit Rate × 16 -1 fEXT : Count source frequency of the UiBRG register (external clock) i = 0 or 1 Figure 15.12 Table 15.7 Calculation Formula of UiBRG (i = 0 or 1) Register Setting Value Bit Rate Setting Example in UART Mode (Internal Clock Selected) Bit Rate (bps) BRG Count Source 1200 2400 4800 9600 14400 19200 28800 31250 38400 51200 f8 f8 f8 f1 f1 f1 f1 f1 f1 f1 System Clock = 20 MHz UiBRG Actual Time Error (%) Setting Value (bps) 129(81h) 64(40h) 32(20h) 129(81h) 86(56h) 64(40h) 42(2Ah) 39(27h) 32(20h) 23(17h) i = 0 or 1 Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 167 of 315 1201.92 2403.85 4734.85 9615.38 14367.82 19230.77 29069.77 31250.00 37878.79 52083.33 0.16 0.16 -1.36 0.16 -0.22 0.16 0.94 0.00 -1.36 1.73 System Clock = 8 MHz UiBRG Actual Setting Error (%) Time (bps) Value 51(33h) 1201.92 0.16 25(19h) 2403.85 0.16 12(0Ch) 4807.69 0.16 51(33h) 9615.38 0.16 34(22h) 14285.71 -0.79 25(19h) 19230.77 0.16 16(10h) 29411.76 2.12 15(0Fh) 31250.00 0.00 12(0Ch) 38461.54 0.16 9(09h) 50000.00 -2.34 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 15.3 15. Serial Interface Notes on Serial Interface • When reading data from the UiRB register either in the clock asynchronous serial I/O mode or in the clock synchronous serial I/O mode. Ensure the data is read in 16-bit units. When the high-order byte of the UiRB register is read, bits PER and FER in the UiRB register and the RI bit in the UiC1 register are set to 0. To check receive errors, read the UiRB register and then use the read data. Example (when reading receive buffer register): MOV.W 00A6H,R0 ; Read the U0RB register • When writing data to the UiTB register in the clock asynchronous serial I/O mode with 9-bit transfer data length, write data to the high-order byte first then the low-order byte, in 8-bit units. Example (when reading transmit buffer register): MOV.B #XXH,00A3H ; Write the high-order byte of U0TB register MOV.B #XXH,00A2H ; Write the low-order byte of U0TB register Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 168 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 16. Clock Synchronous Serial Interface 16. Clock Synchronous Serial Interface The clock synchronous serial interface is configured as follows. Clock synchronous serial interface Clock synchronous serial I/O with chip select (SSU) Clock synchronous communication mode 4-wire bus communication mode I2C bus Interface I2C bus interface mode Clock synchronous serial mode The clock synchronous serial interface uses the registers at addresses 00B8h to 00BFh. Registers, bits, symbols, and functions vary even for the same addresses depending on the mode. Refer to the register diagrams of each function for details. Also, the differences between clock synchronous communication mode and clock synchronous serial mode are the options of the transfer clock, clock output format, and data output format. 16.1 Mode Selection The clock synchronous serial interface has four modes. Table 16.1lists the Mode Selections. Refer to 16.2 Clock Synchronous Serial I/O with Chip Select (SSU) and the sections that follow for details of each mode. Table 16.1 IICSEL Bit in PMR Register 0 0 1 1 Mode Selection Function Bit 0 in 00BDh Bit 7 in 00B8h (SSUMS Bit in SSMR2 (ICE Bit in ICCR1 Register) Register, FS Bit in SAR Register) 0 0 Clock synchronous serial I/O with chip select 0 1 1 0 1 1 Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 169 of 315 I2C bus interface Mode Clock synchronous communication mode 4-wire bus communication mode I2C bus interface mode Clock synchronous serial mode R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 16.2 16. Clock Synchronous Serial Interface Clock Synchronous Serial I/O with Chip Select (SSU) Clock synchronous serial I/O with chip select supports clock synchronous serial data communication. Table 16.2 shows a Clock Synchronous Serial I/O with Chip Select Specifications and Figure 16.1 shows a Block Diagram of Clock Synchronous Serial I/O with Chip Select. Figures 16.2 to 16.9 show Clock Synchronous Serial I/O with Chip Select Associated Registers. Table 16.2 Clock Synchronous Serial I/O with Chip Select Specifications Item Transfer data format Specification • Transfer data length: 8 bits Continuous transmission and reception of serial data are supported since both transmitter and receiver have buffer structures. Operating mode • Clock synchronous communication mode • 4-wire bus communication mode (including bidirectional communication) Master / slave device Selectable I/O pins SSCK (I/O): Clock I/O pin SSI (I/O): Data I/O pin SSO (I/O): Data I/O pin SCS (I/O): Chip-select I/O pin Transfer clock • When the MSS bit in the SSCRH register is set to 0 (operates as slave device), external clock is selected (input from SSCK pin). • When the MSS bit in the SSCRH register is set to 1 (operates as master device), internal clock (selectable among f1/256, f1/128, f1/64, f1/32, f1/16, f1/8 and f1/4, output from SSCK pin) is selected. • Clock polarity and phase of SSCK can be selected. Receive error detection • Overrun error Overrun error occurs during reception and completes in error. While the RDRF bit in the SSSR register is set to 1 (data in the SSRDR register) and when the next serial data receive is completed, the ORER bit is set to 1. Multimaster error • Conflict error When the SSUMS bit in the SSMR2 register is set to 1 (4-wire bus detection communication mode) and the MSS bit in the SSCRH register is set to 1 (operates as master device) and when starting a serial communication, the CE bit in the SSSR register is set to 1 if “L” applies to the SCS pin input. When the SSUMS bit in the SSMR2 register is set to 1 (4-wire bus communication mode), the MSS bit in the SSCRH register is set to 0 (operates as slave device) and the SCS pin input changes state from “L” to “H”, the CE bit in the SSSR register is set to 1. Interrupt requests 5 interrupt requests (transmit-end, transmit-data-empty, receive-data-full, overrun error, and conflict error).(1) Select functions • Data transfer direction Selects MSB-first or LSB-first. • SSCK clock polarity Selects “L” or “H” level when clock stops. • SSCK clock phase Selects edge of data change and data download. NOTE: 1. Clock synchronous serial I/O with chip select has only one interrupt vector table. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 170 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 16. Clock Synchronous Serial Interface f1 Internal clock (f1/i) Internal clock generation circuit Multiplexer SSCK SSMR register SSCRL register SSCRH register Transmit/receive control circuit SCS SSER register SSMR2 register SSTDR register SSO Selector SSTRSR register SSI SSRDR register Interrupt requests (TXI, TEI, RXI, OEI, and CEI) i = 4, 8, 16, 32, 64, 128, or 256 Figure 16.1 Block Diagram of Clock Synchronous Serial I/O with Chip Select Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 171 of 315 Data bus SSSR register R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 16. Clock Synchronous Serial Interface SS Control Register H(4) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol SSCRH Bit Symbol Address 00B8h Bit Name Transfer clock rate select bits (1) CKS1 CKS2 Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0. When read, the content is 0. (2) MSS RW RW RW — Master/slave device select bit 0 : Operates as slave device. 1 : Operates as master device. RW Receive single stop bit(3) 0 : Maintains receive operation after receiving 1 byte of data. 1 : Completes receive operation after receiving 1 byte of data. RW RSSTP — (b7) RW b2 b1 b0 0 0 0 : f1/256 0 0 1 : f1/128 0 1 0 : f1/64 0 1 1 : f1/32 1 0 0 : f1/16 1 0 1 : f1/8 1 1 0 : f1/4 1 1 1 : Do not set. CKS0 — (b4-b3) After Reset 00h Function Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0. When read, the content is 0. — NOTES : 1. The set clock is used w hen the internal clock is selected. 2. The SSCK pin functions as the transfer clock output pin w hen the MSS bit is set to 1 (operates as master device). The MSS bit is set to 0 (operates as slave device) w hen the CE bit in the SSSR register is set to 1 (conflict error occurs). 3. The RSSTP bit is disabled w hen the MSS bit is set to 0 (operates as slave device). 4. Refer to 16.2.8.1 Accessing Registers Associated w ith Clock Synchronous Serial I/O w ith Chip Select for more information. Figure 16.2 SSCRH Register Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 172 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 16. Clock Synchronous Serial Interface SS Control Register L(4) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol Address 00B9h SSCRL Bit Symbol Bit Name — Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0. (b0) When read, the content is 1. SRES — (b3-b2) SOLP SOL Clock synchronous serial I/O w ith chip select control part reset bit After Reset 01111101b Function When this bit is set to 1, the clock synchronous serial I/O w ith chip select control block and SSTRSR register are reset. The values of the registers (1) in the clock synchronous serial I/O w ith chip select register are maintained. RW — RW Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0. When read, the content is 1. — SOL w rite protect bit(2) The output level can be changed by the SOL bit w hen this bit is set to 0. Cannot w rite to this bit. When read, the content is 1. RW Serial data output value When read setting bit 0 : The serial data output is set to “L”. 1 : The serial data output is set to “H”. When w ritten,(2,3) 0 : The data output is “L” after the serial data output. 1 : The data output is “H” after the serial data output. RW — (b6) Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0. When read, the content is 1. — — (b7) Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0. When read, the content is 0. — NOTES : 1. Registers SSCRH, SSCRL, SSMR, SSER, SSSR, SSMR2, SSTDR, and SSRDR. 2. The data output after serial data is output can be changed by w riting to the SOL bit before or after transfer. When w riting to the SOL bit, set the SOLP bit to 0 and the SOL bit to 0 or 1 simultaneously by the MOV instruction. 3. Do not w rite to the SOL bit during data transfer. 4. Refer to 16.2.8.1 Accessing Registers Associated w ith Clock Synchronous Serial I/O w ith Chip Select for more information. Figure 16.3 SSCRL Register Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 173 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 16. Clock Synchronous Serial Interface SS Mode Register(2) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 1 Symbol SSMR Bit Symbol Address 00BAh Bit Name Bit counter 2 to 0 After Reset 00011000b Function 0 0 0 : 8 bits left 0 0 1 : 1 bit left 0 1 0 : 2 bits left 0 1 1 : 3 bits left 1 0 0 : 4 bits left 1 0 1 : 5 bits left 1 1 0 : 6 bits left 1 1 1 : 7 bits left BC0 BC1 BC2 Set to 1. When read, the content is 1. — (b3) Reserved bit — (b4) Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0. When read, the content is 1. SSCK clock phase select bit(1) MLS R R R RW — 0 : Change data at odd edge (Dow nload data at even edge). 1 : Change data at even edge (Dow nload data at odd edge). RW SSCK clock polarity select bit(1) 0 : “H” w hen clock stops. 1 : “L” w hen clock stops. RW MSB first/LSB first select bit 0 : Transfers data MSB first. 1 : Transfers data LSB first. RW CPHS CPOS RW b2 b1 b0 NOTES : 1. Refer to 16.2.1.1 Association betw een Transfer Clock Polarity, Phase and Data for the settings of bits CPHS and CPOS. 2. Refer to 16.2.8.1 Accessing Registers Associated w ith Clock Synchronous Serial I/O w ith Chip Select for more information. Figure 16.4 SSMR Register Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 174 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 16. Clock Synchronous Serial Interface SS Enable Register(1) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol SSER Bit Symbol CEIE — (b2-b1) RE TE Address After Reset 00BBh 00h Bit Name Function Conflict error interrupt enable bit 0 : Disables conflict error interrupt request. 1 : Enables conflict error interrupt request. RW Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0. When read, the content is 0. — Receive enable bit 0 : Disables receive. 1 : Enables receive. RW Transmit enable bit 0 : Disables transmit. 1 : Enables transmit. RW Receive interrupt enable bit 0 : Disables receive data full and overrun error interrupt request. 1 : Enables receive data full and overrun error interrupt request. RW RIE TEIE RW Transmit end interrupt enable bit 0 : Disables transmit end interrupt request. 1 : Enables transmit end interrupt request. Transmit interrupt enable bit TIE 0 : Disables transmit data empty interrupt request. 1 : Enables transmit data empty interrupt request. RW RW NOTE : 1. Refer to 16.2.8.1 Accessing Registers Associated w ith Clock Synchronous Serial I/O w ith Chip Select for more information. Figure 16.5 SSER Register Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 175 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 16. Clock Synchronous Serial Interface SS Status Register(7) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol SSSR Bit Symbol CE — (b1) ORER — (b4-b3) RDRF Address 00BCh Bit Name Conflict error flag(1) After Reset 00h Function 0 : No conflict errors generated 1 : Conflict errors generated(2) Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0. When read, the content is 0. Overrun error flag(1) 0 : No overrun errors generated 1 : Overrun errors generated(3) Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0. When read, the content is 0. Receive data register full (1,4) Transmit end(1, 5) TEND Transmit data empty (1, 5, 6) TDRE RW RW — RW — 0 : No data in SSRDR register 1 : Data in SSRDR register RW 0 : The TDRE bit is set to 0 w hen transmitting the last bit of transmit data. 1 : The TDRE bit is set to 1 w hen transmitting the last bit of transmit data. RW 0 : Data is not transferred from registers SSTDR to SSTRSR. 1 : Data is transferred from registers SSTDR to SSTRSR. RW NOTES : 1. Writing 1 to CE, ORER, RDRF, TEND, or TDRE bit is invalid. To set any of these bits to 0, first read 1 then w rite 0. 2. When the serial communication is started w hile the SSUMS bit in the SSMR2 register is set to 1 (four-w ire bus communication mode) and the MSS bit in the SSCRH register is set to 1 (operates as master device), the CE bit is set to 1 if “L” is applied to the SCS pin input. When the SSUMS bit in the SSMR2 register is set to 1 (four-w ire bus communication mode), the MSS bit in the SSCRH register is set to 0 (operates as slave device) and the SCS pin input changes the level from “L” to “H” during transfer, the CE bit is set to 1. 3. Indicates w hen overrun errors occur and receive completes by error reception. If the next serial data receive operation is completed w hile the RDRF bit is set to 1 (data in the SSRDR register), the ORER bit is set to 1. After the ORER bit is set to 1 (overrun error), transmit and receive operations are disabled w hile the bit remains 1. 4. 5. 6. 7. The RDRF bit is set to 0 w hen reading out the data from the SSRDR register. Bits TEND and TDRE are set to 0 w hen w riting data to the SSTDR register. The TDRE bit is set to 1 w hen the TE bit in the SSER register is set to 1 (transmit enabled). Refer to 16.2.8.1 Accessing Registers Associated w ith Clock Synchronous Serial I/O w ith Chip Select for more information. Figure 16.6 SSSR Register Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 176 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 16. Clock Synchronous Serial Interface SS Mode Register 2(5) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol SSMR2 Bit Symbol SSUMS Address After Reset 00BDh 00h Bit Name Function Clock synchronous serial I/O w ith 0 : Clock synchronous communication mode chip select mode select bit(1) 1 : Four-w ire bus communication mode _____ CSOS SOOS SCKOS CSS0 SCS pin open drain output select bit Serial data open drain output select bit(1) 0 : CMOS output 1 : NMOS open drain output 0 : CMOS output 1 : NMOS open drain output SSCK pin open drain output select bit 0 : CMOS output 1 : NMOS open drain output _____ SCS pin select bits (2) CSS1 SCKS SSCK pin select bit Bidirectional mode enable bit(1, 4) BIDE RW RW RW RW RW b5 b4 0 0 : Functions as port. _____ 0 1 : Functions as SCS input pin. _____ 1 0 : Functions as SCS output pin.(3) _____ 1 1 : Functions as SCS output pin.(3) 0 : Functions as port. 1 : Functions as serial clock pin. 0 : Standard mode (communication using 2 pins of data input and data output) 1 : Bidirectional mode (communication using 1 pin of data input and data output) RW RW RW RW NOTES : 1. Refer to 16.2.2.1 Relationship betw een Data I/O Pin and SS Shift Register for information on combinations of data I/O pins. _____ 2. The SCS pin functions as a port, regardless of the values of bits CSS0 and CSS1 w hen the SSUMS bit is set to 0 (clock synchronous communication mode). 3. This bit functions as the SCS input pin before starting transfer. 4. The BIDE bit is disabled w hen the SSUMS bit is set to 0 (clock synchronous communication mode). 5. Refer to 16.2.8.1 Accessing Registers Associated w ith Clock Synchronous Serial I/O w ith Chip Select for more information. Figure 16.7 SSMR2 Register Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 177 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 16. Clock Synchronous Serial Interface SS Transmit Data Register(1) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol SSTDR Address 00BEh After Reset FFh Function RW Store the transmit data. The stored transmit data is transferred to the SSTRSR register and transmission is started w hen it is detected that the SSTRSR register is empty. When the next transmit data is w ritten to the SSTDR register during the data transmission from RW the SSTRSR register, the data can be transmitted continuously. When the MLS bit in the SSMR register is set to 1 (transfer data w ith LSB-first), the data in w hich MSB and LSB are reversed is read, after w riting to the SSTDR register. NOTE : 1. Refer to 16.2.8.1 Accessing Registers Associated w ith Clock Synchronous Serial I/O w ith Chip Select for more information. SS Receive Data Register(2) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol SSRDR Address 00BFh After Reset FFh Function Store the receive data.(1) The receive data is transferred to the SSRDR register and the receive operation is completed w hen 1 byte of data has been received by the SSTRSR register. At this time, the next receive operation is possible. Continuous reception is possible using registers SSTRSR and SSRDR. RW RO NOTES : 1. The SSRDR register retains the data received before an overrun error occurs (ORER bit in the SSSR register set to 1 (overrun error)). When an overrun error occurs, the receive data may contain errors and therefore should be discarded. 2. Refer to 16.2.8.1 Accessing Registers Associated w ith Clock Synchronous Serial I/O w ith Chip Select for more information. Figure 16.8 Registers SSTDR and SSRDR Port Mode Register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Symbol Address 00F8h PMR Bit Symbol Bit Name Reserved bits — (b2-b0) SSISEL — (b6-b4) IICSEL Figure 16.9 Set to 0. SSI signal pin select bit 0 : P3_3 pin is used for SSI00 pin. 1 : P1_6 pin is used for SSI01 pin. Reserved bits Set to 0. SSU / I2C bus sw itch bit 0 : Selects SSU function. 1 : Selects I2C bus function. PMR Register Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 After Reset 00h Function Page 178 of 315 RW RW RW RW RW R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 16.2.1 16. Clock Synchronous Serial Interface Transfer Clock The transfer clock can be selected among seven internal clocks (f1/256, f1/128, f1/64, f1/32, f1/16, f1/8, and f1/4) and an external clock. When using clock synchronous serial I/O with chip select, set the SCKS bit in the SSMR2 register to 1 and select the SSCK pin as the serial clock pin. When the MSS bit in the SSCRH register is set to 1 (operates as master device), an internal clock can be selected and the SSCK pin functions as output. When transfer is started, the SSCK pin outputs clocks of the transfer rate selected by bits CKS0 to CKS2 in the SSCRH register. When the MSS bit in the SSCRH register is set to 0 (operates as slave device), an external clock can be selected and the SSCK pin functions as input. 16.2.1.1 Association between Transfer Clock Polarity, Phase, and Data The association between the transfer clock polarity, phase and data changes according to the combination of the SSUMS bit in the SSMR2 register and bits CPHS and CPOS in the SSMR register. Figure 16.10 shows the Association between Transfer Clock Polarity, Phase, and Transfer Data. Also, the MSB-first transfer or LSB-first transfer can be selected by setting the MLS bit in the SSMR register. When the MLS bit is set to 1, transfer is started from the LSB and proceeds to the MSB. When the MLS bit is set to 0, transfer is started from the MSB and proceeds to the LSB. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 179 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 16. Clock Synchronous Serial Interface • SSUMS = 0 (clock synchronous communication mode), CPHS bit = 0 (data change at odd edge), and CPOS bit = 0 (“H” when clock stops) SSCK b0 SSO, SSI b1 b2 b3 b4 b5 b6 b7 • SSUMS = 1 (4-wire bus communication mode) and CPHS = 0 (data change at odd edge) SSCK CPOS = 0 (“H” when clock stops) SSCK CPOS = 1 (“L” when clock stops) SSO, SSI b0 b1 b2 b3 b4 b5 b6 b7 SCS • SSUMS = 1 (4-wire bus communication mode) and CPHS = 1 (data download at odd edge) SSCK CPOS = 0 (“H” when clock stops) SSCK CPOS = 1 (“L” when clock stops) SSO, SSI b0 b1 b2 b3 b4 b5 b6 b7 SCS CPHS and CPOS: Bits in SSMR register, SSUMS: Bits in SSMR2 register Figure 16.10 Association between Transfer Clock Polarity, Phase, and Transfer Data Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 180 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 16.2.2 16. Clock Synchronous Serial Interface SS Shift Register (SSTRSR) The SSTRSR register is a shift register for transmitting and receiving serial data. When transmit data is transferred from the SSTDR register to the SSTRSR register and the MLS bit in the SSMR register is set to 0 (MSB-first), the bit 0 in the SSTDR register is transferred to bit 0 in the SSTRSR register. When the MLS bit is set to 1 (LSB-first), bit 7 in the SSTDR register is transferred to bit 0 in the SSTRSR register. 16.2.2.1 Association between Data I/O Pins and SS Shift Register The connection between the data I/O pins and SSTRSR register (SS shift register) changes according to a combination of the MSS bit in the SSCRH register and the SSUMS bit in the SSMR2 register. The connection also changes according to the BIDE bit in the SSMR2 register. Figure 16.11 shows the Association between Data I/O Pins and SSTRSR Register. • SSUMS = 1 (4-wire bus communication mode) and BIDE = 0 (standard mode), and MSS = 1 (operates as master device) • SSUMS = 0 (clock synchronous communication mode) SSTRSR register SSO SSTRSR register SSI • SSUMS = 1 (4-wire bus communication mode) and BIDE = 0 (standard mode), and MSS = 0 (operates as slave device) SSTRSR register SSO SSI • SSUMS = 1 (4-wire bus communication mode) and BIDE = 1 (bidirectional mode) SSTRSR register SSI Figure 16.11 Association between Data I/O Pins and SSTRSR Register Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 181 of 315 SSO SSO SSI R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 16.2.3 16. Clock Synchronous Serial Interface Interrupt Requests Clock synchronous serial I/O with chip select has five interrupt requests: transmit data empty, transmit end, receive data full, overrun error, and conflict error. Since these interrupt requests are assigned to the clock synchronous serial I/O with chip select interrupt vector table, determining interrupt sources by flags is required. Table 16.3 shows the Clock Synchronous Serial I/O with Chip Select Interrupt Requests. Table 16.3 Clock Synchronous Serial I/O with Chip Select Interrupt Requests Interrupt Request Transmit data empty Transmit end Receive data full Overrun error Conflict error Abbreviation TXI TEI RXI OEI CEI Generation Condition TIE = 1, TDRE = 1 TEIE = 1, TEND = 1 RIE = 1, RDRF = 1 RIE = 1, ORER = 1 CEIE = 1, CE = 1 CEIE, RIE, TEIE, and TIE: Bits in SSER register ORER, RDRF, TEND, and TDRE: Bits in SSSR register If the generation conditions in Table 16.3 are met, a clock synchronous serial I/O with chip select interrupt request is generated. Set each interrupt source to 0 by a clock synchronous serial I/O with chip select interrupt routine. However, the TDRE and TEND bits are automatically set to 0 by writing transmit data to the SSTDR register and the RDRF bit is automatically set to 0 by reading the SSRDR register. In particular, the TDRE bit is set to 1 (data transmitted from registers SSTDR to SSTRSR) at the same time transmit data is written to the SSTDR register. Setting the TDRE bit to 0 (data not transmitted from registers SSTDR to SSTRSR) can cause an additional byte of data to be transmitted. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 182 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 16.2.4 16. Clock Synchronous Serial Interface Communication Modes and Pin Functions Clock synchronous serial I/O with chip select switches the functions of the I/O pins in each communication mode according to the setting of the MSS bit in the SSCRH register and bits RE and TE in the SSER register. Table 16.4 shows the Association between Communication Modes and I/O Pins. Table 16.4 Association between Communication Modes and I/O Pins Communication Mode Clock synchronous communication mode Bit Setting SSUMS BIDE MSS TE 0 Disabled 0 0 1 4-wire bus communication mode 1 0 0 1 4-wire bus 1 (bidirectional) communication mode(2) 1 0 1 RE 1 SSI Input −(1) Input Input 1 0 0 1 1 1 0 0 1 1 1 0 Output 0 1 1 Output Input 1 0 0 1 1 −(1) Input 1 −(1) Input −(1) Pin State SSO −(1) Output Output Page 183 of 315 Input −(1) Input Output Output Output Output Input Output Input −(1) Input Input −(1) Input Output Output Output −(1) Output Input Output Input 0 −(1) Output Input 0 1 −(1) Input Output 1 0 −(1) Output Output NOTES: 1. This pin can be used as a programmable I/O port. 2. Do not set both bits TE and RE to 1 in 4-wire bus (bidirectional) communication mode. SSUMS and BIDE: Bits in SSMR2 register MSS: Bit in SSCRH register TE and RE: Bits in SSER register Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 SSCK Input R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 16.2.5 16. Clock Synchronous Serial Interface Clock Synchronous Communication Mode 16.2.5.1 Initialization in Clock Synchronous Communication Mode Figure 16.12 shows Initialization in Clock Synchronous Communication Mode. To initialize, set the TE bit in the SSER register to 0 (transmit disabled) and the RE bit to 0 (receive disabled) before data transmission or reception. Set the TE bit to 0 and the RE bit to 0 before changing the communication mode or format. Setting the RE bit to 0 does not change the contents of flags RDRF and ORER and the contents of the SSRDR register. Start RE bit ← 0 TE bit ← 0 SSER register SSUMS bit ← 0 SSMR2 register SSMR register CPHS bit ← 0 CPOS bit ← 0 Set MLS bit SSCRH register SCKS bit ← 1 Set SOOS bit SSMR2 register SSCRH register Set bits CKS0 to CKS2 Set RSSTP bit SSSR register SSER register Set MSS bit ORER bit ← 0(1) RE bit ← 1 (receive) TE bit ← 1 (transmit) Set bits RIE, TEIE, and TIE End NOTE: 1. Write 0 after reading 1 to set the ORER bit to 0. Figure 16.12 Initialization in Clock Synchronous Communication Mode Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 184 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 16.2.5.2 16. Clock Synchronous Serial Interface Data Transmission Figure 16.13 shows an Example of Clock Synchronous Serial I/O with Chip Select Operation for Data Transmission (Clock Synchronous Communication Mode). During data transmission, clock synchronous serial I/O with chip select operates as described below. When clock synchronous serial I/O with chip select is set as a master device, it outputs a synchronous clock and data. When clock synchronous serial I/O with chip select is set as a slave device, it outputs data synchronized with the input clock. When the TE bit is set to 1 (transmit enabled) before writing the transmit data to the SSTDR register, the TDRE bit is automatically set to 0 (data not transferred from registers SSTDR to SSTRSR) and the data is transferred from registers SSTDR to SSTRSR. After the TDRE bit is set to 1 (data transferred from registers SSTDR to SSTRSR), transmission starts. When the TIE bit in the SSER register is set to 1, the TXI interrupt request is generated. When one frame of data is transferred while the TDRE bit is set to 0, data is transferred from registers SSTDR to SSTRSR and transmission of the next frame is started. If the 8th bit is transmitted while the TDRE bit is set to 1, the TEND bit in the SSSR register is set to 1 (the TDRE bit is set to 1 when the last bit of the transmit data is transmitted) and the state is retained. The TEI interrupt request is generated when the TEIE bit in the SSER register is set to 1 (transmit-end interrupt request enabled). The SSCK pin is fixed “H” after transmit-end. Transmission cannot be performed while the ORER bit in the SSSR register is set to 1 (overrun error). Confirm that the ORER bit is set to 0 before transmission. Figure 16.14 shows a Sample Flowchart of Data Transmission (Clock Synchronous Communication Mode). • When SSUMS = 0 (clock synchronous communication mode), CPHS = 0 (data change at odd numbers), and CPOS = 0 (“H” when clock stops) SSCK SSO b0 b1 b7 1 frame TDRE bit in SSSR register 1 TEND bit in SSSR register 1 b1 b7 1 frame TEI interrupt request generation 0 TXI interrupt request generation 0 Processing by program Figure 16.13 b0 Write data to SSTDR register Example of Clock Synchronous Serial I/O with Chip Select Operation for Data Transmission (Clock Synchronous Communication Mode) Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 185 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 16. Clock Synchronous Serial Interface Start Initialization (1) Read TDRE bit in SSSR register TDRE = 1 ? No (1) After reading the SSSR register and confirming that the TDRE bit is set to 1, write the transmit data to the SSTDR register. When the transmit data is written to the SSTDR register, the TDRE bit is automatically set to 0. Yes Write transmit data to SSTDR register Data transmission continues? (2) Yes (2) Determine whether data transmission continues. No (3) Read TEND bit in SSSR register TEND = 1 ? (3) When data transmission is completed, the TEND bit is set to 1. Set the TEND bit to 0 and the TE bit to 0 and complete transmit mode. No Yes SSSR register TEND bit ← 0(1) SSER register TE bit ← 0 End NOTE: 1. Write 0 after reading 1 to set the TEND bit to 0. Figure 16.14 Sample Flowchart of Data Transmission (Clock Synchronous Communication Mode) Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 186 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 16.2.5.3 16. Clock Synchronous Serial Interface Data Reception Figure 16.15 shows an Example of Clock Synchronous Serial I/O with Chip Select Operation for Data Reception (Clock Synchronous Communication Mode). During data reception clock synchronous serial I/O with chip select operates as described below. When clock synchronous serial I/O with chip select is set as the master device, it outputs a synchronous clock and inputs data. When clock synchronous serial I/O with chip select is set as a slave device, it inputs data synchronized with the input clock. When clock synchronous serial I/O with chip select is set as a master device, it outputs a receive clock and starts receiving by performing dummy read of the SSRDR register. After 8 bits of data are received, the RDRF bit in the SSSR register is set to 1 (data in the SSRDR register) and receive data is stored in the SSRDR register. When the RIE bit in the SSER register is set to 1 (RXI and OEI interrupt requests enabled), the RXI interrupt request is generated. If the SSDR register is read, the RDRF bit is automatically set to 0 (no data in the SSRDR register). Read the receive data after setting the RSSTP bit in the SSCRH register to 1 (after receiving 1 byte of data, the receive operation is completed). Clock synchronous serial I/O with chip select outputs a clock for receiving 8 bits of data and stops. After that, set the RE bit in the SSER register to 0 (receive disabled) and the RSSTP bit to 0 (receive operation is continued after receiving the 1 byte of data) and read the receive data. If the SSRDR register is read while the RE bit is set to 1 (receive enabled), a receive clock is output again. When the 8th clock rises while the RDRF bit is set to 1, the ORER bit in the SSSR register is set to 1 (overrun error: OEI) and the operation is stopped. When the ORER bit is set to 1, receive cannot be performed. Confirm that the ORER bit is set to 0 before restarting receive. Figure 16.16 shows a Sample Flowchart of Data Reception (MSS = 1) (Clock Synchronous Communication Mode). • SSUMS = 0 (clock synchronous communication mode), CPHS = 0 (data download at even edges) and CPOS bit = 0 (“H” when clock stops) SSCK b7 b0 SSI b0 b7 1 frame RDRF bit in SSSR register 1 RSSTP bit in SSCRH register 1 Processing by program Figure 16.15 b0 b7 1 frame 0 RXI interrupt request generation RXI interrupt request generation RXI interrupt request generation 0 Dummy read in SSRDR register Read data in SSRDR register Set RSSTP bit to 1 Read data in SSRDR register Example of Clock Synchronous Serial I/O with Chip Select Operation for Data Reception (Clock Synchronous Communication Mode) Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 187 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 16. Clock Synchronous Serial Interface Start Initialization (1) Dummy read of SSRDR register (2) Last data received? Yes (1) After setting each register in the clock synchronous serial I/O with chip select register, a dummy read of the SSRDR register is performed and the receive operation is started. (2) Determine whether it is the last 1 byte of data to be received. If so, set to stop after the data is received. No Read ORER bit in SSSR register Yes (3) If a receive error occurs, perform error. (6) Processing after reading the ORER bit. Then set the ORER bit to 0. Transmission/reception cannot be restarted while the ORER bit is set to 1. ORER = 1 ? (3) No Read RDRF bit in SSSR register (4) No (4) Confirm that the RDRF bit is set to 1. If the RDRF bit is set to 1, read the receive data in the SSRDR register. When the SSRDR register is read, the RDRF bit is automatically set to 0. RDRF = 1 ? Yes Read receive data in SSRDR register (5) SSCRH register RSSTP bit ← 1 (5)Before the last 1 byte of data is received, set the RSSTP bit to 1 and stop after the data is received. Read ORER bit in SSSR register ORER = 1 ? (6) Yes No Read RDRF in SSSR register No RDRF = 1 ? (7) Yes SSCRH register RSSTP bit ← 0 SSER register RE bit ← 0 (7) Confirm that the RDRF bit is set to 1. When the receive operation is completed, set the RSSTP bit to 0 and the RE bit to 0 before reading the last 1 byte of data. If the SSRDR register is read before setting the RE bit to 0, the receive operation is restarted again. Overrun error processing Read receive data in SSRDR register End Figure 16.16 Sample Flowchart of Data Reception (MSS = 1) (Clock Synchronous Communication Mode) Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 188 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 16.2.5.4 16. Clock Synchronous Serial Interface Data Transmission/Reception Data transmission/reception is an operation combining data transmission and reception, which were described earlier. Transmission/reception is started by writing data to the SSTDR register. When the 8th clock rises or the ORER bit is set to 1 (overrun error) while the TDRE bit is set to 1 (data is transferred from registers SSTDR to SSTRSR), the transmit/receive operation is stopped. When switching from transmit mode (TE = 1) or receive mode (RE = 1) to transmit/receive mode (Te = RE = 1), set the TE bit to 0 and RE bit to 0 before switching. After confirming that the TEND bit is set to 0 (the TDRE bit is set to 0 when the last bit of the transmit data is transmitted), the RDRF bit is set to 0 (no data in the SSRDR register) and the ORER bit is set to 0 (no overrun error), set bits TE and RE to 1. Figure 16.17 shows a Sample Flowchart of Data Transmission/Reception (Clock Synchronous Communication Mode). Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 189 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 16. Clock Synchronous Serial Interface Start Initialization (1) Read TDRE bit in SSSR register TDRE = 1 ? No (1) After reading the SSSR register and confirming that the TDRE bit is set to 1, write the transmit data to the SSTDR register. When the transmit data is written to the SSTDR register, the TDRE bit is automatically set to 0. Yes Write transmit data to SSTDR register (2) Read RDRF bit in SSSR register No RDRF = 1 ? (2) Confirm that the RDRF bit is set to 1. If the RDRF bit is set to 1, read the receive data in the SSRDR register. When the SSRDR register is read, the RDRF bit is automatically set to 0. Yes Read receive data in SSRDR register Data transmission continues? (3) Yes (3) Determine whether data transmission continues. No (4) Read TEND bit in SSSR register TEND = 1 ? (4) When the data transmission is completed, the TEND bit in the SSSR register is set to 1. No Yes (5) (6) SSSR register TEND bit ← 0(1) SSER register RE bit ← 0 TE bit ← 0 (5) Set the TEND bit to 0 (6) and bits RE and TE in the SSER register to 0 before ending transmit/receive mode. End NOTE: 1. Write 0 after reading 1 to set the TEND bit to 0. Figure 16.17 Sample Flowchart of Data Transmission/Reception (Clock Synchronous Communication Mode) Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 190 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 16.2.6 16. Clock Synchronous Serial Interface Operation in 4-Wire Bus Communication Mode In 4-wire bus communication mode, a 4-wire bus consisting of a clock line, a data input line, a data output line, and a chip select line is used for communication. This mode includes bidirectional mode in which the data input line and data output line function as a single pin. The data input line and output line change according to the settings of the MSS bit in the SSCRH register and the BIDE bit in the SSMR2 register. For details, refer to 16.2.2.1 Association between Data I/O Pins and SS Shift Register. In this mode, clock polarity, phase, and data settings are performed by bits CPOS and CPHS in the SSMR register. For details, refer to 16.2.1.1 Association between Transfer Clock Polarity, Phase, and Data. When this MCU is set as the master device, the chip select line controls output. When clock synchronous serial I/O with chip select is set as a slave device, the chip select line controls input. When it is set as the master device, the chip select line controls output of the SCS pin or controls output of a general port according to the setting of the CSS1 bit in the SSMR2 register. When the MCU is set as a slave device, the chip select line sets the SCS pin as an input pin by setting bits CSS1 and CSS0 in the SSMR2 register to 01b. In 4-wire bus communication mode, the MLS bit in the SSMR register is set to 0 and communication is performed MSB-first. 16.2.6.1 Initialization in 4-Wire Bus Communication Mode Figure 16.18 shows Initialization in 4-Wire Bus Communication Mode. Before the data transit/receive operation, set the TE bit in the SSER register to 0 (transmit disabled), the RE bit in the SSER register to 0 (receive disabled), and initialize the clock synchronous serial I/O with chip select. To change the communication mode or format, set the TE bit to 0 and the RE bit to 0 before making the change. Setting the RE bit to 0 does not change the settings of flags RDRF and ORER or the contents of the SSRDR register. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 191 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 16. Clock Synchronous Serial Interface Start RE bit ← 0 TE bit ← 0 SSER register SSUMS bit ← 1 SSMR2 register (1) SSMR register Set bits CPHS and CPOS MLS bits ← 0 SSCRH register (2) SSCRH register (2) Set the BIDE bit to 1 in bidirectional mode and set the I/O of the SCS pin by bits CSS0 to CSS1. Set bits CKS0 to CKS2 ORER bit ← 0(1) SSSR register SSCRH register SSER register Set MSS bit SCKS bit ← 1 Set bits SOOS, CSS0 to CSS1, and BIDE SSMR2 register (1) The MLS bit is set to 0 for MSB-first transfer. The clock polarity and phase are set by bits CPHS and CPOS. Set RSSTP bit RE bit ← 1 (receive) TE bit ← 1 (transmit) Set bits RIE, TEIE, and TIE End NOTE: 1. Write 0 after reading 1 to set the ORER bit to 0. Figure 16.18 Initialization in 4-Wire Bus Communication Mode Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 192 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 16.2.6.2 16. Clock Synchronous Serial Interface Data Transmission Figure 16.19 shows an Example of Clock Synchronous Serial I/O with Chip Select Operation during Data Transmission (4-Wire Bus Communication Mode). During the data transmit operation, clock synchronous serial I/O with chip select operates as described below. When the MCU is set as the master device, it outputs a synchronous clock and data. When the MCU is set as a slave device, it outputs data in synchronization with the input clock while the SCS pin is “L”. When the transmit data is written to the SSTDR register after setting the TE bit to 1 (transmit enabled), the TDRE bit is automatically set to 0 (data has not been transferred from registers SSTDR to SSTRSR) and the data is transferred from registers SSTDR to SSTRSR. After the TDRE bit is set to 1 (data is transferred from registers SSTDR to SSTRSR), transmission starts. When the TIE bit in the SSER register is set to 1, a TXI interrupt request is generated. After 1 frame of data is transferred while the TDRE bit is set to 0, the data is transferred from registers SSTDR to SSTRSR and transmission of the next frame is started. If the 8th bit is transmitted while TDRE is set to 1, TEND in the SSSR register is set to 1 (when the last bit of the transmit data is transmitted, the TDRE bit is set to 1) and the state is retained. If the TEIE bit in the SSER register is set to 1 (transmit-end interrupt requests enabled), a TEI interrupt request is generated. The SSCK pin remains “H” after transmit-end and the SCS pin is held “H”. When transmitting continuously while the SCS pin is held “L”, write the next transmit data to the SSTDR register before transmitting the 8th bit. Transmission cannot be performed while the ORER bit in the SSSR register is set to 1 (overrun error). Confirm that the ORER bit is set to 0 before transmission. In contrast to the clock synchronous communication mode, the SSO pin is placed in high-impedance state while the SCS pin is placed in high-impedance state when operating as a master device and the SSI pin is placed in high-impedance state while the SCS pin is placed in “H” input state when operating as a slave device. The sample flowchart is the same as that for the clock synchronous communication mode. (Refer to Figure 16.14 Sample Flowchart of Data Transmission (Clock Synchronous Communication Mode).) Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 193 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 16. Clock Synchronous Serial Interface • CPHS bit = 0 (data change at odd edges) and CPOS bit = 0 (“H” when clock stops) High-impedance SCS (output) SSCK SSO b6 b7 b7 b0 b6 1 frame TDRE bit in SSSR register 1 TEND bit in SSSR register 1 b0 1 frame TEI interrupt request is generated 0 TXI interrupt request is generated TXI interrupt request is generated 0 Data write to SSTDR register Processing by program • CPHS bit = 1 (data change at even edges) and CPOS bit = 0 (“H” when clock stops) High-impedance SCS (output) SSCK b7 SSO b6 1 frame TDRE bit in SSSR register 1 TEND bit in SSSR register 1 b0 b7 b6 b0 1 frame TEI interrupt request is generated 0 TXI interrupt request is generated TXI interrupt request is generated 0 Processing by program Data write to SSTDR register CPHS, CPOS: Bits in SSMR register Figure 16.19 Example of Clock Synchronous Serial I/O with Chip Select Operation during Data Transmission (4-Wire Bus Communication Mode) Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 194 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 16.2.6.3 16. Clock Synchronous Serial Interface Data Reception Figure 16.20 shows an example of clock synchronous serial I/O with chip select operation (4-wire bus communication mode) for data reception. During data reception, clock synchronous serial I/O with chip select operates as described below. When the MCU is set as the master device, it outputs a synchronous clock and inputs data. When the MCU is set as a slave device, it outputs data synchronized with the input clock while the SCS pin receives “L” input. When the MCU is set as the master device, it outputs a receive clock and starts receiving by performing a dummy read of the SSRDR register. After 8 bits of data are received, the RDRF bit in the SSSR register is set to 1 (data in the SSRDR register) and the receive data is stored in the SSRDR register. When the RIE bit in the SSER register is set to 1 (RXI and OEI interrupt request enabled), an RXI interrupt request is generated. When the SSRDR register is read, the RDRF bit is automatically set to 0 (no data in the SSRDR register). Read the receive data after setting the RSSTP bit in the SSCRH register to 1 (after receiving 1-byte data, the receive operation is completed). Clock synchronous serial I/O with chip select outputs a clock for receiving 8 bits of data and stops. After that, set the RE bit in the SSER register to 0 (receive disabled) and the RSSTP bit to 0 (receive operation is continued after receiving 1-byte data) and read the receive data. When the SSRDR register is read while the RE bit is set to 1 (receive enabled), a receive clock is output again. When the 8th clock rises while the RDRF bit is set to 1, the ORER bit in the SSSR register is set to 1 (overrun error: OEI) and the operation is stopped. When the ORER bit is set to 1, reception cannot be performed. Confirm that the ORER bit is set to 0 before restarting reception. The timing with which bits RDRF and ORER are set to 1, varies depending on the setting of the CPHS bit in the SSMR register. Figure 16.20 shows when bits RDRF and ORER are set to 1. When the CPHS bit is set to 1 (data download at the odd edges), bits RDRF and ORER are set to 1 at some point during the frame. The sample flowchart is the same as that for the clock synchronous communication mode. (Refer to Figure 16.16 Sample Flowchart of Data Reception (MSS = 1) (Clock Synchronous Communication Mode).) Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 195 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 16. Clock Synchronous Serial Interface • CPHS bit = 0 (data download at even edges) and CPOS bit = 0 (“H” when clock stops) High-impedance SCS (output) SSCK SSI b0 b7 b7 1 frame RDRF bit in SSSR register 1 RSSTP bit in SSCRH register 1 b7 b0 b0 1 frame 0 RXI interrupt request is generated RXI interrupt request is generated 0 Data read in SSRDR register Dummy read in SSRDR register Processing by program Set RSSTP bit to 1 RXI interrupt request is generated Data read in SSRDR register • CPHS bit = 1 (data download at odd edges) and CPOS bit = 0 (“H” when clock stops) High-impedance SCS (output) SSCK b7 SSI b0 b7 1 frame RDRF bit in SSSR register 1 RSSTP bit in SSCRH register 1 Processing by program b0 b7 b0 1 frame 0 RXI interrupt request is generated RXI interrupt request is generated 0 Dummy read in SSRDR register Data read in SSRDR register Set RSSTP bit to 1 RXI interrupt request is generated Data read in SSRDR register CPHS and CPOS: Bit in SSMR register Figure 16.20 Example of Clock Synchronous Serial I/O with Chip Select Operation during Data Reception (4-Wire Bus Communication Mode) Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 196 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 16.2.7 16. Clock Synchronous Serial Interface SCS Pin Control and Arbitration When setting the SSUMS bit in the SSMR2 register to 1 (4-wire bus communication mode).and the CSS1 bit in the SSMR2 register to 1 (functions as SCS output pin), set the MSS bit in the SSCRH register to 1 (operates as the master device) and check the arbitration of the SCS pin before starting serial transfer. If clock synchronous serial I/O with chip select detects that the synchronized internal SCS signal is held “L” in this period, the CE bit in the SSSR register is set to 1 (conflict error) and the MSS bit is automatically set to 0 (operates as a slave device). Figure 16.21 shows the Arbitration Check Timing. Future transmit operations are not performed while the CE bit is set to 1. Set the CE bit to 0 (no conflict error) before starting transmission . SCS input Internal SCS (synchronization) MSS bit in SSCRH register 1 0 Transfer start Data write to SSTDR register CE High-impedance SCS output Maximum time of SCS internal synchronization During arbitration detection Figure 16.21 Arbitration Check Timing Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 197 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 16.2.8 16. Clock Synchronous Serial Interface Notes on Clock Synchronous Serial I/O with Chip Select Set the IICSEL bit in the PMR register to 0 (select clock synchronous serial I/O with chip select function) to use the clock synchronous serial I/O with chip select function. 16.2.8.1 Accessing Registers Associated with Clock Synchronous Serial I/O with Chip Select After waiting three instructions or more after writing to the registers associated with clock synchronous serial I/ O with chip select (00B8h to 00BFh) or four cycles or more after writing to them, read the registers. • An example of waiting three instructions or more Program example MOV.B NOP NOP NOP MOV.B • An example of waiting four cycles or more Program example BCLR JMP.B NEXT: BSET 16.2.8.2 #00h,00BBh ; Set the SSER register to 00h. 00BBh,R0L 4,00BBh NEXT : Disable transmission 3,00BBh : Enable reception Selecting SSI Signal Pin Set the SOOS bit in the SSMR2 register to 0 (CMOS output) in the following settings: • SSUMS bit in SSMR2 register = 1 (4-wire bus communication mode) • BIDE bit in SSMR2 register = 0 (standard mode) • MSS bit in SSCRH register = 0 (operate as slave device) • SSISEL bit in PMR register = 1 (use P1_6 pin for SSI01 pin) Do not use the SSI01 pin with NMOS open drain output for the above settings. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 198 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 16.3 16. Clock Synchronous Serial Interface I2C bus Interface The I2C bus interface is the circuit that performs serial communication based on the data transfer format of the Philips I2C bus. Table 16.5 lists the I2C bus interface Specifications, Figure 16.22 shows a Block Diagram of I2C bus interface, and Figure 16.23 shows the External Circuit Connection Example of Pins SCL and SDA. Figures 16.24 to 16.31 show the registers associated with the I2C bus interface. * I2C bus is a trademark of Koninklijke Philips Electronics N. V. Table 16.5 I2C bus interface Specifications Item Specification 2 Communication formats • I C bus format - Selectable as master/slave device - Continuous transmit/receive operation (Because the shift register, transmit data register, and receive data register are independent.) - Start/stop conditions are automatically generated in master mode. - Automatic loading of acknowledge bit during transmission - Bit synchronization/wait function (In master mode, the state of the SCL signal is monitored per bit and the timing is synchronized automatically. If the transfer is not possible yet, the SCL signal goes “L” and the interface stands by.) - Support for direct drive of pins SCL and SDA (NMOS open drain output) • Clock synchronous serial format - Continuous transmit/receive operation (Because the shift register, transmit data register, and receive data register are independent.) I/O pins SCL (I/O): Serial clock I/O pin SDA (I/O): Serial data I/O pin Transfer clock • When the MST bit in the ICCR1 register is set to 0. The external clock (input from the SCL pin) • When the MST bit in the ICCR1 register is set to 1. The internal clock selected by bits CKS0 to CKS3 in the ICCR1 register (output from the SCL pin) Receive error detection • Overrun error detection (clock synchronous serial format) Indicates an overrun error during reception. When the last bit of the next data item is received while the RDRF bit in the ICSR register is set to 1 (data in the ICDRR register), the AL bit is set to 1. Interrupt sources • I2C bus format .................................. 6 sources(1) Transmit data empty (including when slave address matches), transmit ends, receive data full (including when slave address matches), arbitration lost, NACK detection, and stop condition detection. • Clock synchronous serial format ...... 4 sources(1) Transmit data empty, transmit ends, receive data full and overrun error Select functions • I2C bus format - Selectable output level for acknowledge signal during reception • Clock synchronous serial format - MSB-first or LSB-first selectable as data transfer direction NOTE: 1. All sources use one interrupt vector for I2C bus interface. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 199 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 16. Clock Synchronous Serial Interface f1 Transfer clock generation circuit SCL Output control ICCR1 register Transmit/receive control circuit Noise canceller ICCR2 register ICMR register ICDRT register SAR register Output control ICDRS register Noise canceller Address comparison circuit Data bus SDA ICDRR register Bus state judgment circuit Arbitration judgment circuit ICSR register ICIER register Interrupt generation circuit Interrupt request (TXI, TEI, RXI, STPI, NAKI) Figure 16.22 Block Diagram of I2C bus interface Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 200 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 16. Clock Synchronous Serial Interface VCC VCC SCL SCL SDA SDA SCL input SCL output SDA input SDA output SCL (Master) SCL SCL input SCL input SCL output SCL output SDA SDA input SDA output SDA output (Slave1) Figure 16.23 SDA SDA input (Slave2) External Circuit Connection Example of Pins SCL and SDA Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 201 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 16. Clock Synchronous Serial Interface IIC bus Control Register 1(6) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol ICCR1 Bit Symbol CKS0 CKS1 CKS2 CKS3 Address 00B8h Bit Name Transmit clock select bits 3 to b3 b2 b1 b0 0 0 0 0 : f1/28 0(1) 0 0 0 1 : f1/40 0 0 1 0 : f1/48 0 0 1 1 : f1/64 0 1 0 0 : f1/80 0 1 0 1 : f1/100 0 1 1 0 : f1/112 0 1 1 1 : f1/128 1 0 0 0 : f1/56 1 0 0 1 : f1/80 1 0 1 0 : f1/96 1 0 1 1 : f1/128 1 1 0 0 : f1/160 1 1 0 1 : f1/200 1 1 1 0 : f1/224 1 1 1 1 : f1/256 Transfer/receive select bit(2, 3) TRS Master/slave select bit(5) MST Receive disable bit RCVD IIC bus interface enable bit ICE After Reset 00h Function RW RW RW RW RW b5 b4 0 0 : Slave receive mode(4) 0 1 : Slave transmit mode 1 0 : Master receive mode 1 1 : Master transmit mode After reading the ICDRR register w hile the TRS bit is set to 0. 0 : Maintains the next receive operation. 1 : Disables the next receive operation. 0 : This module is halted. (Pins SCL and SDA are set to port function.) 1 : This module is enabled for transfer operations. (Pins SCL and SDA are bus drive state.) RW RW RW RW NOTES : 1. Set according to the necessary transfer rate in master mode. Refer to Table 16.6 Transfer Rate Exam ples for the transfer rate. This bit is used for maintaining of the setup time in transmit mode of slave mode. The time is 10Tcyc w hen the CKS3 bit is set to 0 and 20Tcyc w hen the CKS3 bit is set to 1. (1Tcyc = 1/f1(s)) 2. Rew rite the TRS bit betw een transfer frames. 3. When the first 7 bits after the start condition in slave receive mode match w ith the slave address set in the SAR register and the 8th bit is set to 1, the TRS bit is set to 1. 4. In master mode w ith the I2C bus format, w hen arbitration is lost, bits MST and TRS are set to 0 and the IIC enters slave receive mode. 5. When an overrun error occurs in master receive mode of the clock synchronous serial format, the MST bit is set to 0 and the IIC enters slave receive mode. 6. Refer to 16.3.8.1 Accessing of Registers Associated w ith I2C bus Interface for more information. Figure 16.24 ICCR1 Register Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 202 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 16. Clock Synchronous Serial Interface IIC bus Control Register 2(5) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol Address 00B9h ICCR2 Bit Symbol Bit Name — Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0. (b0) When read, the content is 1. IIC control part reset bit IICRST — (b2) SCLO SDAOP SDAO SCP After Reset 01111101b Function When hang-up occurs due to communication failure during I2C bus interface operation, w rite 1, to reset the control block of the I2C bus interface w ithout setting ports or initializing registers. Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0. When read, the content is 1. RW — 0 : SCL pin is set to “L”. 1 : SCL pin is set to “H”. RO SDAO w rite protect bit When rew rite to SDAO bit, w rite 0 simultaneously (1). When read, the content is 1. RW SDA output value control When read bit 0 : SDA pin output is held “L”. 1 : SDA pin output is held “H”. When w ritten(1,2) 0 : SDA pin output is changed to “L”. 1 : SDA pin output is changed to high-impedance (“H” output via external pull-up resistor). RW Start/stop condition generation disable bit When w riting to the BBSY bit, w rite 0 simultaneously (3). When read, the content is 1. Writing 1 is invalid. RW Bus busy bit(4) When read 0 : Bus is in released state (SDA signal changes from “L” to “H” w hile SCL signal is in “H” state). 1 : Bus is in occupied state (SDA signal changes from “H” to “L” w hile SCL signal is in “H” state). When w ritten(3) 0 : Generates stop condition. 1 : Generates start condition. RW NOTES : 1. When w riting to the SDAO bit, w rite 0 to the SDAOP bit using the MOV instruction simultaneously. 2. Do not w rite during a transfer operation. 3. This bit is enabled in master mode. When w riting to the BBSY bit, w rite 0 to the SCP bit using the MOV instruction simultaneously. Execute the same w ay w hen the start condition is regenerating. 4. This bit is disabled w hen the clock synchronous serial format is used. 5. Refer to 16.3.8.1 Accessing of Registers Associated w ith I2C bus Interface for more information. ICCR2 Register Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 — SCL monitor flag BBSY Figure 16.25 RW Page 203 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 16. Clock Synchronous Serial Interface IIC bus Mode Register(7) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 Symbol ICMR Bit Symbol Address 00BAh Bit Name Bit counter 2 to 0 After Reset 00011000b Function I2C bus format (remaining transfer bit count w hen read out and data bit count of next transfer w hen w ritten.) (1,2) RW b2 b1 b0 0 0 0 : 9 bits (3) 0 0 1 : 2 bits 0 1 0 : 3 bits 0 1 1 : 4 bits 1 0 0 : 5 bits 1 0 1 : 6 bits 1 1 0 : 7 bits 1 1 1 : 8 bits Clock synchronous serial format (w hen read, the remaining transfer bit count and w hen w ritten, 000b.) BC0 BC1 RW RW b2 b1 b0 0 0 0 : 8 bits 0 0 1 : 1 bit 0 1 0 : 2 bits 0 1 1 : 3 bits 1 0 0 : 4 bits 1 0 1 : 5 bits 1 1 0 : 6 bits 1 1 1 : 7 bits BC2 BC w rite protect bit BCWP When rew riting bits BC0 to BC2, w rite 0 simultaneously (2,4). When read, the content is 1. Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0. When read, the content is 1. — (b5) Reserved bit Set to 0. Wait insertion bit(5) 0 : No w ait (Transfer data and acknow ledge bit consecutively) 1 : Wait (After the clock falls for the final data bit, “L” period is extended for tw o transfer clocks cycles.) RW 0 : Data transfer MSB-first(6) 1 : Data transfer LSB-first RW MLS MSB-first / LSB-first select bit NOTES : 1. Rew rite betw een transfer frames. When w riting values other than 000b, w rite w hen the SCL signal is “L”. 2. When w riting to bits BC0 to BC2, w rite 0 to the BCWP bit using the MOV instruction. 3. After data including the acknow ledge bit is transferred, these bits are automatically set to 000b. When the start condition is detected, these bits are automatically set to 000b. 4. Do not rew rite w hen the clock synchronous serial format is used. 5. The setting value is enabled in master mode of the I2C bus format. It is disabled in slave mode of the I2C bus format or w hen the clock synchronous serial format is used. 6. Set to 0 w hen the I2C bus format is used. 7. Refer to 16.3.8.1 Accessing of Registers Associated w ith I2C bus Interface for more information. ICMR Register Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 RW — (b4) WAIT Figure 16.26 RW Page 204 of 315 — RW R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 16. Clock Synchronous Serial Interface IIC bus Interrupt Enable Register(3) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol ICIER Bit Symbol ACKBT Address 00BBh Bit Name Transmit acknow ledge select bit After Reset 00h Function 0 : 0 is transmitted as acknow ledge bit in receive mode. 1 : 1 is transmitted as acknow ledge bit in receive mode. Receive acknow ledge bit 0 : Acknow ledge bit received from receive device in transmit mode is set to 0. 1 : Acknow ledge bit received from receive device in transmit mode is set to 1. ACKBR ACKE Acknow ledge bit judgment 0 : Value of receive acknow ledge bit is ignored select bit and continuous transfer is performed. 1 : When receive acknow ledge bit is set to 1, continuous transfer is halted. RW RW RO RW Stop condition detection interrupt enable bit 0 : Disables stop condition detection interrupt request. 1 : Enables stop condition detection interrupt request.(2) RW NACK receive interrupt enable bit 0 : Disables NACK receive interrupt request and arbitration lost / overrun error interrupt request. 1 : Enables NACK receive interrupt request and arbitration lost / overrun error interrupt request.(1) RW Receive interrupt enable bit 0 : Disables receive data full and overrun error interrupt request. 1 : Enables receive data full and overrun error interrupt request.(1) RW TEIE Transmit end interrupt enable bit 0 : Disables transmit end interrupt request. 1 : Enables transmit end interrupt request. RW TIE Transmit interrupt enable bit 0 : Disables transmit data empty interrupt request. 1 : Enables transmit data empty interrupt request. RW STIE NAKIE RIE NOTES : 1. An overrun error interrupt request is generated w hen the clock synchronous format is used. 2. Set the STIE bit to 1 (enable stop condition detection interrupt request) w hen the STOP bit in the ICSR register is set to 0. 3. Refer to 16.3.8.1 Accessing of Registers Associated w ith I2C bus Interface for more information. Figure 16.27 ICIER Register Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 205 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 16. Clock Synchronous Serial Interface IIC bus Status Register(7) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol ICSR Bit Symbol ADZ AAS Address 00BCh Bit Name General call address recognition flag(1,2) Slave address recognition This flag is set to 1 w hen the first frame follow ing start condition matches bits SVA0 to SVA6 in the flag(1) SAR register in slave receive mode. (Detect the slave address and generate call address.) Arbitration lost flag / overrun error flag(1) AL STOP NACKF RDRF After Reset 0000X000b Function When the general call address is detected , this flag is set to 1. Stop condition detection flag(1) RW RW RW When the I2C bus format is used, this flag indicates that arbitration has been lost in master mode. In the follow ing cases, this flag is set to 1(3). • When the internal SDA signal and SDA pin level do not match at the rise of the SCL signal in master transmit mode. • When the start condition is detected and the SDA pin is held “H” in master transmit/receive mode. This flag indicates an overrun error w hen the clock synchronous format is used. In the follow ing case, this flag is set to 1. • When the last bit of the next data item is received w hile the RDRF bit is set to 1. RW When the stop condition is detected after the frame is transferred, this flag is set to 1. RW No acknow ledge detection When no ACKnow ledge is detected from receive flag(1,4) device after transmission, this flag is set to 1. RW Receive data register full(1,5) When receive data is transferred from registers ICDRS to ICDRR, this flag is set to 1. RW Transmit end(1,6) When the 9th clock cycle of the SCL signal in the I2C bus format occurs w hile the TDRE bit is set to 1, this flag is set to 1. This flag is set to 1 w hen the final bit of the transmit frame is transmitted in the clock synchronous format. TEND Transmit data empty (1,6) TDRE In the follow ing cases, this flag is set to 1. • Data is transferred from registers ICDRT to ICDRS and the ICDRT register is empty. • When setting the TRS bit in the ICCR1 register to 1 (transmit mode). • When generating the start condition (including retransmit). • When changing from slave receive mode to slave transmit mode. RW RW NOTES : 1. 2. Each bit is set to 0 by reading 1 bef ore writing 0. This f lag is enabled in slav e receiv e mode of the I 2C bus f ormat. 3. When two or more master dev ices attempt to occupy the bus at nearly the same time, if the I2C bus Interf ace monitors the SDA pin and the data which the I2C bus Interf ace transmits is dif f erent, the AL f lag is set to 1 and the bus is occupied by another master. 4. The NACKF bit is enabled when the ACKE bit in the ICIER register is set to 1 (when the receiv e acknowledge bit is set to 1, transf er is halted). 5. 6. 7. The RDRF bit is set to 0 when reading data f rom the ICDRR register. Bits TEND and TDRE are set to 0 when writing data to the ICDRT register. Ref er to 16.3.8.1 Accessing of Registers Associated with I 2C bus Interface f or more inf ormation. Figure 16.28 ICSR Register Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 206 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 16. Clock Synchronous Serial Interface Slave Address Register(1) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol SAR Bit Symbol FS SVA0 Address 00BDh Bit Name Format select bit Slave address 6 to 0 SVA1 SVA2 SVA3 SVA4 SVA5 SVA6 Af ter Reset 00h Function 0 : I2C bus format 1 : Clock synchronous serial f ormat Set an address dif f erent f rom that of the other slave devices w hich are connected to the I2C bus. When the 7 high-order bits of the f irst f rame transmitted af ter the starting condition match bits SVA0 to SVA6 in slave mode of the I2C bus f ormat, the MCU operates as a slave device. RW RW RW RW RW RW RW RW RW NOTE : 1. Ref er to 16.3.8.1 Acce s s ing of Re gis te rs As s ociate d w ith I2C bus Inte rface f or more inf ormation. IIC bus Transmit Data Register(1) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol ICDRT Address 00BEh After Reset FFh Function Store transmit data When it is detected that the ICDRS register is empty, the stored transmit data item is transferred to the ICDRS register and data transmission starts. When the next transmit data item is w ritten to the ICDRT register during transmission of the data in the ICDRS register, continuous transmit is enabled. When the MLS bit in the ICMR register is set to 1 (data transferred LSB-first) and after the data is w ritten to the ICDRT register, the MSB-LSB inverted data is read. NOTE : 1. Refer to 16.3.8.1 Accessing of Registers Associated w ith I2C bus Interface for more information. Figure 16.29 Registers SAR and ICDRT Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 207 of 315 RW RW R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 16. Clock Synchronous Serial Interface IIC bus Receive Data Register(1) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol ICDRR Address 00BFh After Reset FFh Function Store receive data When the ICDRS register receives 1 byte of data, the receive data is transferred to the ICDRR register and the next receive operation is enabled. RW RO NOTE : 1. Refer to 16.3.8.1 Accessing of Registers Associated w ith I2C bus Interface for more information. IIC bus Shift Register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol ICDRS Function This register is used to transmit and receive data. The transmit data is transferred from registers ICRDT to ICDRS and data is transmitted from the SDA pin w hen transmitting. After 1 byte of data is received, data is transferred from registers ICDRS to ICDRR w hile receiving. Figure 16.30 RW — Registers ICDRR and ICDRS Port Mode Register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Symbol Address 00F8h PMR Bit Symbol Bit Name Reserved bits — (b2-b0) SSISEL — (b6-b4) IICSEL Figure 16.31 Set to 0. SSI signal pin select bit 0 : P3_3 pin is used for SSI00 pin. 1 : P1_6 pin is used for SSI01 pin. Reserved bits Set to 0. SSU / I2C bus sw itch bit 0 : Selects SSU function. 1 : Selects I2C bus function. PMR Register Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 After Reset 00h Function Page 208 of 315 RW RW RW RW RW R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 16.3.1 16. Clock Synchronous Serial Interface Transfer Clock When the MST bit in the ICCR1 register is set to 0, the transfer clock is the external clock input from the SCL pin. When the MST bit in the ICCR1 register is set to 1, the transfer clock is the internal clock selected by bits CKS0 to CKS3 in the ICCR1 register and the transfer clock is output from the SCL pin. Table 16.6 lists the Transfer Rate Examples. Table 16.6 Transfer Rate Examples ICCR1 Register Transfer Transfer Rate CKS3 CKS2 CKS1 CKS0 Clock f1 = 5 MHz f1 = 8 MHz f1 = 10 MHz f1 = 16 MHz f1 = 20 MHz 0 0 0 0 f1/28 179 kHz 286 kHz 357 kHz 571 kHz 714 kHz 1 f1/40 125 kHz 200 kHz 250 kHz 400 kHz 500 kHz 1 0 f1/48 104 kHz 167 kHz 208 kHz 333 kHz 417 kHz 1 f1/64 78.1 kHz 125 kHz 156 kHz 250 kHz 313 kHz 1 0 0 f1/80 62.5 kHz 100 kHz 125 kHz 200 kHz 250 kHz 1 f1/100 50.0 kHz 80.0 kHz 100 kHz 160 kHz 200 kHz 1 0 f1/112 44.6 kHz 71.4 kHz 89.3 kHz 143 kHz 179 kHz 1 f1/128 39.1 kHz 62.5 kHz 78.1 kHz 125 kHz 156 kHz 1 0 0 0 f1/56 89.3 kHz 143 kHz 179 kHz 286 kHz 357 kHz 1 f1/80 62.5 kHz 100 kHz 125 kHz 200 kHz 250 kHz 1 0 f1/96 52.1 kHz 83.3 kHz 104 kHz 167 kHz 208 kHz 1 f1/128 39.1 kHz 62.5 kHz 78.1 kHz 125 kHz 156 kHz 1 0 0 f1/160 31.3 kHz 50.0 kHz 62.5 kHz 100 kHz 125 kHz 1 f1/200 25.0 kHz 40.0 kHz 50.0 kHz 80.0 kHz 100 kHz 1 0 f1/224 22.3 kHz 35.7 kHz 44.6 kHz 71.4 kHz 89.3 kHz 1 f1/256 19.5 kHz 31.3 kHz 39.1 kHz 62.5 kHz 78.1 kHz Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 209 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 16.3.2 16. Clock Synchronous Serial Interface Interrupt Requests I2C The bus interface has six interrupt requests when the I2C bus format is used and four when the clock synchronous serial format is used. Table 16.7 lists the Interrupt Requests of I2C bus Interface. Since these interrupt requests are allocated at the I2C bus interface interrupt vector table, determining the factor by each bit is necessary. Table 16.7 Interrupt Requests of I2C bus Interface Interrupt Request Generation Condition Format I2C bus Transmit data empty Transmit ends Receive data full Stop condition detection NACK detection Arbitration lost/overrun error TXI TEI RXI STPI NAKI TIE = 1 and TDRE = 1 TEIE = 1 and TEND = 1 RIE = 1 and RDRF = 1 STIE = 1 and STOP = 1 NAKIE = 1 and AL = 1 (or NAKIE = 1 and NACKF = 1) Enabled Enabled Enabled Enabled Enabled Enabled Clock Synchronous Serial Enabled Enabled Enabled Disabled Disabled Enabled STIE, NAKIE, RIE, TEIE, TIE: Bits in ICIER register AL, STOP, NACKF, RDRF, TEND, TDRE: Bits in ICSR register When the generation conditions listed in Table 16.7 are met, an I2C bus interface interrupt request is generated. Set the interrupt generation conditions to 0 by the I2C bus interface interrupt routine. However, bits TDRE and TEND are automatically set to 0 by writing transmit data to the ICDRT register and the RDRF bit is automatically set to 0 by reading the ICDRR register. When writing transmit data to the ICDRT register, the TDRE bit is set to 0. When data is transferred from registers ICDRT to ICDRS, the TDRE bit is set to 1 and by further setting the TDRE bit to 0, 1 additional byte may be transmitted. Set the STIE bit to 1 (enable stop condition detection interrupt request) when the STOP bit is set to 0. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 210 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 16. Clock Synchronous Serial Interface I2C bus Interface Mode 16.3.3 I2C bus Format 16.3.3.1 Setting the FS bit in the SAR register to 0 communicates in I2C bus format. Figure 16.32 shows the I2C bus Format and Bus Timing. The 1st frame following the start condition consists of 8 bits. (1) I2C bus format (a) I2C bus format (FS = 0) S SLA R/W A DATA A A/A P 1 7 1 1 n 1 1 1 Transfer bit count (n = 1 to 8) 1 m Transfer frame count (m = from 1) (b) I2C bus format (when start condition is retransmitted, FS = 0) S SLA R/W A DATA A/A S SLA R/W A DATA A/A P 1 7 1 1 n1 1 1 7 1 1 n2 1 1 1 1 m1 m2 Upper: Transfer bit count (n1, n2 = 1 to 8) Lower: Transfer frame count (m1, m2 = 1 or more) (2) I2C bus timing SDA SCL 1 to 7 S SLA 8 R/W 9 1 to 7 A 8 DATA 9 1 to 7 A 8 DATA 9 A Explanation of symbols S : Start condition The master device changes the SDA signal from “H” to “L” while the SCL signal is held “H”. SLA : Slave address R/W : Indicates the direction of data transmit/receive Data is transmitted from the slave device to the master device when R/W value is 1 and from the master device to the slave device when R/W value is 0. A : Acknowledge The receive device sets the SDA signal to “L”. DATA : Transmit / receive data P : Stop condition The master device changes the SDA signal from “L” to “H” while the SCL signal is held “H”. Figure 16.32 I2C bus Format and Bus Timing Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 211 of 315 P R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 16.3.3.2 16. Clock Synchronous Serial Interface Master Transmit Operation In master transmit mode, the master device outputs the transmit clock and data, and the slave device returns an acknowledge signal. Figures 16.33 and 16.34 show the Operating Timing in Master Transmit Mode (I2C bus Interface Mode). The transmit procedure and operation in master transmit mode are as follows. (1) Set the STOP bit in the ICSR register to 0 to reset it. Then set the ICE bit in the ICCR1 register to 1 (transfer operation enabled). Then set bits WAIT and MLS in the ICMR register and set bits CKS0 to CKS3 in the ICCR1 register (initial setting). (2) Read the BBSY bit in the ICCR2 register to confirm that the bus is free. Set bits TRS and MST in the ICCR1 register to master transmit mode. The start condition is generated by writing 1 to the BBSY bit and 0 to the SCP bit by the MOV instruction. (3) After confirming that the TDRE bit in the ICSR register is set to 1 (data is transferred from registers ICDRT to ICDRS), write transmit data to the ICDRT register (data in which a slave address and R/W are indicated in the 1st byte). At this time, the TDRE bit is automatically set to 0, data is transferred from registers ICDRT to ICDRS, and the TDRE bit is set to 1 again. (4) When transmission of 1 byte of data is completed while the TDRE bit is set to 1, the TEND bit in the ICSR register is set to 1 at the rise of the 9th transmit clock pulse. Read the ACKBR bit in the ICIER register, and confirm that the slave is selected. Write the 2nd byte of data to the ICDRT register. Since the slave device is not acknowledged when the ACKBR bit is set to 1, generate the stop condition. The stop condition is generated by the writing 0 to the BBSY bit and 0 to the SCP bit by the MOV instruction. The SCL signal is held “L” until data is available and the stop condition is generated. (5) Write the transmit data after the 2nd byte to the ICDRT register every time the TDRE bit is set to 1. (6) When writing the number of bytes to be transmitted to the ICDRT register, wait until the TEND bit is set to 1 while the TDRE bit is set to 1. Or wait for NACK (the NACKF bit in the ICSR register is set to 1) from the receive device while the ACKE bit in the ICIER register is set to 1 (when the receive acknowledge bit is set to 1, transfer is halted). Then generate the stop condition before setting bits TEND and NACKF to 0. (7) When the STOP bit in the ICSR register is set to 1, return to slave receive mode. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 212 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 16. Clock Synchronous Serial Interface SCL (master output) 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 SDA (master output) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Slave address 9 2 b7 b6 R/W SDA (slave output) TDRE bit in ICSR register 1 A 1 0 TEND bit in ICSR register 1 0 ICDRT register Address + R/W ICDRS register (2) Instruction of start condition generation Processing by program Figure 16.33 Data 1 Address + R/W (3) Data write to ICDRT register (1st byte) Data 2 Data 1 (5) Data write to ICDRT register (3rd byte) (4) Data write to ICDRT register (2nd byte) Operating Timing in Master Transmit Mode (I2C bus Interface Mode) (1) SCL (master output) 9 SDA (master output) SDA (slave output) TDRE bit in ICSR register 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 A 9 A/A 1 0 TEND bit in ICSR register 1 0 ICDRT register Data n ICDRS register Processing by program Figure 16.34 Data n (3) Data write to ICDRT register (6) Generate stop condition and set TEND bit to 0 (7) Set to slave receive mode Operating Timing in Master Transmit Mode (I2C bus Interface Mode) (2) Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 213 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 16.3.3.3 16. Clock Synchronous Serial Interface Master Receive Operation In master receive mode, the master device outputs the receive clock, receives data from the slave device, and returns an acknowledge signal. Figures 16.35 and 16.36 show the Operating Timing in Master Receive Mode (I2C bus Interface Mode). The receive procedure and operation in master receive mode are shown below. (1) After setting the TEND bit in the ICSR register to 0, switch from master transmit mode to master receive mode by setting the TRS bit in the ICCR1 register to 0. Also, set the TDRE bit in the ICSR register to 0. (2) When performing the dummy read of the ICDRR register and starting the receive operation, the receive clock is output in synchronization with the internal clock and data is received. The master device outputs the level set by the ACKBT bit in the ICIER register to the SDA pin at the 9th clock cycle of the receive clock. (3) The 1-frame data receive is completed and the RDRF bit in the ICSR register is set to 1 at the rise of the 9th clock cycle. At this time, when reading the ICDRR register, the received data can be read and the RDRF bit is set to 0 simultaneously. (4) Continuous receive operation is enabled by reading the ICDRR register every time the RDRF bit is set to 1. If the 8th clock cycle falls after the ICDRR register is read by another process while the RDRF bit is set to 1, the SCL signal is fixed “L” until the ICDRR register is read. (5) If the next frame is the last receive frame and the RCVD bit in the ICCR1 register is set to 1 (disables the next receive operation) before reading the ICDRR register, stop condition generation is enabled after the next receive operation. (6) When the RDRF bit is set to 1 at the rise of the 9th clock cycle of the receive clock, generate the stop condition. (7) When the STOP bit in the ICSR register is set to 1, read the ICDRR register and set the RCVD bit to 0 (maintain the following receive operation). (8) Return to slave receive mode. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 214 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 16. Clock Synchronous Serial Interface Master transmit mode SCL (master output) Master receive mode 9 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 SDA (master output) A SDA (slave output) TDRE bit in ICSR register 1 9 A b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 b7 1 0 TEND bit in ICSR register 1 0 TRS bit in ICCR1 register RDRF bit in ICSR register 1 0 1 0 ICDRS register Data 1 ICDRR register Processing by program Figure 16.35 Data 1 (1) Set TEND and TRS bits to 0 before setting TDRE bits to 0 (2) Read ICDRR register (3) Read ICDRR register Operating Timing in Master Receive Mode (I2C bus Interface Mode) (1) Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 215 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group SCL (master output) 9 SDA (master output) A SDA (slave output) RDRF bit in ICSR register RCVD bit in ICCR1 register 16. Clock Synchronous Serial Interface 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A/A b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 1 0 1 0 ICDRS register Data n-1 ICDRR register Processing by program Data n Data n-1 (5) Set RCVD bit to 1 before reading ICDRR register Data n (6) Stop condition generation (7) Read ICDRR register before setting RCVD bit to 0 (8) Set to slave receive mode Figure 16.36 Operating Timing in Master Receive Mode (I2C bus Interface Mode) (2) Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 216 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 16.3.3.4 16. Clock Synchronous Serial Interface Slave Transmit Operation In slave transmit mode, the slave device outputs the transmit data while the master device outputs the receive clock and returns an acknowledge signal. Figures 16.37 and 16.38 show the Operating Timing in Slave Transmit Mode (I2C bus Interface Mode). The transmit procedure and operation in slave transmit mode are as follows. (1) Set the ICE bit in the ICCR1 register to 1 (transfer operation enabled). Set bits WAIT and MLS in the ICMR register and bits CKS0 to CKS3 in the ICCR1 register (initial setting). Set bits TRS and MST in the ICCR1 register to 0 and wait until the slave address matches in slave receive mode. (2) When the slave address matches at the 1st frame after detecting the start condition, the slave device outputs the level set by the ACKBT bit in the ICIER register to the SDA pin at the rise of the 9th clock cycle. At this time, if the 8th bit of data (R/W) is 1, bits TRS and TDRE in the ICSR register are set to 1, and the mode is switched to slave transmit mode automatically. Continuous transmission is enabled by writing transmit data to the ICDRT register every time the TDRE bit is set to 1. (3) When the TDRE bit in the ICDRT register is set to 1 after writing the last transmit data to the ICDRT register, wait until the TEND bit in the ICSR register is set to 1 while the TDRE bit is set to 1. When the TEND bit is set to 1, set the TEND bit to 0. (4) The SCL signal is released by setting the TRS bit to 0 and performing a dummy read of the ICDRR register to end the process. (5) Set the TDRE bit to 0. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 217 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 16. Clock Synchronous Serial Interface Slave receive mode SCL (master output) Slave transmit mode 9 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 SDA (master output) 1 9 A SCL (slave output) SDA (slave output) TDRE bit in ICSR register A b6 b7 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b7 b0 1 0 TEND bit in ICSR register 1 0 TRS bit in ICCR1 register 1 0 ICDRT register Data 1 ICDRS register Data 3 Data 2 Data 1 Data 2 ICDRR register Processing by program Figure 16.37 (1) Data write to ICDRT register (data 1) (2) Data write to ICDRT register (data 2) (2) Data write to ICDRT register (data 3) Operating Timing in Slave Transmit Mode (I2C bus Interface Mode) (1) Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 218 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 16. Clock Synchronous Serial Interface Slave receive mode Slave transmit mode SCL (master output) 9 SDA (master output) A 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A SCL (slave output) SDA (slave output) TDRE bit in ICSR register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 1 0 TEND bit in ICSR register 1 0 TRS bit in ICCR1 register 1 0 ICDRT register Data n ICDRS register Data n ICDRR register Processing by program Figure 16.38 (3) Set TEND bit to 0 (4) Dummy-read of ICDRR register after setting TRS bit to 0 (5) Set TDRE bit to 0 Operating Timing in Slave Transmit Mode (I2C bus Interface Mode) (2) Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 219 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 16.3.3.5 16. Clock Synchronous Serial Interface Slave Receive Operation In slave receive mode, the master device outputs the transmit clock and data, and the slave device returns an acknowledge signal. Figures 16.39 and 16.40 show the Operating Timing in Slave Receive Mode (I2C bus Interface Mode). The receive procedure and operation in slave receive mode are as follows. (1) Set the ICE bit in the ICCR1 register to 1 (transfer operation enabled). Set bits WAIT and MLS in the ICMR register and bits CKS0 to CKS3 in the ICCR1 register (initial setting). Set bits TRS and MST in the ICCR1 register to 0 and wait until the slave address matches in slave receive mode. (2) When the slave address matches at the 1st frame after detecting the start condition, the slave device outputs the level set in the ACKBT bit in the ICIER register to the SDA pin at the rise of the 9th clock cycle. Since the RDRF bit in the ICSR register is set to 1 simultaneously, perform the dummy-read (the read data is unnecessary because if indicates the slave address and R/W). (3) Read the ICDRR register every time the RDRF bit is set to 1. If the 8th clock cycle falls while the RDRF bit is set to 1, the SCL signal is fixed “L” until the ICDRR register is read. The setting change of the acknowledge signal returned to the master device before reading the ICDRR register takes affect from the following transfer frame. (4) Reading the last byte is performed by reading the ICDRR register in like manner. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 220 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group SCL (master output) 16. Clock Synchronous Serial Interface 9 1 SDA (master output) 2 3 b6 b7 4 5 b4 b5 6 7 b2 b3 8 9 b7 b0 b1 1 SCL (slave output) SDA (slave output) RDRF bit in ICSR register A A 1 0 ICDRS register Data 2 Data 1 ICDRR register Processing by program Figure 16.39 Data 1 (2) Read ICDRR register (2) Dummy read of ICDRR register Operating Timing in Slave Receive Mode (I2C bus Interface Mode) (1) SCL (master output) 9 SDA (master output) 1 b7 3 2 b6 b5 4 5 b4 b3 6 b2 7 b1 8 9 b0 SCL (slave output) SDA (slave output) RDRF bit in ICSR register A A 1 0 ICDRS register Data 2 Data 1 ICDRR register Processing by program Figure 16.40 Data 1 (3) Set ACKBT bit to 1 (3) Read ICDRR register (4) Read ICDRR register Operating Timing in Slave Receive Mode (I2C bus Interface Mode) (2) Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 221 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 16.3.4 16. Clock Synchronous Serial Interface Clock Synchronous Serial Mode 16.3.4.1 Clock Synchronous Serial Format Set the FS bit in the SAR register to 1 to use the clock synchronous serial format for communication. Figure 16.41 shows the Transfer Format of Clock Synchronous Serial Format. When the MST bit in the ICCR1 register is set to 1, the transfer clock is output from the SCL pin, and when the MST bit is set to 0, the external clock is input. The transfer data is output between successive falling edges of the SCL clock, and data is determined at the rising edge of the SCL clock. MSB-first or LSB-first can be selected as the order of the data transfer by setting the MLS bit in the ICMR register. The SDA output level can be changed by the SDAO bit in the ICCR2 register during transfer standby. SCL SDA Figure 16.41 b0 b1 b2 b3 b4 b5 Transfer Format of Clock Synchronous Serial Format Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 222 of 315 b6 b7 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 16.3.4.2 16. Clock Synchronous Serial Interface Transmit Operation In transmit mode, transmit data is output from the SDA pin in synchronization with the falling edge of the transfer clock. The transfer clock is output when the MST bit in the ICCR1 register is set to 1 and input when the MST bit is set to 0. Figure 16.42 shows the Operating Timing in Transmit Mode (Clock Synchronous Serial Mode). The transmit procedure and operation in transmit mode are as follows. (1) Set the ICE bit in the ICCR1 register to 1 (transfer operation enabled). Set bits CKS0 to CKS3 in the ICCR1 register and set the MST bit (initial setting). (2) The TDRE bit in the ICSR register is set to 1 by selecting transmit mode after setting the TRS bit in the ICCR1 register to 1. (3) Data is transferred from registers ICDRT to ICDRS and the TDRE bit is automatically set to 1 by writing transmit data to the ICDRT register after confirming that the TDRE bit is set to 1. Continuous transmission is enabled by writing data to the ICDRT register every time the TDRE bit is set to 1. When switching from transmit to receive mode, set the TRS bit to 0 while the TDRE bit is set to 1. SCL 1 SDA (output) TRS bit in ICCR1 register TDRE bit in ICSR register b0 2 b1 7 b6 8 b7 1 b0 7 b6 8 1 b7 b0 1 0 1 0 ICDRT register ICDRS register Data 1 (3) Data write to ICDRT register Processing by program Data 2 Data 1 Data 3 Data 3 Data 2 (3) Data write to ICDRT register (3) Data write to ICDRT register (3) Data write to ICDRT register (2) Set TRS bit to 1 Figure 16.42 Operating Timing in Transmit Mode (Clock Synchronous Serial Mode) Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 223 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 16.3.4.3 16. Clock Synchronous Serial Interface Receive Operation In receive mode, data is latched at the rising edge of the transfer clock. The transfer clock is output when the MST bit in the ICCR1 register is set to 1 and input when the MST bit is set to 0. Figure 16.43 shows the Operating Timing in Receive Mode (Clock Synchronous Serial Mode). The receive procedure and operation in receive mode are as follows. (1) Set the ICE bit in the ICCR1 register to 1 (transfer operation enabled). Set bits CKS0 to CKS3 in the ICCR1 register and set the MST bit (initial setting). (2) The output of the receive clock starts when the MST bit is set to 1 while the transfer clock is being output. (3) Data is transferred from registers ICDRS to ICDRR and the RDRF bit in the ICSR register is set to 1, when the receive operation is completed. Since the next byte of data is enabled when the MST bit is set to 1, the clock is output continuously. Continuous reception is enabled by reading the ICDRR register every time the RDRF bit is set to 1. An overrun is detected at the rise of the 8th clock cycle while the RDRF bit is set to 1, and the AL bit in the ICSR register is set to 1. At this time, the last receive data is retained in the ICDRR register. (4) When the MST bit is set to 1, set the RCVD bit in the ICCR1 register to 1 (disables the next receive operation) and read the ICDRR register. The SCL signal is fixed “H” after reception of the following byte of data is completed. SCL 1 SDA (input) MST bit in ICCR1 register TRS bit in ICCR1 register b0 2 b1 7 b6 8 b7 1 b0 7 b6 8 1 b7 2 b0 1 0 1 0 RDRF bit in ICSR register 1 0 Data 1 ICDRS register Data 1 ICDRR register Processing by program Figure 16.43 Data 2 (2) Set MST bit to 1 (when transfer clock is output) (3) Read ICDRR register Data 3 Data 2 (3) Read ICDRR register Operating Timing in Receive Mode (Clock Synchronous Serial Mode) Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 224 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 16.3.5 16. Clock Synchronous Serial Interface Noise Canceller The states of pins SCL and SDA are routed through the noise canceller before being latched internally. Figure 16.44 shows a Block Diagram of Noise Canceller. The noise canceller consists of two cascaded latch and match detector circuits. When the SCL pin input signal (or SDA pin input signal) is sampled on f1 and two latch outputs match, the level is passed forward to the next circuit. When they do not match, the former value is retained. f1 (sampling clock) C SCL or SDA input signal D C Q D Latch Period of f1 f1 (sampling clock) Figure 16.44 Block Diagram of Noise Canceller Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 225 of 315 Q Latch Match detection circuit Internal SCL or SDA signal R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 16.3.6 16. Clock Synchronous Serial Interface Bit Synchronization Circuit When setting the I2C bus interface to master mode, the high-level period may become shorter in the following two cases: • If the SCL signal is driven L level by a slave device • If the rise speed of the SCL signal is reduced by a load (load capacity or pull-up resistor) on the SCL line. Therefore, the SCL signal is monitored and communication is synchronized bit by bit. Figure 16.45 shows the Timing of Bit Synchronization Circuit and Table 16.8 lists the Time between Changing SCL Signal from “L” Output to High-Impedance and Monitoring of SCL Signal. Basis clock of SCL monitor timing SCL VIH Internal SCL Figure 16.45 Timing of Bit Synchronization Circuit Table 16.8 Time between Changing SCL Signal from “L” Output to High-Impedance and Monitoring of SCL Signal ICCR1 Register CKS3 0 1 Time for Monitoring SCL CKS2 0 1 0 1 1Tcyc = 1/f1(s) Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 226 of 315 7.5Tcyc 19.5Tcyc 17.5Tcyc 41.5Tcyc R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 16.3.7 16. Clock Synchronous Serial Interface Examples of Register Setting Figures 16.46 to 16.49 show Examples of Register Setting When Using I2C bus interface. Start • Set the STOP bit in the ICSR register to 0. • Set the IICSEL bit in the PMR register to 1. Initial setting Read BBSY bit in ICCR2 register (1) Judge the state of the SCL and SDA lines. No (1) (2) Set to master transmit mode. BBSY = 0 ? (3) Generate the start condition. Yes ICCR1 register TRS bit ← 1 MST bit ← 1 (2) ICCR2 register SCP bit ← 0 BBSY bit ← 1 (3) (4) Set the transmit data of the 1st byte (slave address + R/W). (5) Wait for 1 byte to be transmitted. Write transmit data to ICDRT register (4) (6) Judge the ACKBR bit from the specified slave device. (7) Set the transmit data after 2nd byte (except the last byte). (8) Wait until the ICRDT register is empty. Read TEND bit in ICSR register (9) Set the transmit data of the last byte. No (5) TEND = 1 ? (10) Wait for end of transmission of the last byte. (11) Set the TEND bit to 0. Yes Read ACKBR bit in ICIER register (12) Set the STOP bit to 0. (13) Generate the stop condition. ACKBR = 0 ? No (6) (15) Set to slave receive mode Set the TDRE bit to 0. Yes Transmit mode ? (14) Wait until the stop condition is generated. No Master receive mode Yes Write transmit data to ICDRT register (7) Read TDRE bit in ICSR register No (8) TDRE = 1 ? Yes No Last byte ? (9) Yes Write transmit data to ICDRT register Read TEND bit in ICSR register No (10) TEND = 1 ? Yes ICSR register TEND bit ← 0 (11) ICSR register STOP bit ← 0 (12) ICCR2 register SCP bit ← 0 BBSY bit ← 0 (13) Read STOP bit in ICSR register No (14) STOP = 1 ? Yes ICCR1 register TRS bit ← 0 MST bit ← 0 (15) ICSR register TDRE bit ← 0 End Figure 16.46 Example of Register Setting in Master Transmit Mode (I2C bus Interface Mode) Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 227 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 16. Clock Synchronous Serial Interface Master receive mode TEND bit ← 0 ICSR register (1) Set the TEND bit to 0 and set to master receive mode. Set the TDRE bit to 0. (1,2) TRS bit ← 0 ICCR1 register (1) TDRE bit ← 0 ICSR register (2) Set the ACKBT bit to the transmit device. (1) (3) Dummy read the ICDRR register(1) ICIER register ACKBT bit ← 0 (2) (4) Wait for 1 byte to be received. (5) Judge (last receive - 1). Dummy read in ICDRR register (3) (7) Set the ACKBT bit of the last byte and set to disable the continuous receive operation (RCVD = 1).(2) Read RDRF bit in ICSR register No (6) Read the receive data. (4) (8) Read the receive data of (last byte - 1). RDRF = 1 ? (9) Wait until the last byte is received. Yes (10) Set the STOP bit to 0. (11) Generate the stop condition. Yes Last receive -1? (5) (12) Wait until the stop condition is generated. No Read ICDRR register (13) Read the receive data of the last byte. (6) (14) Set the RCVD bit to 0. (15) Set to slave receive mode. ICIER register ACKBT Bit ← 1 (7) ICCR1 register RCVD Bit ← 1 Read ICDRR register (8) Read RDRF bit in ICSR register No (9) RDRF = 1 ? Yes ICSR register STOP bit ← 0 (10) ICCR2 register SCP bit ← 0 BBSY bit ← 0 (11) Read STOP bit in ICSR register (12) No STOP = 1 ? Yes Read ICDRR register (13) ICCR1 register RCVD bit ← 0 (14) MST bit ← 0 (15) ICCR1 register End NOTES: 1. Do not generate the interrupt while processing steps (1) to (3). 2. When receiving 1 byte, skip steps (2) to (6) after (1) and jump to process of step (7). Processing step (8) is dummy read of the ICDRR register. Figure 16.47 Example of Register Setting in Master Receive Mode (I2C bus Interface Mode) Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 228 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 16. Clock Synchronous Serial Interface Slave transmit mode AAS bit ← 0 ICSR register (1) Set the AAS bit to 0. (1) (2) Set the transmit data (except the last byte). Write transmit data to ICDRT register (2) (3) Wait until the ICRDT register is empty. (4) Set the transmit data of the last byte. Read TDRE bit in ICSR register (5) Wait until the last byte is transmitted. No TDRE = 1 ? (3) (7) Set to slave receive mode. Yes No (6) Set the TEND bit to 0. (8) Dummy read the ICDRR register to release the SCL signal. Last byte ? (4) Yes (9) Set the TDRE bit to 0. Write transmit data to ICDRT register Read TEND bit in ICSR register No TEND = 1 ? ICSR register ICCR1 register Yes TEND bit ← 0 (6) TRS bit ← 0 (7) Dummy read in ICDRR register ICSR register (5) TDRE bit ← 0 (8) (9) End Figure 16.48 Example of Register Setting in Slave Transmit Mode (I2C bus Interface Mode) Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 229 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 16. Clock Synchronous Serial Interface Slave receive mode AAS bit ← 0 (1) ICIER register ACKBT bit ← 0 (2) ICSR register (1) Set the AAS bit to 0.(1) (2) Set the ACKBT bit to the transmit device. (3) Dummy read the ICDRR register Dummy read in ICDRR register (3) (4) Wait until 1 byte is received. (5) Judge (last receive - 1). Read RDRF bit in ICSR register (6) Read the receive data. No (4) (7) Set the ACKBT bit of the last byte.(1) RDRF = 1 ? (8) Read the receive data of (last byte - 1). Yes (9) Wait until the last byte is received Last receive -1? Yes (5) (10) Read the receive data of the last byte. No Read ICDRR register ICIER register ACKBT bit ← 1 Read ICDRR register (6) (7) (8) Read RDRF bit in ICSR register No (9) RDRF = 1 ? Yes Read ICDRR register (10) End NOTE: 1. When receiving 1 byte, skip steps (2) to (6) after (1) and jump to processing step (7). Processing step (8) is dummy read of the ICDRR register. Figure 16.49 Example of Register Setting in Slave Receive Mode (I2C bus Interface Mode) Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 230 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 16.3.8 16. Clock Synchronous Serial Interface Notes on I2C bus Interface Set the IICSEL bit in the PMR register to 1 (select I2C bus interface function) to use the I2C bus interface. 16.3.8.1 Accessing of Registers Associated with I2C bus Interface Wait for three instructions or more or four cycles or more after writing to the same register among the registers associated with the I2C bus Interface (00B8h to 00BFh) before reading it. • An example of waiting three instructions or more Program example MOV.B NOP NOP NOP MOV.B #00h,00BBh ; Set ICIER register to 00h 00BBh,R0L • An example of waiting four cycles or more Program example BCLR JMP.B 6,00BBh NEXT ; Disable transmit end interrupt request BSET 7,00BBh ; Enable transmit data empty interrupt request NEXT: Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 231 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 17. A/D Converter 17. A/D Converter The A/D converter consists of one 10-bit successive approximation A/D converter circuit with a capacitive coupling amplifier. The analog input shares pins P1_0 to P1_3. Therefore, when using these pins, ensure that the corresponding port direction bits are set to 0 (input mode). When not using the A/D converter, set the VCUT bit in the ADCON1 register to 0 (Vref unconnected) so that no current will flow from the VREF pin into the resistor ladder. This helps to reduce the power consumption of the chip. The result of A/D conversion is stored in the AD register. Table 17.1 lists the Performance of A/D Converter. Figure 17.1 shows a Block Diagram of A/D Converter. Figures 17.2 and 17.3 show the A/D Converter-Associated Registers. Table 17.1 Performance of A/D Converter Item A/D conversion method Analog input voltage(1) Operating clock φAD(2) Resolution Absolute accuracy Performance Successive approximation (with capacitive coupling amplifier) 0 V to AVCC 4.2 V ≤ AVCC ≤ 5.5 V f1, f2, f4 2.7 V ≤ AVCC < 4.2 V f2, f4 8 bits or 10 bits selectable AVCC = Vref = 5 V • 8-bit resolution ± 2 LSB • 10-bit resolution ± 3 LSB AVCC = Vref = 3.3 V • 8-bit resolution ± 2 LSB • 10-bit resolution ± 5 LSB Operating mode One-shot and repeat(3) Analog input pin 4 pins (AN8 to AN11) A/D conversion start conditions • Software trigger Set the ADST bit in the ADCON0 register to 1 (A/D conversion starts). • Capture Timer Z interrupt request is generated while the ADST bit is set to 1. Conversion rate per pin • Without sample and hold function 8-bit resolution: 49φAD cycles, 10-bit resolution: 59φAD cycles • With sample and hold function 8-bit resolution: 28φAD cycles, 10-bit resolution: 33φAD cycles NOTES: 1. The analog input voltage does not depend on use of a sample and hold function. When the analog input voltage is over the reference voltage, the A/D conversion result will be 3FFh in 10-bit mode and FFh in 8-bit mode. 2. The frequency of φAD must be 10 MHz or below. Without a sample and hold function, the φAD frequency should be 250 kHz or above. With a sample and hold function, the φAD frequency should be 1 MHz or above. 3. In repeat mode, only 8-bit mode can be used. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 232 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 17. A/D Converter A/D conversion rate selection CKS0 = 1 fRING-fast CKS1 = 1 f1 CKS0 = 0 φAD CKS0 = 1 f2 CKS1 = 0 f4 CKS0 = 0 VCUT = 0 AVSS VREF Resistor ladder VCUT = 1 Successive conversion register Software trigger ADCAP = 0 ADCON0 Trigger Timer Z interrupt request ADCAP = 1 Vcom AD register Decoder Comparator VIN Data bus ADGSEL0 = 0 ADGSEL0 = 1 P1_0/AN8 P1_1/AN9 P1_2/AN10 P1_3/AN11 CH2 to CH0 = 100b CH2 to CH0 = 101b CH2 to CH0 = 110b CH2 to CH0 = 111b CH0 to CH2, CKS0: Bits in ADCON0 register CKS1, VCUT: Bits in ADCON1 register Figure 17.1 Block Diagram of A/D Converter Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 233 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 17. A/D Converter A/D Control Register 0(1) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 1 1 Symbol ADCON0 Bit Symbol CH0 Address 00D6h Bit Name Analog input pin select bits (2) CH1 CH2 MD ADGSEL0 ADCAP ADST After Reset 00000XXXb Function b2 b1 b0 1 0 0 : AN8 1 0 1 : AN9 1 1 0 : AN10 1 1 1 : AN11 Other than above: Do not set. A/D operating mode select 0 : One-shot mode 1 : Repeat mode bit(3) RW RW RW RW RW A/D input group select bit 0 : Disabled 1 : Enabled (AN8 to AN11) RW A/D conversion automatic start bit 0 : Starts at softw are trigger (ADST bit). 1 : Starts at capture (timer Z interrupt request). RW A/D conversion start flag 0 : Disabes A/D conversion. 1 : Starts A/D conversion. RW Frequency select bit 0 [When CKS1 in ADCON1 register = 0] 0 : Selects f4. 1 : Selects f2. [When CKS1 in ADCON1 register = 1] 0 : Selects f1.(4) 1 : fRING-fast RW CKS0 NOTE : 1. If the ADCON0 register is rew ritten during A/D conversion, the conversion result is undefined. 2. Bits CH0 to CH2 are enabled w hen the ADGSEL0 bit is set to 1. 3. After changing the A/D operating mode, select the analog input pin again. 4. Set øAD frequency to 10 MHz or below . A/D Control Register 1(1) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 0 0 0 0 Symbol Address 00D7h ADCON1 Bit Symbol Bit Name Reserved bits — (b2-b0) BITS CKS1 VCUT — (b6-b7) After Reset 00h Function Set to 0. 0 : 8-bit mode 1 : 10-bit mode RW Frequency select bit 1 Refer to the description of the CKS0 bit in the ADCON0 register function. RW Vref connect bit(3) 0 : Vref not connected 1 : Vref connected RW Reserved bits Set to 0. Registers ADCON0 and ADCON1 Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 RW 8/10-bit mode select bit(2) NOTES : 1. If the ADCON1 register is rew ritten during A/D conversion, the conversion result is undefined. 2. Set the BITS bit to 0 (8-bit mode) in repeat mode. 3. When the VCUT bit is set to 1 (connected) from 0 (not connected), w ait for 1 µs or more before starting A/D conversion. Figure 17.2 RW Page 234 of 315 RW R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 17. A/D Converter A/D Control Register 2(1) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 0 0 Symbol ADCON2 Bit Symbol Address 00D4h Bit Name A/D conversion method select bit After Reset 00h Function 0 : Without sample and hold 1 : With sample and hold — (b3-b1) Reserved bits Set to 0. — (b7-b4) Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0. When read, the content is 0. SMP RW RW RW — NOTE : 1. When the ADCON2 register is rew ritten during A/D conversion, the conversion result is undefined. A/D Register (b15) b7 (b8) b0 b7 b0 Symbol AD Address 00C1h-00C0h After Reset Undefined Function When BITS bit in ADCON1 register is set to 1 (10-bit mode). When BITS bit in ADCON1 register is set to 0 (8-bit mode). 8 low -order bits in A/D conversion result A/D conversion result 2 high-order bits in A/D conversion result When read, the content is undefined. Nothing is assigned. If necessary, set to 0. When read, the content is 0. Figure 17.3 Registers ADCON2 and AD Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 235 of 315 RW RO RO — R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 17.1 17. A/D Converter One-Shot Mode In one-shot mode, the input voltage of one selected pin is A/D converted once. Table 17.2 lists the One-Shot Mode Specifications. Figure 17.4 shows Registers ADCON0 and ADCON1 in One-shot Mode. Table 17.2 One-Shot Mode Specifications Item Specification Function The input voltage of one pin selected by bits CH2 to CH0 is A/D converted once. Start conditions • When the ADCAP bit is set to 0 (software trigger), set the ADST bit to 1 (A/D conversion starts). • When the ADCAP bit is set to 1 (capture), timer Z interrupt request is generated while the ADST bit is set to 1. Stop conditions • A/D conversion completes (when the ADCAP bit is set to 0 (software trigger) ADST bit is set to 0). • Set the ADST bit to 0. Interrupt request generation A/D conversion completes. timing Input pin Select one of AN8 to AN11. Reading of A/D conversion Read AD register. result Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 236 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 17. A/D Converter A/D Control Register 0(1) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 1 0 1 Symbol ADCON0 Bit Symbol CH0 Address 00D6h Bit Name Analog input pin select bits (2) CH1 CH2 MD ADGSEL0 ADCAP ADST After Reset 00000XXXb Function b2 b1 b0 1 0 0 : AN8 1 0 1 : AN9 1 1 0 : AN10 1 1 1 : AN11 Other than above: Do not set. A/D operating mode select 0 : One-shot mode bit(3) RW RW RW RW RW A/D input group select bit 0 : Disabled 1 : Enabled (AN8 to AN11) RW A/D conversion automatic start bit 0 : Starts at softw are trigger (ADST bit). 1 : Starts at capture (timer Z interrupt). RW A/D conversion start flag 0 : Disables A/D conversion. 1 : Starts A/D conversion. RW Frequency select bit 0 [When CKS1 in ADCON1 register = 0] 0 : Selects f4. 1 : Selects f2. [When CKS1 in ADCON1 register = 1] 0 : Selects f1.(4) 1 : fRING-fast RW CKS0 NOTES : 1. If the ADCON0 register is rew ritten during A/D conversion, the conversion result is undefined. 2. Bits CH0 to CH2 are enabled w hen the ADGSEL0 bit is set to 1. 3. After changing the A/D operating mode, select the analog input pin again. 4. Set øAD frequency to 10 MHz or below . A/D Control Register 1(1) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 0 1 0 0 0 Symbol Address 00D7h ADCON1 Bit Symbol Bit Name — Reserved bits (b2-b0) BITS CKS1 VCUT — (b6-b7) After Reset 00h Function Set to 0. 0 : 8-bit mode 1 : 10-bit mode RW Frequency select bit 1 Refer to the description of the CKS0 bit in the ADCON0 register function. RW Vref connect bit(2) 1 : Vref connected Reserved bits Set to 0. Registers ADCON0 and ADCON1 in One-shot Mode Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 RW 8/10-bit mode select bit NOTES : 1. If the ADCON1 register is rew ritten during A/D conversion, the conversion result is undefined. 2. When the VCUT bit is set to 1 (connected) from 0 (not connected), w ait for 1 µs or more before starting A/D conversion. Figure 17.4 RW Page 237 of 315 RW RW R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 17.2 17. A/D Converter Repeat Mode In repeat mode, the input voltage of one selected pin is A/D converted repeatedly. Table 17.3 lists the Repeat Mode Specifications. Figure 17.5 shows Registers ADCON0 and ADCON1 in Repeat Mode. Table 17.3 Repeat Mode Specifications Item Specification Function The Input voltage of one pin selected by bits CH2 to CH0 is A/D converted repeatedly Start conditions • When the ADCAP bit is set to 0 (software trigger), set the ADST bit to 1 (A/D conversion starts). • When the ADCAP bit is set to 1 (capture), timer Z interrupt request is generated while the ADST bit is set to 1. Stop condition Set the ADST bit to 0. Interrupt request generation Not generated timing Input pin Select one of AN8 to AN11. Reading of A/D conversion Read AD register. result Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 238 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 17. A/D Converter A/D Control Register 0(1) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 1 1 1 Symbol ADCON0 Bit Symbol CH0 Address 00D6h Bit Name Analog input pin select bits (2) CH1 CH2 MD ADGSEL0 ADCAP ADST After Reset 00000XXXb Function b2 b1 b0 1 0 0 : AN8 1 0 1 : AN9 1 1 0 : AN10 1 1 1 : AN11 Other than above: Do not set. A/D operating mode select 1 : Repeat mode bit(3) RW RW RW RW RW A/D input group select bit 0 : Disabled 1 : Enabled (AN8 to AN11) RW A/D conversion automatic start bit 0 : Starts at softw are trigger (ADST bit). 1 : Starts at capture (requests timer Z interrupt). RW A/D conversion start flag 0 : Disables A/D conversion. 1 : Starts A/D conversion. RW Frequency select bit 0 [When CKS1 in ADCON1 register = 0] 0 : Selects f4. 1 : Selects f2. [When CKS1 in ADCON1 register = 1] 0 : Selects f1.(4) 1 : fRING-fast RW CKS0 NOTES : 1. If the ADCON0 register is rew ritten during A/D conversion, the conversion result is undefined. 2. Bits CH0 to CH2 are enabled w hen the ADGSEL0 bit is set to 1. 3. After changing the A/D operating mode, select the analog input pin again. 4. Set øAD frequency to 10 MHz or below . A/D Control Register 1(1) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 0 1 0 0 0 0 Symbol Address 00D7h ADCON1 Bit Symbol Bit Name Reserved bits — (b2-b0) BITS CKS1 VCUT — (b6-b7) After Reset 00h Function Set to 0. 8/10-bit mode select bit(2) 0 : 8-bit mode Frequency select bit 1 Refer to the description of the CKS0 bit in the ADCON0 register function. Vref connect bit(3) 1 : Vref connected Reserved bits Set to 0. NOTES : 1. If the ADCON1 register is rew ritten during A/D conversion, the conversion result is undefined. 2. Set the BITS bit to 0 (8-bit mode) in repeat mode. 3. When the VCUT bit is set to 1 (connected) from 0 (not connected), w ait for 1 µs or more before starting A/D conversion. Figure 17.5 Registers ADCON0 and ADCON1 in Repeat Mode Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 239 of 315 RW RW RW RW RW RW R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 17.3 17. A/D Converter Sample and Hold When the SMP bit in the ADCON2 register is set to 1 (sample and hold function enabled), the A/D conversion rate per pin increases to 28φAD cycles for 8-bit resolution or 33φAD cycles for 10-bit resolution. The sample and hold function is available in all operating modes. Start A/D conversion after selecting whether the sample and hold circuit is to be used or not. When performing A/D conversion, charge the comparator capacitor in the MCU during the sampling time. Figure 17.6 shows a Timing Diagram of A/D Conversion. Sample and Hold disabled Conversion time of 1st bit 2nd bit Comparison Sampling time Comparison Sampling time Comparison 2.5ø AD cycles 2.5ø AD cycles time time time Sampling time 4ø AD cycles * Repeat until conversion ends Sample and Hold enabled 2nd bit Conversion time of 1st bit Comparison time Sampling time 4ø AD cycles Comparison Comparison Comparison time time time * Repeat until conversion ends Figure 17.6 17.4 Timing Diagram of A/D Conversion A/D Conversion Cycles Figure 17.7 shows the A/D Conversion Cycles. A/D Conversion Mode Conversion Time Conversion time of 1st bit Conversion time 2nd and following bits Sampling Time Sampling Time Comparison Time End of processing Comparison End Time Processing Without sample and hold 8 bits 49φAD 4φAD 2.0φAD 2.5φAD 2.5φAD 8.0φAD Without sample and hold 10 bits 59φAD 4φAD 2.0φAD 2.5φAD 2.5φAD 8.0φAD With sample and hold 8 bits 28φAD 4φAD 2.5φAD 0.0φAD 2.5φAD 4.0φAD With sample and hold 10 bits 33φAD 4φAD 2.5φAD 0.0φAD 2.5φAD 4.0φAD Figure 17.7 A/D Conversion Cycles Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 240 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 17.5 17. A/D Converter Internal Equivalent Circuit of Analog Input Block Figure 17.8 shows the Internal Equivalent Circuit of Analog Input Block. VCC VCC VSS AVCC ON resistor approx. 2 kΩ Wiring resistor approx. 0.2 k Ω Parasitic diode AN8 ON resistor approx. 0.6 k Ω Analog input voltage SW1 SW2 Parasitic diode i ladder-type switches i=4 AMP VIN ON resistor approx. 5 kΩ Sampling control signal VSS C = Approx.1.5 pF SW3 SW4 i ladder-type wiring resistors AVSS ON resistor approx. 2 kΩ Wiring resistor approx. 0.2 k Ω Chopper-type amplifier AN11 SW1 b2 b1 b0 A/D control register 0 Reference control signal A/D successive conversion register Vref VREF Resistor ladder SW2 Comparison voltage ON resistor approx. 0.6 k f A/D conversion interrupt request AVSS Comparison reference voltage (Vref) generator Sampling Comparison SW1 conducts only to the ports selected for analog input. Connect to SW2 and SW3 are open when A/D conversion is not in progress; their status varies as shown by the waveforms in the diagrams at left. Control signal for SW2 Connect to SW4 conducts only when A/D conversion is not in progress. Connect to Control signal for SW3 Connect to NOTE: 1. Use this data only as a guideline for circuit design. Mass production may cause some changes in device characteristics. Figure 17.8 Internal Equivalent Circuit of Analog Input Block Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 241 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 17.6 17. A/D Converter Inflow Current Bypass Circuit Figure 17.9 shows the Configuration of Inflow Current Bypass Circuit and Figure 17.10 shows an Example of Inflow Current Bypass Circuit where VCC or More is Applied. OFF OFF Fixed to GND level Unselected channel ON To the internal logic of the A/D Converter ON External input latched into Selected channel ON OFF Figure 17.9 Configuration of Inflow Current Bypass Circuit VCC or more Leakage current generated Unselected channel OFF Leakage current generated OFF ON Sensor input Selected channel ON Unaffected by leakage To the internal logic of the A/D Converter ON OFF Figure 17.10 Example of Inflow Current Bypass Circuit where VCC or More is Applied Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 242 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 17.7 17. A/D Converter Output Impedance of Sensor under A/D Conversion To carry out A/D conversion properly, charging the internal capacitor C shown in Figure 17.11 has to be completed within a specified period of time. T (sampling time) as the specified time. Let output impedance of sensor equivalent circuit be R0, internal resistance of microcomputer be R, precision (error) of the A/D converter be X, and the resolution of A/D converter be Y (Y is 1024 in the 10-bit mode, and 256 in the 8-bit mode). VC is generally And when t = T, 1 – -------------------------C ( R0 + R ) VC = VIN 1 – e t X X VC = VIN – ---- VIN = VIN 1 – ---- Y Y 1 – --------------------------T C ( R0 + R) = X e ---Y 1 – -------------------------T = ln X ---C ( R0 + R ) Y Hence, T R0 = – ------------------- – R X C • ln ---Y Figure 17.11 shows Analog Input Pin and External Sensor Equivalent Circuit. When the difference between VIN and VC becomes 0.1LSB, we find impedance R0 when voltage between pins VC changes from 0 to VIN-(0.1/ 1024) VIN in time T. (0.1/1024) means that A/D precision drop due to insufficient capacitor charge is held to 0.1LSB at time of A/D conversion in the 10-bit mode. Actual error however is the value of absolute precision added to 0.1LSB. When f(XIN) = 10 MHz, T = 0.25 µs in the A/D conversion mode without sample & hold. Output impedance R0 for sufficiently charging capacitor C within time T is determined as follows. T = 0.25 µs, R = 2.8 kΩ, C = 6.0 pF, X = 0.1, and Y = 1024. Hence, 3 3 0.25 × 10 – 6 R0 = – -------------------------------------------------- – 2.8 ×10 ≈ 1.7 ×10 0.1 6.0 × 10 – 12 • ln ----------1024 Thus, the allowable output impedance of the sensor equivalent circuit, making the precision (error) 0.1LSB or less, is approximately 1.7 kΩ. maximum. MCU Sensor equivalent circuit R0 R (2.8 kΩ) VIN C (6.0 pF) VC NOTE: 1. The capasity of the terminal is assumed to be 4.5 pF. Figure 17.11 Analog Input Pin and External Sensor Equivalent Circuit Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 243 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 17.8 17. A/D Converter Notes on A/D Converter • Write to each bit (other than bit 6) in the ADCON0 register, each bit in the ADCON1 register, or the SMP bit in the ADCON2 register when A/D conversion is stopped (before a trigger occurs). • When the VCUT bit in the ADCON1 register is changed from 0 (VREF not connected) to 1 (VREF connected), wait for at least 1 µs before starting A/D conversion. • After changing the A/D operating mode, select an analog input pin again. • When using the one-shot mode, ensure that A/D conversion is completed before reading the AD register. The IR bit in the ADIC register or the ADST bit in the ADCON0 register can be used to determine whether A/D conversion is completed. • When using the repeat mode, use the undivided main clock as the CPU clock. • If the ADST bit in the ADCON0 register is set to 0 (A/D conversion stops) by a program and A/ D conversion is forcibly terminated during an A/D conversion operation, the conversion result of the A/D converter will be undefined. If the ADST bit is set to 0 by a program, do not use the value of the AD register. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 244 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 18. Flash Memory 18. Flash Memory 18.1 Overview In the flash memory, rewrite operations to the flash memory can be performed in three modes; CPU rewrite, standard serial I/O, and parallel I/O. Table 18.1 lists the Flash Memory Performance (refer to Table 1.1 Functions and Specifications for R8C/1A Group and Table 1.2 Functions and Specifications for R8C/1B Group for items not listed in Table 18.1). Table 18.1 Flash Memory Performance Item Flash memory operating mode Division of erase block Programming method Erase method Programming and erasure control method Rewrite control method Specification 3 modes (CPU rewrite, standard serial I/O, and parallel I/O mode) Refer to Figure 18.1 and Figure 18.2 Byte unit Block erase Program and erase control by software command Rewrite control for blocks 0 and 1 by FMR02 bit in FMR0 register. Rewrite control for block 0 by FMR15 bit and block 1 by FMR16 bit in FMR1 register. 5 commands R8C/1A Group: 100 times; R8C/1B Group: 1,000 times Number of commands Programming Blocks 0 and 1 and erasure (program ROM) (1) Blocks A and B 10,000 times endurance (data flash)(2) ID code check function Standard serial I/O mode supported ROM code protect Parallel I/O mode supported NOTES: 1. Definition of programming and erasure endurance The programming and erasure endurance is defined on a per-block basis. If the programming and erasure endurance is n (n = 100 or 10,000), each block can be erased n times. For example, if 1,024 1-byte writes are performed to block A, a 1-Kbyte block, and then the block is erased, the erase count stands at one. When performing 100 or more rewrites, the actual erase count can be reduced by executing programming operations in such a way that all blank areas are used before performing an erase operation. Avoid rewriting only particular blocks and try to average out the programming and erasure endurance of the blocks. It is also advisable to retain data on the erase count of each block and limit the number of erase operations to a certain number. 2. Blocks A and B are implemented only in the R8C/1B Group. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 245 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group Table 18.2 18. Flash Memory Flash Memory Rewrite Modes Flash Memory Rewrite Mode Function CPU Rewrite Mode User ROM area is rewritten by executing software commands from the CPU. EW0 mode: Rewritable in any area other than flash memory EW1 mode: Rewritable in flash memory Areas which can User ROM area be rewritten Operating mode Single chip mode ROM None programmer Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 246 of 315 Standard Serial I/O Mode Parallel I/O Mode User ROM area is rewritten by a dedicated serial programmer. User ROM area is rewritten by a dedicated parallel programmer. User ROM area User ROM area Boot mode Serial programmer Parallel I/O mode Parallel programmer R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 18.2 18. Flash Memory Memory Map The flash memory contains a user ROM area and a boot ROM area (reserved area). Figure 18.1 shows a Flash Memory Block Diagram for R8C/1A Group. Figure 18.2 shows a Flash Memory Block Diagram for R8C/1B Group. The user ROM area of the R8C/1B Group contains an area (program ROM) which stores MCU operating programs and the blocks A and B (data flash) each 1 Kbyte in size. The user ROM area is divided into several blocks. The user ROM area can be rewritten in CPU rewrite mode and standard serial I/O and parallel I/O modes. When rewriting blocks 0 and 1 in CPU rewrite mode, set the FMR02 bit in the FMR0 register to 1 (rewrite enabled). When the FMR15 bit in the FMR1 register to is set to 0 (rewrite enabled), block 0 is rewritable. When the FMR16 bit to is set 0 (rewrite enabled), block 1 is rewritable. The rewrite control program for standard serial I/O mode is stored in the boot ROM area before shipment. The boot ROM area and the user ROM area share the same address, but have separate memory areas. 8 Kbyte ROM product 0E000h Block 0: 8 Kbytes(1) 4 Kbyte ROM product 0F000h Program ROM Block 0: 4 Kbytes(1) 0FFFFh 0FFFFh User ROM area User ROM area 16 Kbyte ROM product 0C000h Block 1: 8 Kbytes(1) 12 Kbyte ROM product Program ROM 0D000h Block 1: 4 Kbytes(1) 0DFFFh 0E000h 0DFFFh 0E000h Block 0: 8 Kbytes(1) Block 0: 8 Kbytes(1) 0FFFFh 0E000h 0FFFFh 0FFFFh User ROM area 8 Kbytes User ROM area Boot ROM area (reserved area)(2) NOTES: 1. When the FMR02 bit in the FMR0 register is set to 1 (rewrite enabled) and the FMR15 bit in the FMR1 register to 0 (rewrite enabled), block 0 is rewritable. When the FMR16 bit is set to 0 (rewrite enabled), block 1 is rewritable (only for CPU rewrite mode). 2. This area is for storing the boot program provided by Renesas Technology. Figure 18.1 Flash Memory Block Diagram for R8C/1A Group Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 247 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 18. Flash Memory 8 Kbyte ROM product 02400h Block A: 1 Kbyte 4 Kbyte ROM product 02400h Block A: 1 Kbyte Data flash 02BFFh Block B: 1 Kbyte 02BFFh Block B: 1 Kbyte 0E000h Block 0: 8 Kbytes(1) Program ROM 0F000h Block 0: 4 Kbytes(1) 0FFFFh 0FFFFh User ROM area User ROM area 16 Kbyte ROM product 02400h Block A: 1 Kbyte 12 Kbyte ROM product 02400h Block A: 1 Kbyte Data flash 02BFFh Block B: 1 Kbyte 02BFFh Block B: 1 Kbyte 0C000h Block 1: 8 Kbytes(1) Program ROM 0D000h Block 1: 4 Kbytes(1) 0DFFFh 0E000h 0DFFFh 0E000h Block 0: 8 Kbytes(1) Block 0: 8 Kbytes(1) 0FFFFh 0E000h 0FFFFh 0FFFFh User ROM area 8 Kbytes User ROM area Boot ROM area (reserved area)(2) NOTES: 1. When the FMR02 bit in the FMR0 register is set to 1 (rewrite enabled) and the FMR15 bit in the FMR1 register to 0 (rewrite enabled), block 0 is rewritable. When the FMR16 bit is set to 0 (rewrite enabled), block 1 is rewritable (only for CPU rewrite mode). 2. This area is for storing the boot program provided by Renesas Technology. Figure 18.2 Flash Memory Block Diagram for R8C/1B Group Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 248 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 18.3 18. Flash Memory Functions to Prevent Rewriting of Flash Memory Standard serial I/O mode has an ID code check function, and parallel I/O mode has a ROM code protect function to prevent the flash memory from being read or rewritten easily. 18.3.1 ID Code Check Function This function is used in standard serial I/O mode. Unless the flash memory is blank, the ID codes sent from the programmer and the ID codes written in the flash memory are checked to see if they match. If the ID codes do not match, the commands sent from the programmer are not acknowledged. The ID codes consist of 8 bits of data each, the areas of which, beginning with the first byte, are 00FFDFh, 00FFE3h, 00FFEBh, 00FFEFh, 00FFF3h, 00FFF7h, and 00FFFBh. Write programs in which the ID codes are set at these addresses and write them to the flash memory. Address 00FFDFh to 00FFDCh ID1 Undefined instruction vector 00FFE3h to 00FFE0h ID2 Overflow vector BRK instruction vector 00FFE7h to 00FFE4h 00FFEBh to 00FFE8h ID3 Address match vector 00FFEFh to 00FFECh ID4 Single step vector 00FFF3h to 00FFF0h ID5 Oscillation stop detection/watchdog timer/voltage monitor 2 vector 00FFF7h to 00FFF4h ID6 Address break 00FFFBh to 00FFF8h ID7 00FFFFh to 00FFFCh (Reserved) (Note 1) Reset vector 4 bytes NOTE: 1. The OFS register is assigned to 00FFFFh. Refer to Figure 13.2 Registers OFS and WDC and Figure 13.3 Registers WDTR and WDTS for OFS register details. Figure 18.3 Address for Stored ID Code Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 249 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 18.3.2 18. Flash Memory ROM Code Protect Function The ROM code protect function disables reading or changing the contents of the on-chip flash memory by the OFS register in parallel I/O mode. Figure 18.4 shows the OFS Register. The ROM code protect function is enabled by writing 0 to the ROMCP1 bit and 1 to the ROMCR bit. It disables reading or changing the contents of the on-chip flash memory. Once ROM code protect is enabled, the content in the internal flash memory cannot be rewritten in parallel I/O mode. To disable ROM code protect, erase the block including the OFS register with CPU rewrite mode or standard serial I/O mode. Option Function Select Register(1) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 1 1 1 1 Symbol OFS Bit Symbol WDTON — (b1) ROMCR ROMCP1 — (b6-b4) Address 0FFFFh Bit Name Watchdog timer start select bit Before Shipment FFh(2) Function 0 : Starts w atchdog timer automatically after reset. 1 : Watchdog timer is inactive after reset. Reserved bit Set to 1. ROM code protect disabled bit 0 : ROM code protect disabled 1 : ROMCP1enabled RW ROM code protect bit 0 : ROM code protect enabled 1 : ROM code protect disabled RW Reserved bits Set to 1. Count source protect CSPROINI mode after reset select bit 0 : Count source protect mode enabled after reset. 1 : Count source protect mode disabled after reset. NOTES : 1. The OFS register is on the flash memory. Write to the OFS register w ith a program. 2. If the block including the OFS register is erased, FFh is set to the OFS register. Figure 18.4 OFS Register Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 250 of 315 RW RW RW RW RW R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 18.4 18. Flash Memory CPU Rewrite Mode In CPU rewrite mode, the user ROM area can be rewritten by executing software commands from the CPU. Therefore, the user ROM area can be rewritten directly while the MCU is mounted on a board without using a ROM programmer. Execute the program and block erase commands only to blocks in the user ROM area. The flash module has an erase-suspend function when an interrupt request is generated during an erase operation in CPU rewrite mode. It performs an interrupt process after the erase operation is halted temporarily. During erase-suspend, the user ROM area can be read by a program. In case an interrupt request is generated during an auto-program operation in CPU rewrite mode, the flash module has a program-suspend function which performs the interrupt process after the auto-program operation. During program-suspend, the user ROM area can be read by a program. CPU rewrite mode has an erase write 0 mode (EW0 mode) and an erase write 1 mode (EW1 mode). Table 18.3 lists the Differences between EW0 Mode and EW1 Mode. Table 18.3 Differences between EW0 Mode and EW1 Mode Item Operating mode Areas in which a rewrite control program can be located Areas in which a rewrite control program can be executed Areas which can be rewritten EW0 Mode Single-chip mode User ROM area Executing directly in user ROM area is Necessary to transfer to any area other than the flash memory (e.g., RAM) before possible. executing. User ROM area User ROM area However, blocks which contain a rewrite control program are excluded.(1) None • Program and block erase commands • Cannot be run on any block which contains a rewrite control program • Read status register command cannot be executed Read status register mode Read array mode Software command restrictions Modes after program or erase Modes after read status register CPU status during autowrite and auto-erase Flash memory status detection Read status register mode Do not execute this command Operating Conditions for transition to erase-suspend Conditions for transitions to program-suspend CPU clock EW1 Mode Single-chip mode User ROM area Hold state (I/O ports hold state before the command is executed.) • Read bits FMR00, FMR06, and FMR07 Read bits FMR00, FMR06, and FMR07 in the FMR0 register by a program. in the FMR0 register by a program. • Execute the read status register command and read bits SR7, SR5, and SR4 in the status register. Set bits FMR40 and FMR41 in the FMR4 The FMR40 bit in the FMR4 register is set register to 1 by a program. to 1 and the interrupt request of the enabled maskable interrupt is generated. Set bits FMR40 and FMR42 in the FMR4 The FMR40 bit in the FMR4 register is set register to 1 by a program. to 1 and the interrupt request of the enabled maskable interrupt is generated. 5 MHz or below No restriction (on clock frequency to be used) NOTE: 1. When the FMR02 bit in the FMR0 register is set to 1 (rewrite enabled), rewriting block 0 is enabled by setting the FMR15 bit in the FMR1 register to 0 (rewrite enabled), and rewriting block 1 is enabled by setting the FMR16 bit to 0 (rewrite enabled). Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 251 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 18.4.1 18. Flash Memory EW0 Mode The MCU enters CPU rewrite mode and software commands can be acknowledged by setting the FMR01 bit in the FMR0 register to 1 (CPU rewrite mode enabled). In this case, since the FMR11 bit in the FMR1 register is set to 0, EW0 mode is selected. Use software commands to control program and erase operations. The FMR0 register or the status register can be used to determine when program and erase operations complete. During auto-erasure, set the FMR40 bit to 1 (erase-suspend enabled) and the FMR41 bit to 1 (request erasesuspend). Wait for td(SR-SUS) and ensure that the FMR46 bit is set to 1 (read enabled) before accessing the user ROM area. The auto-erase operation can be restarted by setting the FMR41 bit to 0 (erase restarts). To enter program-suspend during the auto-program operation, set the FMR40 bit to 1 (suspend enabled) and the FMR42 bit to 1 (request program-suspend). Wait for td(SR-SUS) and ensure that the FMR46 bit is set to 1 (read enabled) before accessing the user ROM area. The auto-program operation can be restarted by setting the FMR42 bit to 0 (program restarts). 18.4.2 EW1 Mode The MCU is switched to EW1 mode by setting the FMR11 bit to 1 (EW1 mode) after setting the FMR01 bit to 1 (CPU rewrite mode enabled). The FMR0 register can be used to determine when program and erase operations complete. Do not execute software commands that use the read status register in EW1 mode. To enable the erase-suspend function during auto-erasure, execute the block erase command after setting the FMR40 bit to 1 (erase-suspend enabled). The interrupt to enter erase-suspend should be in interrupt enabled status. After waiting for td(SR-SUS) after the block erase command is executed, the interrupt request is acknowledged. When an interrupt request is generated, the FMR41 bit is automatically set to 1 (requests erase-suspend) and the auto-erase operation suspends. If an auto-erase operation does not complete (FMR00 bit is 0) after an interrupt process completes, the auto-erase operation restarts by setting the FMR41 bit to 0 (erase restarts) To enable the program-suspend function during auto-programming, execute the program command after setting the FMR40 bit to 1 (suspend enabled). The interrupt to enter a program-suspend should be in interrupt enabled status. After waiting for td(SR-SUS) after the program command is executed, an interrupt request is acknowledged. When an interrupt request is generated, the FMR42 bit is automatically set to 1 (request program-suspend) and the auto-program operation suspends. When the auto-program operation does not complete (FMR00 bit is 0) after the interrupt process completes, the auto-program operation can be restarted by setting the FMR42 bit to 0 (programming restarts). Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 252 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 18. Flash Memory Figure 18.5 shows the FMR0 Register. Figure 18.7 shows the FMR4 Register. 18.4.2.1 FMR00 Bit This bit indicates the operating status of the flash memory. The bits value is 0 during programming, or erasure (suspend term included); otherwise, it is 1. 18.4.2.2 FMR01 Bit The MCU is made ready to accept commands by setting the FMR01 bit to 1 (CPU rewrite mode). 18.4.2.3 FMR02 Bit Rewriting of blocks 1 and 0 does not accept the program or block erase commands if the FMR02 bit is set to 0 (rewrite disabled). Rewriting of blocks 0 and 1 is controlled by bits FMR15 and FMR16 if the FMR02 bit is set to 1 (rewrite enabled). 18.4.2.4 FMSTP Bit This bit is used to initialize the flash memory control circuits, and also to reduce the amount of current consumed by the flash memory. Access to the flash memory is disabled by setting the FMSTP bit to 1. Therefore, the FMSTP bit must be written to by a program located outside of the flash memory. In the following cases, set the FMSTP bit to 1: • When flash memory access resulted in an error while erasing or programming in EW0 mode (FMR00 bit not reset to 1 (ready)). • When entering on-chip oscillator mode (main clock stops). Figure 18.11 shows a flowchart of the steps to be followed before and after entering on-chip oscillator mode (main clock stop). Note that when going to stop or wait mode while the CPU rewrite mode is disabled, the FMR0 register does not need to be set because the power for the flash memory is automatically turned off and is turned back on again after returning from stop or wait mode. 18.4.2.5 FMR06 Bit This is a read-only bit indicating the status of an auto-program operation. The bit is set to 1 when a program error occurs; otherwise, it is set to 0. For details, refer to the description in 18.4.5 Full Status Check. 18.4.2.6 FMR07 Bit This is a read-only bit indicating the status of an auto-erase operation. The bit is set to 1 when an erase error occurs; otherwise, it is set to 0. Refer to 18.4.5 Full Status Check for details. 18.4.2.7 FMR11 Bit Setting this bit to 1 (EW1 mode) places the MCU in EW1 mode. 18.4.2.8 FMR15 Bit When the FMR02 bit is set to 1 (rewrite enabled) and the FMR15 bit is set to 0 (rewrite enabled), block 0 accepts program and block erase commands. 18.4.2.9 FMR16 Bit When the FMR02 bit is set to 1 (rewrite enabled) and the FMR16 bit is set to 0 (rewrite enabled), block 1 accepts program and block erase commands. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 253 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 18. Flash Memory 18.4.2.10 FMR40 Bit The suspend function is enabled by setting the FMR40 bit to 1 (enable). 18.4.2.11 FMR41 Bit In EW0 mode, the MCU enters erase-suspend mode when the FMR41 bit is set to 1 by a program. The FMR41 bit is automatically set to 1 (request erase-suspend) when an interrupt request of an enabled interrupt is generated in EW1 mode, and then the MCU enters erase-suspend mode. Set the FMR41 bit to 0 (erase restarts) when the auto-erase operation restarts. 18.4.2.12 FMR42 Bit In EW0 mode, the MCU enters program-suspend mode when the FMR42 bit is set to 1 by a program. The FMR42 bit is automatically set to 1 (request program-suspend) when an interrupt request of an enabled interrupt is generated in EW1 mode, and then the MCU enters program-suspend mode. Set the FMR42 bit to 0 (program restart) when the auto-program operation restarts. 18.4.2.13 FMR43 Bit When the auto-erase operation starts, the FMR43 bit is set to 1 (erase execution in progress). The FMR43 bit remains set to 1 (erase execution in progress) during erase-suspend operation. When the auto-erase operation ends, the FMR43 bit is set to 0 (erase not executed). 18.4.2.14 FMR44 Bit When the auto-program operation starts, the FMR44 bit is set to 1 (program execution in progress). The FMR44 bit remains set to 1 (program execution in progress) during program-suspend operation. When the auto-program operation ends, the FMR44 bit is set to 0 (program not executed). 18.4.2.15 FMR46 Bit The FMR46 bit is set to 0 (reading disabled) during auto-erase execution and set to 1 (reading enabled) in erasesuspend mode. Do not access the flash memory while this bit is set to 0. 18.4.2.16 FMR47 Bit Power consumption when reading flash memory can be reduced by setting the FMR47 bit to 1 (enabled). Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 254 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 18. Flash Memory Flash Memory Control Register 0 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 0 Symbol FMR0 Bit Symbol FMR00 FMR01 FMR02 Address 01B7h ____ Bit Name RY/BY status flag FMR06 FMR07 Function 0 : Busy (w riting or erasing in progress) 1 : Ready RW RO CPU rew rite mode select bit(1) 0 : CPU rew rite mode disabled 1 : CPU rew rite mode enabled RW Block 0, 1 rew rite enable bit(2, 6) 0 : Disables rew rite. 1 : Enables rew rite. RW Flash memory stop bit(3, 5) 0 : Enables flash memory operation. 1 : Stops flash memory (enters low -pow er consumption state and flash memory is reset). RW FMSTP — (b5-b4) After Reset 00000001b Reserved bits Set to 0. Program status flag(4) 0 : Completed successfully 1 : Terminated by error RO Erase status flag(4) 0 : Completed successfully 1 : Terminated by error RO RW NOTES : 1. To set this bit to 1, set it to 1 immediately after setting it first to 0. Do not generate an interrupt betw een setting the bit to 0 and setting it to 1. Enter read array mode and set this bit to 0. 2. Set this bit to 1 immediately after setting it first to 0 w hile the FMR01 bit is set to 1. Do not generate an interrupt betw een setting the bit to 0 and setting it to 1. 3. Set this bit by a program located in a space other than the flash memory. 4. This bit is set to 0 by executing the clear status command. 5. This bit is enabled w hen the FMR01 bit is set to 1 (CPU rew rite mode). When the FMR01 bit is set to 0, w riting 1 to the FMSTP bit causes the FMSTP bit to be set to 1. The flash memory does not enter low -pow er consumption state nor is it reset. 6. When setting the FMR01 bit to 0 (CPU rew rite mode disabled), the FMR02 bit is set to 0 (disables rew rite). Figure 18.5 FMR0 Register Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 255 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 18. Flash Memory Flash Memory Control Register 1 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 1 0 0 0 Symbol Address 01B5h FMR1 Bit Symbol Bit Name — Reserved bit (b0) FMR11 — (b4-b2) FMR15 FMR16 — (b7) After Reset 1000000Xb Function When read, the content is undefined. RW RO EW1 mode select bit(1, 2) 0 : EW0 mode 1 : EW1 mode Reserved bits Set to 0. Block 0 rew rite disable bit(2,3) 0 : Enables rew rite. 1 : Disables rew rite. RW Block 1 rew rite disable bit(2,3) 0 : Enables rew rite. 1 : Disables rew rite. RW Reserved bit Set to 1. RW RW RW NOTES : 1. To set this bit to 1, set it to 1 immediately after setting it first to 0 w hile the FMR01 bit is set to 1 (CPU rew rite mode enable) . Do not generate an interrupt betw een setting the bit to 0 and setting it to 1. 2. This bit is set to 0 by setting the FMR01 bit to 0 (CPU rew rite mode disabled). 3. When the FMR01 bit is set to 1 (CPU rew rite mode enabled), bits FMR15 and FMR16 can be w ritten to. To set this bit to 0, set it to 0 immediately after setting it first to 1. To set this bit to 1, set it to 1. Figure 18.6 FMR1 Register Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 256 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 18. Flash Memory Flash Memory Control Register 4 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 Symbol FMR4 Bit Symbol FMR40 Address 01B3h Bit Name Erase-suspend function enable bit(1) After Reset 01000000b Function RW 0 : Erase restart 1 : Erase-suspend request RW Program-suspend request bit 0 : Program restart 1 : Program-suspend request RW Erase command flag 0 : Erase not executed 1 : Erase execution in progress RO Program command flag 0 : Program not executed 1 : Program execution in progress RO Reserved bits Set to 0. Read status flag 0 : Disables reading. 1 : Enables reading. (2) FMR41 Erase-suspend request bit (3) FMR42 FMR43 FMR44 — (b5) FMR46 FMR47 RW 0 : Disable 1 : Enable Low -pow er consumption read 0 : Disable 1 : Enable mode enable bit (1, 4) RO RO RW NOTES : 1. To set this bit to 1, set it to 1 immediately after setting it first to 0. Do not generate an interrupt betw een setting the bit to 0 and setting it to 1. 2. This bit is enabled w hen the FMR40 bit is set to 1 (enable) and it can be w ritten to during the period betw een issuing an erase command and completing the erase. (This bit is set to 0 during the periods other than the above.) In EW0 mode, it can be set to 0 and 1 by a program. In EW1 mode, it is automatically set to 1 if a maskable interrupt is generated during an erase operation w hile the FMR40 bit is set to 1. Do not set this bit to 1 by a program (0 can be w ritten). 3. The FMR42 bit is enabled only w hen the FMR40 bit is set to 1 (enable) and programming to the FMR42 bit is enabled until auto-programming ends after a program command is generated. (This bit is set to 0 during periods other than the above.) In EW0 mode, 0 or 1 can be programmed to the FMR42 bit by a program. In EW1 mode, the FMR42 bit is automatically set to 1 by generating a maskable interrupt during auto-programming w hen the FMR40 bit is set to 1. 1 cannot be w ritten to the FMR42 bit by a program. 4. Use this mode only in low -speed on-chip oscillator mode. Figure 18.7 FMR4 Register Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 257 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 18. Flash Memory Figure 18.8 shows the Timing of Suspend Operation. Erasure starts Erasure suspends Programming Programming Programming Programming Erasure starts suspends restarts ends restarts During erasure FMR00 bit in FMR0 register 1 FMR46 bit in FMR4 register 1 FMR44 bit in FMR4 register 1 FMR43 bit in FMR4 register 1 During programming During programming Erasure ends During erasure Remains 0 during suspend 0 0 0 0 Remains 1 during suspend Check that the FMR43 bit is set to 1 (during erase execution), and that the erase-operation has not ended. Check that the FMR44 bit is set to 1 (during program execution), and that the program has not ended. Check the status, and that the programming ends normally. Check the status, and that the erasure ends normally. The above figure shows an example of the use of program-suspend during programming following erase-suspend. NOTE: 1. If program-suspend is entered during erase-suspend, always restart programming. Figure 18.8 Timing of Suspend Operation Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 258 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 18. Flash Memory Figure 18.9 shows How to Set and Exit EW0 Mode. Figure 18.10 shows How to Set and Exit EW1 Mode. EW0 Mode Operating Procedure Rewrite control program Write 0 to the FMR01 bit before writing 1 (CPU rewrite mode enabled)(2) Set registers CM0 and CM1(1) Execute software commands Transfer a rewrite control program which uses CPU rewrite mode to any area other than the flash memory. Execute the read array command(3) Write 0 to the FMR01 bit (CPU rewrite mode disabled) Jump to the rewrite control program which has been transferred to any area other than the flash memory. (The subsequent process is executed by the rewrite control program in an area other than the flash memory.) Jump to a specified address in the flash memory NOTES : 1. Select 5 MHz or below for the CPU clock by the CM06 bit in the CM0 register and bits CM16 to CM17 in the CM1 register. 2. To set the FMR01 bit to 1, write 0 to the FMR01 bit before writing 1. Do not generate an interrupt between writing 0 and 1. 3. Disable the CPU rewrite mode after executing the read array command. Figure 18.9 How to Set and Exit EW0 Mode EW1 Mode Operating Procedure Program in ROM Write 0 to the FMR01 bit before writing 1 (CPU rewrite mode enabled)(1) Write 0 to the FMR11 bit before writing 1 (EW1 mode) Execute software commands Write 0 to the FMR01 bit (CPU rewrite mode disabled) NOTE : 1. To set the FMR01 bit to 1, write 0 to the FMR01 bit before writing 1. Do not generate an interrupt between writing 0 and 1. Figure 18.10 How to Set and Exit EW1 Mode Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 259 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 18. Flash Memory On-chip oscillator mode (main clock stops) program Transfer an on-chip oscillator mode (main clock stops) program to an area other than the flash memory. Jump to the on-chip oscillator mode (main clock stops) program which has been transferred to an area other than the flash memory. (The subsequent processing is executed by the program in an area other than the flash memory.) Write 0 to the FMR01 bit before writing 1 (CPU rewrite mode enabled) Write 1 to the FMSTP bit (flash memory stops. low power consumption mode)(1) Switch the clock source for the CPU clock. Turn XIN off. Process in on-chip oscillator mode (main clock stops) Turn main clock on → wait until oscillation stabilizes→ switch the clock source for CPU clock(2) Write 0 to the FMSTP bit (flash memory operation) Write 0 to the FMR01 bit (CPU rewrite mode disabled) Wait until the flash memory circuit stabilizes (30 µs)(3) Jump to a specified address in the flash memory NOTES : 1. Set the FMR01 bit to 1 (CPU rewrite mode) before setting the FMSTP bit to 1. 2. Before switching to a different clock source for the CPU, make sure the designated clock is stable. 3. Insert a 30 µs wait time in a program. Do not access the flash memory during this wait time. Figure 18.11 Process to Reduce Power Consumption in On-Chip Oscillator Mode (Main Clock Stops) Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 260 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 18.4.3 18. Flash Memory Software Commands The software commands are described below. Read or write commands and data in 8-bit units. Table 18.4 Software Commands First Bus Cycle Command Read array Read status register Clear status register Program Block erase Mode Write Write Write Write Write Address × × × WA × Data Mode (D7 to D0) FFh 70h Read 50h 40h Write 20h Write Second Bus Cycle Address Data (D7 to D0) × SRD WA BA WD D0h SRD: Status register data (D7 to D0) WA: Write address (ensure the address specified in the first bus cycle is the same address as the write address specified in the second bus cycle.) WD: Write data (8 bits) BA: Given block address ×: Any specified address in the user ROM area 18.4.3.1 Read Array Command The read array command reads the flash memory. The MCU enters read array mode when FFh is written in the first bus cycle. When the read address is entered in the following bus cycles, the content of the specified address can be read in 8-bit units. Since the MCU remains in read array mode until another command is written, the contents of multiple addresses can be read continuously. In addition, the MCU enters read array mode after a reset. 18.4.3.2 Read Status Register Command The read status register command is used to read the status register. When 70h is written in the first bus cycle, the status register can be read in the second bus cycle. (Refer to 18.4.4 Status Register.) When reading the status register, specify an address in the user ROM area. Do not execute this command in EW1 mode. The MCU remains in read status register mode until the next read array command is written. 18.4.3.3 Clear Status Register Command The clear status register command sets the status register to 0. When 50h is written in the first bus cycle, bits FMR06 to FMR07 in the FMR0 register and SR4 to SR5 in the status register are set to 0. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 261 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 18.4.3.4 18. Flash Memory Program Command The program command writes data to the flash memory in 1-byte units. By writing 40h in the first bus cycle and data to the write address in the second bus cycle, an auto-program operation (data program and verify) will start. Make sure the address value specified in the first bus cycle is the same address as the write address specified in the second bus cycle. The FMR00 bit in the FMR0 register can be used to determine whether auto-programming has completed. When suspend function disabled, the FMR00 bit is set to 0 during auto-programming and set to 1 when autoprogramming completes. When suspend function enabled, the FMR44 bit is set to 1 during auto-programming and set to 0 when autoprogramming completes. The FMR06 bit in the FMR0 register can be used to determine the result of auto-programming after it has been finished. (Refer to 18.4.5 Full Status Check.) Do not write additions to the already programmed addresses. When the FMR02 bit in the FMR0 register is set to 0 (rewriting disabled), or the FMR02 bit is set to 1 (rewrite enabled) and the FMR15 bit in the FMR1 register is set to 1 (rewriting disabled), program commands targeting block 0 are not acknowledged. When the FMR16 bit is set to 1 (rewriting disabled), program commands targeting block 1 are not acknowledged. Figure 18.12 shows Program Command (When Suspend Function Disabled). Figure 18.13 shows Program Command (When Suspend Function Enabled). In EW1 mode, do not execute this command for any address which a rewrite control program is allocated. In EW0 mode, the MCU enters read status register mode at the same time auto-programming starts and the status register can be read. The status register bit 7 (SR7) is set to 0 at the same time auto-programming starts and set back to 1 when auto-programming completes. In this case, the MCU remains in read status register mode until the next read array command is written. The status register can be read to determine the result of auto-programming after auto-programming has completed. Start Write the command code 40h to the write address Write data to the write address FMR00 = 1? No Yes Full status check Program completed Figure 18.12 Program Command (When Suspend Function Disabled) Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 262 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group EW0 Mode 18. Flash Memory Maskable interrupt (1, 2) Start I = 1 (enable interrupt)(3) FMR44 = 1 ? No Yes FMR40 = 1 FMR46 = 0 ? No Write the command code 40h Yes FMR42 = 1 Write data to the write address FMR46 = 1 ? FMR44 = 0 ? No No Access flash memory Yes Access flash memory Yes Full status check FMR42 = 0 Program completed REIT EW1 Mode Start Maskable interrupt (2) I = 1 (enable interrupt) Access flash memory FMR40 = 1 REIT Write the command code 40h Write data to the write address FMR42 = 0 FMR44 = 0 ? No Yes Full status check Program completed NOTES: 1. In EW0 mode, the interrupt vector table and interrupt routine for interrupts to be used should be allocated to the RAM area. 2. td(SR-SUS) is needed until the interrupt request is acknowledged after it is generated. The interrupt to enter suspend should be in interrupt enabled status. 3. When no interrupt is used, the instruction to enable interrupts is not needed. Figure 18.13 Program Command (When Suspend Function Enabled) Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 263 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 18.4.3.5 18. Flash Memory Block Erase When 20h is written in the first bus cycle and D0h is written to a given address of a block in the second bus cycle, an auto-erase operation (erase and verify) of the specified block starts. The FMR00 bit in the FMR0 register can be used to determine whether auto-erasure has completed. The FMR00 bit is set to 0 during auto-erasure and set to 1 when auto-erasure completes. The FMR07 bit in the FMR0 register can be used to determine the result of auto-erasure after auto-erasure has completed. (Refer to 18.4.5 Full Status Check.) When the FMR02 bit in the FMR0 register is set to 0 (rewriting disabled) or the FMR02 bit is set to 1 (rewriting enabled) and the FMR15 bit in the FMR1 register is set to 1 (rewriting disabled), the block erase commands targeting block 0 are not acknowledged. When the FMR16 bit is set to 1 (rewriting disabled), the block erase commands targeting block 1 are not acknowledged. Do not use the block erase command during program-suspend. Figure 18.14 shows the Block Erase Command (When Erase-Suspend Function Disabled). Figure 18.15 shows the Block Erase Command (When Erase-Suspend Function Enabled). In EW1 mode, do not execute this command for any address to which a rewrite control program is allocated. In EW0 mode, the MCU enters read status register mode at the same time auto-erasure starts and the status register can be read. The status register bit 7 (SR7) is set to 0 at the same time auto-erasure starts and set back to 1 when auto-erasure completes. In this case, the MCU remains in read status register mode until the next read array command is written. Start Write the command code 20h Write D0h to a given block address FMR00 = 1? No Yes Full status check Block erase completed Figure 18.14 Block Erase Command (When Erase-Suspend Function Disabled) Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 264 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group EW0 Mode 18. Flash Memory Maskable interrupt (1, 2) Start I = 1 (enable interrupt)(3) FMR43 = 1 ? No Yes FMR40 = 1 FMR46 = 0 ? No Write the command code 20h Yes FMR41 = 1 Write D0h to any block address FMR46 = 1 ? FMR00 = 1 ? No No Access flash memory Yes Access flash memory Yes Full status check FMR41 = 0 Block erase completed REIT EW1 Mode Start Maskable interrupt (2) I = 1 (enable interrupt) Access flash memory FMR40 = 1 REIT Write the command code 20h Write D0h to any block address FMR41 = 0 FMR00 = 1 ? No Yes Full status check Block erase completed NOTES: 1. In EW0 mode, the interrupt vector table and interrupt routine for interrupts to be used should be allocated to the RAM area. 2. td(SR-SUS) is needed until the interrupt request is acknowledged after it is generated. The interrupt to enter suspend should be in interrupt enabled status. 3. When no interrupt is used, the instruction to enable interrupts is not needed. Figure 18.15 Block Erase Command (When Erase-Suspend Function Enabled) Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 265 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 18.4.4 18. Flash Memory Status Register The status register indicates the operating status of the flash memory and whether an erase or program operation has completed normally or in error. Status of the status register can be read by bits FMR00, FMR06, and FMR07 in the FMR0 register. Table 18.5 lists the Status Register Bits. In EW0 mode, the status register can be read in the following cases: • When a given address in the user ROM area is read after writing the read status register command • When a given address in the user ROM area is read after executing program or block erase command but before executing the read array command. 18.4.4.1 Sequencer Status (Bits SR7 and FMR00) The sequencer status bits indicate the operating status of the flash memory. SR7 is set to 0 (busy) during auto-programming and auto-erasure, and is set to 1 (ready) at the same time the operation completes. 18.4.4.2 Erase Status (Bits SR5 and FMR07) Refer to 18.4.5 Full Status Check. 18.4.4.3 Program Status (Bits SR4 and FMR06) Refer to 18.4.5 Full Status Check. Table 18.5 Status Register Bits Status Register Bit SR0 (D0) SR1 (D1) SR2 (D2) SR3 (D3) SR4 (D4) FMR0 Register Bit − − − − FMR06 Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Program status SR5 (D5) FMR07 Erase status SR6 (D6) SR7 (D7) − FMR00 Reserved Sequencer status Description Status Name 0 − − − − Completed normally Completed normally − Busy Value after Reset 1 − − − − Error − − − − 0 Error 0 − Ready − 1 D0 to D7: Indicate the data bus which is read when the read status register command is executed. Bits FMR07 (SR5) to FMR06 (SR4) are set to 0 by executing the clear status register command. When the FMR07 bit (SR5) or FMR06 bit (SR4) is set to 1, the program and block erase commands cannot be accepted. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 266 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 18.4.5 18. Flash Memory Full Status Check When an error occurs, bits FMR06 to FMR07 in the FMR0 register are set to 1, indicating the occurrence of an error. Therefore, checking these status bits (full status check) can be used to determine the execution result. Table 18.6 lists the Errors and FMR0 Register Status. Figure 18.16 shows the Full Status Check and Handling Procedure for Individual Errors. Table 18.6 Errors and FMR0 Register Status FRM0 Register (Status Register) Status Error FMR07(SR5) FMR06(SR4) 1 1 Command sequence error 1 0 Erase error 0 1 Program error Error Occurrence Condition • When a command is not written correctly. • When invalid data other than that which can be written in the second bus cycle of the block erase command is written (i.e., other than D0h or FFh).(1) • When the program command or block erase command is executed while rewriting is disabled by the FMR02 bit in the FMR0 register, or the FMR15 or FMR16 bit in the FMR1 register. • When an address not allocated in flash memory is input during erase command input. • When attempting to erase the block for which rewriting is disabled during erase command input. • When an address not allocated in flash memory is input during write command input. • When attempting to write the block for which rewriting is disabled during write command input. • When the block erase command is executed but auto-erasure does not complete correctly. • When the program command is executed but not auto-programming does not complete correctly. NOTE: 1. The MCU enters read array mode when FFh is written in the second bus cycle of these commands. At the same time, the command code written in the first bus cycle is disabled. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 267 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 18. Flash Memory Command sequence error Full status check Execute the clear status register command (set these status flags to 0) FMR06 = 1 and FMR07 = 1? Yes Command sequence error Check if command is properly input No Re-execute the command FMR07 = 1? Yes Erase error Erase error No Execute the clear status register command (set these status flags to 0) Erase command re-execution times ≤ 3 times? FMR06 = 1? Yes Program error No Yes Re-execute block erase command No Program error Execute the clear status register command (set these status flags to 0) Full status check completed Specify the other address besides the write address where the error occurs for the program address(1) NOTE: 1. To rewrite to the address where the program error occurs, check if the full status check is complete normally and write to the address after the block erase command is executed. Figure 18.16 Re-execute program command Full Status Check and Handling Procedure for Individual Errors Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 268 of 315 Block targeting for erasure cannot be used R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 18.5 18. Flash Memory Standard Serial I/O Mode In standard serial I/O mode, the user ROM area can be rewritten while the MCU is mounted on-board by using a serial programmer which is suitable for the MCU. Standard serial I/O mode is used to connect with a serial programmer using a special clock asynchronous serial I/O. There are three standard serial I/O modes: • Standard serial I/O mode 1 ................ Clock synchronous serial I/O used to connect with a serial programmer • Standard serial I/O mode 2 ................ Clock asynchronous serial I/O used to connect with a serial programmer • Standard serial I/O mode 3 ................ Special clock asynchronous serial I/O used to connect with a serial programmer This MCU uses standard serial I/O mode 2 and standard serial I/O mode 3. Refer to Appendix 2. Connection Examples between Serial Writer and On-Chip Debugging Emulator. Contact the manufacturer of your serial programmer for additional information. Refer to the user’s manual of your serial programmer for details on how to use it. Table 18.7 lists the Pin Functions (Flash Memory Standard Serial I/O Mode 2), Table 18.8 lists the Pin Functions (Flash Memory Standard Serial I/O Mode 3). Figure 18.17 shows Pin Connections for Standard Serial I/O Mode 3. After processing the pins shown in Table 18.8 and rewriting the flash memory using a programmer, apply “H” to the MODE pin and reset the hardware to run a program in the flash memory in single-chip mode. 18.5.1 ID Code Check Function The ID code check function determines whether the ID codes sent from the serial programmer and those written in the flash memory match (refer to 18.3 Functions to Prevent Rewriting of Flash Memory). Table 18.7 Pin Functions (Flash Memory Standard Serial I/O Mode 2) Pin VCC,VSS Name Power input I/O RESET P4_6/XIN Reset input I P4_6 input/clock input I P4_7/XOUT P4_7 input/clock output I/O AVCC, AVSS Analog power supply input I P1_0 to P1_7 P3_3 to P3_5 P4_2/VREF MODE P3_7 P4_5 Input port P1 Input port P3 Input port P4 MODE TXD output RXD input Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 269 of 315 Description Apply the voltage guaranteed for programming and erasure to the VCC pin and 0 V to the VSS pin. Reset input pin. Connect a ceramic resonator or crystal oscillator between pins XIN and XOUT. Connect AVSS to VSS and AVCC to VCC, respectively. I Input “H” or “L” level signal or leave the pin open. I Input “H” or “L” level signal or leave the pin open. I Input “H” or “L” level signal or leave the pin open. I/O Input “L”. O Serial data output pin. I Serial data input pin. R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group Table 18.8 18. Flash Memory Pin Functions (Flash Memory Standard Serial I/O Mode 3) Pin VCC,VSS Name Power input I/O RESET P4_6/XIN Reset input I P4_6 input/clock input I P4_7/XOUT P4_7 input/clock output AVCC, AVSS Analog power supply input I P1_0 to P1_7 P3_3 to P3_5, P3_7 P4_2/VREF, P4_5 MODE Input port P1 Input port P3 I I Connect AVSS to VSS and AVCC to VCC, respectively. Input “H” or “L” level signal or leave the pin open. Input “H” or “L” level signal or leave the pin open. Input port P4 I Input “H” or “L” level signal or leave the pin open. MODE I/O Serial data I/O pin. Connect to flash programmer. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 270 of 315 Description Apply the voltage guaranteed for programming and erasure to the VCC pin and 0 V to the VSS pin. Reset input pin. Connect a ceramic resonator or crystal oscillator between pins XIN and XOUT when connecting external I/O oscillator. Apply “H” and “L” or leave the pin open when using as input port R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 18. Flash Memory 20 2 19 3 18 R8C/1A, R8C/1B Group RESET 1 4 Connect oscillator circuit(1) VSS 5 6 VCC 7 MODE 8 17 16 15 14 13 9 12 10 11 Package: PLSP0020JB-A NOTE: 1. It is not necessary to connect an oscillating circuit when operating with the on-chip oscillator clock. Mode Setting Figure 18.17 Signal Value MODE Voltage from programmer RESET VSS → VCC Pin Connections for Standard Serial I/O Mode 3 Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 271 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 18.5.1.1 18. Flash Memory Example of Circuit Application in Standard Serial I/O Mode Figure 18.18 shows an example of Pin Processing in Standard Serial I/O Mode 2, and Figure 18.19 shows Pin Processing in Standard Serial I/O Mode 3. Since the controlled pins vary depending on the programmer, refer to the manual of your serial programmer for details. MCU Data Output TXD Data input RXD MODE NOTES: 1. In this example, modes are switched between single-chip mode and standard serial I/O mode by controlling the MODE input with a switch. 2. Connecting an oscillator is necessary. Set the main clock frequency to between 1 MHz and 20 MHz. Refer to “Appendix 2.1 Connection Examples with M16C Flash Starter (M3A-0806)”. Figure 18.18 Pin Processing in Standard Serial I/O Mode 2 MCU MODE I/O MODE Reset input RESET User reset signal NOTES: 1. Controlled pins and external circuits vary depending on the programmer. Refer to the programmer manual for details. 2. In this example, modes are switched between single-chip mode and standard serial I/O mode by connecting a programmer. 3. When operating with the on-chip oscillator clock, it is not necessary to connect an oscillating circuit. Figure 18.19 Pin Processing in Standard Serial I/O Mode 3 Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 272 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 18.6 18. Flash Memory Parallel I/O Mode Parallel I/O mode is used to input and output software commands, addresses, and data necessary to control (read, program, and erase) the on-chip flash memory. Use a parallel programmer which supports this MCU. Contact the manufacturer of the parallel programmer for more information, and refer to the user’s manual of the parallel programmer for details on how to use it. ROM areas shown in Figures 18.1 and 18.2 can be rewritten in parallel I/O mode. 18.6.1 ROM Code Protect Function The ROM code protect function disables the reading and rewriting of the flash memory. (Refer to the 18.3 Functions to Prevent Rewriting of Flash Memory.) Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 273 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 18.7 18. Flash Memory Notes on Flash Memory 18.7.1 CPU Rewrite Mode 18.7.1.1 Operating Speed Before entering CPU rewrite mode (EW0 mode), select 5 MHz or below for the CPU clock using the CM06 bit in the CM0 register and bits CM16 to CM17 in the CM1 register. This does not apply to EW1 mode. 18.7.1.2 Prohibited Instructions The following instructions cannot be used in EW0 mode because they reference data in the flash memory: UND, INTO, and BRK. 18.7.1.3 Interrupts Table 18.9 lists the EW0 Mode Interrupts and Table 18.10 lists the EW1 Mode Interrupts. Table 18.9 Mode EW0 Mode Interrupts When Watchdog Timer, Oscillation Stop Detection and Voltage Monitor 2 Interrupt Request is Acknowledged Any interrupt can be used Once an interrupt request is acknowledged, by allocating a vector in auto-programming or auto-erasure is RAM forcibly stopped immediately and the flash memory is reset. Interrupt handling starts after the fixed period and the flash memory restarts. Since the block during autoerasure or the address during autoprogramming is forcibly stopped, the normal value may not be read. Execute auto-erasure again and ensure it completes normally. Since the watchdog timer does not stop during the command operation, interrupt requests may be generated. Reset the watchdog timer regularly. When Maskable Interrupt Request is Acknowledged Status EW0 During auto-erasure Auto-programming NOTES: 1. Do not use the address match interrupt while a command is being executed because the vector of the address match interrupt is allocated in ROM. 2. Do not use a non-maskable interrupt while block 0 is being automatically erased because the fixed vector is allocated in block 0. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 274 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group Table 18.10 Mode 18. Flash Memory EW1 Mode Interrupts When Watchdog Timer, Oscillation Stop Detection and Voltage Monitor 2 Interrupt Request is Acknowledged Once an interrupt request is Auto-erasure is suspended after td(SR-SUS) and interrupt handling acknowledged, auto-programming or is executed. Auto-erasure can be auto-erasure is forcibly stopped restarted by setting the FMR41 bit immediately and the flash memory is reset. Interrupt handling starts after in the FMR4 register to 0 (erase the fixed period and the flash memory restart) after interrupt handling restarts. Since the block during autocompletes. Auto-erasure has priority and the erasure or the address during autoprogramming is forcibly stopped, the interrupt request normal value may not be read. acknowledgement is put on Execute auto-erasure again and standby. Interrupt handling is ensure it completes normally. executed after auto-erasure Since the watchdog timer does not completes. Auto-programming is suspended stop during the command operation, interrupt requests may be generated. after td(SR-SUS) and interrupt Reset the watchdog timer regularly handling is executed. Autoprogramming can be restarted by using the erase-suspend function. setting the FMR42 bit in the FMR4 register to 0 (program restart) after interrupt handling completes. Auto-programming has priority and the interrupt request acknowledgement is put on standby. Interrupt handling is executed after auto-programming completes. When Maskable Interrupt Request is Acknowledged Status EW1 During auto-erasure (erase- suspend function enabled) During auto-erasure (erase- suspend function disabled) During autoprogramming (program suspend function enabled) During autoprogramming (program suspend function disabled) NOTES: 1. Do not use the address match interrupt while a command is executing because the vector of the address match interrupt is allocated in ROM. 2. Do not use a non-maskable interrupt while block 0 is being automatically erased because the fixed vector is allocated in block 0. 18.7.1.4 How to Access Write 0 before writing 1 when setting the FMR01, FMR02, or FMR11 bit to 1. Do not generate an interrupt between writing 0 and 1. 18.7.1.5 Rewriting User ROM Area In EW0 Mode, if the supply voltage drops while rewriting any block in which a rewrite control program is stored, it may not be possible to rewrite the flash memory because the rewrite control program cannot be rewritten correctly. In this case, use standard serial I/O mode. 18.7.1.6 Program Do not write additions to the already programmed address. 18.7.1.7 Entering Stop Mode or Wait Mode Do not enter stop mode or wait mode during erase-suspend. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 275 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 19. Electrical Characteristics 19. Electrical Characteristics Please contact Renesas Technology sales offices for the electrical characteristics in the Y version (Topr = -20°C to 105°C ). Table 19.1 Absolute Maximum Ratings Symbol VCC AVCC Parameter Supply voltage Analog supply voltage VI VO Pd Topr Tstg Input voltage Output voltage Power dissipation Operating ambient temperature Storage temperature Table 19.2 IOH(peak) IOH(avg) IOL(sum) IOL(peak) IOL(avg) f(XIN) − Topr = 25°C Rated Value -0.3 to 6.5 -0.3 to 6.5 Unit V V -0.3 to VCC+0.3 -0.3 to VCC+0.3 300 -20 to 85 / -40 to 85 (D version) -65 to 150 V V mW °C °C Recommended Operating Conditions Symbol VCC AVCC VSS AVSS VIH VIL IOH(sum) Condition VCC = AVCC VCC = AVCC Parameter Conditions Supply voltage Analog supply voltage Supply voltage Analog supply voltage Input “H” voltage Input “L” voltage Peak sum output Sum of all pins “H” current IOH(peak) Peak output “H” current Average output “H” current Peak sum output Sum of all pins “L” currents IOL(peak) Peak output “L” Except P1_0 to P1_3 currents P1_0 to P1_3 Drive capacity HIGH Drive capacity LOW Average output Except P1_0 to P1_3 “L” current P1_0 to P1_3 Drive capacity HIGH Drive capacity LOW Main clock input oscillation frequency 3.0 V ≤ VCC ≤ 5.5 V 2.7 V ≤ VCC < 3.0 V System clock OCD2 = 0 3.0 V ≤ VCC ≤ 5.5 V Main clock selected 2.7 V ≤ VCC < 3.0 V OCD2 = 1 HRA01 = 0 On-chip oscillator Low-speed on-chip clock selected oscillator clock selected HRA01 = 1 High-speed on-chip oscillator clock selected Min. 2.7 − − − 0.8VCC 0 − Standard Typ. − VCC 0 0 − − − − − − − − − − − − − − − − − − − − − 0 0 0 0 − − − NOTES: 1. VCC = 2.7 to 5.5 V at Topr = -20 to 85 °C / -40 to 85 °C, unless otherwise specified. 2. Typical values when average output current is 100 ms. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 276 of 315 Max. 5.5 − − − VCC 0.2VCC -60 Unit V V V V V V mA -10 -5 60 mA mA mA − 125 10 30 10 5 15 5 20 10 20 10 − mA mA mA mA mA mA MHz MHz MHz MHz kHz 8 − MHz − − R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group Table 19.3 A/D Converter Characteristics Symbol − − 19. Electrical Characteristics Parameter Resolution Absolute accuracy 10-bit mode 8-bit mode 10-bit mode 8-bit mode Rladder tconv Resistor ladder Conversion time Vref VIA Reference voltage − 10-bit mode 8-bit mode Conditions Vref = VCC φAD = 10 MHz, Vref = VCC = 5.0 V φAD = 10 MHz, Vref = VCC = 5.0 V φAD = 10 MHz, Vref = VCC = 3.3 V(3) φAD = 10 MHz, Vref = VCC = 3.3 V(3) Vref = VCC φAD = 10 MHz, Vref = VCC = 5.0 V φAD = 10 MHz, Vref = VCC = 5.0 V Analog input voltage(4) A/D operating Without sample and clock hold frequency(2) With sample and hold Min. − − − − Standard Typ. − − − − Max. 10 ±3 ±2 ±5 Bits LSB LSB LSB Unit − − ±2 LSB 10 3.3 2.8 2.7 0 − − 40 − − Vcc AVcc kΩ µs µs V V 0.25 − 10 MHz 1 − 10 MHz − − − NOTES: 1. VCC = AVCC = 2.7 to 5.5 V at Topr = -20 to 85 °C / -40 to 85 °C, unless otherwise specified. 2. If f1 exceeds 10 MHz, divide f1 and ensure the A/D operating clock frequency (φAD) is 10 MHz or below. 3. If AVcc is less than 4.2 V, divide f1 and ensure the A/D operating clock frequency (φAD) is f1/2 or below. 4. When the analog input voltage is over the reference voltage, the A/D conversion result will be 3FFh in 10-bit mode and FFh in 8-bit mode. P1 P3 P4 Figure 19.1 Port P1, P3, and P4 Measurement Circuit Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 277 of 315 30pF R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group Table 19.4 Flash Memory (Program ROM) Electrical Characteristics Symbol − − Parameter Program/erase endurance(2) − Byte program time Block erase time Time delay from suspend request until suspend Interval from erase start/restart until following suspend request Interval from program start/restart until following suspend request Time from suspend until program/erase restart Program, erase voltage Read voltage Program, erase temperature − Data hold time(8) − td(SR-SUS) − − − − − 19. Electrical Characteristics Conditions Min. Standard Typ. − Unit Max. − times R8C/1A Group 100(3) R8C/1B Group 1,000(3) − − − − − times 50 0.4 − µs 650 − 400 9 97+CPU clock × 6 cycles − µs 0 − − ns − − µs 2.7 2.7 0 20 − 3+CPU clock × 4 cycles 5.5 5.5 60 − Ambient temperature = 55 °C − − − s µs V V °C year NOTES: 1. VCC = 2.7 to 5.5 V at Topr = 0 to 60 °C, unless otherwise specified. 2. Definition of programming/erasure endurance The programming and erasure endurance is defined on a per-block basis. If the programming and erasure endurance is n (n = 100 or 10,000), each block can be erased n times. For example, if 1,024 1-byte writes are performed to block A, a 1 Kbyte block, and then the block is erased, the programming/erasure endurance still stands at one. However, the same address must not be programmed more than once per erase operation (overwriting prohibited). 3. Endurance to guarantee all electrical characteristics after program and erase. (1 to Min. value can be guaranteed). 4. If emergency processing is required, a suspend request can be generated independent of this characteristic. In that case the normal time delay to suspend can be applied to the request. However, we recommend that a suspend request with an interval of less than 650 µs is only used once because, if the suspend state continues, erasure cannot operate and the incidence of erasure error rises. 5. In a system that executes multiple programming operations, the actual erasure count can be reduced by writing to sequential addresses in turn so that as much of the block as possible is used up before performing an erase operation. For example, when programming groups of 16 bytes, the effective number of rewrites can be minimized by programming up to 128 groups before erasing them all in one operation. In addition, averaging the number of erase operations between block A and block B can further reduce the effective number of rewrites. It is also advisable to retain data on the erase count of each block and limit the number of erase operations to a certain number. 6. If an error occurs during block erase, attempt to execute the clear status register command, then execute the block erase command at least three times until the erase error does not occur. 7. Customers desiring programming/erasure failure rate information should contact their Renesas technical support representative. 8. The data hold time includes time that the power supply is off or the clock is not supplied. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 278 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group Table 19.5 Flash Memory (Data flash Block A, Block B) Electrical Characteristics Symbol − Parameter − Program/erase endurance(2) Byte program time (Program/erase endurance ≤ 1,000 times) Byte program time (Program/erase endurance > 1,000 times) Block erase time (Program/erase endurance ≤ 1,000 times) Block erase time (Program/erase endurance > 1,000 times) Time Delay from suspend request until suspend Interval from erase start/restart until following suspend request Interval from program start/restart until following suspend request Time from suspend until program/erase restart Program, erase voltage Read voltage Program, erase temperature − Data hold time(9) − − − − td(SR-SUS) − − − − − 19. Electrical Characteristics Conditions Min. Unit Max. − times 50 400 µs − 65 − µs − 0.2 9 s − 0.3 − s − − µs 650 − 97+CPU clock × 6 cycles − µs 0 − − ns − − µs 2.7 2.7 − -20(8) 20 − 3+CPU clock × 4 cycles 5.5 5.5 85 − − year 10,000(3) − Ambient temperature = 55 °C Standard Typ. − − V V °C NOTES: 1. VCC = 2.7 to 5.5 V at Topr = −20 to 85 °C / −40 to 85 °C, unless otherwise specified. 2. Definition of programming/erasure endurance The programming and erasure endurance is defined on a per-block basis. If the programming and erasure endurance is n (n = 100 or 10,000), each block can be erased n times. For example, if 1,024 1-byte writes are performed to block A, a 1 Kbyte block, and then the block is erased, the programming/erasure endurance still stands at one. However, the same address must not be programmed more than once per erase operation (overwriting prohibited). 3. Endurance to guarantee all electrical characteristics after program and erase. (1 to Min. value can be guaranteed). 4. If emergency processing is required, a suspend request can be generated independent of this characteristic. In that case the normal time delay to suspend can be applied to the request. However, we recommend that a suspend request with an interval of less than 650 µs is only used once because, if the suspend state continues, erasure cannot operate and the incidence of erasure error rises. 5. In a system that executes multiple programming operations, the actual erasure count can be reduced by writing to sequential addresses in turn so that as much of the block as possible is used up before performing an erase operation. For example, when programming groups of 16 bytes, the effective number of rewrites can be minimized by programming up to 128 groups before erasing them all in one operation. It is also advisable to retain data on the erase count of each block and limit the number of erase operations to a certain number. 6. If an error occurs during block erase, attempt to execute the clear status register command, then execute the block erase command at least three times until the erase error does not occur. 7. Customers desiring programming/erasure failure rate information should contact their Renesas technical support representative. 8. -40 °C for D version. 9. The data hold time includes time that the power supply is off or the clock is not supplied. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 279 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 19. Electrical Characteristics Suspend request (maskable interrupt request) FMR46 Clockdependent time Fixed time (97 µs) Access restart td(SR-SUS) Figure 19.2 Table 19.6 Transition Time to Suspend Voltage Detection 1 Circuit Electrical Characteristics Symbol Vdet1 − td(E-A) Vccmin Parameter Voltage detection level(3) Voltage detection circuit self power consumption Waiting time until voltage detection circuit operation starts(2) MCU operating voltage minimum value Condition VCA26 = 1, VCC = 5.0 V Min. 2.70 − Standard Typ. Max. 2.85 3.00 − Unit V − 600 − 100 nA µs 2.7 − − V NOTES: 1. The measurement condition is VCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V and Topr = -40°C to 85 °C. 2. Necessary time until the voltage detection circuit operates when setting to 1 again after setting the VCA26 bit in the VCA2 register to 0. 3. Ensure that Vdet2 > Vdet1. Table 19.7 Voltage Detection 2 Circuit Electrical Characteristics Symbol Parameter Vdet2 Voltage detection level(4) − Voltage monitor 2 interrupt request generation time(2) Voltage detection circuit self power consumption Waiting time until voltage detection circuit operation starts(3) − td(E-A) Condition VCA27 = 1, VCC = 5.0 V Min. 3.00 Standard Typ. Max. 3.30 3.60 Unit V − 40 − µs − 600 − − 100 nA µs − NOTES: 1. The measurement condition is VCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V and Topr = -40°C to 85 °C. 2. Time until the voltage monitor 2 interrupt request is generated after the voltage passes Vdet2. 3. Necessary time until the voltage detection circuit operates when setting to 1 again after setting the VCA27 bit in the VCA2 register to 0. 4. Ensure that Vdet2 > Vdet1. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 280 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group Table 19.8 19. Electrical Characteristics Reset Circuit Electrical Characteristics (When Using Voltage Monitor 1 Reset) Symbol Parameter Condition Power-on reset valid voltage Vpor2 tw(Vpor2-Vdet1) Supply voltage rising time when power-on reset is deasserted(1) Standard Typ. Max. − Vdet1 − 100 Min. − − -20°C ≤ Topr ≤ 85°C -20°C ≤ Topr ≤ 85°C, tw(por2) ≥ 0s(3) Unit V ms NOTES: 1. This condition is not applicable when using with Vcc ≥ 1.0 V. 2. When turning power on after the time to hold the external power below effective voltage (Vpor1) exceeds10 s, refer to Table 19.9 Reset Circuit Electrical Characteristics (When Not Using Voltage Monitor 1 Reset). 3. tw(por2) is the time to hold the external power below effective voltage (Vpor2). Table 19.9 Reset Circuit Electrical Characteristics (When Not Using Voltage Monitor 1 Reset) Symbol Parameter Condition Vpor1 tw(Vpor1-Vdet1) Power-on reset valid voltage Supply voltage rising time when power-on reset is deasserted tw(Vpor1-Vdet1) Supply voltage rising time when power-on reset is deasserted tw(Vpor1-Vdet1) Supply voltage rising time when power-on reset is deasserted tw(Vpor1-Vdet1) Supply voltage rising time when power-on reset is deasserted -20°C ≤ Topr ≤ 85°C 0°C ≤ Topr ≤ 85°C, tw(por1) ≥ 10 s(2) -20°C ≤ Topr < 0°C, tw(por1) ≥ 30 s(2) -20°C ≤ Topr < 0°C, tw(por1) ≥ 10 s(2) 0°C ≤ Topr ≤ 85°C, tw(por1) ≥ 1 s(2) Min. − − Standard Typ. Max. − 0.1 − 100 Unit V ms − − 100 ms − − 1 ms − − 0.5 ms NOTES: 1. When not using voltage monitor 1, use with Vcc≥ 2.7 V. 2. tw(por1) is the time to hold the external power below effective voltage (Vpor1). Vdet1(3) Vdet1(3) Vccmin Vpor2 Vpor1 tw(por1) tw(Vpor1–Vdet1) Sampling time(1, 2) tw(por2) tw(Vpor2–Vdet1) Internal reset signal (“L” valid) 1 × 32 fRING-S 1 × 32 fRING-S NOTES: 1. Hold the voltage inside the MCU operation voltage range (Vccmin or above) within the sampling time. 2. The sampling clock can be selected. Refer to 7. Voltage Detection Circuit for details. 3. Vdet1 indicates the voltage detection level of the voltage detection 1 circuit. Refer to 7. Voltage Detection Circuit for details. Figure 19.3 Reset Circuit Electrical Characteristics Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 281 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group Table 19.10 19. Electrical Characteristics High-Speed On-Chip Oscillator Circuit Electrical Characteristics Symbol Parameter − High-speed on-chip oscillator frequency when the reset is deasserted High-speed on-chip oscillator frequency temperature • supply voltage dependence(2) − Condition Standard Typ. Max. 8 − Unit VCC = 5.0 V, Topr = 25 °C Min. − 0 to +60 °C/5 V ± 5 %(3) 7.76 − 8.24 MHz -20 to +85 °C/2.7 to 5.5 V(3) 7.68 − 8.32 MHz -40 to +85 °C/2.7 to 5.5 V(3) 7.44 − 8.32 MHz MHz NOTES: 1. The measurement condition is VCC = 5.0 V and Topr = 25 °C. 2. Refer to 10.6.5 High-Speed On-Chip Oscillator Clock for notes on high-speed on-chip oscillator clock. 3. The standard value shows when the HRA1 register is assumed as the value in shipping and the HRA2 register value is set to 00h. Table 19.11 Power Supply Circuit Timing Characteristics Symbol Parameter td(P-R) Time for internal power supply stabilization during power-on(2) td(R-S) STOP exit time(3) Condition NOTES: 1. The measurement condition is VCC = 2.7 to 5.5 V and Topr = 25 °C. 2. Waiting time until the internal power supply generation circuit stabilizes during power-on. 3. Time until CPU clock supply starts after the interrupt is acknowledged to exit stop mode. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 282 of 315 Min. 1 − Standard Typ. Max. − 2000 − 150 Unit µs µs R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group Table 19.12 19. Electrical Characteristics Timing Requirements of Clock Synchronous Serial I/O with Chip Select(1) Symbol Parameter Conditions Standard Typ. − tSUCYC SSCK clock cycle time tHI tLO tRISE SSCK clock “H” width SSCK clock “L” width SSCK clock rising time Master 0.4 0.4 − − − − tFALL SSCK clock falling time Slave Master − − Slave 1 SSO, SSI data input setup time SSO, SSI data input hold time − 100 1 − tSU tH − − tCYC(2) µs ns − − tCYC(2) tLEAD SCS setup time Slave 1tCYC+50 − − ns 1tCYC+50 − − ns tOD SCS hold time SSO, SSI data output delay time Slave − − 1 tSA tOR SSI slave access time SSI slave out open time − − − − 1.5tCYC+100 1.5tCYC+100 tCYC(2) ns ns tLAG NOTES: 1. VCC = 2.7 to 5.5V, VSS = 0V at Ta = -20 to 85 °C / -40 to 85 °C, unless otherwise specified. 2. 1tCYC = 1/f1(s) Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 283 of 315 − − Max. − Unit Min. 4 0.6 0.6 1 1 1 tCYC(2) tSUCYC tSUCYC tCYC(2) µs R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 19. Electrical Characteristics 4-Wire Bus Communication Mode, Master, CPHS = 1 VIH or VOH SCS (output) VIH or VOH tHI tFALL tRISE SSCK (output) (CPOS = 1) tLO tHI SSCK (output) (CPOS = 0) tLO tSUCYC SSO (output) tOD SSI (input) tSU tH 4-Wire Bus Communication Mode, Master, CPHS = 0 VIH or VOH SCS (output) VIH or VOH tHI tFALL tRISE SSCK (output) (CPOS = 1) tLO tHI SSCK (output) (CPOS = 0) tLO tSUCYC SSO (output) tOD SSI (input) tSU tH CPHS, CPOS: Bits in SSMR register Figure 19.4 I/O Timing of Clock Synchronous Serial I/O with Chip Select (Master) Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 284 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 19. Electrical Characteristics 4-Wire Bus Communication Mode, Slave, CPHS = 1 VIH or VOH SCS (input) VIH or VOH tLEAD tHI tFALL tRISE tLAG SSCK (input) (CPOS = 1) tLO tHI SSCK (input) (CPOS = 0) tLO tSUCYC SSO (input) tSU tH SSI (output) tSA tOD tOR 4-Wire Bus Communication Mode, Slave, CPHS = 0 VIH or VOH SCS (input) VIH or VOH tLEAD tHI tFALL tRISE tLAG SSCK (input) (CPOS = 1) tLO tHI SSCK (input) (CPOS = 0) tLO tSUCYC SSO (input) tSU tH SSI (output) tSA tOD tOR CPHS, CPOS: Bits in SSMR register Figure 19.5 I/O Timing of Clock Synchronous Serial I/O with Chip Select (Slave) Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 285 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 19. Electrical Characteristics tHI VIH or VOH SSCK VIH or VOH tLO tSUCYC SSO (output) tOD SSI (input) tSU Figure 19.6 tH I/O Timing of Clock Synchronous Serial I/O with Chip Select (Clock Synchronous Communication Mode) Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 286 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group Table 19.13 19. Electrical Characteristics Timing Requirements of I2C bus Interface (1) Symbol Parameter Condition tSCL SCL input cycle time tSCLH SCL input “H” width tSCLL SCL input “L” width tsf tSP SCL, SDA input fall time SCL, SDA input spike pulse rejection time tBUF Standard Typ. (2) − 12tCYC+600 (2) − 3tCYC+300 Min. Max. − − Unit ns ns 5tCYC+300(2) − − − − ns − 300 − SDA input bus-free time 5tCYC(2) − 1tCYC(2) − ns ns tSTAH Start condition input hold time 3tCYC(2) − − ns tSTAS Retransmit start condition input setup time 3tCYC(2) − − ns tSTOS Stop condition input setup time 3tCYC(2) − − ns tSDAS Data input setup time − − ns tSDAH Data input hold time 1tCYC+20(2) 0 − − ns NOTES: 1. VCC = 2.7 to 5.5 V, VSS = 0 V and Ta = -20 to 85 °C / -40 to 85 °C, unless otherwise specified. 2. 1tCYC = 1/f1(s) VIH SDA VIL tBUF tSTAH tSCLH tSTAS tSP tSTOS SCL P(2) S(1) tsf Sr(3) tSCLL tSDAS tSCL NOTES: 1. Start condition 2. Stop condition 3. Retransmit start condition Figure 19.7 I/O Timing of I2C bus Interface Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 P(2) Page 287 of 315 tSDAH ns R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group Table 19.14 Electrical Characteristics (1) [VCC = 5 V] Symbol VOH 19. Electrical Characteristics IOH = -1 mA Standard Min. Typ. VCC − 2.0 − VCC − 0.3 − VCC − 2.0 − Max. VCC VCC VCC IOH = -500 µA VCC − 2.0 − VCC V − − − − IOL = 15 mA − − 2.0 0.45 2.0 V V V IOL = 5 mA − − 2.0 V IOL = 200 µA − − 0.45 V IOL = 1 mA − − 2.0 V IOL = 500 µA − − 2.0 V INT0, INT1, INT3, KI0, KI1, KI2, KI3, CNTR0, CNTR1, TCIN, RXD0 0.2 − 1.0 V RESET 0.2 − 2.2 V − − − 30 − 40 2.0 50 1.0 125 − 5.0 -5.0 167 − 250 − µA − Parameter Output “H” voltage Except XOUT XOUT VOL Output “L” voltage Except P1_0 to P1_3, XOUT P1_0 to P1_3 XOUT VT+-VT- IIH IIL RPULLUP RfXIN fRING-S VRAM Hysteresis Input “H” current Input “L” current Pull-up resistance Feedback resistance XIN Low-speed on-chip oscillator frequency RAM hold voltage Condition IOH = -5 mA IOH = -200 µA Drive capacity HIGH Drive capacity LOW IOL = 5 mA IOL = 200 µA Drive capacity HIGH Drive capacity LOW Drive capacity LOW Drive capacity HIGH Drive capacity LOW VI = 5 V VI = 0 V VI = 0 V During stop mode NOTE: 1. VCC = 4.2 to 5.5 V at Topr = -20 to 85 °C / -40 to 85 °C, f(XIN) = 20 MHz, unless otherwise specified. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 288 of 315 Unit V V V µA kΩ MΩ kHz V R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group Table 19.15 Symbol ICC 19. Electrical Characteristics Electrical Characteristics (2) [Vcc = 5 V] (Topr = -40 to 85 °C, unless otherwise specified.) Parameter Condition Power supply current High-speed (VCC = 3.3 to 5.5 V) mode Single-chip mode, output pins are open, other pins are VSS, A/D converter is stopped Mediumspeed mode High-speed on-chip oscillator mode Low-speed on-chip oscillator mode Wait mode Wait mode Stop mode Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 XIN = 20 MHz (square wave) High-speed on-chip oscillator off Low-speed on-chip oscillator on = 125 kHz No division XIN = 16 MHz (square wave) High-speed on-chip oscillator off Low-speed on-chip oscillator on = 125 kHz No division XIN = 10 MHz (square wave) High-speed on-chip oscillator off Low-speed on-chip oscillator on = 125 kHz No division XIN = 20 MHz (square wave) High-speed on-chip oscillator off Low-speed on-chip oscillator on = 125 kHz Divide-by-8 XIN = 16 MHz (square wave) High-speed on-chip oscillator off Low-speed on-chip oscillator on = 125 kHz Divide-by-8 XIN = 10 MHz (square wave) High-speed on-chip oscillator off Low-speed on-chip oscillator on = 125 kHz Divide-by-8 Main clock off High-speed on-chip oscillator on = 8 MHz Low-speed on-chip oscillator on = 125 kHz No division Main clock off High-speed on-chip oscillator on = 8 MHz Low-speed on-chip oscillator on = 125 kHz Divide-by-8 Main clock off High-speed on-chip oscillator off Low-speed on-chip oscillator on = 125 kHz Divide-by-8 FMR47 = 1 Main clock off High-speed on-chip oscillator off Low-speed on-chip oscillator on = 125 kHz While a WAIT instruction is executed Peripheral clock operation VCA27 = VCA26 = 0 Main clock off High-speed on-chip oscillator off Low-speed on-chip oscillator on = 125 kHz While a WAIT instruction is executed Peripheral clock off VCA27 = VCA26 = 0 Main clock off, Topr = 25 °C High-speed on-chip oscillator off Low-speed on-chip oscillator off CM10 = 1 Peripheral clock off VCA27 = VCA26 = 0 Page 289 of 315 Min. − Standard Typ. 9 Max. 15 − 8 14 mA − 5 − mA − 4 − mA − 3 − mA − 2 − mA − 4 8 mA − 1.5 − mA − 110 300 µA − 40 80 µA − 38 76 µA − 0.8 3.0 µA Unit mA R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 19. Electrical Characteristics Timing Requirements (Unless otherwise specified: VCC = 5 V, VSS = 0 V at Ta = 25 °C) [ VCC = 5 V ] Table 19.16 XIN Input Symbol tc(XIN) tWH(XIN) tWL(XIN) Standard Min. Max. 50 − 25 − 25 − Parameter XIN input cycle time XIN input “H” width XIN input “L” width Unit ns ns ns VCC = 5 V tc(XIN) tWH(XIN) XIN input tWL(XIN) Figure 19.8 Table 19.17 XIN Input Timing Diagram when VCC = 5 V CNTR0 Input, CNTR1 Input, INT1 Input Symbol tc(CNTR0) tWH(CNTR0) tWL(CNTR0) Standard Min. Max. 100 − 40 − 40 − Parameter CNTR0 input cycle time CNTR0 input “H” width CNTR0 input “L” width Unit ns ns ns VCC = 5 V tc(CNTR0) tWH(CNTR0) CNTR0 input tWL(CNTR0) Figure 19.9 Table 19.18 CNTR0 Input, CNTR1 Input, INT1 Input Timing Diagram when VCC = 5 V TCIN Input, INT3 Input tc(TCIN) TCIN input cycle time Standard Min. Max. − 400(1) tWH(TCIN) TCIN input “H” width 200(2) − ns tWL(TCIN) TCIN input “L” width 200(2) − ns Symbol Parameter Unit ns NOTES: 1. When using timer C input capture mode, adjust the cycle time to (1/timer C count source frequency x 3) or above. 2. When using timer C input capture mode, adjust the pulse width to (1/timer C count source frequency x 1.5) or above. VCC = 5 V tc(TCIN) tWH(TCIN) TCIN input tWL(TCIN) Figure 19.10 TCIN Input, INT3 Input Timing Diagram when VCC = 5 V Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 290 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group Table 19.19 19. Electrical Characteristics Serial Interface Symbol tc(CK) tW(CKH) tW(CKL) td(C-Q) th(C-Q) tsu(D-C) th(C-D) Standard Min. Max. 200 − 100 − 100 − − 50 0 − 50 − 90 − Parameter CLKi input cycle time CLKi input “H” width CLKi input “L” width TXDi output delay time TXDi hold time RXDi input setup time RXDi input hold time Unit ns ns ns ns ns ns ns i = 0 or 1 VCC = 5 V tc(CK) tW(CKH) CLKi tW(CKL) th(C-Q) TXDi td(C-Q) tsu(D-C) th(C-D) RXDi i = 0 or 1 Figure 19.11 Table 19.20 Serial Interface Timing Diagram when VCC = 5 V External Interrupt INT0 Input INT0 input “H” width Standard Min. Max. − 250(1) INT0 input “L” width 250(2) Symbol tW(INH) tW(INL) Parameter − Unit ns ns NOTES: 1. When selecting the digital filter by the INT0 input filter select bit, use an INT0 input HIGH width of either (1/digital filter clock frequency x 3) or the minimum value of standard, whichever is greater. 2. When selecting the digital filter by the INT0 input filter select bit, use an INT0 input LOW width of either (1/digital filter clock frequency x 3) or the minimum value of standard, whichever is greater. VCC = 5 V tW(INL) INT0 input tW(INH) Figure 19.12 External Interrupt INT0 Input Timing Diagram when VCC = 5 V Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 291 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group Table 19.21 Electrical Characteristics (3) [VCC = 3V] Symbol VOH VOL 19. Electrical Characteristics Parameter Output “H” voltage Output “L” voltage Except XOUT XOUT Except P1_0 to P1_3, XOUT P1_0 to P1_3 XOUT VT+-VT- Hysteresis IIH IIL RPULLUP RfXIN fRING-S VRAM RESET Input “H” current Input “L” current Pull-up resistance Feedback resistance XIN Low-speed on-chip oscillator frequency RAM hold voltage IOH = -0.1 mA Standard Min. Typ. VCC − 0.5 − VCC − 0.5 − Max. VCC VCC IOH = -50 µA VCC − 0.5 − VCC V − − 0.5 V IOL = 2 mA − − 0.5 V IOL = 1 mA − − 0.5 V IOL = 0.1 mA − − 0.5 V IOL = 50 µA − − 0.5 V 0.2 − 0.8 V 0.2 − 1.8 V − − µA − 66 − 40 2.0 − 160 3.0 125 − 4.0 -4.0 500 − 250 − Condition IOH = -1 mA Drive capacity HIGH Drive capacity LOW IOL = 1 mA Drive capacity HIGH Drive capacity LOW Drive capacity HIGH Drive capacity LOW INT0, INT1, INT3, KI0, KI1, KI2, KI3, CNTR0, CNTR1, TCIN, RXD0 VI = 3 V VI = 0 V VI = 0 V During stop mode NOTE: 1. VCC = 2.7 to 3.3 V at Topr = -20 to 85 °C / -40 to 85 °C, f(XIN) = 10 MHz, unless otherwise specified. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 292 of 315 Unit V V µA kΩ MΩ kHz V R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group Table 19.22 Symbol ICC 19. Electrical Characteristics Electrical Characteristics (4) [Vcc = 3 V] (Topr = -40 to 85 °C, unless otherwise specified.) Parameter Condition Power supply current High-speed (VCC = 2.7 to 3.3 V) mode Single-chip mode, output pins are open, other pins are VSS, A/D converter is stopped Mediumspeed mode High-speed on-chip oscillator mode Low-speed on-chip oscillator mode Wait mode Wait mode Stop mode Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 XIN = 20 MHz (square wave) High-speed on-chip oscillator off Low-speed on-chip oscillator on = 125 kHz No division XIN = 16 MHz (square wave) High-speed on-chip oscillator off Low-speed on-chip oscillator on = 125 kHz No division XIN = 10 MHz (square wave) High-speed on-chip oscillator off Low-speed on-chip oscillator on = 125 kHz No division XIN = 20 MHz (square wave) High-speed on-chip oscillator off Low-speed on-chip oscillator on = 125 kHz Divide-by-8 XIN = 16 MHz (square wave) High-speed on-chip oscillator off Low-speed on-chip oscillator on = 125 kHz Divide-by-8 XIN = 10 MHz (square wave) High-speed on-chip oscillator off Low-speed on-chip oscillator on = 125 kHz Divide-by-8 Main clock off High-speed on-chip oscillator on = 8 MHz Low-speed on-chip oscillator on = 125 kHz No division Main clock off High-speed on-chip oscillator on = 8 MHz Low-speed on-chip oscillator on = 125 kHz Divide-by-8 Main clock off High-speed on-chip oscillator off Low-speed on-chip oscillator on = 125 kHz Divide-by-8 FMR47 = 1 Main clock off High-speed on-chip oscillator off Low-speed on-chip oscillator on = 125 kHz While a WAIT instruction is executed Peripheral clock operation VCA27 = VCA26 = 0 Main clock off High-speed on-chip oscillator off Low-speed on-chip oscillator on = 125 kHz While a WAIT instruction is executed Peripheral clock off VCA27 = VCA26 = 0 Main clock off, Topr = 25 °C High-speed on-chip oscillator off Low-speed on-chip oscillator off CM10 = 1 Peripheral clock off VCA27 = VCA26 = 0 Page 293 of 315 Min. − Standard Typ. 8 Max. 13 − 7 12 mA − 5 − mA − 3 − mA − 2.5 − mA − 1.6 − mA − 3.5 7.5 mA − 1.5 − mA − 100 280 µA − 37 74 µA − 35 70 µA − 0.7 3.0 µA Unit mA R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 19. Electrical Characteristics Timing requirements (Unless Otherwise Specified: VCC = 3 V, VSS = 0 V at Ta = 25 °C) [VCC = 3 V] Table 19.23 XIN Input Symbol tc(XIN) tWH(XIN) tWL(XIN) Standard Min. Max. 100 − 40 − 40 − Parameter XIN input cycle time XIN input “H” width XIN input “L” width Unit ns ns ns VCC = 3 V tc(XIN) tWH(XIN) XIN input tWL(XIN) Figure 19.13 Table 19.24 XIN Input Timing Diagram when VCC = 3 V CNTR0 Input, CNTR1 Input, INT1 Input Symbol tc(CNTR0) tWH(CNTR0) tWL(CNTR0) Standard Min. Max. 300 − 120 − 120 − Parameter CNTR0 input cycle time CNTR0 input “H” width CNTR0 input “L” width Unit ns ns ns VCC = 3 V tc(CNTR0) tWH(CNTR0) CNTR0 input tWL(CNTR0) Figure 19.14 Table 19.25 CNTR0 Input, CNTR1 Input, INT1 Input Timing Diagram when VCC = 3 V TCIN Input, INT3 Input Symbol Standard Min. Max. − 1,200(1) Parameter Unit tc(TCIN) TCIN input cycle time tWH(TCIN) TCIN input “H” width 600(2) − ns tWL(TCIN) TCIN input “L” width 600(2) − ns ns NOTES: 1. When using the timer C input capture mode, adjust the cycle time to (1/timer C count source frequency x 3) or above. 2. When using the timer C input capture mode, adjust the width to (1/timer C count source frequency x 1.5) or above. VCC = 3 V tc(TCIN) tWH(TCIN) TCIN input tWL(TCIN) Figure 19.15 TCIN Input, INT3 Input Timing Diagram when VCC = 3 V Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 294 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group Table 19.26 19. Electrical Characteristics Serial Interface Symbol tc(CK) tW(CKH) tW(CKL) td(C-Q) th(C-Q) tsu(D-C) th(C-D) Standard Min. Max. 300 − 150 − 150 − − 80 0 − 70 − 90 − Parameter CLKi input cycle time CLKi input “H” width CLKi input “L” width TXDi output delay time TXDi hold time RXDi input setup time RXDi input hold time Unit ns ns ns ns ns ns ns i = 0 or 1 VCC = 3 V tc(CK) tW(CKH) CLKi tW(CKL) th(C-Q) TXDi td(C-Q) tsu(D-C) th(C-D) RXDi i = 0 or 1 Figure 19.16 Table 19.27 Serial Interface Timing Diagram when VCC = 3 V External Interrupt INT0 Input INT0 input “H” width Standard Min. Max. − 380(1) INT0 input “L” width 380(2) Symbol tW(INH) tW(INL) Parameter − Unit ns ns NOTES: 1. When selecting the digital filter by the INT0 input filter select bit, use an INT0 input HIGH width of either (1/digital filter clock frequency x 3) or the minimum value of standard, whichever is greater 2. When selecting the digital filter by the INT0 input filter select bit, use an INT0 input LOW width of either (1/digital filter clock frequency x 3) or the minimum value of standard, whichever is greater VCC = 3 V tW(INL) INT0 input tW(INH) Figure 19.17 External Interrupt INT0 Input Timing Diagram when VCC = 3 V Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 295 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 20. Usage Notes 20. Usage Notes 20.1 Notes on Clock Generation Circuit 20.1.1 Stop Mode When entering stop mode, set the FMR01 bit in the FMR0 register to 0 (CPU rewrite mode disabled) and the CM10 bit in the CM1 register to 1 (stop mode). An instruction queue pre-reads 4 bytes from the instruction which sets the CM10 bit to 1 (stop mode) and the program stops. Insert at least 4 NOP instructions following the JMP.B instruction after the instruction which sets the CM10 bit to 1. • Program example to enter stop mode BCLR BSET FSET BSET JMP.B LABEL_001 : NOP NOP NOP NOP 20.1.2 1,FMR0 0,PRCR I 0,CM1 LABEL_001 ; CPU rewrite mode disabled ; Protect disabled ; Enable interrupt ; Stop mode Wait Mode When entering wait mode, set the FMR01 bit in the FMR0 register to 0 (CPU rewrite mode disabled) and execute the WAIT instruction. An instruction queue pre-reads 4 bytes from the WAIT instruction and the program stops. Insert at least 4 NOP instructions after the WAIT instruction. • Program example to execute the WAIT instruction BCLR 1,FMR0 FSET I WAIT NOP NOP NOP NOP 20.1.3 ; CPU rewrite mode disabled ; Enable interrupt ; Wait mode Oscillation Stop Detection Function Since the oscillation stop detection function cannot be used if the main clock frequency is below 2 MHz, set bits OCD1 to OCD0 to 00b (oscillation stop detection function disabled) in this case. 20.1.4 Oscillation Circuit Constants Ask the manufacturer of the oscillator to specify the best oscillation circuit constants for your system. 20.1.5 High-Speed On-Chip Oscillator Clock The high-speed on-chip oscillator frequency may be changed up to 10%(1) in flash memory CPU rewrite mode during auto-program operation or auto-erase operation. The high-speed on-chip oscillator frequency after auto-program operation ends or auto-erase operation ends is held the state before the program command or block erase command is generated. Also, this note is not applicable when the read array command, read status register command, or clear status register command is generated. The application products must be designed with careful considerations for the frequency change. NOTE: 1.Change ratio to 8 MHz frequency adjusted in shipping. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 296 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 20.2 20. Usage Notes Notes on Interrupts 20.2.1 Reading Address 00000h Do not read address 00000h by a program. When a maskable interrupt request is acknowledged, the CPU reads interrupt information (interrupt number and interrupt request level) from 00000h in the interrupt sequence. At this time, the acknowledged interrupt IR bit is set to 0. If address 00000h is read by a program, the IR bit for the interrupt which has the highest priority among the enabled interrupts is set to 0. This may cause the interrupt to be canceled, or an unexpected interrupt to be generated. 20.2.2 SP Setting Set any value in the SP before an interrupt is acknowledged. The SP is set to 0000h after reset. Therefore, if an interrupt is acknowledged before setting a value in the SP, the program may run out of control. 20.2.3 External Interrupt and Key Input Interrupt Either “L” level or “H” level of at least 250 ns width is necessary for the signal input to pins INT0 to INT3 and pins KI0 to KI3, regardless of the CPU clock. 20.2.4 Watchdog Timer Interrupt Reset the watchdog timer after a watchdog timer interrupt is generated. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 297 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 20.2.5 20. Usage Notes Changing Interrupt Sources The IR bit in the interrupt control register may be set to 1 (interrupt requested) when the interrupt source changes. When using an interrupt, set the IR bit to 0 (no interrupt requested) after changing the interrupt source. In addition, changes of interrupt sources include all factors that change the interrupt sources assigned to individual software interrupt numbers, polarities, and timing. Therefore, if a mode change of a peripheral function involves interrupt sources, edge polarities, and timing, set the IR bit to 0 (no interrupt requested) after the change. Refer to the individual peripheral function for its related interrupts. Figure 20.1 shows an Example of Procedure for Changing Interrupt Sources. Interrupt source change Disable interrupts(2, 3) Change interrupt source (including mode of peripheral function) Set the IR bit to 0 (interrupt not requested) using the MOV instruction(3) Enable interrupts (2, 3) Change completed IR bit: The interrupt control register bit of an interrupt whose source is changed. NOTES: 1. Execute the above settings individually. Do not execute two or more settings at once (by one instruction). 2. Use the I flag for the INTi (i = 0 to 3) interrupts. To prevent interrupt requests from being generated when using peripheral function interrupts other than the INTi interrupt, disable the peripheral function before changing the interrupt source. In this case, use the I flag if all maskable interrupts can be disabled. If all maskable interrupts cannot be disabled, use bits ILVL0 to ILVL2 of the interrupt whose source is changed. 3. Refer to 12.5.6 Changing Interrupt Control Register for the instructions to be used and usage notes. Figure 20.1 Example of Procedure for Changing Interrupt Sources Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 298 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 20.2.6 20. Usage Notes Changing Interrupt Control Register Contents (a) The contents of an interrupt control register can only be changed while no interrupt requests corresponding to that register are generated. If interrupt requests may be generated, disable interrupts before changing the interrupt control register contents. (b) When changing the contents of an interrupt control register after disabling interrupts, be careful to choose appropriate instructions. Changing any bit other than IR bit If an interrupt request corresponding to a register is generated while executing the instruction, the IR bit may not be set to 1 (interrupt requested), and the interrupt request may be ignored. If this causes a problem, use the following instructions to change the register: AND, OR, BCLR, BSET Changing IR bit If the IR bit is set to 0 (interrupt not requested), it may not be set to 0 depending on the instruction used. Therefore, use the MOV instruction to set the IR bit to 0. (c) When disabling interrupts using the I flag, set the I flag as shown in the sample programs below. Refer to (b) regarding changing the contents of interrupt control registers by the sample programs. Sample programs 1 to 3 are for preventing the I flag from being set to 1 (interrupts enabled) before the interrupt control register is changed for reasons of the internal bus or the instruction queue buffer. Example 1: Use NOP instructions to prevent I flag from being set to 1 before interrupt control register is changed INT_SWITCH1: FCLR I ; Disable interrupts AND.B #00H,0056H ; Set TXIC register to 00h NOP ; NOP FSET I ; Enable interrupts Example 2: Use dummy read to delay FSET instruction INT_SWITCH2: FCLR I ; Disable interrupts AND.B #00H,0056H ; Set TXIC register to 00h MOV.W MEM,R0 ; Dummy read FSET I ; Enable interrupts Example 3: Use POPC instruction to change I flag INT_SWITCH3: PUSHC FLG FCLR I ; Disable interrupts AND.B #00H,0056H ; Set TXIC register to 00h POPC FLG ; Enable interrupts Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 299 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 20.3 20.3.1 20. Usage Notes Precautions on Timers Notes on Timer X • Timer X stops counting after a reset. Set the values in the timer and prescaler before the count starts. • Even if the prescaler and timer are read out in 16-bit units, these registers are read 1 byte at a time by the MCU. Consequently, the timer value may be updated during the period when these two registers are being read. • Do not rewrite bits TXMOD0 to TXMOD1, and bits TXMOD2 and TXS simultaneously. • In pulse period measurement mode, bits TXEDG and TXUND in the TXMR register can be set to 0 by writing 0 to these bits by a program. However, these bits remain unchanged if 1 is written. When using the READ-MODIFY-WRITE instruction for the TXMR register, the TXEDG or TXUND bit may be set to 0 although these bits are set to 1 while the instruction is being executed. In this case, write 1 to the TXEDG or TXUND bit which is not supposed to be set to 0 with the MOV instruction. • When changing to pulse period measurement mode from another mode, the contents of bits TXEDG and TXUND are undefined. Write 0 to bits TXEDG and TXUND before the count starts. • The TXEDG bit may be set to 1 by the prescaler X underflow generated after the count starts. • When using the pulse period measurement mode, leave two or more periods of the prescaler X immediately after the count starts, then set the TXEDG bit to 0. • The TXS bit in the TXMR register has a function to instruct timer X to start or stop counting and a function to indicate that the count has started or stopped. 0 (count stops) can be read until the following count source is applied after 1 (count starts) is written to the TXS bit while the count is being stopped. If the following count source is applied, 1 can be read from the TXS bit. After writing 1 to the TXS bit, do not access registers associated with timer X (registers TXMR, PREX, TX, TCSS, and TXIC) except for the TXS bit, until 1 can be read from the TXS bit. The count starts at the following count source after the TXS bit is set to 1. Also, after writing 0 (count stops) to the TXS bit during the count, timer X stops counting at the following count source. 1 (count starts) can be read by reading the TXS bit until the count stops after writing 0 to the TXS bit. After writing 0 to the TXS bit, do not access registers associated with timer X except for the TXS bit, until 0 can be read from the TXS bit. 20.3.2 Notes on Timer Z • Timer Z stops counting after a reset. Set the values in the timer and prescaler before the count starts. • Even if the prescaler and timer are read out in 16-bit units, these registers are read 1 byte at a time by the MCU. Consequently, the timer value may be updated during the period when these two registers are being read. • Do not rewrite bits TZMOD0 to TZMOD1, and the TZS bit simultaneously. • In programmable one-shot generation mode, and programmable wait one-shot generation mode, when setting the TZS bit in the TZMR register to 0 (stops counting) or setting the TZOS bit in the TZOC register to 0 (stops one-shot), the timer reloads the value of the reload register and stops. Therefore, in programmable one-shot generation mode and programmable wait one-shot generation mode read the timer count value before the timer stops. • The TZS bit in the TZMR register has a function to instruct timer Z to start or stop counting and a function to indicate that the count has started or stopped. 0 (count stops) can be read until the following count source is applied after 1 (count starts) is written to the TZS bit while the count is being stopped. If the following count source is applied, 1 can be read from the TZS bit. After writing 1 to the TZS bit, do not access registers associated with timer Z (registers TZMR, PREZ, TZSC, TZPR, TZOC, PUM, TCSC, and TZIC) except for the TZS bit, until 1 can be read from the TZS bit. The count starts at the following count source after the TZS bit is set to 1. Also, after writing 0 (count stops) to the TZS bit during the count, timer Z stops counting at the following count source. 1 (count starts) can be read by reading the TZS bit until the count stops after writing 0 to the TZS bit. After writing 0 to the TZS bit, do not access registers associated with timer Z except for the TZS bit, until 0 can be read from the TZS bit. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 300 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 20.3.3 20. Usage Notes Notes on Timer C Access registers TC, TM0, and TM1 in 16-bit units. The TC register can be read in 16-bit units. This prevents the timer value from being updated between when the low-order bytes and high-order bytes are being read. Example of reading timer C: MOV.W 0090H,R0 Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 ; Read out timer C Page 301 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 20.4 20. Usage Notes Notes on Serial Interface • When reading data from the U0RB register either in the clock asynchronous serial I/O mode or in the clock synchronous serial I/O mode. Ensure the data is read in 16-bit units. When the high-order byte of the U0RB register is read, bits PER and FER in the U0RB register and the RI bit in the U0C1 register are set to 0. To check receive errors, read the UiRB register and then use the read data. Example (when reading receive buffer register): MOV.W 00A6H,R0 ; Read the U0RB register • When writing data to the U0TB register in the clock asynchronous serial I/O mode with 9-bit transfer data length, write data to the high-order byte first then the low-order byte, in 8-bit units. Example (when reading transmit buffer register): MOV.B #XXH,00A3H ; Write the high-order byte of U0TB register MOV.B #XXH,00A2H ; Write the low-order byte of U0TB register Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 302 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 20.5 20. Usage Notes Precautions on Clock Synchronous Serial Interface 20.5.1 Notes on Clock Synchronous Serial I/O with Chip Select Set the IICSEL bit in the PMR register to 0 (select clock synchronous serial I/O with chip select function) to use the clock synchronous serial I/O with chip select function. 20.5.1.1 Accessing Registers Associated with Clock Synchronous Serial I/O with Chip Select After waiting three instructions or more after writing to the registers associated with clock synchronous serial I/ O with chip select (00B8h to 00BFh) or four cycles or more after writing to them, read the registers. • An example of waiting three instructions or more Program example MOV.B #00h,00BBh NOP NOP NOP MOV.B 00BBh,R0L • An example of waiting four cycles or more Program example BCLR 4,00BBh JMP.B NEXT NEXT: BSET 3,00BBh 20.5.1.2 ; Set the SSER register to 00h. : Disable transmission : Enable reception Selecting SSI Signal Pin Set the SOOS bit in the SSMR2 register to 0 (CMOS output) in the following settings: • SSUMS bit in SSMR2 register = 1 (4-wire bus communication mode) • BIDE bit in SSMR2 register = 0 (standard mode) • MSS bit in SSCRH register = 0 (operate as slave device) • SSISEL bit in PMR register = 1 (use P1_6 pin for SSI01 pin) Do not use the SSI01 pin with NMOS open drain output for the above settings. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 303 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 20.5.2 20. Usage Notes Notes on I2C bus Interface Set the IICSEL bit in the PMR register to 1 (select I2C bus interface function) to use the I2C bus interface. 20.5.2.1 Accessing of Registers Associated with I2C bus Interface Wait for three instructions or more or four cycles or more after writing to the same register among the registers associated with the I2C bus Interface (00B8h to 00BFh) before reading it. • An example of waiting three instructions or more Program example MOV.B #00h,00BBh NOP NOP NOP MOV.B 00BBh,R0L • An example of waiting four cycles or more Program example BCLR 6,00BBh JMP.B NEXT NEXT: BSET 7,00BBh Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 304 of 315 ; Set ICIER register to 00h ; Disable transmit end interrupt request ; Enable transmit data empty interrupt request R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 20.6 20. Usage Notes Notes on A/D Converter • Write to each bit (other than bit 6) in the ADCON0 register, each bit in the ADCON1 register, or the SMP bit in the ADCON2 register when A/D conversion is stopped (before a trigger occurs). • When the VCUT bit in the ADCON1 register is changed from 0 (VREF not connected) to 1 (VREF connected), wait for at least 1 µs before starting A/D conversion. • After changing the A/D operating mode, select an analog input pin again. • When using the one-shot mode, ensure that A/D conversion is completed before reading the AD register. The IR bit in the ADIC register or the ADST bit in the ADCON0 register can be used to determine whether A/D conversion is completed. • When using the repeat mode, use the undivided main clock as the CPU clock. • If the ADST bit in the ADCON0 register is set to 0 (A/D conversion stops) by a program and A/ D conversion is forcibly terminated during an A/D conversion operation, the conversion result of the A/D converter will be undefined. If the ADST bit is set to 0 by a program, do not use the value of the AD register. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 305 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 20.7 20. Usage Notes Notes on Flash Memory 20.7.1 CPU Rewrite Mode 20.7.1.1 Operating Speed Before entering CPU rewrite mode (EW0 mode), select 5 MHz or below for the CPU clock using the CM06 bit in the CM0 register and bits CM16 to CM17 in the CM1 register. This does not apply to EW1 mode. 20.7.1.2 Prohibited Instructions The following instructions cannot be used in EW0 mode because they reference data in the flash memory: UND, INTO, and BRK. 20.7.1.3 Interrupts Table 20.1 lists the EW0 Mode Interrupts and Table 20.2 lists the EW1 Mode Interrupts. Table 20.1 Mode EW0 Mode Interrupts When Watchdog Timer, Oscillation Stop Detection and Voltage Monitor 2 Interrupt Request is Acknowledged Any interrupt can be used Once an interrupt request is acknowledged, by allocating a vector in auto-programming or auto-erasure is RAM forcibly stopped immediately and the flash memory is reset. Interrupt handling starts after the fixed period and the flash memory restarts. Since the block during autoerasure or the address during autoprogramming is forcibly stopped, the normal value may not be read. Execute auto-erasure again and ensure it completes normally. Since the watchdog timer does not stop during the command operation, interrupt requests may be generated. Reset the watchdog timer regularly. When Maskable Interrupt Request is Acknowledged Status EW0 During auto-erasure Auto-programming NOTES: 1. Do not use the address match interrupt while a command is being executed because the vector of the address match interrupt is allocated in ROM. 2. Do not use a non-maskable interrupt while block 0 is being automatically erased because the fixed vector is allocated in block 0. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 306 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group Table 20.2 Mode 20. Usage Notes EW1 Mode Interrupts When Watchdog Timer, Oscillation Stop Detection and Voltage Monitor 2 Interrupt Request is Acknowledged Auto-erasure is suspended after Once an interrupt request is td(SR-SUS) and interrupt handling acknowledged, auto-programming or is executed. Auto-erasure can be auto-erasure is forcibly stopped restarted by setting the FMR41 bit immediately and the flash memory is in the FMR4 register to 0 (erase reset. Interrupt handling starts after restart) after interrupt handling the fixed period and the flash memory completes. restarts. Since the block during autoAuto-erasure has priority and the erasure or the address during autoprogramming is forcibly stopped, the interrupt request normal value may not be read. acknowledgement is put on Execute auto-erasure again and standby. Interrupt handling is ensure it completes normally. executed after auto-erasure Since the watchdog timer does not completes. Auto-programming is suspended stop during the command operation, interrupt requests may be generated. after td(SR-SUS) and interrupt Reset the watchdog timer regularly handling is executed. Autoprogramming can be restarted by using the erase-suspend function. setting the FMR42 bit in the FMR4 register to 0 (program restart) after interrupt handling completes. Auto-programming has priority and the interrupt request acknowledgement is put on standby. Interrupt handling is executed after auto-programming completes. When Maskable Interrupt Request is Acknowledged Status EW1 During auto-erasure (erase- suspend function enabled) During auto-erasure (erase- suspend function disabled) During autoprogramming (program suspend function enabled) During autoprogramming (program suspend function disabled) NOTES: 1. Do not use the address match interrupt while a command is executing because the vector of the address match interrupt is allocated in ROM. 2. Do not use a non-maskable interrupt while block 0 is being automatically erased because the fixed vector is allocated in block 0. 20.7.1.4 How to Access Write 0 before writing 1 when setting the FMR01, FMR02, or FMR11 bit to 1. Do not generate an interrupt between writing 0 and 1. 20.7.1.5 Rewriting User ROM Area In EW0 Mode, if the supply voltage drops while rewriting any block in which a rewrite control program is stored, it may not be possible to rewrite the flash memory because the rewrite control program cannot be rewritten correctly. In this case, use standard serial I/O mode. 20.7.1.6 Program Do not write additions to the already programmed address. 20.7.1.7 Entering Stop Mode or Wait Mode Do not enter stop mode or wait mode during erase-suspend. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 307 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 20.8 20. Usage Notes Notes on Noise 20.8.1 Inserting a Bypass Capacitor between VCC and VSS Pins as a Countermeasure against Noise and Latch-Up Connect a bypass capacitor (at least 0.1 µF) using the shortest and thickest wire possible. 20.8.2 Countermeasures against Noise Error of Port Control Registers During rigorous noise testing or the like, external noise (mainly power supply system noise) can exceed the capacity of the MCU’s internal noise control circuitry. In such cases the contents of the port related registers may be changed. As a firmware countermeasure, it is recommended that the port registers, port direction registers, and pull-up control registers will be reset periodically. However, examine the control processing fully before introducing the reset routine as conflicts may be created between the reset routine and interrupt routines. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 308 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group 21. Notes on On-Chip Debugger 21. Notes on On-Chip Debugger When using on-chip debugger to develop and debug programs for the R8C/1A Group and R8C/1B Group, take note of the following. (1) (2) (3) (4) Do not access the related UART1 registers. Some of the user flash memory and RAM areas are used by the on-ship debugger. These areas cannot be accessed by the user. Refer to the on-chip debugger manual for which areas are used. Do not set the address match interrupt (registers AIER, RMAD0, and RMAD1 and fixed vector tables) in a user system. Do not use the BRK instruction in a user system. Connecting and using the on-chip debugger has some special restrictions. Refer to the on-chip debugger manual for on-chip debugger details. Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 309 of 315 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group Appendix 1. Package Dimensions Appendix 1. Package Dimensions Diagrams showing the latest package dimensions and mounting information are available in the “Packages” section of the Renesas Technology website. JEITA Package Code P-LSSOP20-4.4x6.5-0.65 RENESAS Code PLSP0020JB-A Previous Code 20P2F-A 11 *1 E 20 HE MASS[Typ.] 0.1g NOTE) 1. DIMENSIONS "*1" AND "*2" DO NOT INCLUDE MOLD FLASH. 2. DIMENSION "*3" DOES NOT INCLUDE TRIM OFFSET. F 1 10 Index mark c A1 Reference Dimension in Millimeters Symbol D D E A2 A A1 bp c A L *2 A2 *3 e bp Detail F y HE e y L RENESAS Code PRDP0020BA-A Previous Code 20P4B Nom Max 6.5 6.6 4.4 4.5 1.15 1.45 0.1 0.2 0 0.17 0.22 0.32 0.13 0.15 0.2 0° 10° 6.2 6.4 6.6 0.53 0.65 0.77 0.10 0.3 0.5 0.7 MASS[Typ.] 1.0g 11 1 10 c *1 E 20 e1 JEITA Package Code P-SDIP20-6.3x19-1.78 Min 6.4 4.3 NOTE) 1. DIMENSIONS "*1" AND "*2" DO NOT INCLUDE MOLD FLASH. 2. DIMENSION "*3" DOES NOT INCLUDE TRIM OFFSET. D A A2 *2 L A1 Reference Symbol *3 b 3 e SEATING PLANE bp e1 D E A A1 A2 bp b3 c e L Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 310 of 315 Dimension in Millimeters Min Nom Max 7.32 7.62 7.92 18.8 19.0 19.2 6.15 6.3 6.45 4.5 0.51 3.3 0.38 0.48 0.58 0.9 1.0 1.3 0.22 0.27 0.34 15° 0° 1.528 1.778 2.028 3.0 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group JEITA Package Code P-HWQFN28-5x5-0.50 Appendix 1. Package Dimensions RENESAS Code PWQN0028KA-B *1 Previous Code 28PJW-B MASS[Typ.] 0.05g D 15 21 21 15 22 14 14 22 E1 *2 E D2 8 28 Lp 28 8 7 7 1 e bp 1 NOTE) 1. DIMENSIONS "*1" AND "*2" DO NOT INCLUDE MOLD FLASH. x y Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 A1 F Page 311 of 315 Detail F A A2 Reference Symbol D E A2 A A1 bp e Lp x y D2 E1 Dimension in Millimeters Min Nom Max 4.9 5.0 5.1 4.9 5.0 5.1 0.75 0.8 0 0 0.05 0.15 0.2 0.25 0.5 0.5 0.6 0.7 0.05 0.05 2.0 2.0 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B GroupAppendix 2. Connection Examples between Serial Writer and On-Chip Debugging Appendix 2. Connection Examples between Serial Writer and On-Chip Debugging Emulator Appendix Figure 2.1 shows a Connection Example with M16C Flash Starter (M3A-0806) and Appendix Figure 2.2 shows a Connection Example with E8 Emulator (R0E000080KCE00). TXD 20 2 19 R8C/1A, R8C/1B Group (2) 1 3 RESET Connect oscillation circuit(1) VSS 4 5 6 7 MODE 8 18 17 16 VCC 15 14 13 9 12 10 11 10 TXD 7 VSS RXD 4 1 VCC M16C flash starter (M3A-0806) RXD NOTES: 1. An oscillation circuit must be connected, even when operating with the on-chip oscillator clock. 2. Connect an external reset circuit. Appendix Figure 2.1 Connection Example with M16C Flash Starter (M3A-0806) 20 2 19 3 Connect oscillation circuit(1) User reset signal VSS 4 5 6 7 8 14 13 12 RESET 8 18 17 16 15 14 13 9 12 10 11 MODE 10 VCC 4.7 kΩ R8C/1A, R8C/1B Group 1 7 MODE 6 4 2 VSS E8 emulator (R0E000080KCE00) Appendix Figure 2.2 Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 NOTE: 1. It is not necessary to connect an oscillation circuit when operating with the on-chip oscillator clock. Connection Example with E8 Emulator (R0E000080KCE00) Page 312 of 315 VCC R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group Appendix 3. Example of Oscillation Evaluation Circuit Appendix 3. Example of Oscillation Evaluation Circuit Appendix Figure 3.1 shows an Example of Oscillation Evaluation Circuit. 20 2 19 3 4 Connect oscillation circuit VSS 5 6 7 8 R8C/1A, R8C/1B Group RESET 1 Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 16 15 14 13 12 10 11 Example of Oscillation Evaluation Circuit Page 313 of 315 17 9 NOTE: 1. Write a program to perform the evaluation. Appendix Figure 3.1 18 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group Register Index Register Index A AD .......................................................... 235 ADCON0 ................................................ 234 ADCON1 ................................................ 234 ADCON2 ................................................ 235 ADIC ........................................................ 83 AIER ......................................................... 99 K KIEN .........................................................97 KUPIC .......................................................83 O OCD ..........................................................62 OFS ................................................104, 250 C P CM0 ......................................................... 60 CM1 ......................................................... 61 CMP0IC ................................................... 83 CMP1IC ................................................... 83 CSPR ..................................................... 105 D DRR ......................................................... 31 F FMR0 ..................................................... 255 FMR1 ..................................................... 256 FMR4 ..................................................... 257 H HRA0 ....................................................... 63 HRA1 ....................................................... 64 HRA2 ....................................................... 64 R RMAD0 .....................................................99 RMAD1 .....................................................99 S I ICCR1 .................................................... 202 ICCR2 .................................................... 203 ICDRR .................................................... 208 ICDRS .................................................... 208 ICDRT .................................................... 207 ICIER ..................................................... 205 ICMR ...................................................... 204 ICSR ...................................................... 206 INT0F ....................................................... 91 INT0IC ...................................................... 84 INT1IC ...................................................... 83 INT3IC ...................................................... 83 INTEN ...................................................... 91 Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 P1 .............................................................29 P3 .............................................................29 P4 .............................................................30 PD1 ...........................................................29 PD3 ...........................................................29 PD4 ...........................................................29 PM0 ..........................................................55 PM1 ..........................................................56 PMR ..........................................30, 178, 208 PRCR ........................................................77 PREX ......................................................111 PREZ ......................................................125 PUM ........................................................126 PUR0 ........................................................31 PUR1 ........................................................31 Page 314 of 315 S0RIC .......................................................83 S0TIC ........................................................83 S1RIC .......................................................83 S1TIC ........................................................83 SAR ........................................................207 SSCRH ...................................................172 SSCRL ....................................................173 SSER ......................................................175 SSMR .....................................................174 SSMR2 ...................................................177 SSRDR ...................................................178 SSSR ......................................................176 SSTDR ....................................................178 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group T TC .......................................................... 143 TCC0 ...................................................... 144 TCC1 ...................................................... 145 TCIC ......................................................... 83 TCOUT ................................................... 146 TCSS ............................................. 111, 127 TM0 ........................................................ 143 TM1 ........................................................ 143 TX .......................................................... 111 TXIC ......................................................... 83 TXMR ..................................................... 110 TZIC ......................................................... 83 TZMR ..................................................... 124 TZOC ..................................................... 126 TZPR ...................................................... 125 TZSC ...................................................... 125 U U0BRG ................................................... 154 U0C0 ...................................................... 156 U0C1 ...................................................... 157 U0MR ..................................................... 155 U0RB ..................................................... 154 U0TB ...................................................... 154 U1BRG ................................................... 154 U1C0 ...................................................... 156 U1C1 ...................................................... 157 U1MR ..................................................... 155 U1RB ..................................................... 154 U1TB ...................................................... 154 UCON .................................................... 157 V VCA1 ........................................................ 47 VCA2 ........................................................ 47 VW1C ....................................................... 48 VW2C ....................................................... 49 W WDC ...................................................... 104 WDTR .................................................... 105 WDTS .................................................... 105 Rev.1.30 Dec 08, 2006 REJ09B0252-0130 Page 315 of 315 Register Index REVISION HISTORY REVISION HISTORY Rev. Date 0.10 Jun 30, 2005 1.00 Sep 09, 2005 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group Hardware Manual R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group Hardware Manual Description Page − Summary First Edition issued all pages “Under development” deleted 3 Table 1.2 Performance Outline of the R8C/1B Group; Flash Memory: (Data area) → (Data flash) (Program area) → (Program ROM) revised 4 Figure 1.1 Block Diagram; “Peripheral Function” added, “System Clock Generation” → “System Clock Generator” revised 5 Table 1.3 Product Information of R8C/1A Group; “(D)” and “(D): Under development” deleted 6 Table 1.4 Product Information of R8C/1B Group; “(D)” and “(D): Under development” deleted ROM capacity: “Program area” → “Program ROM”, “Data area” → “Data flash” revised 9 Table 1.5 Pin Description; Power Supply Input: “VCC/AVCC” → “VCC”, “VSS/AVSS” → “VSS” revised Analog Power Supply Input: added 11 Figure 2.1 CPU Register; “Reserved Area” → “Reserved Bit” revised 13 2.8.10 Reserved Area; “Reserved Area” → “Reserved Bit” revised 15 3.2 R8C/1B Group, Figure 3.2 Memory Map of R8C/1B Group; “Data area” → “Data flash”, “Program area” → “Program ROM” revised 17 Table 4.2 SFR Information(2); 004Fh: SSU/IIC Interrupt Control Register(2) SSUAIC/IIC2AIC XXXXX000b added NOTE2 added 18 Table 4.3 SFR Information(3); 0085h: “Prescaler Z” → “Prescaler Z Register” 0086h: “Timer Z Secondary” → “Timer Z Secondary Register” 0087h: “Timer Z Primary” → “Timer Z Primary Register” 008Ch: “Prescaler X” → “Prescaler X Register” 008Dh: “Timer X” → “Timer X Register” 0090h, 0091h: “Timer C” → “Timer C Register” revised 20 to 39 “5. Reset” → “5. Programmable I/O Ports” and “6. Programmable I/O Ports” → “6. Reset” revised 31 Table 5.13 Port P3_4/SCS/SDA/CMP1_1 Setting “SCS” → “SCS” Table 5.14 Port P3_5/SSCK/SCL/CMP1_2 Setting “SSK” → “SSCK” C-1 REVISION HISTORY Rev. Date 1.00 Sep 09, 2005 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group Hardware Manual Description Page Summary 33 Table 5.18 Unassigned Pin Handling, Figure 5.11 Unassigned Pin Handling; “Port P4_2, P4_6, P4_7” → “Port P4_6, P4_7” “VREF” → “Port P4_2/VREF” revised 53 Table 9.2 Bus Cycles for Access Space of the R8C/1B Group added, Table 9.3 Access Unit and Bus Operation; “SFR” → “SFR, Data flash”, “ROM/RAM” → “Program ROM, ROM, RAM” revised 62 10.2.1 Low-speed On-Chip Oscillator Clock; “The application products ... to accommodate the frequency range.” → “The application products ... for the frequency change.” revised 10.2.2 High-Speed On-Chip Oscillator Clock; “The high-speed on-chip oscillator frequency ... for details.” added 69 10.5.1 How to Use Oscillation Stop Detection Function; “This function cannot ... is 2 MHz or below.” → “This function cannot be ... is below 2 MHz.” revised 70 Figure 10.9 Procedure of Switching Clock Source From Low-Speed OnChip Oscillator to Main Clock revised 71 10.6.2 Oscillation Stop Detection Function; “Since the oscillation ...frequency is 2MHz or below, ...” → “Since the oscillation ...frequency is below 2MHz, ...” revised 10.6.4 High-Speed On-Ship Oscillator Clock added. 85 Figure 12.10 Judgement Circuit of Interrupts Priority Level; NOTE2 deleted 104 Figure 14.1 Block Diagram of Timer X; “Peripheral data bus” → “Data Bus” revised 117 14.1.6 Precautions on Timer X; “When writing “1” (count starts) to ... writing “1” to the TXS bit.” → ‘ “0” (count stops) can be read ... after the TXS bit is set to “1”.’ revised 118 Figure 14.11 Block Diagram of Timer Z; “Peripheral Data Bus” → “Data Bus” revised 135 14.2.5 Precautions on Timer Z; “When writing “1” (count starts) to ... writing “1” to the TZS bit.” → ‘ “0” (count stops) can be read ... after the TZS bit is set to “1”.’ revised 149 Figure 15.3 U0TB to U1TB, U0RB to U1RB and U0BRG to U1BRG Registers; “UARTi Transmit Buffer Register (i=0 to 1)” and “UARTi Receive Buffer Register (i=0 to 1)” revised 159 Table 15.5 Registers to Be Used and Settings in UART Mode; UiBRG: “−” → “0 to 7” revised 164 Table 16.1 Mode Selection; “RE and TE Bits in SSER Register” added 193 16.2.8.2 Selecting SSI Signal Pin added C-2 REVISION HISTORY Rev. Date 1.00 Sep 09, 2005 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group Hardware Manual Description Page Summary 222 Figure 16.46 Example of Register Setting in Master Transmit Mode (Clock Synchronous Serial Mode); ‘ “• Set the IICSEL bit in the PMR register to “1” ’ added 227 Table 17.1 Performance of A/D Converter • Analog Input Voltage: “0V to Vref” → “0V to AVCC” revised • NOTE1: “When the analog input voltage ... FFh in 8-bit mode.” added 228 Figure 17.1 Block Diagram of A/D Converter; “Vref” → “Vcom” revised 239 Table 18.1 Flash Memory Version Performance; Program and Erase Endurance: (Program area) → (Program ROM), (Data area) → (Data flash) revised 241 18.2 Memory Map; “The user ROM ... area ... Block A and B.” → “The user ROM ... area (program ROM) ... Block A and B (data flash).” revised Figure 18.1 Flash Memory Block Diagram for R8C/1A Group revised 242 Figure 18.2 Flash Memory Block Diagram for R8C/1B Group revised 257 18.4.3.5 Block Erase “The block erase command cannot ... program-suspend.” added 270 Table 19.3 A/D Converter Characteristics; Vref and VIA: Standard value, NOTE4 revised 271 Table 19.4 Flash Memory (Program ROM) Electrical Characteristics; NOTES3 and 5 revised, NOTE8 deleted 272 Table 19.5 Flash Memory (Data flash Block A, Block B) Electrical Characteristics; NOTES1 and 3 revised 274 Table 19.8 Reset Circuit Electrical Characteristics (When Using Voltage Monitor 1 Reset); NOTE2 revised 275 Table 19.10 High-speed On-Chip Oscillator Circuit Electrical Characteristics; “High-Speed On-Chip Oscillator ...” → “High-Speed On-Chip Oscillator Frequency ...” revised NOTE2 added 282 Table 19.15 Electrical Characteristics (2) [Vcc = 5V]; NOTE1 deleted 286 Table 19.22 Electrical Characteristics (4) [Vcc = 3V]; NOTE1 deleted 293 20.3.1 Precautions on Timer X; “When writing “1” (count starts) to ... writing “1” to the TXS bit.” → ‘ “0” (count stops) can be read ... after the TXS bit is set to “1”.’ revised 20.3.2 Precautions on Timer Z; “When writing “1” (count starts) to ... writing “1” to the TZS bit.” → ‘ “0” (count stops) can be read ... after the TZS bit is set to “1”.’ revised 296 20.5.1.2 Selecting SSI Signal Pin added 302 21.Precautions on On-Chip Debugger; (1) added C-3 REVISION HISTORY Rev. Date 1.10 Mar 17, 2006 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group Hardware Manual Description Page Summary − Products of PWQN0028KA-B package included 1 “or SDIP” → “SDIP or a 28-pin plastic molded-HWQFN” 2, 3 Table 1.1, Table 1.2; “28-pin molded-plastic HWQFN” added 5, 6 Table 1.3, Table 1.4; Type No. added, deleted 9 Figure 1.6 added 12 Table 1.7 added 16, 17 Figure 3.1, Figure 3.2; Part Number added, deleted 40 6.2 “When a capacitor is connected to ... pin 0.8VCC or more.” added 57 Figure 10.1 revised 66 Table 10.2; CM1 Register; CM17, CM16 revised 101 Figure 13.2; Option Function Select Register: NOTE 1 revised, NOTE 2 revised Watchdog Timer Control Register: NOTE 1 deleted 110 Table 14.3; NOTE 1 added 139 Figure 14.25 revised 146 Table 14.12; NOTE 1 revised 151 Figure 15.3; NOTE 3 added 153 Figure 15.5; NOTE 1 added 166 Table 16.1 revised 167 Table 16.2; NOTE 1 deleted 175 Figure 16.8 SS Transmit Data Register; The last NOTE 1 deleted 182, 186, 16.2.5.2, 16.2.5.4, 16.2.6.2 190 “When setting the microcomputer to....continuous transmit is enabled.” deleted 183, 187 Figure 16.14 NOTE 2 deleted 235 Table 17.3 revised 240 17.7 added 248 18.3.2; “To disable ROM code protect ....” revised Figure 18.4; NOTE 1 revised, NOTE 2 added 253 Figure 18.5; NOTE 6 added 263 Table 18.5; Value after Reset revised 265 Figure 18.15 revised 275 Table 19.4; “Topr” → “Ambient temperature”, Conditions: VCC = 5.0 V at Topr = 25 °C deleted, NOTE 8 added 276 Table 19.5; “Topr” → “Ambient temperature”, Conditions: VCC = 5.0 V at Topr = 25 °C deleted, NOTE 9 added 279 Table 19.10; NOTE 3 added 280 Table 19.12; Standard of tSA and tOR revised, NOTE: 1. VCC = 2.2 to → 2.7 to C-4 REVISION HISTORY Rev. Date 1.10 Mar 17, 2006 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group Hardware Manual Description Page 284 Summary Table 19.13; NOTE: 1. VCC = 2.2 to → 2.7 to 286, 290 Table 19.15, Table 19.22; The title revised, Condition of Stop Mode “Topr = 25 °C” added 288, 292 Table 19.19, Table 19.26; Standard of td(C-Q) and tsu(D-C) revised 307,308 Package Dimensions revised, added 1.20 Oct 03, 2006 309 Appendix Figure 2.1 revised 310 Appendix Figure 3.1 revised all pages Y version added Factory programming product added 2, 3 Table 1.1, Table 1.2; Specification Interrupts: “Internal: 9 sources” → “Internal: 11 sources” 34 Table 5.12 Setting Value revised 39 Table 6.2 “Pin Functions after Reset” → “Pin Functions while RESET Pin Level is “L”” 64 Figure 10.6; HRA1 NOTE 2 added, HRA2 NOTE 5 added 75 10.6.1 revised, 10.6.2 added 103 Figure 13.2; WDC: After Reset “When read, the content is undefined.” added 120 Figure 14.10 pulled up added, NOTE 6 “In this case, .... of the read-out buffer.” deleted, NOTE 7 deleted 164 Figure 15.10 revised 172 Figure 16.3; SSCRL NOTE 2 revised 203 Figure 16.26 NOTE 3 revised 210 to 215 Figure 16.32 to Figure 16.36 revised 1.30 Dec 08, 2006 250 Table 18.3 Item; Modes after read status register added 257 Figure 18.8 revised 260 18.4.3.1 “In addition, .... after a reset.” added 18.4.3.2 “The MCU remains in read .... command is written.” added 261 18.4.3.4 “The FMR00 bit is set to 0 during .... 1 when auto-programming completes.” → “When suspend function .... 0 when autoprogramming completes.” revised 262 Figure 18.13 added 264 Figure 18.15 revised 267 Figure 18.16 revised 275 Table 19.2; Parameter: System clock added 308 21. (2) revised, (5) deleted 310 Package Dimensions; PWQN0028KA-B revised 20 Table 4.1; 000Fh: After reset “000XXXXXb” → “00X11111b” 36 Table 5.17 Setting Value revised 60 Figure 10.2 NOTE 4 revised C-5 REVISION HISTORY Rev. Date 1.30 Dec 08, 2006 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group Hardware Manual Description Page Summary 71 Figure 10.8 added 73 Figure 10.9 added 76 10.6.1 revised 10.6.2 “Program example to execute the WAIT instruction” revised 98 Table 12.6 revised 104 Figure 13.2; WDC After Reset “00011111b” → “00X11111b” 160 Figure 15.7 revised 165 Figure 15.10 revised 168 15.3 “To check receive errors, read the UiRB register and then use the read data.” added 202 Figure 16.24 NOTE 1 revised 234 Figure 17.2; ADCON0 NOTE 2 revised 236 Table 17.2 Stop conditions “when the ADCAP bit is set to 0 (software trigger)” added 237 Figure 17.4; ADCON0 NOTE 2 revised 239 Figure 17.5; ADCON0 NOTE 2 revised 252 18.4.1, 18.4.2 td(SR-ES) → td(SR-SUS) 276 Table 19.2; Parameter: OCD2 = 1 On-chip oscillator clock selected revised 296 20.1.1 revised 20.1.2 “Program example to execute the WAIT instruction” revised C-6 R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group Hardware Manual Publication Date : Rev.0.10 Rev.1.30 Jun 30, 2005 Dec 08, 2006 Published by : Sales Strategic Planning Div. Renesas Technology Corp. © 2006. Renesas Technology Corp., All rights reserved. Printed in Japan R8C/1A Group, R8C/1B Group Hardware Manual 2-6-2, Ote-machi, Chiyoda-ku, Tokyo, 100-0004, Japan